UNITED STATES
SECURITIES AND EXCHANGE COMMISSION
WASHINGTON, D.C. 20549

 

FORM 20-F

 

(Mark One)

REGISTRATION STATEMENT PURSUANT TO SECTION 12(B) OR 12(G)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

OR

 

ANNUAL REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(D)
OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

For the fiscal year ended December 31, 2019

 

OR

 

TRANSITION REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(D) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

OR

 

SHELL COMPANY REPORT PURSUANT TO SECTION 13 OR 15(D) OF THE SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

Commission File Number: 001-39171

 

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED
(Exact name of Registrant as specified in its charter)

 

Not applicable   Cayman Islands
(Translation of Registrant’s name into English)   (Jurisdiction of incorporation or organization)

 

c/o Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE

P.O. Box 50170

Fujairah, United Arab Emirates

+971 9 201 6666

(Address of Principal Executive Offices)

 

Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper

P.O. Box 50170

Fujairah, United Arab Emirates

+971 9 201 6666

nico.paardenkooper@bpgic.com

(Name, Telephone, Email and/or Facsimile number and Address of Company Contact Person)

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(b) of the Act:

 

Title of each class   Trading Symbol(s)   Name of each exchange on which registered
Ordinary shares, $0.0001 par value per share   BROG   The Nasdaq Stock Market LLC
Warrants to purchase ordinary shares   BROGW   The Nasdaq Stock Market LLC

 

Securities registered or to be registered pursuant to Section 12(g) of the Act: None

 

Securities for which there is a reporting obligation pursuant to Section 15(d) of the Act: None

 

 

 

 

Indicate the number of outstanding shares of each of the issuer’s classes of capital or common stock as of the close of the period covered by the annual report: 109,587,754 ordinary shares

  

Indicate by check mark if the registrant is a well-known seasoned issuer, as defined in Rule 405 of the Securities Act. Yes ☐ No ☒

 

If this report is an annual or transition report, indicate by check mark if the registrant is not required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934. Yes ☐ No ☒

 

Note – Checking the box above will not relieve any registrant required to file reports pursuant to Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 from their obligations under those Sections.

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant: (1) has filed all reports required to be filed by Section 13 or 15(d) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to file such reports), and (2) has been subject to such filing requirements for the past 90 days. Yes ☒ No ☐

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant has submitted electronically and posted on its corporate Web site, if any, every Interactive Data File required to be submitted and posted pursuant to Rule 405 of Regulation S-T (§232.405 of this chapter) during the preceding 12 months (or for such shorter period that the registrant was required to submit and post such files). Yes ☒ No ☐

 

Indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a large accelerated filer, an accelerated filer, a non-accelerated filer or an emerging growth company. See definition of “accelerated filer, large accelerated filer and emerging growth company” in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act.

 

Large accelerated filer ☐     Accelerated filer ☐    Non-accelerated filer ☒    Emerging growth company ☒

 

If an emerging growth company that prepares its financial statements in accordance with U.S. GAAP, indicate by check mark if the registrant has elected not to use the extended transition period for complying with any new or revised financial accounting standards† provided pursuant to Section 13(a) of the Exchange Act. ☐

 

Indicate by check mark which basis of accounting the registrant has used to prepare the financial statements included in this filing:

 

US GAAP ☐   International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board ☒   Other ☐

 

If “Other” has been checked in response to the previous question indicate by check mark which financial statement item the registrant has elected to follow. Item 17 ☐ Item 18 ☐

 

If this is an annual report, indicate by check mark whether the registrant is a shell company (as defined in Rule 12b-2 of the Exchange Act). Yes ☐ No ☒

 

 

 

 

 

  

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

    Page
Reliance on Conditional Exemption from Filing Deadline ii
Cautionary Note Regarding Forward-Looking Statements iii
Explanatory Note iv
Implications of being an Emerging Growth Company v
   
PART I    
     
Item 1. Identity of Directors, Senior Management and Advisors 1
Item 2. Offer Statistics and Expected Timetable 1
Item 3. Key Information 1
Item 4. Information on the Company 29
Item 4A. Unresolved Staff Comments 58
Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects 58
Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees 102
Item 7. Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions 109
Item 8. Financial Information 116
Item 9. The Offer and Listing 118
Item 10. Additional Information 119
Item 11. Quantitative and Qualitative Disclosures About Market Risk 145
Item 12. Description of Securities Other than Equity Securities 147
     
PART II    
     
Item 13 Defaults, Dividend Arrearages and Delinquencies 148
Item 14 Material Modifications to the Rights of Security Holders and Use of Proceeds 150
Item 15 Controls and Procedures 150
Item 16A Audit committee financial expert 151
Item 16B Code of Ethics 151
Item 16C Principal Accountant Fees and Services 151
Item 16D Exemptions from the Listing Standards for Audit Committees 152
Item 16E Purchases of Equity Securities by the Issuer and Affiliated Purchasers 152
Item 16F Change in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant 152
Item 16G Corporate Governance 152
Item 16H Mine Safety Disclosure 153
     
PART III    
     
Item 17. Financial Statements 154
Item 18. Financial Statements 154
Item 19. Exhibits 154

 

-i-

 

  

RELIANCE ON CONDITIONAL EXEMPTION FROM FILING DEADLINE

 

Brooge Energy Limited (the “Company”) is filing this Annual Report on Form 20-F (the “Annual Report”) for the fiscal year ended December 31, 2019, after the April 30, 2020 deadline applicable to the Company for the filing of its Annual Report in reliance on the Order of the Securities and Exchange Commission (the “SEC”), issued on March 25, 2020, pursuant to Section 36 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934 (the “Exchange Act”), granting conditional exemptions from specified provisions of the Exchange Act and certain rules thereunder (Release No. 34-88465) (the “Order”), which permit a delay in filing of up to forty-five days due to circumstances related to the COVID-19 outbreak.

 

As previously disclosed on Form 6-K furnished by the Company on April 29, 2020, although the COVID-19 global pandemic caused little interruption to the operation of the Company’s oil storage facilities due to its highly automated and high-tech designs, it disrupted the operations of its management and corporate staff. In addition to voluntary measures the Company has taken to protect its staff, government authorities have at various recent times implemented lockdown or other measures restricting the movement of people, including staff, vendors and professionals. This has impacted the Company’s ability to efficiently perform work related to the financial statements and related materials necessary for the audit and, as a result, has delayed the completion of the audited consolidated financial statements and other information required to be included in the Annual Report.

 

On June 15, 2020, the Company filed a “Notification of Late Filing” on Form 12b-25 pursuant to Rule 12b-25 of the Exchange Act to further delay by 15 days the filing of the Company’s Annual Report for the year ended December 31, 2019. As previously disclosed on a Form 12b-25, the Annual Report for the year ended December 31, 2019 could not be filed without unreasonable effort and expense. The Company required additional time to compile, review and prepare certain information in its financial statements following delays resulting from the COVID-19 pandemic. As required by Form 12b-25, the Company has filed this Annual Report on Form 20-F on or prior to June 30, 2020.

 

-ii-

 

 

CAUTIONARY NOTE REGARDING FORWARD-LOOKING STATEMENTS

 

This Annual Report on Form 20-F (including information incorporated by reference herein, this “Report”) contains or may contain forward-looking statements as defined in Section 27A of the Securities Act, and Section 21E of the Exchange Act that involve significant risks and uncertainties. All statements other than statements of historical facts are forward-looking statements. These forward-looking statements include information about our possible or assumed future results of operations or our performance. Words such as “expects,” “intends,” “plans,” “believes,” “anticipates,” “estimates,” and variations of such words and similar expressions are intended to identify the forward-looking statements. The risk factors and cautionary language referred to or incorporated by reference in this Report provide examples of risks, uncertainties and events that may cause actual results to differ materially from the expectations described in our forward-looking statements, including among other things, the items identified in the Risk Factors section of this Report.

 

Readers are cautioned not to place undue reliance on these forward-looking statements, which speak only as of the date of this Report. Although we believe that the expectations reflected in such forward-looking statements are reasonable, there can be no assurance that such expectations will prove to be correct. These statements involve known and unknown risks and are based upon a number of assumptions and estimates which are inherently subject to significant uncertainties and contingencies, many of which are beyond our control. Actual results may differ materially from those expressed or implied by such forward-looking statements. We undertake no obligation to publicly update or revise any forward-looking statements contained in this Report, or the documents to which we refer readers in this Report, to reflect any change in our expectations with respect to such statements or any change in events, conditions or circumstances upon which any statement is based.

 

-iii-

 

  

EXPLANATORY NOTES

 

On April 15, 2019, (i) Twelve Seas Investment Company (now known as BPGIC International), a Cayman Islands exempted company (“Twelve Seas”), (ii) Brooge Energy Limited (f/k/a Brooge Holdings Limited), a Cayman Islands exempted company (the “Company”), (iii) Brooge Merger Sub Limited, a Cayman Islands exempted company, and a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company (“Merger Sub”), and (iv) Brooge Petroleum And Gas Investment Company FZE, a company formed under the laws of the Fujairah Free Zone, United Arab Emirates (“BPGIC”), entered into that certain Business Combination Agreement, pursuant to which BPGIC Holdings Limited (“BPGIC Holdings”), a Cayman Islands exempted company also become a party thereafter pursuant to the Assignment and Joinder to Business Combination Agreement dated as of November 19, 2019 (as assignee of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, a company formed under the laws of England and Wales, which became a party to the Business Combination Agreement pursuant to a Joinder to Business Combination Agreement dated as of May 10, 2019) (as amended prior to the date of Closing, including by the foregoing joinders and by the First Amendment to Business Combination Agreement, dated as of September 16, 2019, the “Business Combination Agreement”), pursuant to which, subject to the terms and conditions thereof, upon the consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby on December 20, 2019 (the “Closing”), among other matters, (a) Twelve Seas merged with and into Merger Sub, with Twelve Seas continuing as the surviving entity with the name BPGIC International (“BPGIC International”), and as a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company and with holders of the Twelve Seas’ securities receiving substantially equivalent securities of the Company, and (b) the Company acquired all of the issued and outstanding ordinary shares of BPGIC from BPGIC Holdings in exchange for Ordinary Shares of the Company, subject to the withholding of the escrow shares being deposited in the escrow account in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Business Combination Agreement and the escrow agreement, and with BPGIC becoming a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company (such transactions contemplated by the Business Combination Agreement, collectively, the “Business Combination”).

 

Upon consummation of the Business Combination pursuant to the terms of the Business Combination Agreement, the Company’s Ordinary Shares and warrants to purchase Ordinary Shares became listed on The Nasdaq Stock Market.

 

Unless otherwise indicated, “we,” “us,” “our,” “the Company,” “the Group” and similar terminology refers to Brooge Energy Limited, a company organized under the laws of the Cayman Islands, and its subsidiaries subsequent to the Business Combination.

 

-iv-

 

 

IMPLICATIONS OF BEING AN EMERGING GROWTH COMPANY

 

As a company with less than $1.07 billion in revenue during our last fiscal year, we qualify as an “emerging growth company” as defined in the Jumpstart Our Business Startups Act of 2012 (the “JOBS Act”). An emerging growth company may avail itself of certain exemptions from various reporting requirements that are applicable to other public companies that are not emerging growth companies. For example, we have elected to rely on an exemption from the auditor attestation requirements of Section 404 of the Sarbanes Oxley Act of 2002 (the “Sarbanes Oxley Act”) relating to internal control over financial reporting, and we will not provide such an attestation from our auditors.

 

We will remain an emerging growth company until the earliest of the following:

 

the end of the first fiscal year in which the market value of our Ordinary Shares that are held by non- affiliates is at least $700 million as of the end of the second quarter of such fiscal year;

 

the end of the first fiscal year in which we have total annual gross revenues of at least $1.07 billion;

 

the date on which we have issued more than $1 billion in non-convertible debt securities in any rolling three year period; or

 

December 31, 2024.

 

Once we cease to be an emerging growth company, we will not be entitled to the exemptions provided for by the JOBS Act emptions provided for by the JOBS Act.

 

-v-

 

 

PART I

 

ITEM 1. IDENTITY OF DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND ADVISERS

 

Not Applicable.

 

ITEM 2. OFFER STATISTICS AND EXPECTED TIMETABLE

 

Not Applicable.

 

ITEM 3. KEY INFORMATION

 

A. Selected Financial Data

 

The Company was formed solely to effectuate the Business Combination and to hold BPGIC. Following and as a result of the Business Combination, all of the Company’s business is conducted through BPGIC. The financial statements of the Company, BPGIC and BPGIC International have been prepared in United States Dollars (“$”).

 

Selected Financial Information

 

Consolidated Statements of Comprehensive Income for the years ended December 31, 2019, 2018 and 2017.

 

    2019     2018     2017  
    $     $     $  
                   
Revenue     44,085,374       35,839,268       89,593  
                         
Direct costs     (10,202,465 )     (9,607,360 )     (2,295,809 )
                         
GROSS PROFIT     33,882,909       26,231,908       (2,206,216 )
                         
Listing expenses     (101,773,877 )     -       -  
General and administrative expenses     (2,608,984 )     (2,029,260 )     (574,266 )
Finance costs     (5,730,535 )     (6,951,923 )     (966,926 )
Changes in fair value of derivative financial instruments     (328,176 )     (1,190,073 )     -  
                         
(LOSS) PROFIT AND TOTAL COMPREHENSIVE INCOME FOR THE YEAR     (76,558,663 )     16,060,652       (3,747,408 )
(Loss) / Earnings per share                        
-Basic and diluted     (0.95 )     0.20       (0.04 )
                         
Selected Non-IFRS Financial Data                        
                         
Adjusted EBITDA*     37,059,670       29,918,711       (2,087,954 )
                         
Adjusted EBITDA Margin     84.06 %     83.48 %     -  

 

* Adjusted EBITDA is defined as profit (loss) before finance costs, income tax expense (currently not applicable in the UAE but included here for reference purposes), depreciation, listing expenses and net change in the value of derivative financial instruments

 

1

 

 

Consolidated statements of financial position as of December 31, 2019 and 2018

 

    2019     2018  
    $     $  
             
ASSETS            
                 
Non-current assets     284,893,352       197,629,114  
                 
Current assets     22,359,108       2,307,518  
                 
TOTAL ASSETS     307,252,460       199,936,632  
                 
Equity     125,125,875       60,977,933  
                 
Non-current liabilities     102,799,150       28,115,068  
                 
Current liabilities     79,327,435       110,843,631  
                 
TOTAL EQUITY AND LIABILITIES     307,252,460       199,936,632  

 

B. Capitalization and Indebtedness

 

Not applicable.

 

C. Reasons for the Offer and Use of Proceeds

 

Not applicable.

 

D. Risk Factors

 

Risks Related to BPGIC

 

BPGIC is currently reliant on Al Brooge International Advisory LLC for the majority of its revenues and any material non-payment or non-performance by Al Brooge International Advisory LLC would have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Phase I of the BPGIC Terminal consists of 14 oil storage tanks with an aggregate geometric oil storage capacity of approximately 0.399 million m3 and related infrastructure (“Phase I”). On December 12, 2017, BPGIC entered into a five-year lease and service agreement (the “Phase I End User Agreement”) with an international energy trading company (the “Initial Phase I End User”). BPGIC’s revenues historically depended solely on the fees it received pursuant to the Phase I End User Agreement which were comprised of (i) a monthly fixed fee to lease BPGIC’s Phase I storage capacity (regardless of whether the Initial Phase I End User used any storage capacity) and (ii) monthly variable fees based on the Initial Phase I End User’s usage of the following ancillary services: throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers.

 

2

 

 

In August 2019, with the approval of the Initial Phase I End User, BPGIC restructured its relationship with the Initial Phase I End User by entering into a four-year lease and offtake agreement (the “Phase I Customer Agreement”) with Al Brooge International Advisory LLC (“BIA”), for the Phase I facility. After entering the Phase I Customer Agreement, BIA assumed BPGIC’s rights and obligations under the Phase I End User Agreement. Subsequently, in May 2020, BIA agreed to release 129,000 m3 of the Phase I capacity, amounting to approximately one third of the total Phase I capacity, back to BPGIC. BPGIC leased this capacity to, Totsa Total Oil Trading SA (the “Super Major”), for a 6 month period (the “Super Major Agreement”) subject to renewal for an additional 6 month period with the mutual agreement of the parties.

 

Accordingly, a majority of BPGIC’s revenues for the immediate future are expected to consist of the fees it receives pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement which are comprised of (i) a monthly fixed fee to lease approximately two thirds of BPGIC’s Phase I storage capacity (regardless of whether BIA uses any storage capacity) and (ii) monthly variable fees based on BIA’s, or its sublessees’, usage of the following ancillary services: throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers.

 

The terms of the Phase I Customer Agreement allow BIA to sublease, subject to BPGIC’s prior approval, the use of Phase I’s facilities. In 2020, BIA subleased the use of the Phase I facility to multiple international and regional end users. Under the Phase I Customer Agreement, BIA still retains the obligation to pay any outstanding amounts due, including if a sublessee were to fail to make any payments owed to it. There can be no assurance that in the event of a non-payment by one or more of the Phase I end users, of amounts owed to BIA, that BIA would honor its obligation to pay any outstanding amounts due to BPGIC.

 

We are susceptible to general economic conditions, natural catastrophic events and public health crises, which could adversely affect our operating results.

 

Our results of operations could be adversely affected by general conditions in the global economy, including conditions that are outside of our control, such as the impact of health and safety concerns from the current outbreak of COVID-19. Governments in affected countries, including the United Arab Emirates, have imposed travel bans, quarantines and other emergency public health measures. Those measures, though temporary in nature, may continue and increase depending on developments in the COVID-19’s outbreak. Though our oil storage and services operations have not been significantly impacted by the COVID-19 pandemic, the activities of our executives and corporate staff have been, and may continue to be, disrupted and delayed. Many of the vendors and professionals with whom we work have also experienced disruptions. Our executives and corporate staff have been, and may continue to be, focused on mitigating the effects of COVID-19, which may delay other value-add initiatives.

 

In particular, COVID-19 has resulted, and may continue to result in, delay in negotiations with counterparties, including BIA with respect to the BIA Refinery, that could be material to our business. Further, we and our contractors have been, and may continue to be, delayed or unable to procure essential equipment, supplies or materials for the construction of Phase II in adequate quantities and at acceptable prices.

 

In addition, the COVID-19 pandemic has significantly increased economic uncertainty. It is likely that the current outbreak or continued spread of COVID-19 will cause an economic slowdown, and it is possible that it could cause a global recession. Such adverse impact on the global economy may negatively impact the availability of debt and equity financing on commercially reasonable terms, which, in turn, may adversely affect our ability to successfully execute our business strategies and initiatives, such as the funding of capital expenditures.

 

The extent, if any, to which the coronavirus impacts our results will depend on future developments, which are highly uncertain and will include emerging information concerning the severity of the coronavirus and the actions taken by governments and private businesses to attempt to contain the coronavirus.

 

3

 

 

The Phase I users’ usage of BPGIC’s ancillary services has an impact on BPGIC’s profitability. The demand for such ancillary services can be influenced by a number of factors including current or expected prices and market demand for refined petroleum products, each of which can be volatile.

 

With respect to the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement, the total monthly storage fees are fixed and the total monthly fees for BPGIC’s ancillary services are subject to variation based on BIA’s or its sublessees’ and the Super Major’s, usage of BPGIC’s ancillary services. BPGIC expects its revenue from the ancillary services offered in Phase I to vary based on the orders received from the Super Major and the orders BIA receives from its end users, which in turn, vary based on the orders the Super Major and the Phase I end users receive from their customers. The needs of the Super Major’s and the Phase I end users’ customers, and consequently, the Super Major’s and BIA’s usage of BPGIC’s ancillary services, tend to vary based on a number of factors including current or expected refined petroleum product prices and trading activity. Factors that could lead to a decrease in the demand for BPGIC’s ancillary services include:

 

changes in expectations for future prices of refined petroleum products;

 

the level of worldwide oil and gas production and any disruption of those supplies;

 

a decline in global trade volumes, economic growth, or access to markets;

 

higher fuel taxes or other governmental or regulatory actions that increase, directly or indirectly, the cost of gasoline and diesel; and

 

changes to applicable regulations or new regulations affecting the refined petroleum products serviced by BPGIC.

 

Any of the factors referred to above, either alone or in combination, may result in the Super Major’s and/or the Phase I end users’ reduced usage of BPGIC’s ancillary services, which would ultimately have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

In the event that the Super Major Agreement or the Phase I Customer Agreement expire or otherwise terminate, BPGIC may have difficulty locating a replacement for the Super Major or BIA due to competition with other oil storage companies in the Port of Fujairah and at other ports.

 

BPGIC may have to compete with other oil storage companies in the Port of Fujairah (the “Port of Fujairah” or the “Port”) to secure a third party to contract for BPGIC’s services in the event that the Super Major Agreement or the Phase I Customer Agreement expire or otherwise terminate. Such third parties may not only consider competitors in the Port of Fujairah but may also consider companies located at other ports. Although BPGIC believes that it has a best-in-class technically designed terminal in Fujairah and there is a scarcity of land in Fujairah available for expansion by competitors, BPGIC’s ability to compete could be harmed by factors it cannot control, including:

 

BPGIC’s competitors’ construction of new assets or conversion of existing terminals in a manner that would result in more intense competition in the Port of Fujairah;

 

BPGIC’s competitors, which currently provide services to their own businesses, seeking to provide their services to third parties, including third-party oil companies and oil traders;

 

BPGIC’s competitors making significant investments to upgrade or convert their facilities in a manner that, while limiting their capacity in the short term, would eventually enable them to meet or exceed BPGIC’s capabilities;

 

the perception that another company or port may provide better service; and

 

the availability of alternative heating and blending facilities located closer to users’ operations.

 

Any combination of these factors could result in third parties entering into long-term contracts to utilize the services of BPGIC’s competitors instead of BPGIC’s services, or BPGIC being required to lower its prices or increase its costs to attract such parties, either of which could adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

In addition, in the event that BIA’s agreements with its sublessees expire or otherwise terminate, BIA would have similar risks and may face similar difficulties locating replacements for its sublessees due to competition with other oil storage companies in the Port of Fujairah and at other ports. If BIA is unable to contract with new end users, or the new end users do not use ancillary services to the same extent as the existing sublessees, the ancillary services used by BIA would be reduced and BIA’s ability to satisfy its payment obligations to BPGIC under the Phase I Customer Agreement would be impaired, each of which could adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

4

 

 

BPGIC may be subject to significant risks and expenses when constructing Phase II, which could adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

The construction of the second phase of the terminal that BPGIC is developing on land located in close proximity to the Port of Fujairah’s berth connection points (such land, the “Phase I & II Land”) which is expected to consist of 8 oil storage tanks with an aggregate geometric oil storage capacity of approximately 0.601 million mand related infrastructure (“Phase II”) is subject to a number of risks, including:

 

delays by the Phase II contractor, Audex Fujairah LL FZC (“Audex”), in constructing Phase II;

 

a shortage of building materials, equipment or labor;

 

poor performance in project execution on the part of Audex;

 

difficulty procuring supplies and arranging global shipping due to the COVID-19 lockdowns;

 

COVID-19 cases amongst construction labor;

 

default by or financial difficulties faced by Audex or other third-party service and goods providers or failure by Audex or other providers to meet their contractual obligations;

 

BPGIC’s inability to find a suitable replacement contractor in the event of a default by Audex; and

 

cost overruns that require BPGIC to obtain additional financing because there can be no assurance such additional financing would be available at all or upon acceptable terms by BPGIC.

 

Any of the factors referred to above, either alone or in combination, could materially delay the completion of Phase II or materially increase the costs associated with the construction of Phase II, and therefore materially adversely affect BPGIC’s future financial condition. Any failure to complete construction according to specifications may also result in liabilities, reduced efficiency and lower financial returns than anticipated which may result in BPGIC having to enter into restructuring negotiations with its creditors. Delays in one part of Phase II may cause delays to other parts and to the overall Phase II completion timetable.

 

BPGIC will become reliant on BIA for all of its BIA Refinery revenues, and the termination of the Refinery Agreement would have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

In February 2020, BPGIC and Sahara Energy Resources DMCC (“Sahara”) mutually agreed to discontinue their joint development discussions to install a modular oil refinery at BPGIC’s terminal. Shortly thereafter, BPGIC entered into a new agreement with BIA (the “Refinery Agreement”) which provides that the parties will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd (the “BIA Refinery”). The parties further agreed to negotiate, within 30 days, a sublease agreement and a joint venture agreement (such sublease agreement and joint venture agreement, collectively, the “Refinery Operations Agreement”) to govern the terms on which (i) BPGIC will sublease land to BIA to locate, (ii) BIA will construct, and (iii) BPGIC will operate the BIA Refinery. Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, the parties agreed to extend the period for their negotiations until August 4, 2020. As illustrated by the discontinuance of the prior agreement with Sahara, there can be no assurance that BPGIC and BIA will be able to reach agreement on the terms of a sublease and a joint venture agreement to govern the location, construction and operation of the BIA Refinery.

 

Upon completion of the BIA Refinery, BPGIC will become reliant on BIA for another significant portion of its revenues. If the Refinery Agreement is terminated, there can be no assurance that BPGIC will be able to find a new partner to install a modular refinery at the terminal that BPGIC is developing on two plots of land located in close proximity to the Port of Fujairah’s berth connection points (the “BPGIC Terminal”), or enter into a comparable agreement to provide refinery, storage and ancillary services at comparable or more favorable pricing and/or terms. Additionally, BPGIC may incur substantial cost if it suffers delays in locating a third party or if modifications or installation of a new refinery are required by a new agreement. The occurrence of any one or more of these events could have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

BPGIC will become reliant on BIA for all of its Phase II revenues, and the termination of the Phase II Customer Agreement and the failure to find a replacement for BIA would have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

In connection with Phase II, BPGIC entered into a five-year lease and service agreement (the “Phase II End User Agreement”) with an international commodities trading company (the “Phase II End User”), which extends automatically for an additional five years. Pursuant to the Phase II End User Agreement, the Phase II End User has agreed to lease all eight oil storage tanks in Phase II once Phase II becomes operational, which is expected to occur during 2020.

 

5

 

 

In September 2019, with the approval of the Phase II End User, BPGIC restructured its relationship with the Phase II End User by entering into a five-year lease and offtake agreement (the “Phase II Customer Agreement”) for the Phase II facility with BIA. In connection with the Phase II Customer Agreement, BIA assumed BPGIC’s rights and obligations under the Phase II End User Agreement.

 

When Phase II becomes operational, BPGIC will become reliant on BIA for another significant portion of its revenues. In the event that insolvency proceedings are commenced against BIA, BPGIC would have the option to terminate the Phase II Customer Agreement. Upon the termination of the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC would be able to enter into lease and service agreements with one or more third parties. However, in that event, there can be no assurance that BPGIC would be able to locate one or more third parties to enter into lease and service agreements with BPGIC and/or that BPGIC would be able to obtain agreements for a comparable amount of utilization of Phase II’s oil storage and ancillary services at comparable or more favorable pricing and/or terms. Additionally, BPGIC may incur substantial costs if it suffers delays in locating a third party or if modifications to Phase II are required by a new agreement. The occurrence of any one or more of these events would have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

The terms of the Phase II Customer Agreement allow BIA to sublease, subject to BPGIC’s prior approval, the use of Phase II’s facilities, and by assuming the Phase II End User Agreement, BIA subleased the use of the Phase II facility to the Phase II End User. Under the Phase II Customer Agreement, BIA still retains the obligation to pay any outstanding amounts due, including if a sublessee were to fail to make any payments owed to BIA. There can be no assurance that in the event of a non-payment by the Phase II End User, or another sublessee, of amounts owed to BIA, that BIA would honor its obligation to pay any outstanding amounts due to BPGIC in the event of a non-payment by a sublessee.

 

BPGIC will become further reliant on BIA for a substantial majority of its revenues, and any material non-payment or non-performance by BIA would have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Upon completion of Phase II and the BIA Refinery, BIA will be BPGIC’s customer with respect to a substantial majority of the capacity of the Phase I facility, and will be BPGIC’s sole customer with respect to the Phase II facility and the BIA Refinery.

 

The terms of both the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Phase II Customer Agreement allow BIA to sublease the corresponding facilities, subject to BPGIC’s prior approval. BIA has subleased the Phase I capacity that it still leases to certain end users. By assuming the Phase II End User Agreement, BIA has subleased the Phase II facility to the Phase II End User. Under both the Phase I Customer Agreement, and the Phase II Customer Agreement, BIA remains obligated to pay any outstanding amounts due to BPGIC, even if a sublessee fails to make any payment owed to BIA as sublessor. There can be no assurance that BIA would honor its obligation to pay any outstanding amounts due to BPGIC.

 

BIA’s inability or failure to meet its obligations under the Phase I Customer Agreement, the Phase II Customer Agreement, or both, would have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations. If BIA fails to honor its obligations under either agreement, BPGIC is entitled to terminate such agreement and BIA remains liable to pay certain termination fees. However, in that event, there can be no assurance that BPGIC would be able to locate one or more third parties to enter into lease and service agreements with BPGIC and/or that BPGIC would be able to obtain agreements for a comparable amount of utilization of such facility and ancillary services at comparable or more favorable pricing and/or terms. Additionally, BPGIC may incur substantial costs if it suffers delays in locating a third party or if modifications to such facility are required by a new agreement. The occurrence of any one or more of these events would have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

6

 

 

The scarcity of available land in the Fujairah oil zone region could subject BPGIC to competition for additional land, unfavorable lease terms for that land and limit BPGIC’s ability to expand its facilities in Fujairah beyond Phase III.

 

As discussed further in “Item 4.B Information on the Company ¾ Business Overview — Strategy” and “Item 4.A History and Development of the Company — Proposed Phase III”, BPGIC has entered into a land lease agreement, dated as of February 2, 2020 (the “Phase III Land Lease Agreement”), by and between BPGIC and the Fujairah Oil Industry Zone (“FOIZ”) to lease an additional plot of land that has a total area of approximately 450,000 m2 (the “Phase III Land”). BPGIC intends to use the relevant land to expand its crude oil storage and service and refinery capacity (“Phase III”).

 

However, all land in the Fujairah oil zone region is owned and controlled by FOIZ. The Fujairah oil zone region currently has limited available land to lease. As a result, BPGIC’s ability to further expand its facilities if it wishes to expand in Fujairah beyond Phase III is limited. This could subject BPGIC to enhanced competition both in terms of price and lease terms for any land that becomes available to lease.

 

If BPGIC is able to lease additional land, there can be no assurance that it would be able to do so on terms that are as favorable or more favorable than the terms of the land lease that BPGIC entered into in connection with Phases I and II, dated as of March 10, 2013, by and between Fujairah Municipality and BPGIC, as amended by the novation agreement, dated September 1, 2014, by and among Fujairah Municipality, BPGIC and FOIZ (the “Phase I & II Land Lease” and together with the Phase III Land Lease Agreement, the “Land Leases”) or the Phase III Land Lease Agreement, or that would allow BPGIC to use the land as intended. BPGIC’s inability to secure new land from FOIZ in the Fujairah oil zone region could substantially impair BPGIC’s regional growth prospects in Fujairah beyond Phase III, leading to fewer remaining options for its expansion in Fujairah, other than the acquisition of an existing third-party owned oil storage terminal in Fujairah.

 

Accidents involving the handling of oil products at the BPGIC Terminal could disrupt BPGIC’s business operations and/or subject it to environmental and other liabilities.

 

Accidents in the handling of oil products (hazardous or otherwise) at the BPGIC Terminal could disrupt BPGIC’s business operations during any repair or clean-up period, which could negatively affect its business operations. The BPGIC Terminal, which has received multiple international awards since it began operations, was designed to minimize the risk of oil leakage and has state-of-the-art control facilities. In addition, pursuant to the Fujairah Municipality environmental regulations, BPGIC installed impermeable lining over the ground soil throughout its tank farm area and any other area where oil leakage could occur and potentially reach the ground soil. BPGIC intends to take similar steps to minimize the risk of oil leakage in connection with Phase III. Nevertheless, there is a risk that oil leakages or fires could occur at the terminal and, in the event of an oil leakage, there can be no assurance that the installed lining will prevent any oil products from reaching the ground soil. Although BPGIC believes that it has adequate insurance in place to insure against the occurrence of any of the foregoing events, any such leakages or fires could disrupt terminal operations and result in material remediation costs. Any such damage or contamination could reduce gross throughput and/or subject BPGIC to liability in connection with environmental damage, any or all of which could have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

The BIA Refinery, once completed, will face operating hazards, and the potential limits on insurance coverage could expose us to potentially significant liability costs.

 

Once completed, the BIA Refinery will be subject to certain operating hazards, and our cash flow from its operations could decline if it experiences a major accident, pipeline rupture or spill, explosion or fire, is damaged by severe weather or other natural disaster, or otherwise is forced to curtail its operations or shut down. These operating hazards could result in substantial losses due to personal injury and/or loss of life, severe damage to and destruction of property and equipment and pollution or other environmental damage and may result in significant curtailment or suspension of our related operations.

 

Although we intend to maintain insurance policies, including personal and property damage and business interruption insurance for each of our facilities, we cannot ensure that this insurance will be adequate to protect us from all material expenses related to potential future claims for personal and property damage or significant interruption of operations.

 

Furthermore, we may be unable to maintain or obtain insurance of the type and amount we desire at reasonable rates. If we were to incur a significant liability for which we were not fully insured, it could affect our financial condition and diminish our ability to make distributions to our shareholders.

 

7

 

 

When the BIA Refinery is completed, our financial results will be affected by volatile refining margins, which are dependent upon factors beyond our control, including the price of crude oil, to the extent such volatility reduces customer demand of ancillary services.

 

When the BIA Refinery is operational, our financial results will be affected by the relationship, or margin, between refined petroleum product prices and the prices for crude oil and other feedstocks to the extent decreases in refining margins reduce BIA ‘s use of the BIA Refinery and our ancillary services. Historically, refining margins have been volatile, and we believe they will continue to be volatile in the future. BIA’s costs to acquire feedstocks and the price at which it can ultimately sell refined petroleum products depend upon several factors beyond its, and our, control, including regional and global supply of and demand for crude oil, gasoline, diesel, and other feedstocks and refined petroleum products. These in turn depend on, among other things, the availability and quantity of imports, production levels, levels of refined petroleum product inventories, productivity and growth (or the lack thereof) of global economies, international relations, political affairs, and the extent of governmental regulation. Some of these factors can vary by region and may change quickly, adding to market volatility, while others may have longer-term effects. The longer-term effects of these and other factors on refining and marketing margins are uncertain. Decreased refining margins could have a significant effect on the extent to which BIA uses the BIA Refinery and our ancillary services which, in turn, could have a significant effect on our financial results.

 

BPGIC’s competitive position and prospects depend on the expertise and experience of senior management and BPGIC’s ability to continue to attract, retain and motivate qualified personnel.

 

BPGIC’s business is dependent on retaining the services of, or in due course promptly obtaining equally qualified replacements for senior management, those persons named as senior managers in Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees¾A. Directors and Senior Management. Competition in the UAE for personnel with relevant expertise is intense and it could lead to challenges in locating qualified individuals with suitable practical experience in the oil storage industry. Although BPGIC has employment agreements with all of the members of senior management, the retention of their services cannot be guaranteed. Should they decide to leave BPGIC, it may be difficult to replace them promptly with other managers of sufficient expertise and experience or at all. To mitigate this risk, BPGIC intends to enter into long term incentive plans with members of senior management in due course. In the event of any increase in the levels of competition in the oil storage industry or general price levels in the Fujairah region, BPGIC may experience challenges in retaining members of the senior management team or recruiting replacements with the appropriate skills. Should BPGIC lose any of the members of senior management without prompt and equivalent replacement or if BPGIC is otherwise unable to attract or retain such qualified personnel for BPGIC’s requirements, this could have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition and results of operations. For more information regarding senior management, see Item 6. Directors, Senior Management and Employees¾A. Directors and Senior Management.

 

In connection with the preparation of the Company’s consolidated financial statements as of and for the years ended December 31, 2017, 2018 and 2019, the Company and its independent registered public accounting firm identified two material weaknesses in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting, one related to lack of sufficient skilled personnel and one related to lack of sufficient entity level and financial reporting policies and procedures.

 

Prior to the consummation of the Business Combination, the Company was neither a publicly listed company, nor an affiliate or a consolidated subsidiary of, a publicly listed company, and it has had limited accounting personnel and other resources with which to address its internal controls and procedures. Effective internal control over financial reporting is necessary for it to provide reliable financial reports and, together with adequate disclosure controls and procedures, are designed to prevent fraud.

 

In connection with the preparation and external audit of the Company’s financial statements as of and for the years ended December 31, 2017 and December 31, 2018, the Company and our auditors, noted material weaknesses in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. The Public Company Accounting Oversight Board has defined a material weakness as a deficiency, or a combination of deficiencies, in internal control over financial reporting, such that there is a reasonable possibility that a material misstatement of the Company’s financial statements will not be prevented or detected on a timely basis.

 

8

 

 

The material weaknesses identified were (1) a lack of sufficient skilled personnel with requisite IFRS and SEC reporting knowledge and experience and (2) a lack of sufficient entity level and financial reporting policies and procedures that are commensurate with IFRS and SEC reporting requirements. These material weaknesses remain as of December 31, 2019.

 

The Company was not required to perform an evaluation of internal control over financial reporting as of December 31, 2019, December 31, 2018 or December 31, 2017 in accordance with the provisions of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act. Had such an evaluation been performed, additional control deficiencies may have been identified by the Company’s management, and those control deficiencies could have also represented one or more material weaknesses.

 

The Company’s auditors did not undertake an audit of the effectiveness of its internal controls over financial reporting. The Company’s independent registered public accounting firm will not be required to report on the effectiveness of their respective internal controls over financial reporting pursuant to Section 404(b) of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002 until the Company’s first annual report on Form 20-F following the date on which it ceases to qualify as an “emerging growth company,” which may be up to five full fiscal years following the date of the Closing. The process of assessing the effectiveness of the Company’s internal control over financial reporting may require the investment of substantial time and resources, including by members of the Company’s senior management. As a result, this process may divert internal resources and take a significant amount of time and effort to complete. In addition, the Company cannot predict the outcome of this determination and whether the Company will need to implement remedial actions in order to implement effective control over financial reporting. If in subsequent years the Company is unable to assert that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is effective, or if the Company’s auditors express an opinion that the Company’s internal control over financial reporting is ineffective, the Company could lose investor confidence in the accuracy and completeness of their financial reports, which could have a material adverse effect on the price of the Company’s securities. The Company will start implementing a number of measures from second half year of FY 2020 to address the material weaknesses including (i) hiring personnel with relevant public reporting experience, (ii) conducting training for Company personnel with respect to IFRS and SEC financial reporting requirements and (iii) documenting and evaluating the controls over financial reporting. In this regard, the Company will need to dedicate internal resources, recruit personnel with public reporting experience, potentially engage outside consultants and adopt a detailed work plan to assess and document the adequacy of their internal control over financial reporting. This may include taking steps to improve control processes as appropriate, validating that controls are functioning as documented and implementing a continuous reporting and improvement process for internal control over financial reporting.

 

9

 

 

Our auditor’s report includes a going concern paragraph.

 

As of 31 December 2018, the Group had not paid USD 3.7 million of principal and accrued interest that was due under the Group’s Phase I Financing Facilities. Also, as of 31 December 2018, the Group was not in compliance with its debt covenants, including the debt service coverage ratio contained in the Group’s Phase I Financing Facilities. Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the loan agreements, these breaches constituted events of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the loans. Accordingly, as of 31 December 2018, the Group has classified its debt balance of USD 94.8 million as a current liability.

 

On 10 September 2019 and again on 30 December 2019 the Group entered into agreements with its lender to amend the Phase 1 Financing Facility such that on 31 December 2019 the Group was in compliance with the amended facility agreement. At 31 December 2019, the Group’s current liabilities exceeded its current assets by USD 57 million.

 

Subsequent to the year end, the Group defaulted on its commitments under its term loans and the Group was not in compliance with its debt covenants, including the debt service coverage ratio contained in the Group’s loan agreement. Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the loan agreements, these breaches constituted events of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the loans.

 

On 15 June 2020, the Group entered into an agreement with its lender to amend its Phase I Financing Facilities (note15). The Group will have to pay principal and accrued interest of USD 8.8 million in 2020 which represents the cumulative instalments including interest outstanding from periods prior to this amended agreement and an amendment fee of USD 136,000. Term loan (1) and Term loan (2) is now payable in 46 and 16 instalments respectively starting 30 June 2020 with final maturity on 31 July 2030 and 31 July 2023, respectively.

 

During 2018, the Group signed a sales agreement for phase 2 to provide storage and ancillary services to an international commodity trading company, which was novated to a new party during the year. Phase 2 operations are scheduled to start in fourth quarter of 2020 and management expects this will generate significant operating cash flows. The Group is in receipt of a loan facility letter date 15 October 2018 from a lender. The Group intends to draw down from this facility to finance the payments due to the contractor in respect of Phase 2 construction in the third quarter of 2020. The ability of the Group to draw down on this facility is contingent upon a number of conditions agreed in the facility letter which will need to be assessed and approved by the bank prior to the disbursement of funds.

 

Based on the above noted, management has considered the going concern status of the Group and believes there to be a material uncertainty that casts significant doubt upon the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern. Based on management’s forecasts the capital expenditure requirements for phase 2 and debt servicing as described above will be funded by cash generated through the ongoing operations and further drawdowns from approved loan facilities. The Group’s management acknowledge that there is a risk that the quantum and timing of cash flows may not be achievable in line with the twelve months forecasts from the date of approval of the Group’s financial statements. Accordingly, there is significant doubt that the Group will be able to pay its obligations as they fall due and this significant doubt is not alleviated by management’s plans.

 

The financial statements have been prepared assuming that the Group will continue as a going concern. Accordingly, the consolidated financial statements do not include any adjustments relating to the recoverability and classification of recorded asset amounts, the amounts and classification of liabilities, or any other adjustments that might result in the event the Group is unable to continue as a going concern.

 

10

 

 

BPGIC has a limited operating history and this Report contains limited financial information, which makes it particularly difficult for a potential investor to evaluate BPGIC’s financial performance and predict its future prospects.

 

BPGIC commenced operations of Phase I in late Fourth Quarter 2017 and began operating it at full capacity on April 1, 2018. As a result, although BPGIC’s senior management and site teams have up to thirty years of relevant international and industry experience, BPGIC has only limited operating results to demonstrate its ability to operate its business on which a potential investor may rely to evaluate BPGIC’s business and prospects. Accordingly, the financial information included in this Report may be of limited use in assessing the business. BPGIC is also subject to the business risks and uncertainties associated with any new business, including the risk that it will not achieve its operating objectives and business strategy. BPGIC’s limited operating history increases the risks and uncertainties that potential investors face in making an investment in the Ordinary Shares and warrants and the lack of historic information may make it particularly difficult for a potential investor to evaluate BPGIC’s financial performance and forecast reliable long-term trends.

 

If BPGIC is unable to make acquisitions on economically acceptable terms, its future growth would be limited, and any acquisitions it makes could adversely affect its business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

As discussed further in “Item 4.B Information on the Company ¾ Business Overview ¾ Strategy”, one of BPGIC’s medium to long term strategies is to potentially grow its business through the acquisition and development of oil storage terminals globally. BPGIC’s strategy to grow its business is dependent on its ability to make acquisitions that improve its financial condition. If BPGIC is unable to make acquisitions from third parties because it is unable to identify attractive acquisition candidates or negotiate acceptable purchase contracts, it is unable to obtain financing for these acquisitions on economically acceptable terms or it is outbid by competitors, its future growth will be limited. Furthermore, even if BPGIC does consummate acquisitions that it believes will be accretive, they may in fact harm its business, financial condition and results of operations. Any acquisition involves potential risks, some of which are beyond BPGIC’s control, including, among other things:

 

inaccurate assumptions about revenues and costs, including synergies;

 

an inability to successfully integrate the various business functions of the businesses BPGIC acquires;

 

an inability to hire, train or retain qualified personnel to manage and operate BPGIC’s business and newly acquired assets;

 

an inability to comply with current or future applicable regulatory requirements;

 

the assumption of unknown liabilities;

 

limitations on rights to indemnity from the seller;

 

inaccurate assumptions about the overall costs of equity or debt;

 

the diversion of management’s attention from other business concerns;

 

unforeseen difficulties operating in new product areas or new geographic areas; and

 

customer or key employee losses at the acquired businesses.

 

If BPGIC consummates any future acquisitions, its business, financial condition and results of operations may change significantly, and holders of Ordinary Shares will not have the opportunity to evaluate the economic, financial and other relevant information that BPGIC will consider in determining the application of these funds and other resources.

 

11

 

 

BPGIC is subject to a wide variety of regulations and may face substantial liability if it fails to comply with existing or future regulations applicable to its businesses or obtain necessary permits and licenses pursuant to such regulations.

 

BPGIC’s operations are subject to extensive international, national and local laws and regulations governing, amongst other things, the loading, unloading and storage of hazardous materials, environmental protection and health and safety. BPGIC’s ability to operate its business is contingent on its ability to comply with these laws and regulations and to obtain, maintain and renew as necessary related approvals, permits and licenses from governmental agencies and authorities in Fujairah and the UAE. Because of the complexities involved in ensuring compliance with different and sometimes inconsistent national and international regulatory regimes, BPGIC cannot assure investors that it will remain in compliance with all of the regulatory and licensing requirements imposed on it by each relevant jurisdiction. BPGIC’s failure to comply with all applicable regulations and obtain and maintain requisite certifications, approvals, permits and licenses, whether intentional or unintentional, could lead to substantial penalties, including criminal or administrative penalties or other punitive measures, result in revocation of its licenses and/or increased regulatory scrutiny, impair its reputation, subject it to liability for damages, or invalidate or increase the cost of the insurance that it maintains for its business. Additionally, BPGIC’s failure to comply with regulations that affect its staff, such as health and safety regulations, could affect its ability to attract and retain staff. BPGIC could also incur civil liabilities such as abatement and compensation for loss in amounts in excess of, or that are not covered by, its insurance. For the most serious violations, BPGIC could also be forced to suspend operations until it obtains such approvals, certifications, permits or licenses or otherwise brings its operations into compliance.

 

In addition, changes to existing regulations or tariffs or the introduction of new regulations or licensing requirements are beyond BPGIC’s control and may be influenced by political or commercial considerations not aligned with its interests. Any such changes to regulations, tariffs or licensing requirements could adversely affect BPGIC’s business by reducing its revenue, increasing its operating costs or both and BPGIC may be unable to mitigate the impact of such changes.

 

Finally, any expansion of the scope of the regulations governing BPGIC’s environmental obligations, in particular, would likely involve substantial additional costs, including costs relating to maintenance and inspection, development and implementation of emergency procedures and insurance coverage or other financial assurance of BPGIC’s ability to address environmental incidents or external threats. If BPGIC is unable to control the costs involved in complying with these and other laws and regulations, or pass the impact of these costs on to users through pricing, BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations could be adversely affected.

 

Any material reduction in the quality or availability of the Port of Fujairah’s facilities could have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

BPGIC is dependent on the Port of Fujairah to operate and maintain the Port’s facilities at an appropriate standard and BPGIC is dependent on such facilities, including the berths, the very large crude carrier (“VLCC”) jetty and the associated pipelines, to operate its business. Any interruptions or reduction in the capabilities or availability of these facilities would result in reduced volumes being transported through the BPGIC Terminal. Reductions of this nature are beyond BPGIC’s control. If the utilization or the costs to BPGIC or users to deliver oil products through these facilities were to significantly increase, BPGIC’s profitability could be reduced. The Port of Fujairah’s facilities are subject to deterioration or damage, due to potential declines in the physical condition of its facilities and ship collisions, among other things. Any failure of the Port of Fujairah to carry out necessary repairs, maintenance and expansions of its facilities and any resulting interruptions for access to its facilities could adversely affect BPGIC’s business volumes, cause delays in the arrival and departure of oil tankers or disruptions to BPGIC’s operations, in part or in whole, may subject BPGIC to liability or impact its brand and reputation and may otherwise hinder the normal operation of the BPGIC Terminal, which could have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

BPGIC is subject to restrictive covenants in its Financing Facilities that may limit its operating flexibility and, if it defaults under its covenants, it may not be able to meet its payment obligations.

 

BPGIC entered into secured Shari’a compliant Istisna’ and Murabaha financing arrangements of $84.6 million (the “Phase I Construction Facility”) and of $11.1 million (the “Phase I Admin Building Facility” and together with the Phase I Construction Facility, the “Phase I Construction Facilities”) to fund a portion of the construction costs of Phase I, of $3.5 million (the “Phase I Short Term Financing Facility” and together with the Phase I Construction Facilities, the “Phase I Financing Facilities”) to settle certain amounts due under the Phase I Construction Facilities and of $95.3 million (the “Phase II Financing Facility” and together with the Phase I Financing Facilities, the “Financing Facilities”) to fund a portion of the capital expenditure in respect of Phase II. The Financing Facilities contain covenants limiting BPGIC’s ability to incur indebtedness, grant liens, engage in transactions with affiliates and make distributions on or redeem or repurchase ordinary shares. The Phase I Financing Facilities contain covenants requiring BPGIC to maintain certain financial ratios, including a facility service coverage ratio of greater than 1.50:1. Similarly, the Phase II Financing Facility also contains restrictive financial covenants, including, (i) a minimum facility service coverage ratio of 1.25:1, (ii) a participations to value ratio not exceeding 1.50:1 at all times, (iii) a participations to cost ratio not exceeding 57% at any date, and (iv) an amount equivalent to one instalment including interest in a facility service reserve account at all times or in the event of an initial public offering, an amount equivalent to the next two instalments including interest.

 

12

 

 

On December 30, 2019, BPGIC and FAB agreed to amend the Phase I Construction Facility to defer the installments due thereunder to later dates. The key changes resulting from the amendment were as follows:

 

1. an amount of $5,729,417.50 which was due on November 30, 2019 will now be repayable on February 28, 2020;

 

2. an amount of $1,765,553.50 which was due on January 31, 2020 will now be payable in two installments: $882,776.75 on January 31, 2020 and $882,776.75 on February 28, 2020; and

 

3. the Debt Service Reserve Account to be created by February 28, 2020; and

 

4. testing of the Debt Service Coverage Ratio covenant to start on February 28, 2020 and to be conducted on each subsequent due date.

 

BPGIC did not comply with the terms of the Phase I Construction Facilities as amended on December 30, 2019. A payment of principal and interest of $6.6 Million for the Phase I Construction Facility due on February 28, 2020 was not paid. Payments of principal and interest totaling $2.2 Million for the Phase I Construction Facility and the Phase I Admin Building Facility due on April 30, 2020 were not made. The Debt Service Reserve Account did not maintain a balance in an amount equivalent to one quarterly instalment including interest by February 28, 2020. BPGIC did not maintain a minimum Debt Service Coverage Ratio of 150% beginning on February 28, 2020. These non-payments and failures to comply with covenants were events of default, but, as in the past, the lender did not declare an event of default.

 

On June 15, 2020, BPGIC entered into an agreement with its lender to amend the Phase I Construction Facilities (the “June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment”).

 

Pursuant to the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, BPGIC and the lender agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Construction Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from June 30, 2020 through December 31, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
June 30, 2020   $2.99 Million
July 31, 2020   $3.62 Million
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $1.01 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $3.87 Million
Total   $11.9 Million by end of 2020

 

13

 

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 30, 2030, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $1.77 Million

 

Pursuant to the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, BPGIC and the lender also agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Admin Building Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from August 31, 2020 through December 21, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $0.41 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $0.80 Million
Total   $1.63 Million by end of 2020

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 31, 2023, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $0.54 Million.

 

Testing of the Debt Service Ratio Covenant will start on December 31, 2020 and will be conducted on each subsequent payment date. A Debt Service Reserve Account containing at least 1 quarter of debt service amounts must be maintained with the lender by October 31, 2020 and at all times thereafter through the term of the Phase I Construction Facility or until BPGIC repays all liabilities owed under the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC pledged the account to the lender as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC, The Company and BPGIC Holdings undertook to have no other bank accounts except for the one that is the Debt Service Reserve Account until the Phase I Construction Facilities are repaid and to route all funds through the Debt Service Reserve Account. BPGIC further granted the lender a non-possessory mortgage over the Phase I Customer Agreement as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities.

 

Also pursuant to the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, BPGIC negotiated revised pricing terms as follows:

 

o Phase I Construction Facility: Enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021; and

 

o Phase I Admin Building Facility: Enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021.

 

There is no change in the final maturity of Phase I Construction Facility which is July 30, 2030 and Phase I Admin Building Facility which is July 31, 2023. BPGIC will pay FAB a transaction service fee of $0.14 million in connection with the June 15, 2020 amendment.

 

BPGIC’s ability to comply with these restrictions and covenants may be affected by events beyond its control, including prevailing economic, financial and industry conditions. If BPGIC is unable to comply with these restrictions and covenants, a significant portion of the indebtedness under the Financing Facilities may become immediately due and payable. BPGIC might not have, or be able to obtain, sufficient funds to make these accelerated payments. In addition, BPGIC’s obligations under the Financing Facilities are secured by substantially all of BPGIC’s assets, and if BPGIC is unable to repay the indebtedness under the Financing Facilities, the lenders could seek to foreclose on such assets, which would adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations. The Financing Facilities also have cross-default provisions that apply to any other material indebtedness that BPGIC may have. For more information regarding the Financing Facilities, see the section entitled “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects— Liquidity and Capital Resources — Debt Sources of Liquidity.

 

The Company and BPGIC have and will hire, new management personnel and have implemented a number of corporate governance and financial reporting procedures and other policies, processes, systems and controls which have a limited operating history.

 

The Company and BPGIC has hired new management personnel, including a new chief financial officer, and implemented a number of corporate governance and financial reporting procedures and other policies, processes, systems and controls to comply with the requirements for a foreign private issuer on The Nasdaq Capital Market (“Nasdaq”). While the Company believes it is in full compliance with these requirements, it does not have a long track record on which it can assess the performance and effectiveness of these policies, processes, systems and controls or the analysis of their outputs. Any material inadequacies, weaknesses or failures in BPGIC’s policies, processes, systems and controls could have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

14

 

 

The fixed cost nature of BPGIC’s operations could result in lower profit margins if certain costs were to increase and BPGIC were not able to offset such costs with sufficient increases in its storage or ancillary service fees or its customers’ utilization of BPGIC’s ancillary services.

 

BPGIC’s fixed costs for Phase I, Phase II and the BIA Refinery are paid for with the fixed storage fees it receives or will receive, as the case may be, from BIA and the Super Major. BPGIC expects that a large portion of its future expenses related to the operation of the BPGIC Terminal will be relatively fixed because the costs for full-time employees, rent in connection with the Land Leases, maintenance, depreciation, utilities and insurance generally do not vary significantly with changes in users’ needs. However, BPGIC expects that its profit margins could change if its costs change.

 

In particular, if wages in the region’s oil storage industry were to increase, BPGIC may need to increase the levels of its employee compensation more rapidly than in the past to remain competitive or keep up with increases in general price levels or inflation in the UAE and in Fujairah. If wage costs were to increase at a greater rate than our customers’ utilization of BPGIC’s ancillary services, then such increased wage costs may reduce BPGIC’s profit margins.

 

The Phase I Customer Agreement provides that every two years, BPGIC may elect to review and seek to amend its storage and ancillary services fees with BIA. The Phase I Customer Agreement provides that the outcome of this review can result only in either an increase in rates or no change. As such, if wages were to increase, BPGIC may yield lower margins for a period of time before it is able to review and amend its storage and ancillary service fees. Furthermore, if BIA does not agree to increase the storage and ancillary service fees, or if the increase is insufficient, then BPGIC may not be able to maintain its profit margins.

 

The pricing terms for the Refinery Operations Agreement remain subject to negotiation with BIA. If BPGIC is unable to negotiate for periodic price review and increases or if any such increase is insufficient, then BPGIC may not be able to maintain its profit margins.

 

The Phase II Customer Agreement provides that every two years, BPGIC may elect to seek to amend its storage fee to the applicable market price. The Phase II Customer Agreement provides that the outcome of this amendment can result only in either an increase in rate or no change from the contracted floor price. As such, if wages were to increase, BPGIC may yield lower margins for a period of time before it is able to amend its storage fees. Furthermore, if the increase is insufficient, or BIA does not agree to increase the fees, then BPGIC may not be able to maintain its profit margins.

 

BPGIC expects that its fixed costs for Phase III will be paid for with the fixed storage fees it will receive from the Phase III customer(s). BPGIC expects that a large portion of its future expenses related to the operation of Phase III will be relatively fixed because the costs for full-time employees, rent in connection with the Phase III Land Lease Agreement, maintenance, depreciation, utilities and insurance generally do not vary significantly with changes in users’ needs. However, as with its fixed costs for Phase I and Phase II, BPGIC expects that its profit margins could change if its costs, in particular wage costs, change.

 

If BPGIC is unable to maintain its margins, it could have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

BPGIC is dependent on its IT and operational systems, which may fail or be subject to disruption.

 

BPGIC relies on the proper functioning of its information technology, including the information technology systems in BPGIC’s operation control room, databases, computer systems, telecommunication networks and other infrastructure in its day-to-day operations. BPGIC’s business continuity procedures and measures may not anticipate, prevent or mitigate a network failure or disruption and may not protect against an incident in the limited event that there is no alternative system or backed-up data in place. The nature of BPGIC’s operations and the variety of systems in place to support its business can also present challenges to the efficiency of its information technology networks. BPGIC’s systems are vulnerable to interruptions or damage from a number of factors, including power loss, network and telecommunications failures, data corruption, computer viruses, security breaches, natural disasters, theft, vandalism or other acts, although the BPGIC Terminal’s operational system has limited vulnerability to computer viruses or security breaches because the systems are fully isolated. BPGIC is reliant on third party vendors to supply and maintain much of its information technology. In particular, as is the case for many of BPGIC’s competitors, a significant percentage of its core operations currently use information and technology systems provided by ABB Group and Intelex Technologies, Inc., which BPGIC relies on for related support and upgrades. BPGIC may experience delay or failure in finding a suitable replacement in the event that one or more of the third-party vendors ceases operations or becomes otherwise unable or unwilling to meet BPGIC’s needs.

 

15

 

 

There have been an increasing number of cyber security incidents affecting companies around the world, which have caused operational failures or compromised sensitive or confidential corporate data. Although we do not believe our systems are at a greater risk of cyber security incidents than other similar organizations, such cyber security incidents may result in the loss or compromise of customer, financial, or operational data; loss of assets; disruption of billing, collections, or normal operating activities; disruption of electronic monitoring and control of operational systems; and delays in financial reporting and other management functions. Possible impacts associated with cyber security incidents (which generally are increasing in both frequency and sophistication) may include, among others, remediation costs related to lost, stolen, or compromised data; repairs to data processing systems; increased cyber security protection costs; reputational damage; lawsuits seeking damages; regulatory actions; and adverse effects on our compliance with applicable privacy and other laws and regulations. Such occurrences could have an adverse effect on our business, operating results, and financial condition.

 

Although the BPGIC Terminal, based on the nature of BPGIC’s business, is configured to keep its systems operational under abnormal conditions, including with respect to business processes and procedures, any failure or breakdown in these systems could interrupt BPGIC’s normal business operations and result in a significant slowdown in operational and management efficiency for the duration of such failure or breakdown. Any prolonged failure or breakdown could dramatically affect BPGIC’s ability to offer services to users, which could have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Beyond Phase II, expansion of BPGIC’s business may require substantial capital investment, and BPGIC may not have sufficient capital to make future capital expenditures and other investments as it deems necessary or desirable.

 

BPGIC operates in a capital-intensive industry that requires a substantial amount of capital and other long-term expenditures, including those relating to the expansion of existing terminal facilities and the development and acquisition of new terminal facilities. BPGIC has several plans for expansion beyond Phase II, including Phase III, that may require significant capital investment. For example, BPGIC plans to establish an external connection to the local power grid in due course, which would provide the BPGIC Terminal with an additional source of power if necessary.

 

In addition, as discussed further in “Item 4.B Information on the Company ¾ Business Overview — Strategy”, in 2020, BPGIC entered into the Phase III Land Lease Agreement with FOIZ to lease the Phase III Land, a plot of land that has a total area of approximately 450,000 mon which it would build a new oil storage facility. BPGIC has engaged MUC OIL & Gas Engineering Consultancy, LLC (“MUC”), the same advisor that designed the BPGIC Terminal, to create several proposals for the design of Phase III. If BPGIC decides to construct a new facility, it would require substantial capital investment, and BPGIC may not have sufficient capital to make the capital expenditures and other investments as it deems necessary or desirable.

 

To meet the financing requirements for such capital investments, BPGIC may have to utilize a combination of internally generated cash and external borrowings, including banking and capital markets transactions. BPGIC may also seek, in the event that further material expansion opportunities arise in the future, to obtain additional funding from the capital markets to further enhance its funding position. BPGIC’s ability to arrange external financing and the cost of such financing is dependent on numerous factors, including its future financial condition, general economic and capital market conditions, interest rates, credit availability from banks or other lenders, investor confidence in BPGIC, applicable provisions of tax and securities laws and political and economic conditions in any relevant jurisdiction. Moreover, the decline in global credit markets and reduced liquidity may affect BPGIC’s ability to secure financing on commercially reasonable terms, if at all. BPGIC cannot provide any assurance that it will be able to arrange any such external financing on commercially reasonable terms, if at all, and it may be required to secure any such financing with a lien over its assets or agree to contractual limitations on its business. If BPGIC is unable to generate or obtain funds sufficient to make necessary or desirable capital expenditure and other investments, it may be unable to grow its business, which may have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Beyond Phase II, the aforementioned projects and the projects described in “Item 4.B Business Overview — Strategy”, BPGIC may consider additional projects in the future, which would be subject to the same risks mentioned above.

 

16

 

 

Increases in interest rates, to the extent BPGIC has not hedged its interest rate exposure, could adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations and its ability to issue equity or incur debt for acquisitions or other purposes.

 

Interest rates may increase in the future. As a result, BPGIC’s floating interest rates on its Financing Facilities or future credit facilities and debt offerings could be higher than current levels, causing BPGIC’s financing costs to generally increase to the extent BPGIC has not fully hedged its interest rate risk exposure. Although BPGIC has entered into a contractual arrangement with First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC (“FAB”) to hedge the interest rates for BPGIC’s interest payments coming due from June 28, 2019 to June 30, 2023 under the Phase I Financing Facilities, to the extent BPGIC does not hedge its interest rate exposure resulting from other borrowings, including the Phase II Financing Facility, or such hedging arrangements prove ineffective, a rising interest rate environment could have an adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations and its ability to issue equity or incur debt for acquisitions or other purposes.

 

Risks Related to the Company’s Business and Operations

 

The value of your investment in the Company are subject to the significant risks affecting the Company and BPGIC and inherent in the industry in which BPGIC operates. You should carefully consider the risks and uncertainties described below and other information included in this Report. If any of the events described below occur, the Company’s business and financial results could be adversely affected in a material way. This could cause the trading price of the ordinary shares, par value $0.0001 per share, of the Company (the “Ordinary Shares”) to decline, perhaps significantly, and you therefore may lose all or part of your investment. As used in the risks described in this subsection, references to “we,” “us” and “our” are intended to refer to BPGIC unless the context clearly indicates otherwise.

 

The Company’s only significant asset is its ownership of BPGIC and such ownership may not be sufficient to pay dividends or make distributions or obtain loans to enable the Company to pay any dividends on its Ordinary Shares or satisfy other financial obligations.

 

The Company is a holding company and does not directly own any operating assets other than its ownership of interests in BPGIC. The Company depends on BPGIC for distributions, loans and other payments to generate the funds necessary to meet its financial obligations, including its expenses as a publicly traded company and to pay any dividends. The earnings from, or other available assets of, BPGIC may not be sufficient to make distributions or pay dividends, pay expenses or satisfy the Company’s other financial obligations.

 

Fluctuations in operating results, quarter to quarter earnings and other factors, including incidents involving BPGIC’s customers and negative media coverage, may result in significant decreases in the price of the Company’s securities.

 

The stock markets experience volatility that is often unrelated to operating performance. These broad market fluctuations may adversely affect the trading price of the Company’s securities and, as a result, there may be significant volatility in the market price of the Company’s securities. If BPGIC is unable to operate profitably as investors expect, the market price of the Company securities will likely decline when it becomes apparent that the market expectations may not be realized. In addition to operating results, many economic and seasonal factors outside of the Company’s or BPGIC’s control could have an adverse effect on the price of the Company’s securities and increase fluctuations in its quarterly earnings. These factors include certain of the risks discussed herein, operating results of other companies in the same industry, changes in financial estimates or recommendations of securities analysts, speculation in the press or investment community, negative media coverage or risk of proceedings or government investigation, the possible effects of war, terrorist and other hostilities, pandemics, adverse weather conditions, changes in general conditions in the economy or the financial markets or other developments affecting the oil and gas storage industry.

 

17

 

 

The Company incurs higher costs as a result of being a public company.

 

The Company has and will continue to incur significant additional legal, accounting, insurance and other expenses, including costs associated with public company reporting requirements. The Company will incur higher costs associated with complying with the requirements of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act, the Dodd-Frank Wall Street Reform and Consumer Protection Act, and related rules implemented by the SEC and Nasdaq. The expenses incurred by public companies generally for reporting and corporate governance purposes have been increasing. These laws and regulations increase the Company’s legal and financial compliance costs and render some activities more time-consuming and costly. The Company may need to hire more employees or engage outside consultants to comply with these requirements, which will increase its costs and expenses. These laws and regulations could make it more difficult or costly for the Company to obtain certain types of insurance, including director and officer liability insurance, and the Company may be forced to accept reduced policy limits and coverage or incur substantially higher costs to obtain the same or similar coverage. These laws and regulations could also make it more difficult for us to attract and retain qualified persons to serve on the Company’s board of directors, board committees or as executive officers. Furthermore, if the Company is unable to satisfy its obligations as a public company, it could be subject to delisting of its Ordinary Shares and/or warrants, fines, sanctions and other regulatory action and potentially civil litigation.

 

The escrow release provisions of the Escrow Agreement may affect management decisions and incentives.

 

Under the Escrow Agreement dated as of May 10, 2019, by and among the Company, Continental Stock Transfer and Trust (“Continental”), as escrow agent, and BPGIC Holdings (as assignee of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC) as amended by the First Amendment to the Escrow Agreement, dated December 20, 2019, by and among BPGIC Holdings, Continental and the Company (as amended, the “Seller Escrow Agreement”), up to 20 million additional Ordinary Shares that were placed in escrow at Closing will be released to BPGIC Holdings in the event that the Company meets certain Annualized EBITDA (as defined in the Seller Escrow Agreement) or share price targets during the period commencing from the Closing until the end of the twentieth (20th) fiscal quarter after the commencement date of the first full fiscal quarter beginning after the Closing (the “Seller Escrow Period”). As a result, the Company’s management may focus on increasing the Annualized EBITDA of the Company and its subsidiaries, including BPGIC, for quarters within the Seller Escrow Period rather than on increasing net income during such quarters. Additionally, the share price target can be achieved at any time during the Seller Escrow Period, and the share price targets could be achieved early in the Seller Escrow Period which would trigger release of the escrow shares even if the share price fell later in the Seller Escrow Period. See “Item 10.C Material Contracts – Seller Escrow Agreement”.

 

The Company may or may not pay cash dividends in the foreseeable future.

 

Although the Company announced in the Fourth Quarter that it intends to pay a $0.25 quarterly dividend to its public shareholders beginning in the First Quarter of 2020, the Company has not paid such dividend, and has not committed to pay a cash dividend on such terms and in such amount with respect to its Ordinary Shares, and the Company may not pay cash dividends with respect to its Ordinary Shares at all. In light of the economic impact of the COVID-19 pandemic, the board of directors subsequently determined that, notwithstanding its prior announcement, it was in the best interests of the Company as a precautionary measure and to prudently preserve cash, to delay issuance of dividends. No assurance can be given that the Company will ultimately pay any dividend to its shareholders. Any decision to declare and pay dividends in the future will be made at the discretion of the board of directors of the Company and will depend on, among other things, applicable law, regulations, restrictions, the Company’s and BPGIC’s respective results of operations, financial condition, cash requirements, contractual restrictions, the Company’s and BPGIC’s future projects and plans and other factors that the board of directors may deem relevant. In addition, the Company’s ability to pay dividends depends significantly on the extent to which it receives dividends from BPGIC and there can be no assurance that BPGIC will pay dividends. As a result, capital appreciation, if any, of the Company’s Ordinary Shares will be a shareholder’s sole source of gain for the foreseeable future.

 

18

 

 

The market for the Company’s securities may not be sustained, which would adversely affect the liquidity and price of the Company’s securities.

 

The price of the Company’s securities may vary significantly due to general market or economic conditions. Furthermore, an active trading market for the Company’s securities may not be sustained. You may be unable to sell your securities unless a market can be sustained.

 

The price of the Company’s Ordinary Shares may be volatile.

 

The price of the Company’s Ordinary Shares may fluctuate due to a variety of factors, including but not limited to:

 

actual or anticipated fluctuations in our quarterly and annual results and those of other public companies in the industry;

 

mergers and strategic alliances in the oil and gas industries;

 

market prices and conditions in the oil and gas markets;

 

changes in government regulation;

 

potential or actual military conflicts or acts of terrorism;

 

existing or future global or regional health crises;

 

the failure of securities analysts to publish research about us, or shortfalls in our operating results compared to levels forecast by securities analysts;

 

announcements concerning us or our competitors; and

 

the general state of the securities markets.

 

These market and industry factors may materially reduce the market price of our Ordinary Shares, regardless of our operating performance. Volatility in the price of our Ordinary Shares may increase volatility in the price of our warrants.

 

19

 

 

Reports published by analysts, including projections in those reports that differ from our actual results, could adversely affect the price and trading volume of our Ordinary Shares.

 

We currently expect that securities research analysts will establish and publish their own periodic projections for our business. These projections may vary widely and may not accurately predict the results we actually achieve. Our share price may decline if our actual results do not match the projections of these securities research analysts. Similarly, if one or more of the analysts who write reports on us downgrades our shares or publishes inaccurate or unfavorable research about our business, our share price could decline. If one or more of these analysts ceases coverage of us or fails to publish reports on us regularly, our share price or trading volume could decline. While we expect research analyst coverage, if no analysts commence coverage of us, the trading price and volume for our Ordinary Shares could be adversely affected.

 

The Company may issue additional Ordinary Shares or other equity securities without your approval, which would dilute your ownership interests and may depress the market price of the Company’s Ordinary Shares.

 

The Company may issue additional Ordinary Shares or other equity securities of equal or senior rank in the future in connection with, among other things, future acquisitions, repayment of outstanding indebtedness or our equity incentive plan, without shareholder approval, in a number of circumstances.

 

The Company’s issuance of additional Ordinary Shares or other equity securities of equal or senior rank would have the following effects:

 

the Company’s existing shareholders’ proportionate ownership interest in the Company will decrease;

 

the amount of cash available per share, including for payment of dividends in the future, may decrease;

 

the relative voting strength of each previously outstanding Ordinary share may be diminished; and

 

the market price of the Company’s Ordinary Shares may decline.

 

The exercise price of the Company’s warrants can fluctuate under certain circumstances which, if triggered, can result in potentially material dilution of the Company’s then existing shareholders.

 

Currently, there are outstanding a total of 21,228,900 warrants to purchase one Ordinary Share at an exercise price of $11.50. The price at which such Ordinary Shares may be purchased upon exercise of the warrants may be adjusted in certain circumstances, including, but not limited to, when (i) the Company undertakes certain share capitalizations, share sub-divisions, rights offerings or other similar events, or (ii) the Company pays certain dividends or makes certain distributions in cash, securities or other assets to the holders of Ordinary Shares on account of such Ordinary Shares. These adjustments are intended to provide the investors in the Company’s warrants with partial protection from the effects of actions that dilute their interests in the Company on a fully-exercised basis. In addition, the Company may, in its sole discretion, temporarily lower the exercise price of the Company’s warrants provided it lowers the price for not less than twenty (20) business days, provides at least twenty (20) days prior notice to the registered holders of such warrants and applies such decrease consistently to all warrants. These provisions could result in substantial dilution to investors in the Company’s Ordinary Shares.

 

20

 

 

The Company is a Cayman Islands exempted company and, because judicial precedent regarding the rights of shareholders is different under Cayman Islands law than under U.S. law, you could have less protection of your shareholder rights than you would under U.S. law.

 

The Company’s corporate affairs are governed by its Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association, the Cayman Islands Companies Law (2020 Revision) (the “Companies Law”), and the common law of the Cayman Islands. The rights of shareholders to take action against the directors, actions by non-controlling shareholders and the fiduciary responsibilities of the Company’s directors to the Company under Cayman Islands law are to a large extent governed by the common law of the Cayman Islands. The common law of the Cayman Islands is derived in part from comparatively limited judicial precedent in the Cayman Islands as well as from English common law, which has persuasive, but not binding, authority on a court in the Cayman Islands. Your rights as a shareholders and the fiduciary responsibilities of the Company’s directors under Cayman Islands law are different from under statutes or judicial precedent in some jurisdictions in the United States. In particular, the Cayman Islands has a different body of securities laws from the United States and may provide significantly less protection to investors. In addition, some U.S. states, such as Delaware, have different bodies of corporate law than the Cayman Islands.

 

The Company has been advised by its Cayman Islands legal counsel, Maples and Calder, that the courts of the Cayman Islands are unlikely (i) to recognize or enforce against the Company judgments of courts of the United States predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the United States or any State and (ii) in original actions brought in the Cayman Islands, to impose liabilities against the Company predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the United States or any State, so far as the liabilities imposed by those provisions are penal in nature. In those circumstances, although there is no statutory enforcement in the Cayman Islands of judgments obtained in the United States, the courts of the Cayman Islands will recognize and enforce a foreign money judgment of a foreign court of competent jurisdiction without retrial on the merits based on the principle that a judgment of a competent foreign court imposes upon the judgment debtor an obligation to pay the sum for which judgment has been given provided certain conditions are met. For a foreign judgment to be enforced in the Cayman Islands, such judgment must be final and conclusive and for a liquidated sum, and must not be in respect of taxes or a fine or penalty, inconsistent with a Cayman Islands judgment in respect of the same matter, impeachable on the grounds of fraud or obtained in a manner, and/or be of a kind the enforcement of which is, contrary to natural justice or the public policy of the Cayman Islands (awards of punitive or multiple damages may well be held to be contrary to public policy). A Cayman Islands Court may stay enforcement proceedings if concurrent proceedings are being brought elsewhere. There is recent Privy Council authority (which is binding on the Cayman Islands Court) in the context of a reorganization plan approved by the New York Bankruptcy Court which suggests that due to the universal nature of bankruptcy/insolvency proceedings, foreign money judgments obtained in foreign bankruptcy/insolvency proceedings may be enforced without applying the principles outlined above. However, a more recent English Supreme Court authority (which is highly persuasive but not binding on the Cayman Islands Court), has expressly rejected that approach in the context of a default judgment obtained in an adversary proceeding brought in the New York Bankruptcy Court by the receivers of the bankruptcy debtor against a third party, and which would not have been enforceable upon the application of the traditional common law principles summarized above and held that foreign money judgments obtained in bankruptcy/insolvency proceedings should be enforced by applying the principles set out above, and not by the simple exercise of the Courts’ discretion. Those cases have now been considered by the Cayman Islands Court. The Cayman Islands Court was not asked to consider the specific question of whether a judgment of a bankruptcy court in an adversary proceeding would be enforceable in the Cayman Islands, but it did endorse the need for active assistance of overseas bankruptcy proceedings. The Company understands that the Cayman Islands Court’s decision in that case has been appealed and it remains the case that the law regarding the enforcement of bankruptcy/insolvency related judgments is still in a state of uncertainty.

 

You have limited ability to bring an action against the Company or against its directors and officers, or to enforce a judgment against the Company or them, because the Company is incorporated in the Cayman Islands, because the Company conducts all of its operations in the United Arab Emirates and because all of the Company’s directors and officers reside outside the United States.

 

The Company is incorporated in the Cayman Islands and currently conducts all of its operations through its subsidiary, BPGIC, in the United Arab Emirates. All of the Company’s assets are located outside the United States. The Company’s officers and directors reside outside the United States and a substantial portion of the assets of those persons are located outside of the United States. As a result, it could be difficult or impossible for you to bring an action against the Company or against these individuals in the United States in the event that you believe that your rights have been infringed under the applicable securities laws or otherwise. Even if you are successful in bringing an action of this kind, the laws of the Cayman Islands and of the United Arab Emirates could render you unable to enforce a judgment against the Company’s assets or the assets of the Company’s directors and officers.

 

21

 

 

Shareholders of Cayman Islands exempted companies such as the Company have no general rights under Cayman Islands law to inspect corporate records and accounts or to obtain copies of lists of shareholders of these companies. The Company’s directors have discretion under Cayman Islands law to determine whether or not, and under what conditions, the Company’s corporate records could be inspected by the Company’s shareholders, but are not obliged to make them available to the Company’s shareholders. This could make it more difficult for you to obtain the information needed to establish any facts necessary for a shareholder motion or to solicit proxies from other shareholders in connection with a proxy contest.

 

As a result of all of the above, the Company’s shareholders might have more difficulty in protecting their interests in the face of actions taken by management, members of the board of directors or controlling shareholders than they would as public shareholders of a U.S. company.

 

Provisions in the Company’s Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association may inhibit a takeover of us, which could limit the price investors might be willing to pay in the future for the Company’s securities and could entrench management.

 

The Company’s Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association contain provisions that may discourage unsolicited takeover proposals that shareholders of the Company may consider to be in their best interests. Among other provisions, the ability of the Company’s board of directors to issue preferred shares with preferences and voting rights determined by the board without shareholder approval may make it more difficult for the Company’s shareholders to remove incumbent management and accordingly discourage transactions that otherwise could involve payment of a premium over prevailing market prices for the Company’s securities. Other anti-takeover provisions in the Company’s Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association include the indemnification of the Company’s officers and directors, the requirement that directors may only be removed from the Company’s board of directors for cause and the requirement for a Special Resolution to amend provisions therein that affect shareholder rights. These provisions could also make it difficult for the Company’s shareholders to take certain actions and limit the price investors might be willing to pay for the Company’s securities.

 

As a “foreign private issuer” under the rules and regulations of the SEC, the Company is permitted to, does, and will, file less or different information with the SEC than a company incorporated in the United States or otherwise subject to these rules, and will follow certain home-country corporate governance practices in lieu of certain Nasdaq requirements applicable to U.S. issuers.

 

The Company is considered a “foreign private issuer” under the Exchange Act and is therefore exempt from certain rules under the Exchange Act, including the proxy rules, which impose certain disclosure and procedural requirements for proxy solicitations for U.S. and other issuers. Moreover, the Company is not required to file periodic reports and financial statements with the SEC as frequently or within the same time frames as U.S. companies with securities registered under the Exchange Act. The Company currently prepares its financial statements in accordance with IFRS. The Company will not be required to file financial statements prepared in accordance with or reconciled to U.S. GAAP so long as its financial statements are prepared in accordance with IFRS as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board. The Company is not required to comply with Regulation FD, which imposes restrictions on the selective disclosure of material information to shareholders. In addition, the Company’s officers, directors and principal shareholders are exempt from the reporting and short-swing profit recovery provisions of Section 16 of the Exchange Act and the rules under the Exchange Act with respect to their purchases and sales of the Company’s securities.

 

In addition, as a “foreign private issuer” whose Ordinary Shares are listed on Nasdaq, the Company is permitted to follow certain home-country corporate governance practices in lieu of certain Nasdaq requirements. A foreign private issuer must disclose in its Annual Reports filed with the SEC each NASDAQ requirement with which it does not comply followed by a description of its applicable home country practice. The Company currently follows some, but not all of the corporate governance requirements of Nasdaq. With respect to the corporate governance requirements of the Company that it does follow, the Company cannot make any assurances that it will continue to follow such corporate governance requirements in the future, and may therefore in the future, rely on available Nasdaq exemptions that would allow the Company to follow its home country practice. Unlike the requirements of Nasdaq, the corporate governance practice and requirements in the Cayman Islands do not require the Company, and the Company has not established, and currently does not intend to establish, a nominations committee; and do not require the Company, and the Company currently does not intend, to seek shareholder approval for certain security issuances specified in Nasdaq Rule 5635. Such Cayman Islands home country practices may afford less protection to holders of the Company’s Ordinary Shares. For additional information regarding the home country practices the Company intends to follow in lieu of Nasdaq requirements, see “Item 16G. Corporate Governance”.

 

22

 

 

The Company would lose its status as a “foreign private issuer” under current SEC rules and regulations if more than 50% of the Company’s outstanding voting securities become directly or indirectly held of record by U.S. holders and one of the following is true: (i) the majority of the Company’s directors or executive officers are U.S. citizens or residents; (ii) more than 50% of the Company’s assets are located in the United States; or (iii) the Company’s business is administered principally in the United States. If the Company loses its status as a foreign private issuer in the future, it will no longer be exempt from the rules described above and, among other things, will be required to file periodic reports and annual and quarterly financial statements as if it were a company incorporated in the United States. If this were to happen, the Company would likely incur substantial costs in fulfilling these additional regulatory requirements and members of the Company’s management would likely have to divert time and resources from other responsibilities to ensuring these additional regulatory requirements are fulfilled.

 

The Company is an “emerging growth company,” and any decision on the Company’s part to comply with certain reduced disclosure requirements applicable to emerging growth companies could make its Ordinary Shares less attractive to investors.

 

The Company is an “emerging growth company,” as defined in the JOBS Act and, for as long as it continues to be an emerging growth company, it may choose to take advantage of certain exemptions from various reporting requirements applicable to other public companies including, but not limited to: not being required to have its internal control over financial reporting audited by its independent registered public accounting firm pursuant to Section 404 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act for a specified time period; reduced disclosure obligations regarding executive compensation in its periodic reports and proxy statements; and exemptions from the requirements to hold a nonbinding advisory vote on executive compensation and to obtain shareholder approval of any golden parachute payments not previously approved. It may take advantage of these provisions for up to five years or such earlier time that it is no longer an “emerging growth company.” The Company will remain an “emerging growth company” for up to five years, although, it would cease to be an “emerging growth company” upon the earliest of: the first fiscal year following the fifth anniversary of the consummation of the Closing; the first fiscal year after its annual gross revenue is $1.07 billion or more; the date on which it has, during the previous three-year period, issued more than $1 billion in non-convertible debt securities; or the date on which it is deemed to be a “large accelerated filer” as defined in the Exchange Act. To the extent the Company takes advantage of any of these reduced reporting burdens in this annual report or in future filings, the information that it provides to its security holders may be different than you might get from other public companies in which you hold equity interests. The Company cannot predict if investors find, or will find, its Ordinary Shares less attractive because it may rely on these exemptions. If some investors find the Company’s Ordinary Shares less attractive as a result, there may be a less active trading market for its Ordinary Shares and its share price may be more volatile.

 

The Company’s controlling shareholder has substantial influence over the Company and its interests may not be aligned with the interests of the Company’s other shareholders.

 

BPGIC Holdings holds approximately 85.7% of the Company’s voting equity. Each of BPGIC Holdings, Nicolaas Paardenkooper as the Chief Executive Officer of BPGIC Holdings and the majority shareholder of BPGIC Holdings have substantial influence over our business, including decisions regarding mergers, consolidations, the sale of all or substantially all of our assets, election of directors, declaration of dividends and other significant corporate actions. As the controlling shareholder, BPGIC Holdings may take actions that are not in the best interests of the Company’s other shareholders. These actions may be taken in many cases even if they are opposed by the Company’s other shareholders. In addition, this concentration of ownership may discourage, delay or prevent a change in control which could deprive you of an opportunity to receive a premium for your Ordinary Shares as part of a sale of the Company.

 

23

 

 

Risks Related to Doing Business in Countries in Which BPGIC Operates

 

BPGIC is subject to political and economic conditions in Fujairah and the UAE.

 

All of BPGIC’s operations are located in the UAE. BPGIC’s operations in Fujairah are located near an area of strategic economic and military importance for the entire region. As such, BPGIC’s future business may be affected by the financial, political and general economic conditions prevailing from time to time in the region and the UAE.

 

Although economic growth rates in the UAE remain above those of many more developed, as well as regional, markets, the UAE has experienced slower economic growth in recent years, following the downturn experienced as a result of the global financial crisis in 2008 and the sharp decline in oil prices in recent years, which remain volatile and below historic highs. There can be no assurance that economic growth or performance in Fujairah or the UAE, in general, will be sustained. The UAE’s wealth remains largely based on oil and gas. Despite the UAE being viewed as being less vulnerable than some of its Gulf Cooperation Council (“GCC”) neighbors, due to the growth in the non-oil sector and the sizeable wealth of the government of Abu Dhabi, fluctuations in energy prices have an important bearing on economic growth. To the extent that economic growth or performance in the UAE subsequently declines, BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations may be adversely affected. In addition, the implementation by the governments of the UAE of restrictive fiscal or monetary policies or regulations, including in respect of interest rates, or new legal interpretations of existing regulations and the introduction of taxation or exchange controls could have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition, results of operations and prospects.

 

While the UAE enjoys domestic political stability and generally healthy international relations, since early 2011 there has been political unrest in a range of countries in the Middle East and North Africa (“MENA”) region, including Algeria, Bahrain, Egypt, Iraq, Libya, Morocco, Oman, Saudi Arabia, Syria, Tunisia and Yemen. This unrest has ranged from public demonstrations to, in extreme cases, armed conflict and civil war and has given rise to a number of regime changes and increased political uncertainty across the region. The MENA region is currently subject to a number of armed conflicts including those in Yemen (in which the UAE armed forces, along with a number of other Arab states, are involved), Syria and Iraq as well as the multinational conflict with Islamic State.

 

It is not possible to predict the occurrence of events or circumstances such as terrorism, war or hostilities, or more generally the financial, political and economic conditions prevailing from time to time, or the impact of such occurrences or conditions, and no assurance can be given that BPGIC would be able to sustain its current profit levels if adverse financial, political or economic events or circumstances were to occur. A general downturn or instability in certain sectors of the UAE or the regional economy, or political upheaval therein, could have an adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, results of operations and financial condition. Investors should also note that BPGIC’s business and financial performance could be adversely affected by political, economic or related developments both within and outside the MENA region because of interrelationships within the global financial markets.

 

On June 5, 2017, three GCC countries, Saudi Arabia, the UAE and Bahrain, as well as Egypt and Yemen, severed diplomatic ties with Qatar, cut trade and transport links and imposed sanctions on Qatar. The stated rationale for such actions was Qatar’s support of terrorist and extremist organisations and Qatar’s interference in the internal affairs of other countries. There can be no assurance as to when diplomatic relations will be restored or air, land and sea connections reopened with Qatar. It is also not currently possible to predict the outcome of this dispute, and any significant escalation or continuation of the current situation for an extended period could negatively affect Fujairah and the UAE.

 

In the past, political conflicts have resulted in attacks on vessels, mining of waterways and other efforts to disrupt shipping. Continuing conflicts, instability and other recent developments in the Middle East and elsewhere, including recent attacks involving vessels and vessel seizures in the Strait of Hormuz, and the presence of U.S. or other armed forces in Afghanistan and Syria, may lead to additional acts of terrorism or armed conflict around the world, and our customer’s vessels may face higher risks of being attacked or detained. BPGIC’s business and financial performance would be adversely affected by any reduction in use of the Port of Fujairah as a result of such tensions or conflict.

 

24

 

 

Prospective investors should also be aware that investments in emerging markets, such as the UAE, are subject to greater risks than those in more developed markets. The economy of the UAE, like those of many emerging markets, has been characterized by significant government involvement through direct ownership of enterprises and extensive regulation of market conditions, including foreign investment, foreign trade and financial services. While the policies of the local and central governments of the UAE generally resulted in improved economic performance in previous years, there can be no assurance that these levels of performance can be sustained.

 

Recent geopolitical developments have increased the risk that the region in which BPGIC operates could be involved in an escalating conflict that could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

On September 14, 2019, certain attacks on an oil processing plant and an oil field in Saudi Arabia took place, which, according to preliminary reports, significantly disrupted the oil production capacity of Saudi Arabia, and could cause short and/or long term geopolitical strife. The government of Saudi Arabia and the United States have reported their belief that the attacks were conducted by Iran or its proxy (possibly Yemen). Whether or not these reports are accurate, rising tensions in the region could significantly place the extraction, production and delivery of oil produced in the region at risk. Further, because the UAE is also involved in the conflict in Yemen, it is possible that the perpetrators of the attacks may seek to launch a similar attack against the UAE. Should such an attack occur, or should rising tension in the region cause a conflict, the ports, pipelines and terminal facilities of the UAE could be at risk and BPGIC’s operations could be materially and adversely affected.

 

BPGIC’s business operations could be adversely affected by terrorist attacks, natural disasters or other catastrophic events beyond its control.

 

BPGIC’s business operations could be adversely affected or disrupted by terrorist attacks, natural disasters (such as floods, fires or significant storms) or other catastrophic or otherwise disruptive events, including changes to predominant natural weather, sea and climatic patterns, piracy, sabotage, insurrection, military conflict or war, riots or civil disturbance, radioactive or other material environmental contamination, an outbreak of a contagious disease, or changes to sea levels, which may adversely affect global or regional trade volumes or user demand for oil products transported to or from affected areas, and denial of the use of any railway, port, airport, shipping service or other means of transport and disrupt users’ logistics chains. In addition, BPGIC may be exposed to extreme weather conditions such as severe heat, flooding, rain or wind conditions, which could disrupt activities at the BPGIC Terminal and the Port of Fujairah. Several of BPGIC’s competitors in the Fujairah oil zone region have experienced issues with flooding in the past due to the region’s close proximity to the Al Hajar mountainous region, where floods sometimes occur when a significant amount of rain mixes with the dirt from the mountains and subsequently clogs the region’s drainage system. Although the BPGIC Terminal has been designed with sufficient drainage capabilities to handle certain flooding scenarios and the Phase I oil storage tanks have been constructed to withstand high levels of radiation and fire in accordance with NFPA standards, if the flooding, radiation or fire is significantly severe, there can be no assurance BPGIC’s business operations would be unaffected by it.

 

The occurrence of any of these events at the BPGIC Terminal or in Fujairah may reduce BPGIC’s business volumes, cause delays in the arrival and departure of oil tankers or disruptions to its operations, in part or in whole, may increase the costs associated with storage, heating or blending activities, may subject BPGIC to liability or impact its brand and reputation and may otherwise hinder the normal operation of the BPGIC Terminal, which could substantially impair BPGIC’s growth prospects and could have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition and results of operations. Although BPGIC has insurance in place to cover certain of these events if they occur at the BPGIC Terminal, including sabotage and terrorism insurance, there can be no assurance that such insurance will be sufficient to cover all costs and lost business volumes associated with such events.

 

Climate change legislation or regulations restricting emissions of greenhouse gases could result in increased operating and capital costs and reduced demand for BPGIC’s storage services.

 

There is a growing belief that emissions of greenhouse gases (“GHGs”), such as carbon dioxide and methane, may be linked to climate change. Climate change and the costs that may be associated with its impacts and the regulation of GHGs have the potential to affect BPGIC’s business and the businesses of users in many ways, including negatively impacting the costs BPGIC incurs in providing its services and the demand for its services (due to change in both costs and weather patterns).

 

25

 

 

In February 2005, the Kyoto Protocol to the United Nations Framework Convention on Climate Change, or the Kyoto Protocol, entered into force. The UAE ratified the Kyoto Protocol in 2005. The first commitment period of the Kyoto Protocol ended in 2012, but it was nominally extended past its expiration date with a requirement for a new legal construct to be put into place by 2015. To that end, in December 2015, over 190 countries, including the UAE, reached an agreement to reduce global greenhouse gas emissions. From the time BPGIC completed construction of Phase I on November 19, 2017, its facilities have been in full compliance with the latest requirements. The Paris Agreement, which enters into force in 2020, will require governments to take legislative and regulatory measures to reduce emissions that are thought to be contributing to climate change. While BPGIC has already taken certain measures to reduce emissions of volatile organic compounds, additional measures might become necessary, which could increase operating costs. Moreover, BPGIC’s business might be impacted by changes in demand of the oil products that it stores to the extent users are impacted by such regulations.

 

Although it is not possible at this time to accurately estimate how potential future laws or regulations addressing GHG emissions would impact BPGIC’s business, any future local, national, international or federal laws or implementing regulations that may be adopted to address GHG emissions could possibly require BPGIC to incur increased operating costs and could adversely affect demand for the oil or oil products it stores. The potential increase in the costs of BPGIC’s operations resulting from any legislation or regulation to restrict emissions of GHGs could include new or increased costs to operate and maintain its facilities, install new emission controls on its facilities, acquire allowances to authorize its greenhouse gas emissions, pay any taxes related to its GHG emissions and administer and manage a GHG emissions program. Moreover, incentives to conserve energy or use alternative energy sources could reduce demand for BPGIC’s services. BPGIC cannot predict with any certainty at this time how these possibilities may affect its operations. Many scientists have concluded that increasing concentrations of GHGs in the Earth’s atmosphere may produce climate change that could have significant physical effects, such as increased frequency and severity of storms, droughts, and floods and other climatic events; if such effects were to occur, they could have an adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

BPGIC may incur significant costs to maintain compliance with, or address liabilities under, environmental, health and safety regulation applicable to its business.

 

BPGIC’s business operations are subject to UAE, national, state and local environmental laws and regulations concerning, among other things, the management of hazardous substances, the storage and handling of hazardous waste, the control of the emission of vapor into the air and water discharges, the remediation of contaminated sites and employee health and safety. These laws and regulations are complex and subject to change. BPGIC could incur unexpected costs, penalties and other civil and criminal liability if it fails to comply with applicable environmental or health and safety laws. Although BPGIC has installed impermeable lining over the ground soil throughout the Phase I & II Land’s tank farm area and any other area where oil leakage could occur and potentially reach the ground soil, and intends to take similar preventative measures for the Phase III Land, there can be no assurance in the unlikely event of an accidental leak, release or spill of oil products or other products at the BPGIC Terminal site, that BPGIC will not experience operational disruptions or incur costs related to cleaning and disposing waste and oil products, remediating ground soil or groundwater contamination, paying for government penalties, addressing natural resource damage, compensating for human exposure or property damage, or a combination of these measures. Although BPGIC believes it has adequate insurance in place to insure against the occurrence of any of the foregoing events, there can be no assurance that BPGIC’s insurance would be sufficient to cover all potential costs. Therefore, the occurrence of any of the foregoing events could have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Furthermore, although BPGIC monitors the exposure of its employees, neighbors and others to risks connected with its operations, future health claims of its employees or other such persons, caused by past, present or future exposure cannot be excluded. BPGIC could be subject to claims by government authorities, individuals and other third parties seeking damages for alleged personal injury or property damage resulting from hazardous substance contamination or exposure caused by its operations, facilities or products, and BPGIC’s insurance may not be sufficient to cover these claims.

 

In addition, compliance with future environmental or health and safety laws and regulations may require significant capital or operational expenditures or changes to BPGIC’s operations.

 

26

 

 

BPGIC could be adversely affected by violations of anti-corruption laws or economic sanctions programs.

 

Currently, all of BPGIC’s operations are conducted in the UAE. BPGIC is committed to doing business in accordance with all applicable laws and its own code of ethics. BPGIC is subject, however, to the risk that customers, end users, BPGIC or their respective officers, directors, employees and agents may take actions determined to be in violation of anti-corruption laws. In addition, as a result of the Business Combination, BPGIC is subject to the U.S. Foreign Corrupt Practices Act. Any violations of applicable anti-corruption laws could result in substantial civil and criminal penalties, and could have a damaging effect on BPGIC’s reputation and business relationships. Furthermore, BPGIC is subject to economic sanctions programs, including those administered by the United Nations Security Council, the United Arab Emirates and the United States. Although the Company has policies and procedures designed to ensure compliance with applicable sanctions programs, there can be no assurance that such policies and procedures are or will be sufficient or that customers, users, BPGIC, the Company or their respective officers, directors, employees and agents will not take actions in violation of the Company’s policies and procedures (or otherwise in violation of the relevant sanctions regulations) for which they, the Company or BPGIC may ultimately be held responsible.

 

Tax liabilities associated with indirect taxes on the oil products BPGIC services could result in losses to it.

 

In Fujairah, the oil products that BPGIC stores and blends for BIA and the Super Major in the Phase I facility are subject to numerous duties or taxes that are not based on income, sometimes referred to as “indirect taxes”, including import duties, excise duties, environmental levies and value-added taxes. Once the BIA Refinery and Phase II become operational, the oil products that BPGIC handles for BIA in connection with the BIA Refinery and the Phase II facility will likely be subject to similar “indirect taxes”. Under the terms and conditions of the respective customer agreements, BPGIC is entitled to pass on such indirect taxes to its customers.

 

However, changes to existing regulations for indirect taxes or the introduction of new regulations are beyond BPGIC’s control and may be influenced by political or commercial considerations not aligned with its interests. Any such regulations could adversely affect BPGIC’s business by increasing its costs to the extent it is unable to pass on such indirect taxes to BIA, and as a result, adversely affect its business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Changes to VAT law in the UAE may have an adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

On August 23, 2017, the government of the UAE published Federal Decree-Law No. 8 of 2017 (the “VAT Law”) on value added tax (“VAT”) which came into effect on January 1, 2018. Cabinet Decision No. 52 of 2017 on the executive regulations of the VAT Law, issued on November 26, 2017, and Cabinet Decision No. 59 of 2017 on designated zones for the purposes of the VAT Law, issued on December 28, 2017, provide that certain designated zones in the UAE are subject to special VAT treatment. Subject to it continuing to meet the conditions set out in the executive regulations to the VAT Law, the area in which BPGIC operates is a designated zone for the purposes of the VAT Law and therefore BPGIC benefits from certain exemptions under the VAT Law. There is no guarantee that the free zone in which BPGIC operates will remain a designated zone in the future. If the area in which BPGIC operates loses its designation as a designated zone or any change is made to the applicable rate on the supply of services for the area in which BPGIC operates, BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations may be adversely affected.

 

27

 

 

BPGIC’s business may be materially adversely affected if the US dollar/UAE dirham-tied exchange rate were to be removed or adjusted.

 

All of BPGIC’s current revenues are received in US dollars and all of its operating costs are incurred in UAE dirhams. All of BPGIC’s current revenues and operating costs derive from its operations in the UAE. Although the US dollar/UAE dirham exchange rate is currently fixed, there can be no assurance that the government of the UAE will not de-peg the UAE dirham from the US dollar in the future. Alternatively, the existing fixed rate may be adjusted in a manner that increases the costs of certain equipment used in BPGIC’s business or decreases BPGIC’s receipt of payments from users. Any adjustment of the fixed rate or de-pegging of the UAE dirham from the US dollar in the future could cause BPGIC’s operations and reported results of operations and financial condition to fluctuate due to currency translation effects, which could have a material adverse effect on its business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

BPGIC’s business may be materially adversely affected by unlawful or arbitrary governmental action.

 

Governmental authorities in the UAE have a high degree of discretion and, at times, act selectively or arbitrarily, without hearing or prior notice, and sometimes in a manner that is contrary to law or influenced by political or commercial considerations. Such governmental action could include, among other things, the expropriation of property without adequate compensation or the forcing of business acquisitions, combinations or sales. Any such action taken may have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Legal and regulatory systems may create an uncertain environment for investment and business activities.

 

The UAE’s institutions and legal and regulatory systems are not yet as fully matured and as established as those of Western Europe and the United States. Existing laws and regulations may be applied inconsistently with anomalies in their interpretation or implementation. Such anomalies could affect BPGIC’s ability to enforce its rights under its contracts or to defend its business against claims by others. Changes in the UAE legal and regulatory environment, including in relation to foreign ownership restrictions, labor, welfare or benefit policies or in tax regulations could have a material impact on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

The grant and future exercise of registration rights may adversely affect the market price of Ordinary Shares of the Company.

 

Pursuant to the existing registration rights agreement with Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC (“Twelve Seas Sponsor”) and the registration rights agreement entered into in connection with the Business Combination and which are described elsewhere in this Report, Twelve Seas’ Sponsor and BPGIC Holdings can demand that the Company register their registrable securities under certain circumstances and will also have piggyback registration rights for these securities in connection with certain registrations of securities that the Company undertakes.

 

The registration of these securities will permit the public resale of such securities. The registration and availability of such a significant number of securities for trading in the public market may have an adverse effect on the market price of the Company’s Ordinary Shares.

 

Sales of a substantial number of the Company’s securities in the public market could adversely affect the market price of its Ordinary Shares.

 

As of the Closing of the Business Combination, Twelve Seas Sponsor) and certain officers and directors of Twelve Seas (the “Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders”) held 4,721,900 Ordinary Shares and 529,000 warrants. Such Company securities are subject to a one year lock up restriction following the Closing, subject to the possible early release of 50% of such shares in the event the closing price of the Ordinary Shares exceeds $12.50 for 20 trading days during any 30 trading day period. After the lock-up period expires, these Ordinary Shares will become eligible for future sale in the public market. 1,552,500 of such Ordinary Shares are held in escrow and subject to forfeiture on the terms and conditions of the Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement (defined below). As and if the milestones in the Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement are satisfied, portions of the escrowed shares will be released to the Twelve Seas Sponsor and will become eligible for future sale in the public market. Sales of a significant number of these Ordinary Shares of the Company in the public market, or the perception that such sales could occur, could reduce the market price of Ordinary Shares of the Company.

 

28

 

 

Nasdaq may not continue to list the Company’s securities on its exchange, and delisting could limit investors’ ability to make transactions in the Company’s securities and subject the Company to additional trading restrictions.

 

The Company’s securities are currently listed on Nasdaq. The Company may be unable to maintain the listing of its securities in the future. If the Company is unable to maintain the listing of its securities on Nasdaq, the Company could face significant material adverse consequences, including:

 

a limited availability of market quotations for its securities;

 

a less liquid market for its securities;

 

a limited amount of news and analyst coverage for the company; and

 

a decreased ability to issue additional securities or obtain additional financing in the future.

 

ITEM 4. INFORMATION ON THE COMPANY

 

A. History and development of the Company

 

The Company’s legal and commercial name is Brooge Energy Limited. Until April 7, 2020, the Company’s legal and commercial name was Brooge Holdings Limited. The Company was incorporated for the purpose of effectuating the Business Combination and to hold BPGIC. The Company was incorporated under the laws of the Cayman Islands as an exempted company on April 12, 2019. Prior to the Business Combination, the Company owned no material assets and did not operate any business. The name and mailing address of the Company’s agent and registered office is Maples Corporate Services Limited, P.O. Box 309, Ugland House, Grand Cayman KY1-1104, Cayman Islands. Its principal executive office is that of BPGIC, located at P.O. Box 50170, Fujairah, United Arab Emirates and its telephone number is +971 9 201 6666.

 

In accordance with the terms and conditions of the Business Combination Agreement, upon the closing of the Business Combination on December 20, 2019, Twelve Seas merged with Merger Sub and holders of Twelve Seas securities received substantially similar securities of the Company, and Twelve Seas continued as the surviving entity and a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company under the name BPGIC International, and the Company acquired all of the issued and outstanding ordinary shares of BPGIC from BPGIC Holdings in exchange for Ordinary Shares of the Company and BPGIC became a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company. All of the Company’s operations are conducted through BPGIC.

 

29

 

 

History and Development

 

The following timeline sets forth BPGIC’s major milestones.

  

 

BPGIC was incorporated in 2013 in the Fujairah Free Zone, UAE, to provide oil storage, heating and blending services. On February 10, 2013, the Fujairah Free Zone Authority provided BPGIC with a license to engage in the following activities: (i) trading and storing all varieties of oil products and gas, including crude and fuel oils; (ii) building, managing and investing in refineries and all other types of investments; and (iii) exploring and extracting crude oil and gas in both onshore and offshore fields.

 

On March 10, 2013, BPGIC entered into the 60-year Phase I &II l Land Lease with the Fujairah Municipality, a local government organization specializing in municipal urban and rural municipal affairs, for a parcel of land to build and operate the BPGIC Terminal, which is in the Port of Fujairah. On September 1, 2014, the Phase I & II Land Lease was novated from the Fujairah Municipality to FOIZ. For more information regarding the Phase I & II Land Lease see “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Phase I & II Land Lease”.

 

On March 31, 2016, BPGIC entered into a Port Facilities Agreement with the Port of Fujairah. For more information regarding the Port Facilities Agreement, see “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Phase I & II Land Lease”. After several years of planning and design, BPGIC finalized plans for Phase I during the First Quarter of 2015. BPGIC signed an EPC agreement for Phase I (the “Phase I EPC Agreement”) on April 2, 2015 with Audex and commenced work in accordance with the Phase I EPC Agreement. Audex completed Phase I works on November 19, 2017 and between 2014 and 2017, BPGIC incurred a total cost of $170 million in connection with its construction. On December 12, 2017, BPGIC entered into the Phase I End User Agreement with the Initial Phase I End User. BPGIC began testing operations on December 20, 2017 and commenced limited operations on January 18, 2018. From the time BPGIC began its operations on December 20, 2017 to February 28, 2018, BPGIC limited the availability of its storage capacity to 40 percent, allowing its management team to test all systems and make any necessary adjustments. BPGIC increased the availability of its storage capacity to approximately 70 percent on March 1, 2018 and to 100 percent on April 1, 2018.

 

In August 2019, with the approval of the Initial Phase I End User, BPGIC entered into the Phase I Customer Agreement with BIA to restructure its relationship with the Initial Phase I End User. Under the Phase I Customer Agreement, BPGIC leased the Phase I facilities to BIA, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed the rights and obligations of BPGIC under the Phase I End User Agreement. In 2020, BIA notified BPGIC that it had entered sublease arrangements for parts of the Phase I storage capacity with additional end users. In May 2020, BIA agreed to release 129,000 m3 of the Phase I capacity, amounting to approximately one third of the total Phase I capacity, back to BPGIC.

 

30

 

 

Following the restructuring, BIA’s agreements with other end users and BIA’s release of approximately one third of the capacity of the Phase I facility, BPGIC leases approximately two thirds of the capacity of the Phase I facility to BIA, and BIA subleases the capacity to its end users. BIA’s obligations to pay BPGIC for the storage and ancillary services provided at the Phase I facility are independent of the Phase I end users’ actual payments to BIA. Pursuant to the Super Major Agreement, BPGIC leases the remaining one third of the capacity of Phase I to the Super Major for a 6 month period subject to renewal for an additional 6 month period with the mutual agreement of the parties.

 

As of December 31, 2019, BPGIC had funded the construction of Phase I, Phase II and all of its other cash requirements with funds from the Phase I Financing Facilities, and net equity contributions (other than share capital) since 2014 of $71.01 million from shareholders. For additional information regarding the Phase I Financing Facilities, see “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Debt Sources of Liquidity”.

 

As Phase I neared completion, BPGIC finalized plans for Phase II in the Third Quarter of 2017. On June 27, 2018, BPGIC entered into the Phase II End User Agreement with the Phase II End User. On September 3, 2018, BPGIC signed the Phase II EPC Agreement with Audex. Phase II work commenced in September 2018 and according to the schedule in the Phase II EPC Agreement, it is expected to be completed in 2020. The expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II is $160.6 million (comprised of construction costs of $150.0 million and capitalised interest and land lease and consultancy charges of $10.6 million). On September 3, 2018, BPGIC signed a project management agreement (the “Phase II Project Management Agreement”) with MUC, the same advisor that designed the BPGIC Terminal, so that MUC could manage the construction plan of Phase II.

 

On October 15, 2018, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Financing Facility, which is a $95.3 million secured Shari’a compliant Istisna’ financing arrangement coordinated by FAB, to fund a portion of the capital expenditure in respect of Phase II.

 

In September 2019, with the approval of the Phase II End User, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Customer Agreement with BIA to restructure its relationship with the Phase II End User. Under the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC leased the Phase II facilities to BIA, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed the rights and obligations of BPGIC under the Phase II End User Contract. Following this restructuring, BPGIC leases the Phase II facility to BIA, and BIA subleases the facility to the Phase II End User. BIA’s obligations to pay BPGIC for the storage and ancillary services provided at the Phase II facility are independent of the Phase II End User’s actual payments to BIA.

 

Phase II is expected to focus its operations primarily on the storage and blending of crude oil. Phase II will involve the construction of eight additional oil storage tanks with an aggregate geometric oil storage capacity of approximately 0.601 million m3, which will increase BPGIC’s aggregate geometric oil storage capacity to approximately 1 million m3. In February 2017, BPGIC finalized and issued a front end engineering document, which sets out the qualifications, specifications, drawings and designs of Phase II, to Audex. On September 3, 2018, BPGIC signed the EPC agreement with Audex for the development of Phase II, (the “Phase II EPC Agreement”). As part of Phase II, BPGIC intends to follow a similar approach to Phase I by investing in high-grade, long-life materials for the construction and development of its facilities. Audex commenced construction of Phase II in September 2018 and plans to complete construction in 2020. Phase II is being constructed adjacent to Phase I. The expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II is $160.6 million which is comprised of construction costs of $150.0 million and capitalised interest and land lease and consultancy charges of $10.6 million. The expected capital expenditure of $160.6 million in respect of Phase II will be funded by:

 

drawings of $90.6 million under the Phase II Financing Facility; and

 

shareholders contributions, proceeds of the Business Combination, and internally generated cashflow in the aggregate amount of $70.0 million.

 

31

 

 

Of the $160.6 million expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II, $39.2 million was paid in the year ended December 31, 2019. During 2020, $24.8 million was paid through June 2020 and balance is expected to be paid out before the end of the year. See “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — BPGIC may be subject to significant risks and expenses when constructing Phase II, which could adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

As was the case with Phase I, in order to de-risk the start-up of operations of Phase II, on June 27, 2018, BPGIC entered into the Phase II End User Agreement with the Phase II End User, an international commodities trading company. Pursuant to the Phase II End User Agreement, the Phase II End User has agreed to lease all eight oil storage tanks in Phase II and will become the end-user with respect to Phase II once Phase II becomes operational, which is expected to occur during the Fourth Quarter of 2020. In September 2019, with the approval of the Phase II End User, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Customer Agreement with BIA to restructure its relationship with the Phase II End User. Under the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC leased the Phase II facilities to BIA, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed the rights and obligations of BPGIC under the Phase II End User Agreement.

 

For more information regarding the Phase II End User Agreement, see “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Phase II End User Agreement and Phase II Customer Agreement”.

 

For more information regarding Phase II, see the sections entitled “Item 4.B Information on the Company ¾ Business Overview — Proposed Phase II” and “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Debt Sources of Liquidity”. In March 2019, BPGIC partnered with Sahara to develop and operate a modular refinery within the BPGIC Terminal with minimal capital expenditure by BPGIC. Under the terms of the parties agreement, Sahara would finance and arrange the development, construction and commissioning of a modular refinery capable of supplying IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur content shipping fuel with initial production capacity of 24,000 b/d.

 

In February 2020, BPGIC and Sahara mutually agreed to discontinue their joint development project to install a modular oil refinery at BPGIC’s terminal. Shortly thereafter, BPGIC entered into the Refinery Agreement, a new agreement with BIA which provides that the parties will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for the BIA Refinery, a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd operated by BPGIC. The parties further agreed to negotiate, within 30 days, the Refinery Operations Agreement, a sublease agreement and a joint venture agreement to govern the terms on which (i) BPGIC will sublease land to BIA to locate, (ii) BIA will construct, and (iii) BPGIC will operate the refinery. Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, the parties agreed to extend the period for their negotiations until August 4, 2020 and negotiations remain ongoing.

 

BPGIC is in the advanced stages of planning Phase III, a major expansion in the Port of Fujairah. In February 2020, BPGIC entered into the Phase III Land Lease Agreement to secure the Phase III Land, a new plot of land of approximately 450,000 m2 near its existing facilities. BPGIC believes that the Phase III Land can house additional storage capacity of up to 3,500,000 m3. s of the date of this Report, BPGIC does not yet have any planned capital expenditures in connection with Phase III, other than the cost of a FEED study for storage capacity of up to 3.5 million m3 and a 180,000 bbl refinery.

 

The SEC maintains an Internet site that contains reports, proxy and information statements, and other information regarding issuers that file electronically with the SEC which is accessible at http://www.sec.gov. Since we are a “foreign private issuer,” we are exempt from the rules and regulations under the Exchange Act prescribing the furnishing and content of proxy statements, and our officers, directors and principal shareholders are exempt from the reporting and “short-swing” profit recovery provisions contained in Section 16 of the Exchange Act, with respect to their purchase and sale of our shares. In addition, we are not required to file reports and financial statements with the SEC as frequently or as promptly as U.S. companies whose securities are registered under the Exchange Act. However, we are required to file with the SEC an Annual Report on Form 20-F containing financial statements audited by an independent accounting firm. The Company’s website is https://www.broogeholdings.com/.

 

32

 

 

B. Business Overview

 

In this section, references to “we,” “us,” “BPGIC” and “our” are intended to refer to Brooge Energy Limited and its subsidiaries, unless the context clearly indicates otherwise.

 

This section contains forward-looking statements about the business and operations of the Company and BPGIC. The actual results of the Company and BPGIC may differ materially from those currently anticipated as a result of many factors, including those described under “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this prospectus. See “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward Looking Statements”.

 

Overview

 

BPGIC is an oil storage and service provider strategically located in the Port of Fujairah in the emirate of Fujairah in the UAE. BPGIC’s vision is to develop an oil storage business that differentiates itself from competitors by providing its customers with fast order processing times, excellent customer service and high accuracy blending services with low oil losses. BPGIC has a 60-year lease of land, consisting of an initial 30-year lease and a 30-year renewal lease, for its operations located in close proximity to the Port of Fujairah’s berth connection points. BPGIC is initially developing its terminal’s storage capacity in two phases, Phase I, which is already operational, and Phase II, which is under construction, and simultaneously considering and planning to operate the modular refinery being constructed by BIA. Phase I commenced operations in December 2017, Phase II is under construction, the terms of development of the BIA Refinery are currently being negotiated, and Phase III is in the FEED studies stage. BPGIC is led by an experienced management team with over 30 years of experience in the oil storage terminal industry.

 

The Port of Fujairah is the main bunkering location in the MENA region and the second largest bunkering hub in the world. The Port of Fujairah has witnessed increased growth in port traffic in recent years with oil and oil product volumes increasing at a compound annual growth rate of 15 percent over the eight-year period from 2010 (34 million MT) to 2017 (90 million MT). Located just outside the Strait of Hormuz, the Port of Fujairah allows ships transporting oil and oil products to bypass the Strait of Hormuz, one of world’s most vulnerable chokepoints given that 35 percent of the world’s seaborne oil and oil products passes through it each year. There is an increasing preference among companies to avoid sending their vessels through the Strait of Hormuz due to geopolitical risk, higher transportation costs due to increased insurance costs as well as congestion and queuing times at ports inside the Arabian Gulf. The Port of Fujairah’s geographic position outside the Strait of Hormuz allows vessels transporting oil and oil products to bypass the Strait of Hormuz and avoid incurring such additional costs and delays.

 

Phase I comprises 14 oil storage tanks with an aggregate geometric oil storage capacity of approximately 0.399 million m3 and related infrastructure. The operations of Phase I are focused primarily on the storage, heating and blending of fuel oil and clean petroleum products, including aviation fuel, gas oil, gasoline, marine gas oil and naphtha. BPGIC designed Phase I to focus its operations on servicing such products after assessing the historical and expected demand for such services in the Port of Fujairah region and the evolution and availability of associated infrastructure. As described below, BPGIC designed Phase I with several key features that enable it to provide users with high accuracy blending services with low oil losses. In addition, due to the relatively long term of Phase I & II Land Lease, which has a total period of 60 years, when compared to similar land leases for oil storage terminals located in the Port of Fujairah, BPGIC constructed Phase I with materials, including pumps, valves and steel structures, that have longer expected life spans than comparable materials utilized by other oil storage terminals. As a result, BPGIC believes Phase I will benefit from annual maintenance costs over the period of the Phase I & II Land Lease that are lower than the average for comparable oil storage terminals. In addition, all 14 oil storage tanks in Phase I have been designed to permit conversions from storing one clean petroleum product to another at an average speed of 48 hours and from storing fuel oil to gas oil at an average speed of 14 days, which BPGIC believes compares favorably to BPGIC’s competitors in the UAE region, allowing BPGIC to swiftly adjust its services to meet changing market demands. BPGIC can perform up to 11 simultaneous operations in Phase I, including tank-to-tank transfers, recirculations, blending, heating, loading and discharging, permitting BPGIC to service multiple user orders during the same time period. Phase I has a fully segregated internal manifold, high oil transfer flow rates and an indirect connection to all the Port of Fujairah berths, including certain underutilized berths that are in close proximity to the BPGIC Terminal, to allow users to benefit from lower contamination risks and faster vessel turnaround times and permitting greater access to the BPGIC Terminal. As is common in the oil storage industry, BPGIC commenced operations of Phase I on a staggered basis to ensure a safe and efficient start-up of operations. From the time BPGIC began its operations in December 2017 to March 2018 (testing period), BPGIC limited the availability of its storage capacity to 40 percent, allowing its management team to test all systems and make any necessary adjustments. BPGIC increased the availability of its storage capacity to approximately 70 percent on March 1, 2018, and to 100 percent on April 1, 2018.

 

33

 

 

Since it began operations, BPGIC has won four awards and been shortlisted for several others. In 2019, BPGIC was named the winner of the “Outstanding Port/Terminal Design of the Year 2019” award by The Global Ports Forum, and of the “Excellence in Terminal Optimisation Award” by Tank Storage Magazine’s Global Tank Storage Awards. In March 2018, BPGIC was short-listed by Tank Storage magazine, despite its relatively short track record, for the “Most Efficient Storage Terminal” global award for best throughput rates and most effective operations. In March 2019, BPGIC was once again, short-listed by Tank Storage magazine for the “Most Efficient Storage Terminal” global award, as well as the “Safety Excellence in Bulk Liquid Storage” and “Biggest Commitment to Environmental Protection” global awards.

 

In order to de-risk the start-up of operations of Phase I, on December 12, 2017, BPGIC entered into the Phase I End User Agreement with the Initial Phase I End User. Pursuant to the Phase I End User Agreement, the Initial Phase I End User leased all 14 oil storage tanks in Phase I for an initial period of five years, which extends automatically for an additional five years unless terminated prior to the scheduled expiration date. In August 2019, with the approval of the Initial Phase I End User, BPGIC entered into the Phase I Customer Agreement with BIA to restructure its relationship with the Initial Phase I End User. Under the Phase I Customer Agreement, BPGIC leased the Phase I facilities to BIA, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed the rights and obligations of BPGIC under the Phase I End User Agreement. In 2020, BIA notified BPGIC that it had entered sublease arrangements for parts of the Phase I storage capacity with additional end users. For more information regarding the Phase I End User Agreement and Phase I Customer Agreement, see “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Phase I End User Agreement, Phase I Customer Agreement and Super Major Agreement”.

 

As Phase I neared completion, BPGIC finalized plans for Phase II in the Third Quarter of 2017. On June 27, 2018, BPGIC entered into the Phase II End User Agreement with the Phase II End User. On September 3, 2018, BPGIC signed the Phase II EPC Agreement with Audex. Phase II work commenced in September 2018 and according to the schedule in the Phase II EPC Agreement, it is expected to be completed in 2020. The expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II is $160.6 million (comprised of construction costs of $150.0 million and capitalised interest and land lease and consultancy charges of $10.6 million). On September 3, 2018, BPGIC signed the Phase II Project Management Agreement with MUC to engage MUC to manage the construction plan of Phase II.

 

On October 15, 2018, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Financing Facility, which is a $95.3 million secured Shari’a compliant Istisna’ financing arrangement coordinated by FAB, to fund a portion of the capital expenditure in respect of Phase II.

 

In September 2019, with the approval of the Phase II End User, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Customer Agreement with BIA to restructure its relationship with the Phase II End User. Under the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC leased the Phase II facilities to BIA, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed the rights and obligations of BPGIC under the Phase II End User Contract. Following this restructuring, BPGIC leases the Phase II facility to BIA, and BIA subleases the facility to the Phase II End User. BIA’s obligations to pay BPGIC for the storage and ancillary services provided at the Phase II facility are independent of the Phase II End User’s actual payments to BIA.

 

34

 

 

Phase II is expected to focus its operations primarily on the storage and blending of crude oil. Phase II involves the construction of eight additional oil storage tanks with an aggregate geometric oil storage capacity of approximately 0.601 million m3, which will increase BPGIC’s aggregate geometric oil storage capacity to approximately 1 million m3. In February 2017, BPGIC finalized and issued a front end engineering document, which sets out the qualifications, specifications, drawings and designs of Phase II, to Audex. On September 3, 2018, BPGIC signed Phase II EPC Agreement. As part of Phase II, BPGIC has followed a similar approach to Phase I by investing in high-grade, long-life materials for the construction and development of its facilities. Audex commenced construction of Phase II in September 2018 and plans to complete construction in 2020. Phase II is being constructed adjacent to Phase I. The expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II is $160.6 million which is comprised of construction costs of $150.0 million and capitalised interest and land lease and consultancy charges of $10.6 million. The expected capital expenditure of $160.6 million in respect of Phase II will be funded by:

 

drawings of $90.6 million under the Phase II Financing Facility; and

 

shareholders contributions, proceeds of the Business Combination, and internally generated cashflow in the aggregate amount of $70.0 million.

 

Of the $160.6 million expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II, $39.20 million was paid by the end of fiscal year 2019. During 2020, $24.8 million was paid through June 2020 and balance is expected to be paid out before the end of the year. See “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — BPGIC may be subject to significant risks and expenses when constructing Phase II, which could adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

As was the case with Phase I, in order to de-risk the start-up of operations of Phase II, on June 27, 2018, BPGIC entered into the Phase II End User Agreement with the Phase II End User, an international commodities trading company. Pursuant to the Phase II End User Agreement, the Phase II End User has agreed to lease all eight oil storage tanks in Phase II and will become the end-user with respect to Phase II once Phase II becomes operational, which is expected to occur during the Fourth Quarter of 2020. In September 2019, with the approval of the Phase II End User, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Customer Agreement with BIA to restructure its relationship with the Phase II End User. Under the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC leased the Phase II facilities to BIA, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed the rights and obligations of BPGIC under the Phase II End User Agreement.

 

In May 2020, BIA agreed to release 129,000 m3 of the Phase I capacity, amounting to approximately one third of the total Phase I capacity, back to BPGIC. Pursuant to the Super Major Agreement, BPGIC leased this capacity to the Super Major for a 6 month period subject to renewal for an additional 6 month period with the mutual agreement of the parties. For more information regarding the Super Major Agreement, see “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Phase I End User Agreement, Phase I Customer Agreement and Super Major Agreement”.

 

In March 2019, BPGIC partnered with Sahara to develop and operate a modular refinery within the BPGIC Terminal with minimal capital expenditure by BPGIC. Under the terms of the parties agreement, Sahara would finance and arrange the development, construction and commissioning of a modular refinery capable of supplying IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur content shipping fuel with initial production capacity of 25,000 b/d.

 

In February 2020, BPGIC and Sahara mutually agreed to discontinue their joint development project to install a modular oil refinery at BPGIC’s terminal. Shortly thereafter, BPGIC entered into the Refinery Agreement, a new agreement with BIA which provides that the parties will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for the BIA Refinery, a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd operated by BPGIC on land leased by BPGIC. The parties further agreed to negotiate, within 30 days, a sublease agreement and a joint venture agreement to govern the terms on which BPGIC will sublease land to BIA to locate, BIA will construct, and BPGIC will operate the refinery. Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, the parties agreed to extend the period for their negotiations until August 2020and negotiations remain ongoing.

 

BPGIC is in advanced stages of planning Phase III, a further major expansion in the Port of Fujairah. In February 2020, BPGIC entered into the Phase III Land Lease Agreement to secure the Phase III Land, a new plot of land of approximately 450,000 m2 near its existing facilities. BPGIC believes that the Phase III Land can house additional storage capacity and refinery of up to 3,500,000 m3. The Phase III Land is the subject of ongoing FEED studies, which, in parallel with prospective end-user discussions, will enable BPGIC to determine the optimal layout and product mix. Currently, BPGIC plans to use the Phase III Land to further increase its crude oil storage and refinery services capacity. See “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — The scarcity of available land in the Fujairah oil zone region could subject BPGIC to competition for additional land, unfavorable lease terms for that land and limit BPGIC’s ability to expand its facilities in Fujairah beyond Phase III.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2019, the Company generated revenue from operations of $44.0 million, a loss and total comprehensive loss of $76.5 million and an Adjusted EBITDA of $37.1 million. As at December 31, 2019, the Company had total assets of $307.3 million. For more information regarding BPGIC’s financial condition and results of operations, see “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects”.

 

35

 

 

Competitive Strengths

 

Strategic location of the BPGIC Terminal.

 

The BPGIC Terminal is strategically located in the Port of Fujairah, which is the main bunkering location in the MENA region and the second largest bunkering hub in the world. The Port of Fujairah has witnessed increased growth in port traffic in recent years with oil and oil product volumes increasing at a compound annual growth rate of 15 percent over the eight-year period from 2010 (34 million MT) to 2017 (90 million MT). Located just outside the Port of Fujairah, the Strait of Hormuz is one of world’s most vulnerable chokepoints for the transportation of oil and oil products as approximately 35 percent of the world’s yearly average seaborne oil and oil products passes through it each year. There is an increasing preference among companies to avoid sending their vessels through the Strait of Hormuz due to the continued geopolitical uncertainty from Iran and the higher transportation costs due to increased insurance costs as well as congestion and queuing times at ports inside the Arabian Gulf. The Port of Fujairah’s geographic position outside the Strait of Hormuz allows vessels transporting oil and oil products to bypass the Strait of Hormuz and avoid incurring such additional costs and delays.

 

In addition, the BPGIC Terminal is strategically positioned in a prime location within the Port of Fujairah. BPGIC benefits from the BPGIC Terminal’s close proximately to berths 8 and 9 due to the shorter travel distances required for oil product transfers, which in effect lowers contamination risks and leads to faster vessel turnaround times.

 

Best-in-class facility with low costs.

 

BPGIC operates the BPGIC Terminal under a 60-year lease, which has allowed BPGIC to design and build a terminal for long term use by using materials that have longer expected life spans than comparable materials utilized by other oil storage terminals in the MENA region, which the Company believes enabled it to build a best-in-class facility. As of the date of this Report, the BPGIC Terminal has been inspected by five of the top six global oil majors, all of the top five global oil traders, the top three regional oil traders and three of the five local and regional state oil companies. As is common in the oil storage industry, BPGIC did not receive any notifications from such companies as to whether the BPGIC Terminal was approved for use by such companies; however, in each case, BPGIC believes the BPGIC Terminal was approved.

 

Phase I was constructed by Audex, an EPC contractor that has a strong track record in building terminals and over 20 years of experience in the industry. All 14 oil storage tanks in Phase I have been designed to permit conversions from storing one clean petroleum product to another at an average speed of 48 hours and from storing fuel oil to gas oil at an average speed of 14 days, which BPGIC believes compares favorably to BPGIC’s competitors in the UAE region, allowing BPGIC to adjust its services to meet changing market demands. BPGIC can perform up to 11 simultaneous operations in Phase I, including tank-to-tank transfers, recirculations, blending, heating, loading and discharging, permitting BPGIC to service multiple user orders during the same time period. Phase I has a fully segregated internal manifold, high oil transfer flow rates and an indirect connection to all the Port of Fujairah berths, including certain underutilized berths that are in close proximity to the BPGIC Terminal, to allow users to benefit from lower contamination risks and faster vessel turnaround times while permitting greater access to the BPGIC Terminal. A fine stripping system has been installed, to minimize energy costs, lowering loss ratios and a higher degree of stripping.

 

In addition, maintenance costs for the BPGIC Terminal are relatively low. Furthermore, as the BPGIC Terminal is located in a free-zone, BPGIC is currently not required to pay any taxes and both the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Phase II Customer Agreement specify that any port fees charged by the Port of Fujairah in connection with BIA’s activities, or those of BIA’s sublessees, are to be paid by BIA. Similarly, the Super Major Agreement specifies that any port fees charged by the Port of Fujairah related to the Super Major’s activities are to be paid by the Super Major.

 

36

 

 

As discussed below in the sections entitled “Item 4.B Business Overview — Strategy — Expand the scale of existing operations by completing Phase II and operating the BIA Refinery”, “Item 4.B Business Overview — The BPGIC Terminal — Proposed BIA Refinery”, and “Item 4.B Business Overview — The BPGIC Terminal — Proposed Phase II”, BPGIC is currently partnering with BIA in connection with the development of the modular BIA Refinery, and undertaking Phase II construction, which will expand the terminal’s oil storage capacity and enable it to provide services for crude oil. As was the case for Phase I, high-grade, long-life materials will be utilized in the construction and development of these facilities. Phase II will also benefit from the fine stripping system utilized in Phase I. Furthermore, the Phase II Customer Agreement specifies that any port fees charged by the Port of Fujairah in connection with BIA’s activities are to be paid by BIA.

 

Stable and predictable revenue stream for storage services.

 

BPGIC generates stable and predictable cash flows for its storage services by providing fee-based, take-or-pay storage services to BIA, under a long-term agreement. BPGIC’s storage business is not subject to seasonal fluctuations.

 

BPGIC entered into the Phase I End User Agreement on December 12, 2017, pursuant to which the Initial Phase I End User paid a monthly fixed storage fee to lease all of Phase I’s storage capacity (irrespective of whether the Initial Phase I End User used any storage capacity). The Phase I End User Agreement is for an initial period of five years, with a remaining period of approximately three and a half years, and is renewable for an additional five year period. For the year ended December 31, 2017, BPGIC generated 100 percent of its total revenue from monthly fees for storage services For the year ended December 31, 2018, BPGIC generated 57.9 percent of its total revenue from monthly fees for storage services. For the year ended December 31, 2019, BPGIC generated 54.3 percent of its total revenue from monthly fees for storage services.

 

In August 2019, BPGIC entered into the Phase I Customer Agreement to restructure its relationship with the Initial Phase I End User. Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement, BPGIC leased the Phase I facility to BIA on identical price terms and otherwise on substantially the same terms as those of the Phase I End User Agreement, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed BPGIC’s rights and obligations under the Phase I End User Agreement. Like the Initial Phase I End User, BIA is required to pay a monthly fixed storage fee to lease Phase I’s storage capacity. In 2020, BIA notified BPGIC that it had entered sublease arrangements for parts of the Phase I storage capacity with additional end users. BIA is required to satisfy any amounts due for the monthly fixed storage fee in advance for each applicable month. Although BIA subleases the Phase I facility to the Initial Phase I End User pursuant to the novated Phase I End User Agreement, BIA’s obligation to pay the monthly fixed storage fee to BPGIC is independent of BIA’s obligation to pay, and actual payment to, BIA. The Phase I Customer Agreement is for an initial period of four years with a renewal period of five years. The level of the fixed storage fee for Phase I is more than sufficient to cover all of BPGIC’s Phase I operating costs (other than the variable costs associated with ancillary services), including operating costs, wages, depreciation and interest costs. See “Item 10.C Material Contracts— Phase I End User Agreement and Phase I Customer Agreement and Super Major Agreement— Storage Fee”.

 

In May 2020, BIA agreed to release 129,000 m3 of the Phase I capacity, amounting to approximately one third of the total Phase I capacity, back to BPGIC. Pursuant to the Super Major Agreement, BPGIC leased this capacity to the Super Major. The Super Major is required to pay a monthly fixed storage fee to lease its storage capacity at Phase I. The Super Major paid the storage fee for the initial six month term of the Super Major Agreement up front. The Super Major Agreement is renewable for an additional six months with the mutual agreement of the parties. See “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Phase I End User Agreement, Phase I Customer Agreement and Super Major Agreement — Storage Fee”.

 

The Phase I Customer Agreement also provides that every two years, BPGIC may elect to review and seek to amend the storage fee. The Phase I Customer Agreement provides that the outcome of this review can result only in either an increase in rates or no change.

 

BPGIC and BIA are still negotiating the Refinery Operations Agreement, however BPGIC expects that upon the commencement of the BIA Refinery’s operations, which is currently projected to occur during the Third Quarter of 2021, BIA will pay a monthly fixed fee for storage leased in connection with the BIA Refinery. BPGIC entered into the Phase II End User Agreement on June 27, 2018, pursuant to which the Phase II End User is required to pay a monthly fixed storage fee to lease all of Phase II’s storage capacity (regardless of whether the Phase II End User uses any storage capacity) once the facility is operational. The Phase II End User Agreement is for an initial period of five years from January 1, 2020 (subject to adjustment if the facility is not operational on that date), and is renewable for an additional five year period.

 

37

 

 

In September 2019, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Customer Agreement to restructure its relationship with the Phase II End User. Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC agreed to lease the Phase II facility to BIA, once operational, on identical price terms and otherwise on substantially the same terms as those of the Phase II End User Agreement, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed BPGIC’s rights and obligations under the Phase II End User Agreement. Like the Phase II End User, BIA is required to pay a monthly fixed storage fee to lease all of Phase II’s storage capacity. BIA is required to satisfy any amounts due for the monthly fixed storage fee in advance for each applicable month. Although BIA subleases the Phase II facility to the Phase II End User pursuant to the Phase II End User Agreement, BIA’s obligation to pay the monthly fixed storage fee to BPGIC is independent of the Phase II End User’s obligation to pay, and actual payment to, BIA. The Phase II Customer Agreement is for an initial period of five years with a renewal period of five years.

 

Suite of ancillary services, which provide additional revenue streams.

 

Under the Phase I End User Agreement, BPGIC was able to increase its revenue beyond the monthly fixed storage fee by providing the Initial Phase I End User with ancillary services. These ancillary services included throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers and earned BPGIC additional revenue in accordance with the type and quantity of ancillary services the Initial Phase I End User requested.

 

The Initial Phase I End User primarily acts as an intermediary in the oil products and services supply chain by obtaining purchase or service orders for certain oil products (including fuel oil and refined petroleum products) from oil companies and then working with service providers such as BPGIC to fulfil such orders. The year ended December 31, 2017, ancillary services did not generate any contribution towards revenue. For the year ended December 31, 2018, BPGIC generated 42.1 percent of its total revenue from monthly fees for ancillary services. For the year ended December 31, 2019, BPGIC generated 45.7 percent of its total revenue from monthly fees for ancillary services. BPGIC expects its revenues from ancillary services to be a significant driver of value for BPGIC going forward. See “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Phase I End User Agreement, Phase I Customer Agreement and Super Major Agreement — Ancillary Services”.

 

Similarly, under the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement, BPGIC is able to supplement its revenue by providing BIA or its sublessees, and the Super Major, ancillary services including throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers. To provide these ancillary services, BPGIC charges a fee, that varies by service, equal to a contractual rate per m3 per month. As a result, BPGIC earns additional revenue in accordance with the type and quantity of ancillary services BIA or its sublessees, and the Super Major, use. BPGIC’s ability to provide ancillary services is enhanced due to the design of Phase I, which was designed, among other things, to provide high accuracy blending services with low oil losses, high oil transfer flow rates and the ability to perform up to 11 simultaneous operations, which contributes to Phase I’s attractiveness as a one-stop location for extensive product customization. Because all of BPGIC’s costs are covered by the storage fee, revenues from ancillary services (less any associated variable costs) are a significant driver of profitability for BPGIC. BPGIC’s monthly revenue for ancillary services will depend on the extent to which BIA’s sublessees and the Super Major, utilize the ancillary services. Although BPGIC’s ancillary services revenue is partially dependent on the Phase I sublessees, BIA’s obligation to pay for the ancillary services used by it or the Initial Phase I End User (or other sublessee) is independent of the sublessees’ obligation to pay, and actual payment to, BIA.

 

The Phase I Customer Agreement also provides that every two years, BPGIC may elect to review and seek to amend the ancillary services fees. The Phase I Customer Agreement provides that the outcome of this review can result only in either an increase in rates or no change.

 

Although BPGIC and BIA are still negotiating the Refinery Operations Agreement, BPGIC expects that BIA will pay ancillary service fees in connection with any ancillary services that it uses. Although such use may be greater or lesser than, and the fees generated by such use may be greater or lesser than, the fees currently received from BIA based on the usage of its end users, we BIA Refinery will provide an operating financial benefit to BPGIC.

  

The ancillary service terms of the Phase II Customer Agreement are similar to the ancillary service terms of the Phase I Customer Agreement. Upon the commencement of Phase II’s operations, which is expected to occur during the second half of 2020, BPGIC expects that the ancillary service operations of Phase II will be substantially similar to the ancillary service operations of Phase I.

 

Experienced senior management team.

 

BPGIC is led by the members of senior management, who have over 30 years of experience collectively in the oil storage terminal, infrastructure sectors and related markets. As a result, members of senior management will be able to leverage their significant experience while implementing and executing BPGIC’s business plan and to achieve certain growth milestones. Members of senior management also have experience with overseeing the construction of oil storage terminals as a result of the Phase I construction process, which is expected to facilitate their management and execution of the Phase II and Phase III construction process and other future projects.

 

38

 

  

Industry and Market Data

 

The Company and BPGIC rely on and refer to industry data, information and statistics regarding the markets in which it competes from research as well as from publicly available information and industry and general publications. The Company and BPGIC have supplemented this information where necessary with their own internal estimates and information obtained from discussions with BPGIC customers, taking into account publicly available information about other industry participants and management’s best view as to information that is not publicly available. The Company has taken such care as it considers reasonable in the extraction and reproduction of information from such data from third-party sources.

 

Industry publications, research, studies and forecasts generally state that the information they contain has been obtained from sources believed to be reliable, but that the accuracy and completeness of such information is not guaranteed. Forecasts and other forward-looking information obtained from these sources are subject to the same qualifications and uncertainties as the other forward-looking statements in this Report. These forecasts and forward-looking information are subject to uncertainty and risk due to a variety of factors, including those described under “Item 3.D Risk Factors.” These and other factors could cause results to differ materially from those expressed in the forecasts or estimates from independent third parties and us.

 

Strategy

 

BPGIC’s vision is to develop an oil storage business that differentiates itself from competitors by providing its customers with fast order processing times, excellent customer service and high accuracy blending services with low oil losses. In this pursuit, the key components of BPGIC’s business strategy are as follows:

 

Expand the scale of existing operations by completing Phase II and operating the BIA Refinery.

 

BPGIC plans to leverage its experience from building and operating Phase I while building and ramping up operations for Phase II. Phase II involves the construction of eight additional oil storage tanks with an aggregate geometric oil storage capacity of approximately 0.601 million m3, which will increase BPGIC’s aggregate geometric oil storage capacity to approximately 1.0 million m3. This would lead to the BPGIC Terminal becoming one of the largest oil storage terminals by storage capacity in the Port of Fujairah. On September 3, 2018, BPGIC signed the Phase II EPC Agreement with Audex. Phase II work commenced in September 2018 and according to the schedule in the Phase II EPC Agreement, it is expected to be completed in 2020. The expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II is $160.6 million (comprised of construction costs of $150.0 million and capitalized interest and land lease and consultancy charges of $10.6 million). The expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II will be partially funded by drawings of $90.6 million under the Phase II Financing Facility. For details of the remaining expected capital expenditure, see “Item 4.B Business Overview— Overview”.

 

39

 

 

BPGIC expects Phase II operations to commence during the second half of 2020. BPGIC plans to focus Phase II’s operations primarily on the storage and blending of crude oil and thereby capitalize on the demand for crude oil storage. On June 27, 2018, BPGIC entered into the Phase II End User Agreement with the Phase II End User, an international commodities trading company. Pursuant to the Phase II End User Agreement, the Phase II End User agreed to lease all eight oil storage tanks in Phase II once Phase II becomes operational. In September 2019, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Customer Agreement to restructure its relationship with the Phase II End User. Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC agreed to lease the Phase II facility, once operational, to BIA on identical price terms and otherwise substantially similar terms as those of the Phase II End User Agreement, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed BPGIC’s rights and obligations under the Phase II End User Agreement. BPGIC expects to generate additional revenues and expenses in connection with Phase II’s operations. Similar to the commencement of operations for Phase I, BPGIC may initially commence operations of Phase II in accordance with certain required safety measures and ramp up utilization of its storage capacity and ancillary services over time to mitigate any potential operational risks. This would impact the amount of storage and ancillary service fees BPGIC would earn during the first quarter of operations under the Phase II Customer Agreement. For more information regarding the terms of the Phase II Customer Agreement, see “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Phase II End User Agreement and Phase II Customer Agreement”.

 

BPGIC is in discussion with BIA to finance, develop, construct and commission the BIA Refinery at minimal capital cost to BPGIC. The Refinery Operations Agreement is still under negotiation, but BPGIC expects that the BIA Refinery will have an initial production capacity of 25,000 b/d and be capable of producing IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur content shipping fuel. Upon completion, the BIA Refinery is expected to be one of first refineries in the MENA region producing IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur content shipping fuel. BPGIC currently expects the BIA Refinery to be developed, constructed and installed by the Second Quarter of 2021 and for operations to commence during the Third Quarter of 2021. For more information regarding the Refinery Agreement, see “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Refinery Agreement”.

 

Growth Through Expansion of BPGIC’s Facilities and Geography

 

BPGIC intends to leverage senior management’s long-standing industry expertise in the oil and gas and storage sector, initially within the Gulf region and, ultimately more broadly geographically, to ensure BPGIC continues to enhance its competitiveness, expand its solution offerings to customers and increase shareholder value. As a result, BPGIC is continuously looking at numerous expansion opportunities beyond Phase III. Our ordinary course of business includes discussions with various potential parties, regarding different types of business opportunities, and in a variety of different geographic markets. None of these ongoing various discussions have yet reached the stage of definitive agreements and there can be no assurance that they ever will.

 

The business opportunities available vary widely from traditional customer contracts with global industry participants to various partnerships, ranging from operating or acquiring existing facilities to building new facilities. Some potential partnership opportunities have included partial or full financing commitments from the prospective partner for the existing or new facilities, while some opportunities are traditional acquisitions by the Company of existing facilities. The Company carefully evaluates all growth opportunities to ensure its business remains focused on its high-end market positioning and value creation for existing shareholders.

 

For instance, within the Fujairah market, BPGIC is now in the FEED stage for the further major expansion near its existing facilities, which it refers to as Phase III. In February 2020, BPGIC executed the Phase III Land Lease Agreement, a lease agreement to secure a new plot of land of approximately 450,000 m2, near its existing facilities. BPGIC currently intends to use such land to further increase its capacity for crude oil storage and services by an additional capacity. We expect that Phase III alone could be three-and-a-half (3.5) times the size of the Company’s projected operations post-Phase II. Concurrently, BPGIC is in discussions with top global oil majors, which have expressed interest in securing portions of the capacity of a Phase III facility. As of the date of this Report, BPGIC does not yet have any planned capital expenditures in connection with Phase III, other than the cost of a FEED study for storage capacity of up to 3.5 million m3 and a 180,000 bbl refinery. For more information regarding Phase III, see the section entitled “Item 4.A History and Development of the Company— Proposed Phase III.”

 

In addition to this specific land for Phase III, BPGIC will continue to pursue additional projects within the Fujairah market, either through partnerships with parties who have land leases or through efforts to secure additional land itself in Fujairah.

 

Preliminary discussions with existing and potential customers regarding geographic expansion opportunities outside of BPGIC’s current market by acquiring certain of their existing facilities as part of long-term service contracts are ongoing. For instance, BPGIC has entered into preliminary agreements with a global commodity trading firm to evaluate acquisitions of that firm’s interests in oil storage terminals in Africa and Europe. We believe both terminals are well located and provide strategic opportunities for our expansion into those markets, including available land to expand with new state-of-the-art facilities such as we have in Fujairah. We are in the preliminary due diligence phase with respect to these opportunities, and there is no assurance we will decide to pursue them.

 

40

 

 

For related risks, see “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — Beyond Phase II, expansion of BPGIC’s business may require substantial capital investment, and it may not have sufficient capital to make future capital expenditures and other investments as it deems necessary or desirable”.

 

Continue to build relationships with potential customers.

 

BPGIC is focused on diversifying its potential customer base over the medium to long-term. Due to Phase I’s strong performance track record to date, and BPGIC’s reputation and business development efforts, including through inspections from potential users, BPGIC believes that it has developed strong relationships with several oil traders that could potentially utilize the services of Phase I and II. The familiarity potential users have gained through their inspections and that oil traders have developed through their experience with BPGIC’s Phase I facility represent a valuable marketing opportunity for BPGIC: given the nature of the industry, positive word-of-mouth feedback by these groups can help to establish BPGIC’s industry reputation and thereby help drive potential customer business in the future. Moreover, by continuing to build upon BPGIC’s performance track record during Phase II (after it commences operations) and business developments efforts, BPGIC would be able to expand its base of potential customers for future contracts for oil storage or ancillary services. Similarly, the BIA Refinery, once operational, will expand the scope of services that BPGIC can offer, diversifying the types of industry participants that it can service.

 

Phase I

 

Phase I went into operation in December 2017 and between 2014 and 2017, BPGIC incurred a total cost of $170 million in connection with its construction. BPGIC began development of the BPGIC Terminal after several years of planning and discussions with industry participants. BPGIC’s aim in developing the BPGIC Terminal was to create a new standard for oil storage tank terminals by designing a terminal that would reduce user oil losses and achieve better blending results than existing oil storage tank terminals. As described below, BPGIC designed Phase I with several key features that enable it to provide users with high-accuracy blending services with low oil losses. In addition, due to the relatively long term of the Phase I & II Land Lease, when compared to comparable land leases for oil storage terminals located in the Port of Fujairah, BPGIC constructed Phase I with materials that have longer expected life spans than comparable materials utilized by other oil storage terminals in the area. As a result, BPGIC believes Phase I will benefit from annual maintenance costs over the period of the Phase I & II Land Lease that are lower than average for comparable oil storage terminals.

 

The key features of Phase I include:

 

all 14 oil storage tanks are inter-connected via the internal manifold that connects the 14 oil storage tanks of Phase I (the “Phase I Internal Manifold”);

 

the pumping and stripping systems of the Phase I Internal Manifold are equipped with a fine stripping system, minimizing energy costs, lowering loss ratios and permitting a high degree of stripping to be achieved;

 

the ability to more efficiently perform required maintenance activities and prepare pipelines for oil transfers;

 

lower loss ratios and contamination risks;

 

recirculation of oil products to assist with the blending process;

 

the ability to simultaneously perform several Phase I operations, permitting BPGIC to service multiple user orders during the same time period; and

 

all 14 oil storage tanks have been designed to permit conversions from storing one clean petroleum product to another and from storing fuel oil to gas oil at a speed which is favorable compared to that of competitors in the UAE region, allowing BPGIC to adjust its services to meet changing market demands.

 

Tanks

 

Phase I has 14 oil storage tanks, which are capable of storing gas oil, marine gas oil, fuel oil, naphtha, aviation fuel, gasoline, pygas, reformate, cutter stock and methyl tert-butyl ether. Each of the oil storage tanks has been designed to allow fast and efficient cleaning, which permits efficient conversions from storing one product to another. The 14 oil storage tanks are also equipped with the following features:

 

accurate product level measurements: a real-time electronic measuring system that monitors product levels in each oil storage tank;

 

an efficient, high-quality blending system which improves the quality and speed of blends;

 

effective drainage systems leading to lower product contamination risks and allowing for a faster product change process;

 

automated fire-fighting systems: an automated fire system that activates automatically in the event of a fire;

 

41

 

 

a well-designed pipeline connection: a pipeline connection to the Phase I Internal Manifold that allows any oil storage tank to be connected to the stripping systems and to any other oil storage tank or berth in the Port of Fujairah connected to Matrix Manifold 1 or Matrix Manifold 2; and

 

heating services: eight of the oil storage tanks have heating coils installed. Currently, only four of the oil storage tanks are connected to the heating system.

 

The following table displays the key attributes of the 14 oil storage tanks of Phase I:

 

Tank No.   Capable of 
Servicing(1)
  Diameter (m) x
Height (m)
  Blending
Capability
  Roof Type(2)   Tank Heating
Capability
  Geometric
Capacity (m3)
  Max
Capacity (m3)
101   GO/ FO   42 x 30   Yes   AGDR   Yes   41,563   40,207
102   GO/ FO   42 x 30   Yes   AGDR   Yes   41,563   40,207
103   GO/ FO   42 x 30   Yes   AGDR   Yes   41,563   40,207
104   GO/ FO   42 x 30   Yes   AGDR   Yes   41,563   40,207
105   Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ MGO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate   36 x 30   Yes   AGDR with IFR   Yes, but not currently enabled   30,536   29,031
106   Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ MGO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate   36 x 30   Yes   AGDR with IFR   Yes, but not currently enabled   30,536   29,031
107   Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ MGO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate   36 x 30   Yes   AGDR with IFR   Yes, but not currently enabled   30,536   29,031
108   Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ MGO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate   36 x 30   Yes   AGDR with IFR   Yes, but not currently enabled   30,536   29,031
109   Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ MGO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate   36 x 30   Yes   AGDR with IFR   No   30,536   29,031
110   Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ MGO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate   36 x 30   Yes   AGDR with IFR   No   30,536   29,031
111   Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate/ CS   23 x 30   Yes   AGDR   No   12,464   11,850
112   Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate/ CS   23 x 30   Yes   AGDR   No   12,464   11,850
113   MTBE/ Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate   23 x 30   Yes   AGDR with IFR   No   12,464   11,850
114   MTBE / Gasoline/ AF/ GO/ Naphtha/ Pygas/ Reformate   23 x 30   Yes   AGDR with IFR   No   12,464   11,850
Total Storage Capacity (m3)   399,324   382,400

 

____________
(1) All the oil storage tanks are convertible and can be cleaned and converted to service other oil products; “GO” means Gas Oil; “FO” means Fuel Oil; “AF” means Aviation Fuel; “MGO” means Marine Gas Oil; “CS” means Cutter Stock; “MTBE” means Methyl Tertiary-Butyl Ether.
(2) “AGDR” means Aluminium Geodesic Dome Roof; “AGDR with IFR” means Aluminium Geodesic Dome Roof with Internal Floating Roof.

 

42

 

 

BPGIC transports oil products from the BPGIC Terminal to the Port of Fujairah’s berths through the use of pumps and four piggable jetty pipelines. The pumps facilitate on-loading operations from the Phase I Internal Manifold by pumping oil products through one or more of the four piggable jetty pipelines to Matrix Manifold 2, and then through the Port of Fujairah’s pipelines, to ships located at berths 8 and 9 or to ships located at berths 2-7 via Matrix Manifold 1. BPGIC has seven pumps that it can use to on-load oil products to Matrix Manifold 2. Four of the pumps are capable of transporting gas oil/gasoline at an individual flow rate of 1,250 m3/hr and at a combined flow rate of 5,000 m3/hr. Three of the pumps are capable of transporting fuel oil at an individual flow rate of 1,500 m3/hr and at a combined flow rate of 4,500 m3/hr. BPGIC also utilizes these pumps to facilitate inter-tank transfers, blending and other transfers throughout the BPGIC Terminal.

 

The users utilize their ship pumps to transport oil products from the relevant berths in the Port of Fujairah via Matrix Manifold 2 to the Phase I Internal Manifold, and following the construction and commencement of operations of Phase II, to the proposed internal manifold that will connect the 8 oil storage tanks of Phase II (the “Phase II Internal Manifold”).

 

The Phase I Internal Manifold is equipped with a general stripping system that removes any excess oil products left in the pipelines following any oil product transfers and adds it back to appropriate batches, and a fine stripping system that removes any excess oil products left in the general stripping system and adds it back to appropriate batches. The two levels of stripping permit a high degree of stripping to be achieved. All oil products transferred from any oil storage tank to the stripping systems flows downhill, minimizing energy costs. The Phase I Internal Manifold is also equipped with cranes to perform required maintenance activities and prepare pipelines for oil transfers.

 

As part of Phase II, BPGIC is currently constructing the Phase II Internal Manifold, an additional internal manifold system to enable crude oil operations. The Phase II Internal Manifold is being constructed adjacent to the Phase I Internal Manifold on the remaining land available under the Phase I & II Land Lease.

 

Direct Connection to Matrix Manifold 2

 

The Phase I Internal Manifold is directly connected to the Port of Fujairah’s Matrix Manifold 2, which is approximately 500 meters away. The Matrix Manifold 2 is directly connected to berths 8 and 9, which are in close proximity to the BPGIC Terminal. The terminal benefits from its close proximately to berths 8 and 9 due to the shorter travel distances required for oil product transfers, which in effect lowers contamination risks and leads to faster vessel turnaround times. Berths 8 and 9 can accommodate vessels with a maximum overall length of 330 meters and a minimum overall length of 75 meters. As part of Phase II, BPGIC plans to directly connect the Phase II Internal Manifold to the Port of Fujairah’s Matrix Manifold 2.

 

The Matrix Manifold 2 is also connected to the Port of Fujairah’s Matrix Manifold 1, which is in turn connected to berths 1-7 of the Port of Fujairah, providing users with broad access to the BPGIC Terminal.

 

Generators

 

Four electricity generators were installed as part of the construction of Phase I. The generators, developed by Cummins Generator Technologies, are diesel-powered and can produce up to 6,000 kWh of power, which BPGIC believes will be sufficient to provide for the needs of Phase I, Phase II and the BIA Refinery. As BPGIC’s diesel fuel needs currently vary each month based on the Phase I sublessees’ and the Super Major’s activity levels, BPGIC entered into an arrangement with a local diesel fuel provider, pursuant to which it can order diesel fuel on a monthly or as-needed basis. At the beginning of each month, the local diesel fuel provider will send BPGIC a quote for the price of diesel fuel, and subject to any potential price negotiation, BPGIC will place orders based on its projected needs for the applicable month.

 

43

 

 

Blending

 

BPGIC believes that Phase I benefits from state-of-the-art blending capabilities, allowing high levels of accuracy in meeting customer blending specifications. BPGIC’s blending services are designed to accommodate a variety of mixing specifications and to prevent any evaporation or leakage. The stripping systems and oil storage tanks are designed to prevent losses, contamination and residue accumulation, enabling BPGIC to produce blends that precisely meet customer specifications and the volume/mass requested.

 

All Phase I oil storage tanks are connected via the Phase I Internal Manifold and have blending capabilities, which permits BPGIC to utilize any available oil storage tank for blending purposes, leads to higher tank availability for processing user orders and allows BPGIC to perform mixtures within short timeframes.

 

Each of the oil storage tanks is equipped with some of the latest technology blending equipment and a real-time electronic measuring system that monitors product levels, resulting in faster blending times and more consistent blends. In connection with a standard blending request, BPGIC takes the specified quantity of oil products to be blended and adds them into a single oil storage tank. A part of the mixture is then withdrawn from and added back to the oil storage tank at high velocity. This typically causes the surrounding liquid to create a circulation path within the oil storage tank, which mixes the oil products and continues until the specified blend requirements are achieved. Generally, the purpose of blending fuel oil is to modify its viscosity or thickness to meet customer specifications and the purpose of blending gasoline is to modify its octane number to meet customer specifications.

 

Heating

 

As part of Phase I, BPGIC constructed a heating system, comprised of a boiler and direct pipeline connections to certain oil storage tanks that have heating coils installed. Generally, in connection with a heating request, BPGIC heats special purpose heating oil in the boiler and then circulates the heating oil via a pipeline connection to the heating coils located at the bottom of an applicable oil storage tank. The heating oil is then recirculated between the boiler and through the heating coils of the applicable oil storage tank until the oil product in the oil storage tank reaches the specified temperature.

 

Currently, eight of the Phase I oil storage tanks have heating coils installed, but due to current business needs, only four are connected to the heating system. As the heating needs of Phase I increase, BPGIC plans to connect additional oil storage tanks to the heating system. Each new connection will require BPGIC to establish a new pipeline connection between the boiler and the applicable oil storage tank. BPGIC also plans to construct four additional oil storage tanks with heating capacity in connection with Phase II. BPGIC believes that the current heating system will be sufficient to meet the heating needs of the eight oil storage tanks in Phase I that have, and the four oil storage tanks in Phase II that will have, heating capacity.

 

Customer Ordering Process

 

BPGIC is committed to providing excellent customer service. BPGIC has allocated a customer service officer (a “CSO”) to BIA with respect to Phase I and tested an online ordering system which will be rolled out within Q3 2020, which enables BIA and the Super Major to place storage, heating and blending orders and track order statuses in real-time. As an alternative, BIA can also place service orders by calling its CSO. When placing orders, BIA and the Super Major must provide the relevant order details, including the requested services, oil product specifications and desired timing. Following the submission of a service order, the CSO responsible for reviewing the service order will correspond with BIA or the Super Major, as applicable, provide a cost estimate for the proposed services, coordinate logistics for discharging operations, including berth reservations through the Port of Fujairah’s reservation system and payment of Port fees on BIA’s or the Super Major’s behalf, as applicable, and liaise with operational staff to facilitate and process the service order. Upon the completion of the requested services, the CSO will notify BIA or the Super Major, as applicable, of the completion status, coordinate with surveyors to provide any required samples, organize logistics for on-loading operations and send an itemized invoice to BIA or the Super Major, as applicable, for the services provided. In the future, if and when BPGIC engages with any additional users, BPGIC intends to designate a CSO to each additional user but may also expand the scope of the current CSO’s responsibilities to cover any such additional user.

 

44

 

 

BIA Refinery

 

BPGIC is in discussion with BIA to develop and operate the BIA Refinery at minimal cost to BPGIC. BPGIC and BIA are still negotiating the Refinery Operations Agreement, however BPGIC expects that BIA will finance and arrange the development, construction and commissioning of a modular refinery on a parcel of BPGIC’s land. BPGIC anticipates that BIA will engage an EPC Contractor to design and procure construction and commission of the BIA Refinery. The parties have extended their deadline to negotiate the Refinery Operations Agreement to August 4, 2020. BPGIC currently projects that the BIA Refinery will be completed by the Second Quarter of 2021, and will commence operations in the Third Quarter of 2021. The BIA Refinery is expected to be amongst the first refineries in the MENA region capable of supplying IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur content shipping fuel. The facility is initially expected to have an initial production capacity of 25,000 b/d.

 

Capital Expenditure

 

The expected capital expenditure by BPGIC in connection with the BIA Refinery is minimal.

 

Key Features and Components

 

The key proposed features of the BIA Refinery:

 

will be capable of producing IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur shipping fuel; and
     
modular design will permit future expansion.

 

Proposed Phase II

 

Scope

 

Phase II is currently being constructed adjacent to Phase I on the remaining land available under the Phase I & II Land Lease. BPGIC had a soil investigation report completed for the land, which determined that the land was adequate for the purposes of construction and the operation of the facilities. Phase II involves the construction of (i) four crude oil storage tanks with a projected geometric storage capacity of 0.431 million m3; (ii) four crude/fuel oil storage tanks with a projected geometric storage capacity of 0.171 million m3; (iii) the Phase II Internal Manifold to service only crude oil; and (iv) the associated infrastructure and facilities, including two new crude oil pipelines and four new pumps to carry crude oil between the Phase II Internal Manifold and Matrix Manifold 2. Portions of the infrastructure to support the two new crude oil pipelines and the Phase II Internal Manifold were developed during Phase I. Each of the four crude/fuel oil storage tanks is expected to be capable of storing crude and fuel oils; however, BPGIC, BIA and the Phase II End User currently intend to use this storage capacity primarily to store and blend crude oil. BPGIC considered Phase II when developing its plan for Phase I, and constructed infrastructure to accommodate the needs of Phase II and will not need to substantially reconfigure its facilities or install additional generators in order to construct and operate the proposed facilities.

 

Capital Expenditure

 

The expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II is $160.6 million which is comprised of construction costs of $150.0 million and capitalised interest and land lease and consultancy charges of $10.6 million. The expected capital expenditure of $160.6 million in respect of Phase II will be funded by:

 

drawings of $90.6 million under the Phase II Financing Facility; and

 

shareholders contributions, proceeds of the Business Combination, and internally generated cashflow in the aggregate amount of $70.0 million.

 

45

 

 

Of the $160.6 million expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II, $39.20 million was paid by the end of fiscal year 2019. During 2020, $24.8 million was paid through June 2020 and balance is expected to be paid out before the end of the year. See “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — BPGIC may be subject to significant risks and expenses when constructing Phase II, which could adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.

 

Key Features and Components

 

The key proposed features of Phase II include:

 

all eight oil storage tanks will be inter-connected via the Phase II Internal Manifold;

 

the pumping and stripping systems of the Phase II Internal Manifold will be equipped with fine stripping systems to minimize energy costs, lower loss ratios and remote changes on product contaminations;
     
the cranes of the Phase II Internal Manifold will allow BPGIC to more efficiently perform required maintenance activities and prepare pipelines for oil transfers;

 

each of the two piggable crude oil jetty pipelines will be directly connected between the Phase II Internal Manifold and Matrix Manifold 2, lowering loss ratios and contamination risks;
     
BPGIC will be able to perform up to six simultaneous operations in Phase II, including tank-to-tank transfers, recirculations, blending, heating, loading and discharging, which would permit BPGIC to service multiple user orders during the same time period; and
     
four of the oil storage tanks will be constructed to permit conversion between crude oil and fuel oil products, allowing BPGIC to adjust its services to meet changing market demands.

 

Proposed Tanks

 

As part of Phase II, BPGIC is currently constructing eight oil storage tanks. The proposed oil storage tanks are expected to be equipped with the following features:

 

accurate product level measurements: a real-time electronic measuring system that will monitor product levels in each oil storage tank;
     
effective drainage systems leading to lower product contamination risks and higher cleanliness levels;
     
automated fire-fighting systems that will activate automatically in the event of a fire;
     
an efficient, high quality blending system for faster crude oil blending times and more consistent blends; and
     
a well-designed pipeline connection: a pipeline connection to the Phase II Internal Manifold and a fine stripping system.

 

46

 

 

The following table displays the expected key attributes of the proposed eight oil storage tanks of Phase II:

 

Tank No.   Service   Diameter (m) x
Height (m)
  Blending
Capability
  Roof Type(1)   Tank Heating   Geometric
Capacity (m3)
  Max
Capacity (m3)
201   Crude Oil   70 x 28   Yes   EFRT   No   107,756   101,900
202   Crude Oil   70 x 28   Yes   EFRT   No   107,756   101,900
203   Crude Oil   70 x 28   Yes   EFRT   No   107,756   101,900
204   Crude Oil   70 x 28   Yes   EFRT   No   107,756   101,900
205   Crude Oil/Fuel Oil   42 x 30   Yes   AGDR/ With CS IFR   Yes   42,558   40,600
206   Crude Oil/Fuel Oil   42 x 30   Yes   AGDR/ With CS IFR   Yes   42,558   40,600
207   Crude Oil/Fuel Oil   42 x 30   Yes   AGDR/ With CS IFR   Yes   42,558   40,600
208   Crude Oil/Fuel Oil   42 x 30   Yes   AGDR/ With CS IFR   Yes   42,558   40,600
Total Storage Capacity (m3)   601,261   570,000

 

 

(1) EFRT” means External Floating Roof Tank; “AGDR/ With CS IFR” means Aluminium Geodesic Dome Roof with Carbon Steel Internal Floating Roof.

 

47

 

 

Proposed Phase II Internal Manifold

 

As a part of the construction of the Phase II Internal Manifold, BPGIC plans to install two piggable jetty pipelines and four pumps to transport crude oil from the BPGIC Terminal to the Port of Fujairah’s berths. The infrastructure to support the pipelines was built during Phase I. The four proposed pumps are expected to facilitate on-loading operations from the Phase II Internal Manifold by pumping crude oil through one or more of the two proposed piggable crude oil jetty pipelines to Matrix Manifold 2. Each of the four pumps is expected to be capable of transporting product at a flow rate of 4,000 m3/hr and at a combined flow rate of 16,000 m3/hr. BPGIC plans to also utilize these pumps to facilitate inter-tank transfers, blending and other transfers throughout the terminal.

 

Similar to the Phase I Internal Manifold, the Phase II Internal Manifold is expected to have general and fine stripping systems.

 

Proposed Blending of Crude Oil

 

Phase II is expected to have state-of-the-art blending capabilities, similar to Phase I, which would allow it to achieve high levels of accuracy in meeting customer blending specifications.

 

BPGIC plans to blend various grades of crude oil to achieve customer specifications, including to attain specified properties for vapor pressure, viscosity, sulfur content and salt content.

 

Development and Implementation

 

In an effort to de-risk the construction of Phase II, BPGIC entered the Phase II EPC Agreement with Audex for the construction of Phase II (including all its component parts and associated infrastructure) on a fixed price lump sum basis. The Phase II EPC Agreement also includes a clause for liquidated damages if the contractor fails to complete the work within the schedule in the Phase II EPC Agreement. Phase II work commenced in September 2018 and according to the schedule in the Phase II EPC Agreement, it is expected to be completed in the Fourth Quarter of 2020. The expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II is $160.6 million. The expected capital expenditure in respect of Phase II will be partially funded by drawings of $90.6 million under the Phase II Financing Facility. For details of the remaining expected capital expenditure see “Item 4.B— Proposed Phase II — Capital Expenditure”. BPGIC also entered into the Phase II Project Management Agreement with MUC, the same advisor that designed the facilities for the Port of Fujairah and the BPGIC Terminal, so that MUC could manage the construction plan of Phase II. For more information regarding the proposed funding of Phase II, see “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Indebtedness”.

 

Off-take and Sales Arrangements

 

On June 27, 2018, BPGIC entered into the Phase II End User Agreement with the Phase II End User, an international commodities trading company. The Phase II End User agreed to lease all eight oil storage tanks in Phase II once Phase II becomes operational, which is expected to occur in the Fourth Quarter of 2020.

 

In September 2019, with the consent of the Phase II End User, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Customer Agreement to restructure its relationship with the Phase II End User. Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC agreed to lease the Phase II facility, once operational, to BIA on identical price terms and otherwise substantially similar terms as those of the Phase II End User Agreement, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed BPGIC’s rights and obligations under the Phase II End User Agreement. Once Phase II becomes operational, BIA is required to pay (i) a monthly fixed storage fee to lease all of Phase II’s storage capacity and (ii) monthly variable ancillary service fees for the following ancillary services: throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers. BIA is required to satisfy any amounts due for the monthly fixed storage fee in advance for each applicable month. Because BIA subleases the facility to the Phase II End User, BPGIC’s monthly revenue for ancillary services will depend on the extent to which the Phase II End User utilizes the ancillary services. Notwithstanding the sublease, BIA’s obligation to pay both the monthly fixed storage fee and the ancillary services fees to BPGIC is independent of the Phase II End User’s obligation to pay, and actual payment to, BIA. For more information regarding the Phase II Customer Agreement, see “Item 10.C Material Contract — Phase II End User Agreement and Phase II Customer Agreement”.

 

48

 

 

Proposed Phase III

 

BPGIC is in the advanced stages of planning Phase III, a further major expansion in the Port of Fujairah. In February 2020, BPGIC entered into the Phase III Land Lease Agreement to secure the Phase III Land, a new plot of land of approximately 450,000 m2 near its existing facilities. BPGIC believes that the Phase III Land can house additional storage capacity of up to 3,500,000 m3.

 

Security and Business Resilience

 

The BPGIC Terminal has a high degree of security. It has security cameras in various strategic locations inside and outside of the terminal. Fire alarm and detection systems are installed in all facilities and oil storage tanks. The terminal has firefighters on-site and conducts a fire drill every three months. The lighting system covers all areas of the facility on a 24-hour, seven day a week basis. The majority of the lights are solar powered and use LED lighting, reducing energy costs. The BPGIC Terminal is operational 24 hours a day and is pass-card protected. There are also multiple levels of clearance for employees and contractors.

 

BPGIC is committed to improving its security on an ongoing basis, while assuring quality service and continued customer satisfaction. BPGIC’s corporate security policy is designed to protect BPGIC’s personnel, assets, reputation and customers’ interests by employing the highest corporate, ethical and operational standards to meet BPGIC’s vision of excellence.

 

BPGIC’s security and business resilience objectives are met through the implementation of a planned set of security standards initiatives and internal programs. These are consistent with the relevant international security legislation and appropriately recognized and accredited quality management systems. All Phase I oil storage tanks are certified to the relevant NFPA and API industry and international standards. In accordance with NFPA standards, all Phase I oil storage tanks have been constructed to withstand high levels of radiation.

 

Environmental and Safety and Maintenance Matters

 

BPGIC is subject to laws and regulations relating to the protection of the environment and natural resources including, among other things, the management of hazardous substances, the storage and handling of hazardous waste, the control of air emissions and water discharges and the remediation of contaminated sites. BPGIC is also subject to health and safety regulations including, among other things, noise, workplace health and safety and regulations governing the handling, transport and packing of hazardous materials. Compliance with these laws and regulations may require the attainment of permits to conduct regulated activities; restrict the type, quantities and concentration of pollutants that may be emitted or discharged into or onto to the land, air and water; restrict the handling and disposal of solid and hazardous wastes; apply specific health and safety criteria addressing worker protection; and require remedial measures to mitigate pollution from former and on-going operations. While these laws and regulations affect BPGIC’s maintenance capital expenditures and net income, BPGIC believes it does not affect its competitive position, as the operations of its competitors are similarly affected.

 

BPGIC’s facilities are in substantial compliance with applicable environmental and other laws and regulations, including security and safety at work laws. However, these laws and regulations are subject to change by regulatory authorities, and continued or future compliance with such laws and regulations, or changes in the interpretation of such laws and regulations, may require BPGIC to incur expenditures. Failure to comply with these laws and regulations may result in the assessment of administrative, civil and criminal penalties, the imposition of remedial obligations, and the issuance of injunctions that may limit or prohibit some or all of BPGIC’s operations. Additionally, a discharge of hazardous waste into the environment could, to the extent that the event is not fully insured, subject BPGIC to substantial expenses, including costs to comply with applicable laws and regulations and to resolve claims made by third parties for claims for personal injury and property damage. These impacts could directly and indirectly affect BPGIC’s business, and have an adverse impact on its financial position, results of operations and liquidity. See “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — BPGIC may incur significant costs to maintain compliance with, or address liabilities under, environmental, health and safety regulation applicable to its business.

 

49

 

 

BPGIC has a corporate health and safety program to govern the way it conducts its operations at its facilities. Each of the employees and consultants is required to understand and follow the health and safety plan and have the necessary training for certain tasks performed at the facilities. BPGIC performs preventive and normal maintenance on all of its oil storage tanks and systems and makes repairs and replacements when necessary or appropriate. BPGIC also conducts routine and required inspections of such assets in accordance with applicable regulation. Most of the oil storage tanks are equipped with internal floating roofs in accordance with industry requirements to minimize regulated emissions and prevent potentially flammable vapor accumulation. The soil surrounding the oil storage tanks is capable of resisting oil penetration and has an oil leakage detection system in place, which is intended to minimize the effects of any oil leakage and potential oil pollution. The terminal facilities also have response plans, spill prevention and control plans, and other programs in place to respond to emergencies.

 

Information Technology and Operating Systems

 

The BPGIC Terminal’s IT systems, including the IT systems in BPGIC’s operational control room, are configured to remain in operation, including under abnormal conditions. Appropriate manual backup procedures and automatic processes have been devised to support the terminal’s operations in case of any unexpected system downtime or failure. The terminal’s four physical servers have redundant power supply sources and there is an on-site standby server to accommodate for a server shutdown. The majority of BPGIC’s IT systems have been provided by the ABB Group and Intelex Technologies, Inc.

 

In order to prevent both a disruption of BPGIC’s operations as well as to safeguard users’ data, automatic and manual data back-up procedures and recovery plans are in place to save and restore data and systems. System data and network device configurations are saved on external hard-disk drives and secured by third-party cloud service providers. The IT operations are maintained on a 24/7 basis, with automatic monitoring of all systems, emergency and standby duties, and third-party support and maintenance agreements in place where needed. The network infrastructure is periodically tested to ensure compliance with applicable security and performance requirements and appropriate tests are performed to ensure system security and performance are not compromised in connection with any updates to the IT infrastructure.

 

Any system interruptions caused by telecommunications failures, computer viruses, software errors, third party services, cloud computing providers, cyberattack or other attempts to harm our systems can result in the unavailability or slowdown of our IT systems.

 

In order to ensure a high degree of IT security, BPGIC has procedures in place to prevent external threats to the IT systems. All files and emails exchanged over BPGIC’s network are scanned. A web filtering policy in the firewall prevents access to websites with vulnerabilities. A centrally managed anti-virus software with daily reporting of threats and vulnerabilities is installed in all user machines and servers at the BPGIC Terminal. In addition, the network is logically segmented between users, employees and network guests and provides different levels access to different users. For more information regarding the risks associated with BPGIC’s information technology and operating systems, see “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — BPGIC is dependent on its IT and operational systems, which may fail or be subject to disruption.

 

BPGIC installed an online ordering system, which enables users to place storage, heating and blending orders and track order statuses in real-time. For more information regarding the customer ordering process, see “Item 4.B— The BPGIC Terminal — Phase I — Customer Ordering Process.

 

Employees

 

BPGIC is led by the senior management team which has extensive technical, operational and management experience in the oil storage terminal industry. As at December 31, 2019, BPGIC had employed 16 employees and 47 contractors. BPGIC commenced hiring of its experienced operational staff in the second half of 2017, so that it would have a full complement of staff ready when Phase I operations commenced in December 2017. The 47 contractors are engaged under third-party outsourcing contracts and the 16 employees are engaged under individual employment contracts.

 

All 47 of the contractors are contracted through Flowi Facility Management LLC (“Flowi”), a subsidiary of MUC. The 47 contractors serve in various roles in several of BPGIC’s departments, including operations, information technology and health and safety. Pursuant to BPGIC’s contract with Flowi, dated April 1, 2017, as extended, (the “Flowi Agreement”), Flowi is contractually obligated to release all 47 contractors from its employment and transfer them to BPGIC’s employment after contract completion. BPGIC management is currently considering whether to extend the Flowi Agreement for another year.

 

50

 

 

In addition to the BPGIC Terminal Office Building, BPGIC also has a small administrative office in the emirate of Abu Dhabi.

 

BPGIC believes that the material terms of its third-party sourcing contracts and employment agreements are customary for the UAE and the oil storage industry and that it has a good relationship with its employees and contractors.

 

The following table sets out the number of employees and contractors employed by BPGIC at December 31, 2019 by main location.

 

Location                  
    As at December 31,     As at December 31,  
    2017     2018     2019  
Fujairah     6       55       56  
Abu Dhabi     3       8       7  
Total     9       63       63  

 

Insurance

 

BPGIC’s operations and assets are insured under an insurance program administered by Lockton Insurance Brokers — Dubai, an insurance broker. The program covers the Phase I facilities and related assets, and the liabilities of the Phase I operations and BPGIC. The major elements of this program are property damage, business interruption, terrorism and political violence, worker’s compensation, environmental liability, employer liability, directors’ and officers’ liability insurance, personal injury and third-party liability, including that of terminal operators. BPGIC additionally maintains local insurance, including healthcare and other insurance required by BPGIC’s jurisdiction.

 

Premiums are allocated based on the insured values, history of claims and type of risk. BPGIC believes that the amount of coverage provided is comprehensive and appropriate for its business.

 

Legal Proceedings

 

From time to time, we may be involved in legal proceedings in the ordinary course of our business. We are currently not a party to any material legal or administrative proceedings.

 

Regulations of BPGIC

 

BPGIC’s operations are subject to various laws, standards and regulations relating to the oil and gas industry. BPGIC’s operations are extensively regulated by national and local authorities in the United Arab Emirates, including with respect to labor, health, safety, environment and licensing requirements. Additional requirements may also be imposed on BPGIC in connection with new or existing operations, including as a result of different or more stringent interpretation or enforcement of existing laws and regulations or a change in the laws and regulations. These additional requirements may not be anticipated by us. As a consequence, BPGIC may need to change its operations significantly or incur increased costs in order to comply with such requirements. Compliance with any additional environmental requirements may be costly and time-consuming. In addition, violations of any new or existing requirements could result in substantial fines or liabilities; delays in securing, or the inability to secure and maintain, permits, authorizations or licenses necessary for BPGIC’s business; injunctions; reputational damage; and other negative consequences, which may result in lost revenue and reputational damage.

 

51

 

 

BPGIC is subject to laws and regulations relating to the protection of the environment and natural resources including, among other things, the management of hazardous substances, the storage and handling of hazardous waste, the control of air emissions and water discharges and the remediation of contaminated sites. Non-compliance with environmental regulations could result in severe fines, increased costs, and suspension or permanent shut down of activities. BPGIC’s operations are subject to the environmental risks inherent in the oil and gas sector. BPGIC’s operations are or may become subject to laws and regulations, including applicable international conventions, controlling the discharge of materials into the environment, pollution, contamination and hazardous waste disposal or otherwise relating to the protection of the environment.

 

Specifically, BPGIC is subject to environmental laws and regulations in the United Arab Emirates. Environmental laws and regulations applicable to BPGIC’s business activities, or which may become applicable, could impose significant liability on BPGIC for damages, clean-up costs, fines and penalties in the event of oil spills or similar discharges of pollutants or contaminants into the environment or improper disposal of hazardous waste generated in the course of operations. To date, such laws and regulations have not had a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s operating results, and BPGIC has not experienced an accident that has exposed it to material liability arising out of or relating to discharges of pollutants into the environment. However, there can be no assurance that such accidents will not occur in the future. Legislative, judicial and regulatory responses to such an incident could substantially increase BPGIC’s and/or BPGIC’s clients’ liabilities. In addition to potential increased liabilities, such legislative, judicial or regulatory action could impose increased financial, insurance or other requirements that may adversely impact the entire oil industry.

 

The legal frameworks in the United Arab Emirates for environmental protection are under continual development and, in time, relevant legislative bodies may impose stricter environmental regulations or apply existing regulations more strictly, including regulations regarding discharges into air and water, the handling and disposal of solid and hazardous waste, land use and reclamation and remediation of contamination. Compliance with environmental laws, regulations and standards, where applicable, may require BPGIC to make significant capital expenditures, such as the installation of costly equipment or operational changes. These costs could have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial position, results of operation and prospects. Any failure to comply with applicable laws and regulations may result in reputational damage to us, administrative and civil penalties, criminal sanctions or the suspension or termination of BPGIC’s operations. Failure to comply with these statutes and regulations may subject BPGIC to civil or criminal enforcement action, which may not be covered by contractual indemnification or insurance and could have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s financial position, operating results and cash flows. New laws and government regulations or changes to existing laws and government regulations may add to costs, limit BPGIC’s operations or reduce demand for BPGIC’s services.

 

Health and safety standards

 

BPGIC is subject to health and safety regulations in the United Arab Emirates including, among other things, noise, workplace health and safety and regulations governing the handling, transport and packing of hazardous materials. Compliance with these laws and regulations may require the attainment of permits to conduct regulated activities; restrict the handling and disposal of solid and hazardous wastes; and apply specific health and safety criteria addressing worker protection. These laws and regulations are subject to change by regulatory authorities, and continued or future compliance with such laws and regulations, or changes in the interpretation of such laws and regulations, may require BPGIC to incur expenditures. Failure to comply with these laws and regulations may result in the assessment of administrative, civil and criminal penalties, the imposition of remedial obligations, and the issuance of injunctions that may limit or prohibit some or all of BPGIC’s operations. These impacts could directly and indirectly affect BPGIC’s business, and have an adverse impact on its financial position, results of operations and liquidity.

 

C. Organizational structure

 

Brooge Energy Holdings is a holding company with two wholly-owned subsidiaries:

 

Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE, incorporated in 2013 in the Fujairah Free Zone, UAE, to provide oil storage, heating and blending services; and

 

52

 

 

BPGIC International (f/k/a Twelve Seas Investment Company), a Cayman Islands exempted company, a former special purpose acquisition company, incorporated in 2017 in the Cayman Islands.

 

The Company’s current organizational chart is set forth below.

 

All of the Company’s business is currently conducted through BPGIC.

 

 

D. Property, plants and equipment

 

The Company has its headquarters in Fujairah, United Arab Emirates. The table below summarizes its facilities as of December 31, 2019 and [June [12], 2020].

 

        Gross Area
(square
      Lease period  
Country   Location   meter)   Use   Start   End  
UAE   Port of Fujairah   153,916.93   Site of oil storage tanks and administrative building   On or around 3/10/2013  

On or around

3/31/2073(1)

 
UAE   Port of Fujairah   450,074.7 3   Intended site of additional oil storage tanks and refinery   On or around 2/2/2020  

On or around

2/2/2080(2)

 

 

 

(1) The lease ends on or around 3/31/2073 after giving effect to an automatic 30 year extension after the initial 30 year term ends on or around 3/31/2043.

(2) The lease ends on or around 2/2/2080 after giving effect to an automatic 30 year extension after the initial 30 year term ends on or around 2/2/2040.

 

All of the Company’s business is currently conducted through BPGIC.

 

53

 

 

The BPGIC Terminal

 

BPGIC began development of the BPGIC Terminal after several years of planning and discussions with industry participants. During this time, BPGIC engaged an industry consultant to conduct a market assessment of the oil storage industry in the Port of Fujairah region and to identify and assess business opportunities and strategies. BPGIC also engaged MUC, the same advisor that designed the facilities for the Port of Fujairah, to design the BPGIC Terminal. During the design stage, BPGIC assessed various challenges faced by other oil storage terminals, including preventing oil losses and precisely meeting customer blending requirements, and incorporated solutions to such challenges into the design of the terminal. BPGIC’s aim in developing the BPGIC Terminal was to create a new standard for oil storage tank terminals by designing a terminal that would reduce oil losses and achieve better blending results than existing oil storage tank terminals. As described below, BPGIC designed the BPGIC Terminal with several key features that enable it to provide users with high-accuracy blending services with low oil losses. In addition, due to the relatively long-term period of the Phase I & II Land Lease when compared to similar land leases for oil storage terminals located in the Port of Fujairah, BPGIC constructed Phase I with materials, including pumps, valves and steel structures, that have longer expected life spans than comparable materials utilized by other oil storage terminals. As a result, BPGIC believes Phase I will benefit from annual maintenance costs over the period of the Phase I & II Land Lease that are lower than the average for comparable oil storage terminals. See “Item 4.B — Competitive Strengths — Design and Features of the BPGIC Terminal”. As part of Phase II, BPGIC is following a similar approach as that followed in Phase I by investing in high-grade, long-life materials for the construction and development of its facilities.

 

Location

 

 

The BPGIC Terminal is located in the Port of Fujairah in the emirate of Fujairah in the UAE. The Port of Fujairah is a gateway between the Indian Ocean and the Arabian Gulf, and is strategically situated in one of the world’s major oil markets for fuel oil, crude oil and refined oil products. In addition to the Port of Fujairah’s close access to major markets in the Middle East, it also serves as an outlet to East Africa and South Asia and serves as a consolidation point for fuel oil outlets and the regional fuel oil markets, reducing the need for ships to cross through the Strait of Hormuz.

 

54

 

 

The Strait of Hormuz has been a strategic geographic chokepoint for many years, and as such, it has often been a site of international military conflict and military exercises. Such events have caused safety concerns and travel delays for ships crossing through the Strait of Hormuz. The Strait of Hormuz has also been subject to repeated threats of closure and blockage by Iran. In 2012, Iran threatened to close the Strait of Hormuz due to international pressures to stop its nuclear program and an Iranian oil embargo that was enacted by the European Union in late January 2012. On September 14, 2019, an attack on Saudi Arabia’s oil facilities and fields, largely blamed on Iran or its proxies, significantly increased tensions in the area, and heightened the distinct possibility that similar attacks by Iran on strategic oil facilities and ports in the UAE or a regional conflict may result. Despite these recent and past threats, the Strait of Hormuz has never been closed. See “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — Any material reduction in the quality or availability of the Port of Fujairah’s facilities could have a material adverse effect on BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations”; “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks Related to Doing Business in Countries in Which BPGIC Operates — Recent geopolitical developments have increased the risk that the region in which BPGIC operates could be involved in an escalating conflict that could have a material adverse effect on our business, financial condition and results of operations.”

 

The Habshan-Fujairah oil pipeline, which is a crude oil pipeline that runs between the emirate of Abu Dhabi and the Port of Fujairah, enables ships to obtain crude oil produced in Abu Dhabi without having to cross the Strait of Hormuz. The crude oil pipeline currently has the capacity to transport 1.5 million barrels a day, which is approximately half of the daily average amount of crude oil that was produced in the UAE in 2017. There is increasing focus in the UAE region on using the crude oil pipeline, as the government of Abu Dhabi has publicly stated that it intends to ensure that approximately 75 percent of the crude oil designated for export in Abu Dhabi goes through the pipeline and to Fujairah.

 

The Port of Fujairah is the largest multi-purpose port on the Eastern seaboard of the UAE, approximately 70 nautical miles from the Strait of Hormuz. Initial construction of the Port of Fujairah started in 1978 as part of the economic development of the UAE. Full operations commenced in 1983. Since then, the Port of Fujairah has embarked on a continuing process of enhancement to both its facilities and its comprehensive range of functions.

 

The Port of Fujairah initially developed oil terminal 1 (“OT1”) comprising three marine loading berths (berths 1, 2 and 3), oil terminal 2 (“OT2”) comprising four marine loading berths (berths 4, 5, 6 and 7), and a matrix manifold connecting OT1 and OT2 to certain existing oil tank terminals (“Matrix Manifold 1”). To cater to the increasing demand arising from the growing storage capacity in Fujairah, the Port of Fujairah began developing the second phase of OT2, adding two new berths (berths 8 and 9) and a second matrix manifold (“Matrix Manifold 2”). The project, completed in 2014, raised the overall throughput capacity of the Port of Fujairah and contributed to the growth of Fujairah as the largest oil hub in the region. Matrix Manifold 2 is connected directly to berths 8 and 9 and, through a connection to Matrix Manifold 1, is connected indirectly to the remaining Port of Fujairah berths. The BPGIC Terminal is connected to Matrix Manifold 2, which gives it direct access to underutilized berths 8 and 9. Berth 1 is currently unavailable for BPGIC’s use as the Port of Fujairah granted exclusive access and use of berth 1 to four other parties, who have since installed pipelines and marine loading arms on the berth.

 

To further cater to the increasing demand arising from the growing storage capacity in Fujairah, the Port of Fujairah has developed a VLCC jetty in the Indian Ocean, which allows the Port of Fujairah to accommodate vessels with a maximum overall length of 344 meters and a minimum overall length of 240 meters. The Port of Fujairah completed construction of the VLCC jetty in June 2016 and the jetty went into operation on August 24, 2016.

 

The Port of Fujairah imposes certain requirements on the companies and oil tankers utilizing its port, including requirements for flow rate capacity and ground soil lining. The current minimum required flow rates vary based on berth location and vessel size and range between 460 m3/hr and 3,900 m3/hr, and although the Port of Fujairah has already increased the flow rate requirements in the past, it is possible that the Port of Fujairah could increase them again in the future. BPGIC is well positioned to satisfy any future increases for minimum required flow rates as the pumps in Phase I are capable of transporting gas oil/gasoline at a combined flow rate of 5,000 m3/hr and fuel oil at a combined flow rate of 4,500 m3/hr, which is more than the current minimum required flow rate and exceeds the combined flow rates of many of the other oil storage terminals that are subject to the Port of Fujairah’s requirements. The Port of Fujairah also requires each oil storage terminal to install impermeable lining throughout its tank farm area and any other area where oil leakage could occur and potentially reach the ground soil. In connection with the construction of Phase I, BPGIC installed the required lining at the Phase I & II Land and is one of only a few oil storage terminals that has been able to satisfy this requirement.

 

The Port of Fujairah requires oil tankers to use the Port’s reservation system to reserve berths and imposes certain charges on such users, including fees, marine and administrative charges. For information regarding BPGIC’s customer ordering process and coordination of reservations, see “Item 4.B — Phase I — Customer Ordering Process”.

 

55

 

 

Phase I & II Land Lease

 

On March 10, 2013, BPGIC entered into the Phase I & II Land Lease, as amended by the Novation Agreement dated September 1, 2014. The amended agreement binds BPGIC and FOIZ for a total term of 60 years. The Phase I & II Land has a total area of 153,916.93 m2. BPGIC used this land to build Phase I and is currently using the remaining portion of the site to build Phase II. Upon mutual agreement of the parties, the term of the Phase I & II Land Lease can be renewed or extended for a further period, the term of which is unspecified and therefore subject to agreement between the parties.

 

BPGIC began paying rent under the Phase I & II Land Lease in 2014. The rent for 2019 was $2,313,323 and rent increases by 2 percent per annum. Payments are required to be made in advance (the time period of which is unspecified) in four equal quarterly instalments. BPGIC is required to pay all taxes imposed by the federal government of the UAE or FOIZ; however, the leased premises are in a free zone and BPGIC is entitled to all benefits applying to free zone entities, including benefits in respect of taxes.

 

The Phase I & II Land Lease required BPGIC to enter into the Port Facilities Agreement, which grants it certain usage and access rights in connection with the Port’s facilities. The term of the Port Facilities Agreement, which BPGIC entered into on March 31, 2016, is 25 years and it automatically renews for another 25 years at the end of its term. The Port Facilities Agreement requires BPGIC to pay certain fees in connection with the use of the Port of Fujairah’s facilities; however, the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement provide that any fees charged by the Port of Fujairah in respect of services provided to BIA or the Super Major, including transportation, loading, unloading, use of berths, marine charges, administration charges, penalties and/or use of any of the Port of Fujairah’s facilities, shall be paid by BIA or the Super Major, respectively. Currently, the Phase I sublessees send BIA any such amounts to be paid, BIA delivers any such amounts to BPGIC, and BPGIC then sends such amounts to the Port. Once the BIA Refinery and Phase II become operational, BPGIC expects to follow a similar approach with BIA and the Phase II End User. The Super Major delivers any amounts payable to the Port of Fujairah to BPGIC, which passes the payments on to the Port. Pursuant to the Port Facilities Agreement, BPGIC is required to pay such amounts and is responsible for such amounts irrespective of whether the Super Major, the Phase I end users, the Phase II End User, or BIA pay such fees.

 

BPGIC is required to obtain the FOIZ’s prior permission in order to use the leased premises for any purpose other than in connection with Phase I and Phase II, or the BIA Refinery. The Phase I & II Land Lease contains representations and warranties, dispute resolution and indemnification clauses that are customary for the UAE and the oil storage industry. FOIZ can cancel the agreement if BPGIC fails to make certain required rental payments or fails to perform or meet in any material respect any material term, condition, covenant, agreement or obligation under the agreement.

 

BPGIC Terminal Office Building

 

In connection with Phase I, BPGIC built a five-story office building with an area of 3,388 m2 (the “BPGIC Terminal Office Building”) adjacent to the 14 oil storage tanks. Audex completed construction for the BPGIC Terminal Office Building in November 2017 and BPGIC incurred a total cost of $28.0 million in connection with its construction. BPGIC partially funded the construction of the BPGIC Terminal Office Building with funds obtained from the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC owns the BPGIC Terminal Office Building. The BPGIC Terminal Office Building accommodates all terminal and office staff and contains the operational control room for the BPGIC Terminal, where BPGIC facilitates the performance of its services. BPGIC believes that the BPGIC Terminal Office Building will have sufficient capacity to cater to the operations of the BIA Refinery and Phase II. For additional information regarding the Phase I Construction Facilities, see “Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects — Liquidity and Capital Resources — Debt Sources of Liquidity”.

 

56

 

 

Phase III

 

In February 2020, BPGIC entered into the Phase III Land Lease Agreement, a land lease agreement to lease the Phase III Land, a plot of land in the Port of Fujairah that has a total area of approximately 450,000 m2. The agreement provides for an initial 30 year term with an automatic 30 year renewal. Upon mutual agreement of the parties, the term of the Phase I & II Land Lease can be renewed or extended for a further period, the term of which is unspecified and therefore subject to agreement between the parties. BPGIC will begin paying rent under the Phase III Land Lease Agreement on the earlier of the date that is 18 months from the date of the Phase III Land Lease Agreement and the commissioning of the Phase III facility. The initial annual rent will be $6,126,467 and rent increases by 2 percent per annum. All amounts in respect of rent for each quarter shall be invoiced by and paid to FOIZ in Dirhams by immediately available funds due net thirty (30) days after receipt of invoice. BPGIC is required to pay all taxes imposed by the federal government of the UAE or FOIZ; however, the leased premises are in a free zone and BPGIC is entitled to all benefits applying to free zone entities, including benefits in respect of taxes.

 

 

Scope

 

BPGIC is in the FEED stage of planning Phase III, a further major expansion in the Port of Fujairah. In February 2020, BPGIC entered into the Phase III Land Lease Agreement and secured the Phase III Land, a plot of land of approximately 450,000 m2 near its existing facilities. BPGIC believes that the Phase III Land can house additional storage capacity of up to 3,500,000 m3.

 

BPGIC had an initial technical design with different layout options completed for the Phase III Land.

 

Capital Expenditure

 

As BPGIC is in FEED stages of Phase III, it is not possible to reliably estimate the related capital expenditures. However, BPGIC anticipates the cost per m3 of Phase III to be approximately equal to the cost per m3 of Phase I and Phase II. As of the date of this Report, BPGIC does not yet have any planned capital expenditures in connection with Phase III, other than the costs of the ongoing FEED studies. BPGIC expects to be able to start projecting Phase III capital expenditures after it receives the results of the FEED studies in the Third Quarter of 2020. See “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — BPGIC may be subject to significant risks and expenses when constructing Phase II, which could adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations”.

 

57

 

 

Design

 

The Phase III Land is the subject of ongoing FEED studies, which, in parallel with prospective end-user discussions, will enable BPGIC to determine the optimal layout and product mix. Currently, BPGIC plans to use the Phase III Land to further increase its crude oil storage and services and refinery capacity.

 

 

Note: Illustrative Phase III plan may vary. Blueprint subject to change based on FEED results which are expected in the Third Quarter of 2020.

 

BPGIC engaged MUC for the FEED process, the same advisor that designed the facilities for the Port of Fujairah and the BPGIC Terminal, to create proposals for the design of Phase III

 

ITEM 4A. UNRESOLVED STAFF COMMENTS

 

None.

 

ITEM 5. OPERATING AND FINANCIAL REVIEW AND PROSPECTS

  

58

 

 

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED MANAGEMENT’S DISCUSSION AND ANALYSIS OF
FINANCIAL CONDITION AND RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

You should read the following discussion together with our financial statements and the related notes included elsewhere in this Annual Report. This discussion contains forward looking statements about our business and operations. Our actual results may differ materially from those we currently anticipate as a result of many factors, including those we describe under “Risk Factors” and elsewhere in this Annual Report. See “Cautionary Note Regarding Forward Looking Statements.”

 

In this section, references to “we,” “us,” and “our” are intended to refer to Brooge Energy Limited, unless the context clearly indicates otherwise.

 

Our Management’s Discussion and Analysis of Financial Condition and Results of Operations is presented below in eight sections:

 

Overview

 

Key Factors Affecting the Historical and Future Results of Operations
     
Business Combination and Nasdaq Listing
     
Results of Operations
     
Liquidity and Capital Resources
     
Trend Information
     
Related Party Transactions
     
Other Risk Disclosures

 

59

 

 

OVERVIEW

 

The Company (Brooge Energy Limited) formerly known as Brooge Holdings Limited, is a company with limited liability registered as an exempted company in the Cayman Islands. The company was incorporated on April 12, 2019 for the sole purpose of consummating the business combination described further below. On April 15, 2019, BPGIC (Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE) entered into a business combination agreement with Twelve Seas (Twelve Seas Investment Company), a company listed on Nasdaq, the Company and BPGIC FZE’s shareholders.

 

The business combination was accounted for as a reverse acquisition in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRS”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”). Under this method of accounting, the Company and Twelve Seas are treated as the “acquired” company. This determination was primarily based on BPGIC FZE comprising the ongoing operations of the combined company, BPGIC FZE’s senior management comprising the senior management of the combined company, and BPGIC FZE’s stockholders having a majority of the voting power of the combined company. For accounting purposes, BPGIC FZE is deemed to be the accounting acquirer in the transaction and, consequently, the transaction is treated as a recapitalization of BPGIC FZE. Accordingly, the consolidated assets, liabilities and results of operations of BPGIC are the historical financial statements of the combined company, and the Company’s and Twelve Seas’ assets, liabilities and results of operations are consolidated with BPGIC beginning on the acquisition date.

 

As a result of the above transaction, the Company became the ultimate parent of BPGIC and Twelve Seas on the acquisition date, December 20, 2019. The Company’s common stock and warrants are traded on the NASDAQ Capital Market under the ticker symbols BROG and BROGW, respectively.

 

Following the Business Combination, the Company became an independent oil storage and service provider, through its wholly-owned subsidiary, BPGIC, strategically located in the Port of Fujairah in the emirate of Fujairah in the UAE. Unless otherwise indicated, for the purposes of this Item 5. Operating and Financial Review and Prospects, we collectively evaluate the business as “group” business consisting of the Company, Twelve Seas and BPGIC (the “Group”).

 

The Group’s vision is to develop an oil storage business that differentiates itself from competitors by providing its customers with fast order processing times, excellent customer service and high accuracy blending services with low oil losses. BPGIC has a 60-year lease of land for its operations located in close proximity to the Port of Fujairah’s berth connection points. The Group is initially developing the BPGIC Terminal’s storage capacity in two phases, Phase I, which is already operational, and Phase II, which is under construction, and simultaneously with BIA, is working on developing the BIA Refinery, a modular refinery. Phase I commenced operations in December 2017, Phase II is currently under construction. BIA and BPGIC are currently negotiating the terms of the Refinery Operations Agreement and BPGIC expects to finalize their agreement in August 2020.

 

Tank storage facilities play a vital role in the business of refined petroleum products, crude oil and liquid chemicals. They serve as a critical logistical midstream link between the upstream (exploration and production) and the downstream (refining) segments of the refined petroleum product and crude oil industry. They are used to store primary, intermediate and end products and facilitate a continuous supply of the required feedstock to refineries and chemical plants in the processing industry on the one hand and absorb fluctuations in sales volumes on the other.

 

60

 

 

Key Factors Affecting Our Results of Operations

 

The following factors can affect the results of our operations:

 

End Users versus Customers

 

Commencing in August 2019, BPGIC’s sole contractual customer changed although the end-user of its facilities remained the same. In August 2019, BPGIC entered into a contract with BIA which became the direct customer of BPGIC. In turn, BIA subleased group’s facilities to the existing end user.

 

Pursuant to the Phase I End User Agreement, the Initial Phase I End User was the sole revenue generating customer of the Company until July 2019. From August 2019 forward, the Initial Phase I End User remained the sole end user of the Phase I facilities, but BIA became the sole customer of Group.

 

In August 2019, the Group executed the Phase I Customer Agreement, covering the Phase I facility and containing identical price terms and otherwise substantially the same terms as the Phase I End User Agreement with the Initial Phase I End User. The Phase I End User Agreement was novated to BIA.

 

In 2020, BIA notified BPGIC that it had entered sublease arrangements for parts of the Phase I storage capacity with additional end users. In April 2020, BPGIC entered into the Super Major Agreement, a storage contract until November 8, 2020 with the Super Major for storage agreement of 61,072 m3 as on April 28, 2020 with additional 67,928 m3 starting May 8, 2020 resulting into total committed capacity of 129,000 m3. This was done with approval from BIA which has an option to lease back the capacity upon termination of the Super Major Agreement.

 

In September 2019, the Group executed the Phase II Customer Agreement with BIA, covering the Phase II facility and containing identical price terms and otherwise substantially the same terms as the Phase II End User Agreement with the Phase II End User. Immediately upon entering the Phase II Customer Agreement, BIA subleased the BPGIC’s Phase II facility back to the existing Phase II End User on terms substantially similar to the original terms.

 

Pursuant to the Phase II End User Agreement, the Phase II End User is not expected to begin occupying the Phase II facility or using BPGIC’s services until the Phase II facility is operational which is currently estimated to occur in the Fourth Quarter of 2020. Once the Phase II facility is operational, the Phase II End User will utilize the facility as the sub-lessee of BIA who will be the direct customer of BPGIC.

 

The operational commencement of the BIA Refinery is currently anticipated to occur in the Third Quarter of 2021

 

61

 

 

Customer Concentration

 

Until April 2020, BIA was the Group’s only customer and the Group was reliant on it for all of its revenues. For the years ended December 31, 2017 and December 31, 2018, the Initial Phase I End User accounted for 100 percent of the Group’s revenues. For the year ended December 31, 2019, the Initial Phase I End User and BIA collectively accounted for 100 percent of the Group’s revenues. In May 2020, BIA agreed to release 129,000 m3 of the Phase I capacity, amounting to approximately one third of the total Phase I capacity, back to BPGIC. Pursuant to the Super Major Agreement, BPGIC leased this capacity to the Super Major. The Super Major is required to pay a monthly fixed storage fee to lease its storage capacity at Phase I. The Super Major paid the storage fee for the initial six month term of the Super Major Agreement up front. The Super Major Agreement is renewable for an additional six months with the mutual agreement of the parties. See “Item 10.C Material Contracts — Phase I End User Agreement, Phase I Customer Agreement and Super Major Agreement — Storage Fee”.

 

The Company has recently received extensive enquiries for storage as oil prices have fallen dramatically. The Company has been evaluating the enquiries and that will seek to eliminate its customer concentration risk further.

 

Currently, the Group’s monthly revenue is primarily driven by the monthly fixed storage fee it charges BIA and the Super Major to use all of Phase I’s storage capacity, which remains the same each month irrespective of whether they utilize any storage capacity. The fixed storage fee, which is billed monthly in advance, represents the lease of storage capacity and the service provided to the customer for handling an agreed level of throughput of fuel oil and clean products. The fixed storage fee is allocated to the lease and service components based on their relative stand-alone selling price, which is based on an analysis of lease-related and service-related costs for the contract, adjusted for representative profit margins. The lease component is recognized on a straight-line basis over the term of the initial lease and the service component is recognized over time as the customer simultaneously receives and consumes the benefits provided by the Group’s performance. The Group’s monthly revenue is impacted by the monthly variable ancillary service fees it charges BIA, which would vary each month based on BIA’s usage of the following ancillary services: throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers. BPGIC’s monthly revenue ultimately varies based on BIA’s end users’ and Super Major’s usage of the ancillary services.

 

In March 2019, BPGIC entered into an agreement with Sahara to operate a modular refinery to be developed, installed and owned by Sahara, or a wholly owned subsidiary of Sahara, at the BPGIC Terminal. In February 2020, BPGIC and Sahara mutually agreed to discontinue their joint development discussions. On February 23, 2020, BPGIC entered into the Refinery Agreement with BIA, a new agreement which provides that the parties will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for the BIA Refinery, a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd. The parties agreed to negotiate the Refinery Operations Agreement, consisting of a sublease agreement and a joint venture agreement, to govern the terms on which (i) BPGIC will sublease land to BIA to locate, (ii) BIA will construct, and (iii) BPGIC will operate the BIA Refinery. The terms of the Refinery Operations Agreement are still under negotiation and the parties aim to finalize their agreement in August 2020. The Group expects the BIA Refinery to commence operations and BIA’s payment obligations under the Refinery Operations Agreement to begin in the Third Quarter of 2021, at which time the BIA Refinery will begin generating revenue.

 

Other than the Super Major, BIA is expected be the sole customer for Phase I, Phase II and the BIA Refinery, however BIA is expected to sublease the facilities to multiple end users.

 

62

 

 

Group’s Cost Structure and Margins

 

The Group’s cost structure and margins are derived from the Group’s revenues which currently come, and are expected to continue to come, from two types of fees, fixed fees for storage and variable fees for ancillary services. Once the BIA Refinery is operational, the Group’s revenues are expected to come from three types of fees, refinery operations fees, fixed fees for storage and variable fees for ancillary services. The mix of these fees affects revenues, operating margins and net income. In particular, the relatively high fixed price nature of the Group’s operations could result in lower profit margins if certain costs were to increase and the Group was not able to offset the increase in costs with sufficient increases in its storage or ancillary service fees or the end users’ utilization of BPGIC’s ancillary services.

 

The Group’s direct costs, which are comprised principally of employee costs with related benefits and depreciation along with indirect cost of land lease rentals generally remain stable across broad ranges of activity levels at the terminal and, as discussed above, its storage fee revenues are fixed or will be fixed, as the case may be, pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement, the Super Major Agreement, the Phase II Customer Agreement and the Refinery Operations Agreement. Accordingly, changes in the Group’s operating margins are largely driven by the amount of ancillary services provided and the fees the group earns for such services. For more information regarding the related risks, see “Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — The fixed cost nature of BPGIC’s operations could result in lower profit margins if certain costs were to increase and BPGIC were not able to offset such costs with sufficient increases in its storage or ancillary service fees or our customers’ utilization of BPGIC’s ancillary services.”

  

During the year ended December 31, 2019, the Group incurred cash expenses of $3.2 million as expenses incurred in connection with Brooge Energy Limited’s listing on Nasdaq. In addition, the Group, in accordance with the requirements of IFRS, has recorded a non-cash expense as listing expenses to the extent of $98.6 million which is the difference between the fair value of the 10.9 million Ordinary Shares (including 1.6 million Ordinary Shares held in escrow) issued to Twelve Seas’ shareholders in the Business Combination and the fair value of the net assets of Twelve Seas acquired at the time of Business Combination which had a significant impact on the current year’s profitability. The listing expenses also include the fair value of 21.2 million warrants which were valued at a fair value of $0.8 per warrant amounting to $16.9 million. However, these costs, which total $101.8 million, are of a one-off non-recurring nature and pertain only to the year ended December 31, 2019. These costs will be added back to the profits in the computation of Adjusted EBITDA.

 

Once the BIA Refinery and Phase II facility are operational, our mix of relatively fixed revenue and variable revenue will also depend on ancillary service requirements for the BIA Refinery and the Phase II End User as the sub-lessee of the Phase II facility.

 

63

 

  

National and International Expansion

 

The Group’s future revenue growth and results of operations will depend on its ability to secure additional land and develop additional facilities or acquire existing facilities on commercially favorable terms both nationally and internationally. The Group operates in a capital-intensive industry that requires a substantial amount of capital and other long-term expenditures, including those relating to the expansion of existing terminal facilities and the development and acquisition of new terminal facilities. Accordingly, the Group’s successful expansion also depends on its ability to generate or obtain funds sufficient to make significant capital expenditures.

 

Oil Market Pricing Structure

 

Increases or decreases in the price of crude oil has some impact on end-user demand for our ancillary services, unlike demand for storage which is fully contractually committed at fixed rates. For instance, when the expected future price for an oil product is believed to be higher than the current market price for that product, it is said to be in a “contango market.” In such a market, oil traders are more likely to store the product and put a hold on processing the product via ancillary services, until there is an upward revision in prices. Vice versa if the expected future price for an oil product is believed to be lower than the current market price for that product, it is said to be in a “backwardation market.” In such a market, oil traders are more likely to process the product via ancillary services in order to sell at the current market price, rather than store the product when future prices are expected to be lower. However there is no reduction in ancillary services billing and we expect the same to be in line with previous periods. This is mainly because our end users have long term contracts of supply of certain types of products with ultimate end users. This requires ongoing ancillary services of circulation, blending, heating etc. The group is continuously monitoring the market and is in constant touch with phase I and Phase II end user for the same.

 

Phase III & Refinery

 

The group is in the early stages of pursuing a further major expansion near its existing facilities, which it refers to as Phase III. In July 2019, BPGIC executed an initial lease agreement to secure a new plot of land of approximately 450,000 m2 near its existing facilities. On February 2, 2020 BPGIC signed a formal land lease agreement with FOIZ for construction of storage facility of approximately up to 3.5 million m3 and refinery production of up to 180,000 bpd. Phase III alone could be three (3) times the size of the Company’s projected operations post-Phase II and post-the initial refinery phase. Concurrently, BPGIC is in discussions with top global oil majors, which have expressed interest in securing portions of the capacity of a Phase III facility. As on date, the group does not yet have any planned capital expenditures in connection with Phase III. The only recognized expenses here is the FOIZ rental which as per the agreement would be AED 50 m2 for 450,075 m2 per annum with 2% annual increase. However this rent will accrue only after the end of 18 months from the agreement date or first commissioning of the plant whichever happens earlier.

 

64

 

 

In addition to this specific land for Phase III, BPGIC will continue to pursue additional projects within the Fujairah market, either through joint cooperation with parties who have land leases or through efforts to secure additional land itself in Fujairah. The group already has in place contracts with existing customers and is working towards enhancing the relationship for additional ancillary and other services.

 

Recent Developments

 

BIA Refinery

 

In March 2019, BPGIC partnered with Sahara to develop and operate a modular refinery within the BPGIC Terminal with minimal capital expenditure by BPGIC. Under the terms of the parties agreement, Sahara would finance and arrange the development, construction and commissioning of a modular refinery capable of supplying IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur content shipping fuel with initial production capacity of 24,000 b/d.

 

In February 2020, BPGIC and Sahara mutually agreed to discontinue their joint development project to install a modular oil refinery at BPGIC’s terminal. Shortly thereafter, BPGIC entered into the Refinery Agreement, a new agreement with BIA which provides that the parties will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for the BIA Refinery, a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd operated by BPGIC. The parties further agreed to negotiate, within 30 days, the Refinery Operations Agreement, a sublease agreement and a joint venture agreement to govern the terms on which (i) BPGIC will sublease land to BIA to locate, (ii) BIA will construct, and (iii) BPGIC will operate the refinery. Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, the parties agreed to extend the period for their negotiations until August 4, 2020 and negotiations remain ongoing.

 

Phase II

 

In September 2019, BPGIC entered into the Phase II End User Agreement, a five-year lease and service agreement with BIA Pursuant to the Phase II End User Agreement, the term and the payment and performance obligations thereunder will commence upon the completion of Phase II facilities. Fees under the Phase II End User Agreement are comprised of (i) a monthly fixed fee to use BPGIC’s Phase II storage capacity (regardless of whether the Phase II End User uses any storage capacity) and (ii) monthly variable fees based on the Phase II End User’s usage of ancillary services comprising throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers.

 

BUSINESS COMBINATION and NASDAQ LISTING TRANSACTIONS

 

On April 15, 2019, (i) Twelve Seas Investment Company (now known as BPGIC International), (ii) Brooge Energy Limited (f/k/a Brooge Holdings Limited), (iii) Brooge Merger Sub Limited, and a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company, and (iv) Brooge Petroleum And Gas Investment Company FZE, entered into that certain Business Combination Agreement, pursuant to which BPGIC Holdings Limited also become a party thereafter pursuant to the Assignment and Joinder to Business Combination Agreement dated as of November 19, 2019 (as assignee of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, which became a party to the Business Combination Agreement pursuant to a Joinder to Business Combination Agreement dated as of May 10, 2019), as the same was amended prior to the date of Closing, including by the foregoing joinders and by the First Amendment to Business Combination Agreement, dated as of September 16, 2019. Pursuant to the Business Combination Agreement, subject to the terms and conditions thereof and upon the consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby upon Closing, among other matters:

 

(a) Merger Sub was to merge with Twelve Seas, with Twelve Seas continuing as the surviving entity, and with holders of Twelve Seas securities receiving securities of Brooge Energy Limited, which will become a new public company (the “Merger”), and

 

(b) Brooge Energy Limited was to acquire all of the issued and outstanding capital shares of BPGIC (the “Purchased Shares”) from BPGIC Holdings in exchange for its Ordinary Shares, with BPGIC becoming a wholly-owned subsidiary of Brooge Energy Limited (the “Acquisition”).

 

65

 

 

Twelve Seas was incorporated under the laws of the Cayman Islands on November 30, 2017. It was listed on NASDAQ Capital Market and was a blank check company formed in order to effect a merger, capital stock exchange, asset acquisition or other similar business combination with one or more businesses or entities.

 

Merger Sub was incorporated in April 2019 solely to effectuate the Business Combination described herein. From its formation through the Closing, Merger Sub owned no material assets and did not operate any business. Upon Closing, Merger Sub merged with and into Twelve Seas and ceased to exist as a separate entity.

 

The Merger and the Acquisition occurred simultaneously and their execution is interconnected, i.e. the Acquisition could not occur without the Merger and vice versa, we consider the Merger and the Acquisition as one transaction.

 

On December 20, 2019, the Group announced the consummation of the Business Combination. Pursuant to the Business Combination Agreement

 

(i) each outstanding ordinary share of Twelve Seas was exchanged for one (1) Ordinary Share of Brooge Energy Limited.
     
(ii) each outstanding warrant of Twelve Seas was exchanged for one warrant of Brooge Energy Limited.
     
(iii) each outstanding right of Twelve Seas was converted into one-tenth of an Ordinary Share of Brooge Energy Limited, rounded down to the nearest whole share per shareholder.
     
(iv) each outstanding unit of Twelve Seas was separated into its component parts and then exchanged for one (1) Ordinary Share of Brooge Energy Limited, one (1) warrant of Brooge Energy Limited and one-tenth of an Ordinary Share of Brooge Energy Limited.

 

BPGIC Holdings had the right, at the sole election of BPGIC (the “Cash Election”), to receive a portion of the consideration for the Purchased Shares at the Closing as cash in lieu of receiving Brooge Energy Limited Ordinary Shares in an amount not to exceed 40% of the Closing Net Cash (with the “Closing Net Cash” being the aggregate cash and cash equivalents of Twelve Seas and Brooge Energy Limited as of the Closing, including remaining funds in the Twelve Seas’ trust account after giving effect to the redemption and the proceeds of any potential private placement financing, less unpaid expenses and liabilities of Twelve Seas and the Company as of the Closing, prior to giving effect to any Cash Election).

 

Upon Closing, Twelve Seas became a wholly owned subsidiary of the Company and changed its name from “Twelve Seas Investment Company” to “BPGIC International”. In connection with the closing of the Business Combination, holders of 16,997,181 ordinary shares of Twelve Seas sold in Twelve Sea’s initial public offering (“IPO”) exercised their right to redeem such shares at a price of $10.31684239 per share, for an aggregate redemption amount of approximately $175.36 million. In addition, 1,035,000 ordinary shares of Twelve Seas were forfeited by certain pre-IPO shareholders. Effective December 23, 2019, Twelve Sea’s ordinary shares, warrants, rights and units ceased trading, and were replaced by Brooge Energy Limited’ ordinary shares and warrants on The Nasdaq Stock Market under the symbols “BROG” and “BROGW,” respectively.

 

66

 

 

The total consideration paid by the Company to BPGIC Holdings for the purchased shares was 98,718,035 Ordinary Shares after reduction of 1,281,965 shares due to the 40% cash election exercised by BPGIC Holdings. Twenty Million (20,000,000) of the Company’s Ordinary Shares otherwise issuable to BPGIC Holdings at the Closing (together with any equity securities paid as dividends or distributions with respect to such shares or into which such shares are exchanged or converted, the “Seller Escrow Shares”) were instead issued to BPGIC Holdings in escrow, and are held by Continental, as escrow agent for the benefit of BPGIC Holdings, to be held and controlled, along with any other Escrow Property (as defined in the Seller Escrow Agreement and together with the Seller Escrow Shares, the “Seller Escrow Property”) by Continental in a separate segregated escrow account (the “Seller Escrow Account”), and released in accordance with the Seller Escrow Agreement.

 

The Seller Escrow Property will only become vested and not subject to forfeiture, and released to BPGIC Holdings, in the event that the Company meets the following performance or milestone requirements during the Seller Escrow Period, the period commencing from the Closing until the end of the twentieth (20th) fiscal quarter after the commencement date of the first full fiscal quarter beginning after the Closing:

 

(i) One-half (½) of the Seller Escrow Property shall become vested and no longer subject to forfeiture, and be released to BPGIC Holdings, in the event that either: (a) the Annualized EBITDA (as defined in the Seller Escrow Agreement) for any full fiscal quarter during the Seller Escrow Period (beginning with the first full fiscal quarter beginning after the Closing) (an “Seller Escrow Quarter”) equals or exceeds $175,000,000 or (b) at any time during the Seller Escrow Period, the closing price of the Company Ordinary Shares equals or exceeds $12.50 per share (subject to equitable adjustment) for any ten (10) Trading Days (as defined in the Seller Escrow Agreement) within any twenty (20) Trading Day period during the Seller Escrow Period.

 

(ii) All Seller Escrow Property remaining in the Seller Escrow Account shall become vested and no longer subject to forfeiture, and be released to BPGIC Holdings, in the event that either: (a) the Annualized EBITDA for any Seller Escrow Quarter equals or exceeds $250,000,000 or (b) at any time during the Seller Escrow Period, the closing price of the Company Ordinary Shares equals or exceeds $14.00 per share (subject to equitable adjustment) for any ten (10) Trading Days within any twenty (20) Trading Day period during the Seller Escrow Period.

  

While the Seller Escrow Property is held in the Seller Escrow Account, BPGIC Holdings shall have all voting, consent and other rights (other than the rights to dividends, distributions or other income paid or accruing to the Seller Escrow Property). The Seller Escrow Agreement provides, however, that after the Closing, BPGIC Holdings shall be permitted to (i) pledge or otherwise encumber the Seller Escrow Property as collateral security for documented loans entered into by BPGIC Holdings, the Company or its subsidiaries, including BPGIC, after the Closing or (ii) transfer its rights to the Seller Escrow Property to a third party, provided, that (a) in each case of clauses (i) and (ii), that the lender’s or transferee’s rights to any such pledged or transferred Seller Escrow Property shall be subject to the provisions of the Seller Escrow Agreement and the sections of the Business Combination Agreement pertaining to the escrow, including the forfeiture provisions contained therein, and (b) in the event of a pledge or encumbrance of the Seller Escrow Property under clause (i) above, BPGIC Holdings may transfer the Seller Escrow Property to another escrow agent selected by BPGIC Holdings and reasonably acceptable to the Company.

 

67

 

 

Twelve Seas’ Initial Shareholders beneficially owned and were entitled to vote an aggregate of 5,175,000 ordinary shares that were issued prior to Twelve Seas’ IPO. Simultaneously with the execution of the Business Combination Agreement, the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders entered into a letter agreement with Twelve Seas, the Company and BPGIC (the “Founder Share Letter”), pursuant to which the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders agreed, effective upon the Closing, on a pro-rata basis amongst the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders based on the number of Founder Shares owned by each of them, to (i) forfeit 20% of the Founder Shares owned by the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders at the Closing and (ii) subject 30% of the Founder Shares owned by the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders at the Closing (including any Ordinary Shares issued in exchange therefor in the Merger) to escrow and vesting and potential forfeiture obligations that are substantially identical to those that apply to the Seller Escrow Property as described above.

 

Upon completion of the Business Combination, the officers and directors of Twelve Seas resigned. The directors of Brooge Energy Limited are designated by BPGIC. The current officers of BPGIC remain to be the officers of BPGIC and became officers of Brooge Energy Limited, holding the equivalent positions as those held with BPGIC.

 

RESULTS OF OPERATIONS

 

Disclaimer: The consolidated financial statements are prepared as a continuation of the financial statements of BPGIC, the accounting acquirer, and retroactively adjusted to reflect the legal capital of the legal parent/acquiree (the Company, Brooge Energy Limited). The comparative financial years included herein are derived from the consolidated financial statements of BPGIC as adjusted to reflect the legal capital of the legal parent/acquiree (the Company, Brooge Energy Limited).

 

Description of Operations

 

We conduct our operations through a dedicated operation team at the BPGIC Terminal. Our operations are categorized into two reported business services; Storage and Ancillary services.

 

Storage. We own terminal and storage facilities in United Arab Emirates in the emirate of Fujairah, currently with 399,324 m3 storage capacity for storage of clean oil. and fuel oil. Upon completion of Phase II, a crude oil storage facility, the capacity of the BPGIC Terminal will be expanded by approximately 600,000 m3 increasing the total capacity of the BPGIC Terminal to approximately 1,000,000 m3. Phase III is projected to have a capacity of approximately 3,500,000 m3. BPGIC entered into the Phase III Land Lease Agreement with FOIZ for the Phase III Land, however, the FEED (Front End Engineering Design) studies that are necessary for the Company to better understand its options with respect to the Phase III Land are still in progress. From December 2017 when BPGIC began its operations to February 28, 2018, BPGIC limited the availability of its storage capacity to 40 percent to allow management to test all systems and make any necessary adjustments. On March 1, 2018, BPGIC increased the availability of its storage capacity to approximately 70 percent, and on April 1, 2018, to 100 percent which is now currently at 100%.

 

Ancillary Services. Ancillary services are further classified into 4 sub streams, Blending & Circulation, Heating, Throughput and Intertank Transfer. We began offering ancillary services in April 2018 after management had completed its initial tests of the facility.

 

68

 

 

BPGIC charges BIA and the Super Major variable fees based on usage for the following ancillary services:

 

Throughput Fees. Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement, BIA and the Super Major, respectively, are required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products delivered from the BPGIC Terminal to the Port of Fujairah’s berths or from the berths to the BPGIC Terminal during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. Each month BIA and the Super Major are each allocated an initial amount of throughput volume at no charge that corresponds with the storage capacity that they each lease. For BIA this amount is approximately 270,000 m3 each month and for the Super Major this amount is approximately 129,000 m3. Both BIA and the Super Major are required to pay BPGIC throughput fees on throughput volume to the extent the aggregate amount of throughput volume provided by BPGIC exceeds such initial amount. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees varies based upon, among other factors, the volume of oil products exiting the BPGIC Terminal. As BIA’s sublessees and the Super Major, utilize the ancillary services, which involves sending and receiving oil products to and from the BPGIC Terminal, it will lead to corresponding increases in the throughput volumes delivered to the extent BPGIC sends oil products to the Port of Fujairah’s berths. Upon mutual agreement, BPGIC could charge a supplementary fee to the extent BIA or the Super Major exceed an agreed amount of throughput volume.
     
Blending Fees. Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement, BIA and the Super Major, respectively, are required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products blended during the blending processes performed during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. BIA and the Super Major are responsible for providing BPGIC with blend specifications, the component oil products and any additives in connection with any blend request. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees varies based upon the activity levels of BIA’s sublessees, and the Super Major.
     
Heating Fees. Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement, BIA is required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products heated during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees varies based upon the activity levels of BIA’s sublessees. The Super Major does not contract for heating services.

 

Inter-Tank Transfer Fees. Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement, BIA and the Super Major are required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products that they transferred between oil storage tanks during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees varies based upon the activity levels of BIA’s sublessees and the Super Major.

 

69

 

 

Summary Financial Results

 

In $   For the year Ended December 31,  
  2017     2018     2019  
Revenue     89,593       35,839,268       44,085,374  
Direct costs     (2,295,809 )     (9,607,360 )     (10,202,465 )
GROSS (LOSS) PROFIT     (2,206,216 )     26,231,908       33,882,909  
Listing Expenses     -       -       (101,773,877 )
General and administrative expenses     (574,266 )     (2,029,260 )     (2,608,984 )
Finance costs     (966,926 )     (6,951,923 )     (5,730,535 )
Changes in fair value of derivative financial instruments     -       (1,190,073 )     (328,176 )
(LOSS) PROFIT FOR THE PERIOD     (3,747,408 )     16,060,652       (76,558,663 )
(LOSS) PROFIT % to Revenue     -       45 %     (174 )%

 

In the Fourth Quarter of 2017, we began testing operations of the Phase I facilities. In the First Quarter of 2018, we began commercial operations of Phase I facilities at reduced storage capacity with no ancillary services to further test systems and make necessary adjustments. In the Second Quarter of 2018, we began operating at full storage capacity with complete ancillary services.

 

In the First Quarter of 2018, we began commercial operations of Phase I facilities at reduced storage capacity with no ancillary services to further test systems and make necessary adjustments. In the Second Quarter of 2018, we began operating at full storage capacity with complete ancillary services which resulted into an increase in Revenue by $8,246,106 and also corresponding Direct Costs by $595,105. This resulted in an overall Gross Profit increase of $7,651,001 for the year 2019 when compared to the year 2018.

 

As a consequence of the accounting for the Business Combination described above, there was a decrease in Net profit from $16,060,652 (45% of Revenue) in 2018 to a net loss of $76,558,663 in 2019. This is primarily attributable to a non-cash expense of $98.6 million being the difference between the fair value of Ordinary Shares issued to Twelve Seas’ shareholders in the Business Combination plus fair value of warrants and the Cash consideration received from Twelve Seas as a part of the Business Combination. This is in addition to the $3.2 million actual expenses incurred in connection with the Company’s listing on Nasdaq in 2019.

 

Revenue

 

    For the Year Ended December 31,  
Revenue Breakup   2017     2018     2019  
Fixed consideration – leasing component     62,995       14,586,315       16,846,481  
Fixed consideration – service component     26,598       6,158,667       7,112,959  
Ancillary services     -       15,094,286       20,125,934  
Total Revenue     89,593       35,839,268       44,085,374  
Revenue Break Up %                        
Storage fee     100 %     58 %     54 %
Ancillary Services fee     -       42 %     46 %

 

70

 

 

Year Ended December 31, 2017 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2018

 

Our revenue increased from $0.1 million in 2017 to $35.8 million in 2018 as a result of Phase I facilities becoming commercially operational in the First Quarter of 2018.

 

Our storage fee revenue increased from $0.1 million in 2017 to $20.7 million in 2018 as a result of Phase I’s storage capacity becoming commercially operational in the First Quarter of 2018.

 

Our ancillary services fee revenue increased from nil in 2017 to $15.1 million in 2018 as a result of Phase I’s ancillary services becoming commercially operational in the Second Quarter of 2018.

 

For 2017, storage fees comprised 100% of our total revenue. For 2018, storage fees comprised 58% of our total revenue and ancillary services fees comprised 42% of our total revenue as a result of Phase I’s ancillary services becoming commercially operational in the Second Quarter of 2018.

 

Year Ended December 31, 2018 Compared to Year Ended December 31, 2019

 

Our revenue increased from $35.8 million in 2018 to $44.1 million in 2019 primarily because we operated Phase I at full storage capacity for the year ended December 31, 2019 whereas we operated Phase I at reduced storage capacity and without ancillary services in the First Quarter of 2018.

 

Our storage fee revenue increased from $20.7 million in 2018 to $23.9 million in 2019. This is primarily attributable to our operating of Phase I at full storage capacity the full year 2019 while capacity was reduced during the First Quarter of 2018.

 

Our ancillary services fee revenue increased from $15.1 million in 2018 to $20.1 million in 2019 primarily because we offered ancillary services for the full year 2019, but we operated Phase I without ancillary services in the First Quarter of 2020.

 

For the year ended December 31, 2019, storage fees comprised 54% of total revenue and ancillary service fees comprise 46% of total revenue while for the year ended December 31, 2018, storage fees comprised 58% of our total revenue and ancillary services fees comprised 42% of our total revenue. This change in revenue mix is primarily driven by the fact that only storage revenue was generated in the First Quarter of 2018 whereas both storage and ancillary services revenue were generated in the First Quarter of 2019.

 

71

 

 

Direct Costs

 

The consolidated entities direct costs pertain only to BPGIC because there is no revenue generated at the Brooge Energy level. Direct costs are comprised principally of employee costs and related benefits, depreciation and, to a lesser extent, insurance and certain other miscellaneous operating costs.

 

Employee costs and related benefits consist of compensation to employees who provide customer support and services and external contractor costs.

 

Depreciation expenses consist of depreciation on Phase I’s oil storage tanks, administrative buildings and installations. The Company depreciates these assets using the straight-line depreciation method assuming an average useful life of 50 years for the tanks and 20 to 25 years for the buildings and installations. The Company expects its depreciation expenses will increase following the completion of Phase II and to remain a significant non-cash expense in the future, given the capital-intensive nature of its business.

 

    For the year Ended December 31,  
Direct Costs $ for   2017     2018     2019  
Employee costs & benefits     1,518,794       2,808,702       3,074,727  
Depreciation     692.528       5,716,063       5,785,745  
Spares and consumables     50,891       592,471       788,792  
Insurance     31,304       377,053       323,702  
Other expenses     2,292       113,071       229,499  
Total Direct Costs     2,295,809       9,607,360       10,202,465  

 

Year ended December 31, 2017 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2018

 

Direct costs increased by 318.5% from $2.3 million in 2017 to $9.6 million in 2018 as a result of Phase I facilities becoming commercially operational in the First Quarter of 2018.

 

The most significant component of direct costs is depreciation which increased from $0.7 million in 2017 to $5.7 million because construction of Phase I facilities was completed in the Fourth Quarter of 2017 and thus depreciation for the facilities was only recorded for 43 days in 2017 but for was recorded for the full year in 2018.

 

Employee costs & related benefits increased by 84.9% from $1.5 million in 2017 to $2.8 million in 2018 due to, amongst other things, additional employees associated with the commencement of Phase I operations in 2018 as compared to 2017 when the plant was under construction for the first 11 months of the year, though the operations staff was mobilized beginning in June 2017 for training etc. so that there would not be any loss of hours and to ensure enhanced productivity once Phase I went operational.

 

Year ended December 31, 2018 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2019

 

Direct costs increased by 6.2% from $9.6 million in 2018 to $10.2 million in 2019 primarily because we operated Phase I at full storage capacity for the year ended December 31, 2019 whereas we operated Phase I at reduced storage capacity and without ancillary services in the First Quarter of 2018.

 

Though the total direct costs were consistent with just 6.2% increase, at individual expense category level Employee costs & related benefits increased by 9.5% from $2.8 million in 2018 to $3.1 million in 2019 due to, amongst other things, an increase in number of staff and also increase in the charges fir outsourced staff.

 

As depreciation is on a straight-line basis, it remained almost the same with a minor increase of 1.2% and that was primarily due to the purchase of some furniture and other assets that were capitalized in 2019. Spares and Consumables increased by 33.1% from $0.59 million in 2018 to $0.79 million in 2019 and other expenses which mainly consist of maintenance contracts and various plant related licenses increased by 103% from $0.11 million in 2018 to $0.23 million in 2019. Both of these increases are primarily due to the Phase I facility operating at full capacity throughout the year in 2019 plus also a petty component of cost increase.

 

Gross (Loss) Profit

 

Year ended December 31, 2017 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2018

 

Following a gross loss of $2.2 million in 2017, BPGIC had a gross profit of $26.2 million in 2018. The transition from gross loss to gross profit is primarily attributable to the Phase I facility becoming operational from the First Quarter of 2018.

 

72

 

 

Year ended December 31, 2018 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2019

 

Following a gross profit of $26.2 million in 2018, BPGIC had a gross profit of $33.9 million in 2019. Revenue increased by $8,246,106 and Direct Costs increased by $595,105 resulting in an overall increase in Gross Profit of $7,651,001 for 2019 over 2018. The increase is primarily attributable to the fact that in the First Quarter of 2018, we began commercial operations of Phase I facilities at reduced storage capacity with no ancillary services to further test systems and make necessary adjustments. In the Second Quarter of 2018, we began operating at full storage capacity with complete ancillary services.

 

Listing Expenses

 

The Company’s listing expenses are of one-time non-recurring nature and will only impact the 2019 financial statements as the Company listed on Nasdaq in 2019.

 

    For the year Ended December 31,  
Listing Expenses $   2019  
Fair value of 10,869,719 Ordinary Shares (including 1,552,500 Founder Escrow Shares) Issued to Twelve Seas at $10.49 per share     114,023,352  
Fair value of 21,229,000 warrants at $0.80 per Warrant     16,983,200  
Net Liability of Twelve Seas at Business Combination     680,081  
Total Value of Consideration     131,686,633  
Less        
Proceeds received Post Merger Twelve Assets (Cash)     (33,064,615 )
Listing Expenses Total (Non – Cash) – IFRS 2     98,622,019  
Listing Expenses Total (Cash)*     3,151,858  
Total Listing Expenses     101,773,877  

 

* Listing Expenses Total (Cash) represents promissory note of USD 1.5 million, fees paid to legal advisors, consultants, and other necessary expenses incurred in relation to the Group’s listing on the US market.

 

As per IFRS 2, the Ordinary Shares distributed at the time of Business Combination are valued at the fair value which was $10.49 as on December 19, 2019 and the fair value of the warrants is calculated at $0.80 per warrant. The difference between the fair value of the Ordinary Shares and warrants issued and the fair value of the net assets received amounting $98.62 million have been recognized as a listing expense. This is the primary reason for the substantial increase in indirect expenses and corresponding reduction in net profits resulting into a net loss of $76.6 million during 2019.

 

General and Administrative Expenses

 

The Company’s general and administrative expenses include costs not directly attributable to the operations of the BPGIC Terminal and consist primarily of compensation costs for its executive, financial, human resources, and administrative functions. Other significant expenses include outside legal counsel, independent auditors and other outside consultants, recruiting, travel, rent and advertising.

 

73

 

 

    For the year Ended December 31,  
General & Administrative Expenses $   2017     2018     2019  
Employee costs     287,481       1,178,919       1,471,974  
Consultancy expenses     54,529       337,491       535,275  
Recruitment expenses     53,912       33,362       1,360  
Travel and related expenses     16,544       11,515       52,506  
Short-term leases     43,380       22,325       10,346  
Advertisement, subscriptions & Committee Expenses     37,223       116,495       131,494  
Printing and stationery     12,636       22,713       25,954  
License costs     22,872       19,249       15,502  
Communication expenses     9,379       19,773       35,465  
Other expenses     36,310       267,418       326,108  
Total G&A Expenses     574,266       2,029,260       2,608,984  

 

Year ended December 31, 2017 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2018

 

General and administrative expenses increased by 253.4% from $0.6 million in 2017 to $2.0 million in 2018. The increased expenses consisted primarily of $1.2 million in employee costs and related benefits, with the balance of the increase attributable to consultancy, recruitment and other working capital expenses. Employee costs increased in 2018 because of an increased headcount including appointments of a CFO, Finance Manager, Legal Secretary, FP&A Manager.

 

Year ended December 31, 2018 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2019

 

General and administrative expenses increased by 28.6% from $2.0 million in 2018 to $2.6 million in 2019. The increased expenses consisted primarily of employee costs and related benefits had a jump by 24.9% from $1.2 million in 2018 to $1.5 Million in 2019. This was mainly due to increase in salaries of various staff in addition to bonus to some staff. Further, during 2019, there was some employee turnover that resulted in some employees with higher compensation than prior staff.

 

There was an increase in consultancy expenses by 58.6% from $0.34 million in 2018 to $0.54 million in 2019. This was mainly attributable to increase in Statutory Audit fees and lawyers’ fees pertaining to drafting of an offtake agreement with BIA plus other professional fees in terms of legal opinions in normal course of business.

 

There is also an increase of 21.9% in other expenses from $0.27 million in 2018 to $0.32 million in 2019. This increase relates to committee expenses paid for or provided to board members of $0.07 million in 2019 which was nil in 2018.

 

Finance Costs

 

The Company’s finance costs consist of amortization of lease liability interest and interest expense under its Financing Facilities (as defined below).

 

The Phase I & II Land Lease entered into in March 2013 has an initial term of 30 years, which is extendable for another 30 years. The Company has concluded that it has the right to use of the land and, accordingly, recorded a lease liability in accordance with IFRS 16. Given the Company’s use of the land, it is reasonably certain that it will continue to lease the land until the end of lease period (i.e. 60 years) and, accordingly, the lease rental amounts cover a period up to 60 years and are discounted at the rate of 9.5% as the incremental borrowing rate of the Company over 60 years.

 

74

 

 

    For the year Ended December 31,  
Finance Cost ($) for   2017     2018     2019  
Interest on lease liability     318,957       1,387,612       1,412,796  
Finance costs on term loan & Bank Charges     647,969       5,564,311       4,317,739  
Total Finance Cost     966,926       6,951,923       5,730,535  

 

Year ended December 31, 2017 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2018

 

Finance costs increased from $1.0 million in 2017 to $7.0 million in 2018. In 2018, finance costs consisted almost entirely of $5.6 million in finance costs on term loans under the Phase I Financing Facilities and $1.4 million in interest on lease liability.

 

During 2017, the interest on lease liability and interest on term loans during the repayment period were capitalized and added to the cost of construction of the Phase I facility and, as a result, the finance costs recorded within the Company’s statement of comprehensive income for the year ended December 31, 2017 were only for the period from November 19, 2017, the date on which Phase I was ready for its intended use, through December 31, 2017. For the year ended December 31, 2018, the majority of finance costs accrued over the period were recorded within the statement of comprehensive income resulting in the high variance between finance costs for the year ended December 31, 2018 as compared to the year ended December 31, 2017.

 

Year ended December 31, 2018 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2019.

 

Finance costs reduced by 17.6% from $7.0 Million in 2018 to $5.7 Million in 2019. In 2018, finance costs consisted almost entirely of $5.6 million in finance costs on term loans under the Phase I Financing Facilities which has reduced to $4 Million in 2019. This is mainly because during the period July 2018 there was a decrease in bank borrowing rates to EIBOR + 3% on loans from earlier EIBOR + 3.5% with minimum 5.5%. Also with payment of principal there is reduction in Principal which results into decrease of interest amount on loans. There is $1.4 million in interest on lease liability that is almost same in both the years 2018 and 2019.

 

75

 

 

Net Profit

 

Year ended December 31, 2017 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2018

 

Following a net loss of $3.7 million in 2017, BPGIC had a net profit of $16.1 million in 2018. The transition from net loss to net profit is primarily attributable to the Phase I facility becoming operational in the First Quarter of 2018.

 

Year ended December 31, 2018 Compared to Year ended December 31, 2019

 

As a consequence of the accounting for the Business Combination described above, there was a decrease in Net profit from $16,060,652 (45% of Revenue) in 2018 to a net loss of $76,558,663 in 2019. This is primarily attributable to a non-cash expense of $98.6 million being the difference between the fair value of Ordinary Shares issued to Twelve Seas’ shareholders in the Business Combination plus fair value of warrants and the Cash consideration received from Twelve Seas as a part of the Business Combination. This is in addition to the $3.2 million actual expenses incurred in connection with the Company’s listing on Nasdaq in 2019.

 

Adjusted EBITDA

 

We define Adjusted EBITDA as profit (loss) before finance costs, income tax expense (currently not applicable in the UAE but included here for reference purposes), depreciation, listing expenses and net change in the value of derivative financial instruments. In addition to non-cash items, we have selected items for adjustment to EBITDA which management feels decrease the comparability of our results among periods. These items are identified as those which are generally outside of the results of day-to-day operations of the business. Except for listing expenses, these items are not considered non-recurring, infrequent or unusual, but do erode comparability among periods in which they occur with periods in which they do not occur or occur to a greater or lesser degree.

 

Note About Non-IFRS Financial Measures

 

Our Adjusted EBITDA improved from negative $2.1 million for the year ended December 31, 2017 to $29.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2018 because of operations during the year 2018.

 

Our Adjusted EBITDA improved from $29.9 million (83.48% of revenue) for the year ended December 31, 2018 to $37.1 million (84.1% of revenue) for the year ended December 31, 2019 and as explained earlier we have added back the one-time listing expenses of $101.8 million to net loss to provide what we believe is a better comparison and evaluation of Adjusted EBITDA.

 

Adjusted EBITDA is not a financial measure presented in accordance with IFRS. Adjusted EBITDA should not be considered in isolation or as a substitute for or superior to analysis of our results, including net income, prepared in accordance with IFRS. Because Adjusted EBITDA is a non-IFRS measure, it may be defined differently by other companies in our industry, our definition of this Non-IFRS financial measure may not be comparable to similarly titled measures of other companies, thereby diminishing the utility. We encourage investors and others to review our financial information in its entirety and not rely on a single financial measure.

 

We present Adjusted EBITDA as a supplemental performance measure because we believe that the presentation of this non-IFRS financial measure will provide useful information to investors in assessing our financial condition and results of operations. Profit (loss) is the IFRS measure most directly comparable to Adjusted EBITDA. Adjusted EBITDA has important limitations as an analytical tool because it excludes some, but not all, items that affect net income. Some limitations of Adjusted EBITDA are:

 

Adjusted EBITDA does reflect finance costs of, or the cash requirements necessary to service interest on our debts; and

 

Adjusted EBITDA excludes depreciation and although these are non-cash charges, the assets being depreciated may have to be replaced in the future.

 

76

 

 

Management compensates for the limitations of Adjusted EBITDA as an analytical tool by reviewing the comparable IFRS measure, understanding the difference between Adjusted EBITDA and profit (loss) and incorporating this knowledge into its decision-making processes. We believe that investors benefit from having access to the same financial measures that our management uses in evaluating our operating results.

 

The following table presents a reconciliation of net income to Adjusted EBITDA, the most directly comparable IFRS financial measure for the various periods:

    For the Year Ended December 31,  
$   2017     2018     2019  
Profit (loss) for the year/ period     (3,747,408 )     16,060,652       (76,558,663 )
Adjustments for                        
 Depreciation charge     692,528       5,716,063       5,785,745  
 Finance costs     966,926       6,951,923       5,730,535  
Listing Expenses     -       -       101,773,877  
Net changes in fair value of derivative financial instruments     -       1,190,073       328,176  
Total Adjustments     1,659,454       13,858,059       113,618,333  
Adjusted EBITDA     (2,087,954 )     29,918,711       37,059,670  
Revenues     89,593       35,839,268       44,085,374  
Adjusted EBITDA % of Revenues     -       83.48 %     84.06 %

 

LIQUIDITY AND CAPITAL RESOURCES

 

Overview

 

Our capital requirements have primarily been for capital expenditures related to the development of Phase I and Phase II, debt service, operating expenses, and shareholder distributions. Historically, we have funded our capital requirements through the Financing Facilities and equity contributions. We anticipate funding our future capital requirements and debt service payments with cash generated from our operations, funds received through the business combination and future borrowings. To the extent we choose to seek additional financing in the future (whether for development, acquisition opportunities as they arise or the refinancing of the Financing Facilities when due at more favorable terms), we expect to fund such activities through cash generated from operations and through securing further debt financing from banks and the capital markets.

 

On December 31, 2018, we had a bank overdraft position due to ongoing discussions with our bank regarding the restructuring of our loan facilities, and on December 31, 2019, we had cash of $19.8 million. As of December 31, 2019, we had (i) the Phase I Financing Facility, a term loan facility for an aggregate amount of $84.6 million which we primarily used to fund a portion of the construction cost of the Phase I facility, (ii) the Phase I Admin Building Facility, a term loan facility for an aggregate of $11.1 million which we primarily used to fund a portion of the construction cost of an administrative building in Fujairah, (iii) the Phase I Short Term Financing Facility, a term loan facility for an aggregate of $3.5 million which we primarily used to settle certain accrued interest on the Phase I Financing Facility, and (iv) the Phase II Financing Facility, a term loan facility for up to an aggregate of $95.3 million. Each facility is a Sharia compliant financing arrangement. As of December 31, 2019, we had $78.4 million outstanding under the Phase I Financing Facility ($82.2 Million as on December 31, 2018), $8.0 million outstanding under the Phase I Admin Building Facility ($10.1 million as on December 31, 2018), Nil outstanding under the Phase I Short Term Financing Facility as this was completely paid out and settled during 2019 ($2.4 Million as on December 31, 2018) and no borrowings outstanding under the Phase II Financing Facility.

 

77

 

 

In addition to above as a part of the business combination agreement as on December 31, 2019 with Twelve Seas an amount of $1.5 Million is due to Early Bird Capital Inc. at the end of one year from the date of the combination i.e. December 20, 2020 and an amount of $0.77 Million payable to Sponsors of Twelve Seas in two parts, $0.27 Million by January 31, 2020 (already paid as on date of this document) and $0.5 Million by June 30,2020. This amount is non-interest bearing and non-collateral. These 2 amounts totaling to $2.27 million (Nil as on December 31, 2018) is shown as short term debt commitment at Consolidated Entity level in addition to above term loan facilities from bank.

 

Cash Flows for the Years Ended

 

The following table summarizes our cash flows from operating, investing and financing activities in $.

 

    2017     2018     2019  
Operating Activities     (2,252,917 )     27,896,721       53,414,352  
Investing Activities     (21,924,553 )     (271,403 )     (60,355,262 )
Financing Activities     24,319,059       (31,617,070 )     30,479,378  
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH     141,589       (3,991,752 )     23,538,468  

 

Operating Activities

 

Net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2018 of $27.9 million compared to net cash used in operating activities of $2.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to operating cash flow from the Phase I facility which became commercially operational in 2018.

 

Net cash provided by operating activities for the year ended December 31, 2019 was $53.4 million compared to net cash provided in operating activities of $27.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2018. There was a net loss reported for $76.6 million in 2019, this was due to listing expense of $101.8 million. This includes non-cash listing expense of $98.6 million and a promissory note of $1.5 million which were added back to net loss for computation of cash flow from Operating Activities’. The increased operating income is primarily attributable to our operation of Phase I at full storage capacity for the year ended December 31, 2019 whereas we operated Phase I at reduced storage capacity and without ancillary services in the First Quarter of 2018.

 

In addition to above the increase in Trade receivables were in line with 2018, however the increase in accruals and payables is due to the construction of Phase II.

 

Investing Activities

 

Net cash used in investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2018 decreased to $0.3 million from $21.9 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to the completion of the Phase I facility in early 2018 without a ramp-up in cash used for Phase II during the year. Net cash used in 2017 consisted primarily of $22.5 million relating to the construction of the Phase I facility which was completed on November 19, 2017.

 

Net cash used in investing activities for the year ended December 31, 2019 increased to $60.4 million from $0.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2018, primarily due to the construction of Phase II facility in 2019. Net cash used in 2019 consisted primarily of $21.7 million being the balance from the advance paid to contractor of Phase II and remaining $39.0 million relating to the construction of the Phase II facility which is expected to be completed by the Fourth Quarter of 2020.

 

78

 

 

Financing Activities

 

Net cash used in financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2018 was $31.6 million as compared to net cash provided by financing activities of $24.3 million for the year ended December 31, 2017, primarily due to an increase in distributions to shareholders, increase in payments of interest and principal, and a reduction of additional borrowings. For the year ended December 31, 2018, net cash used in financing activities consisted primarily of $25.0 million in distributions to shareholders, $7.2 million in interest payments, and $3.5 million in principal repayments, partially offset by $4 million in proceeds from term loans. For the year ended December 31, 2017, net cash provided by financing activities consisted primarily of $16.7 million in proceeds from term loans and $11.2 million in proceeds from shareholder contributions, partially offset by payments of $3.4 million of interest and $0.1 million of financing transaction costs.

 

Net cash generated by financing activities for the year ended December 31, 2019 was $30.5 million as compared to net cash used for financing activities of $31.6 million for the year ended December 31, 2018. This was primarily due to an increase in capital from the Business Combination with Twelve Seas in the amount of $33.1 million and $23.3 million injected by related parties of the consolidated entity. An amount of $8.4 million was used for repayment of principal on Financing Facilities and $1.5 million towards payment of interest on Financing Facilities. Further, an amount of $13.6 million was paid to certain pre-Business Combination shareholders as a portion of 40% Cash Election resulting in a net cash position from Financing of $30.5 Million.

 

Working Capital

 

Year Ended December 31, 2019

 

As of December 31, 2019, BPGIC had negative working capital of $57.0 million Compared to a negative $108.5 million in 2018. This was due to the following:

 

a. During the year 2019 there was a capital accrual in the amount of $31.6 million calculated based on the percentage of completion of the Phase II Terminal as of December 31, 2019. There was an advance paid to contractors in the amount of $21.7 million which was classified as a non current asset under Advances to contractors and hence does not form a part of working capital computation.
     
b. There is an amount of $17.1 million payable to the contractor and project manager as of December 31, 2019 contributing to an increase in Accounts payable.
     
c. The cash position also decreased to the extent of $13.6 million as a result of cash election clause in the business combination agreement paid to certain pre-Business Combination shareholders of BPGIC wherein they had an option to opt either for shares or cash and wherein they opted for cash. This reduced the bank balance having direct impact on the cash in hand position with reduction in Current assets.

 

Year Ended December 31, 2018

 

Under the Phase I Financing Facilities, BPGIC was subject to certain covenants requiring amongst other things, the maintenance of:

 

(i) a minimum debt service coverage ratio (“DSCR”) of 150% at all times and if the ratio decreases to 120% or less, it results in an event of default; and
     
(ii) an amount equivalent to one quarterly instalment including interest in a debt service reserve account (“DSRA”) at all times.

 

79

 

 

As of December 31, 2018, BPGIC had negative working capital of $108.5 million. This was due to the following:

 

a. During the year there was a net cash outflow of $25.0 million to the shareholders from its operating cash flow and another $10.7 million cash outflow for loan repayment.
     
b. In 2018, BPGIC was in discussions with the lender to restructure the Phase I Financing Facilities on more favorable terms in line with the current market rates and lending criteria. As of December 31, 2018, discussions were still in progress, and a payment in the amount of $3.8 million was due to the bank as an installment payment consisting of $2.7 million in principal repayment and $1.0 million in interest. As discussions were ongoing, the payment was processed from BPGIC’s bank account creating an overdraft in its current bank account, which was reflected as the bank overdraft in the December 31, 2018 statement of financial position.

 

In addition to the circumstances described in subparagraph b above, BPGIC did not comply with the first and second covenant listed above. Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the Phase I Financing Facilities, the lender could have done so as a result of the breach of the covenants described above and could have required immediate repayment of the amounts outstanding. Accordingly, the December 31, 2018 statement of financial position classifies all of the Company’s bank loans as current liabilities. The Company’s lender has not requested any immediate repayment of these loans and the loan agreements have been amended on September 10, 2019 and subsequently on December 30, 2019 and June 15, 2020, including revised repayment schedules. (Please refer to note 13 of BPGIC’s financial statements as of December 31, 2017 and 2018 for further information).

 

Year Ended December 31, 2017

 

As of December 31, 2017, the Company had negative working capital of $100.5 million. This was due to the following:

 

a. During the year 2017, BPGIC had no operating income which is a primary requirement for computing DSCR. Further, the Phase I Construction Facilities were not fully drawn which is a primary requirement for determining the amount of one quarterly installment including interest to be placed in the DSRA. As such, BPGIC did not comply with the DSCR and DSRA covenants.
     
b. These breaches constituted an event of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the amounts outstanding. Accordingly, the Company has classified the entire amount outstanding of $94.2 million as of December 31, 2017 as a current liability based on the non-compliance.

 

80

 

 

Capital Expenditures

 

In 2019, we made capital expenditures of $87.3 million ($2 Million in 2018) including advance paid to contractor and this is primarily in connection with construction of Phase II. These expenditures were financed by cash from operations and cash injected by the shareholders.

 

Our additional capital expenditures during 2020 are expected to be approximately $79.3 million, which we expect to fund primarily through cash from operations, shareholder contributions, the proceeds of the Business Combination, and drawdowns on the Phase II Financing Facility. These planned capital expenditures will consist primarily of expenditures related to the construction of the Phase II facility.

 

Debt Sources of Liquidity

 

Current ($)   Terms   Due   Dec-17     Dec-18     Dec-19  
Term loan (1) - Phase I Loan   3 month EIBOR + 3% margin   2020     83,424,947       82,245,595       10,135,939  
Term loan (2) - Admin Building Loan   3 month EIBOR + 3% margin   2020     10,738,804       10,165,703       2,138,248  
Term loan (3) - Short Term Loan   2 month EIBOR + 2% margin   2020     -       2,380,790       -  
Term loan (4) - Promissory Note Early Bird Inc.   Non-Interest Bearing   2020     -       -       1,500,000  
Term Loan (5) - Promissory Note Twelve Seas Sponsors   Non-Interest Bearing   2020     -       -       765,000  
              94,163,751       94,792,088       14,539,187  
Non Current ($)                                
Term loan (1)   3 month EIBOR + 3% margin   Jul-30     -       -       68,271,743  
Term loan (2)   3 month EIBOR + 3% margin   Jul-23     -       -       5,889,207  
              -       -       74,160,950  
Total Loan as on             94,163,751       94,792,088       88,700,137  

 

81

 

 

As of December 31, 2019, BPGIC was in compliance with the terms of its Financing Facilities. However, BPGIC was not in compliance with its debt covenants, including the debt service coverage ratio contained in the Company’s Phase I Financing Facilities at all times during the year ended December 31, 2019.  Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the loan agreements, these breaches constituted events of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the loans.

 

On September 10, 2019, the Company entered into an agreement with its lender to amend the Phase I Construction Facility. The principal and accrued interest of $5,494,063 outstanding under this facility as of July 31, 2019 as per the original repayment schedule became due on November 30, 2019. The Phase I Construction Facility became payable in 45 instalments starting October 31, 2019 with final maturity on July 30, 2030. The Phase I Admin Building Financing Facility and the Phase I Short Term Financing Facility were not amended as part of the September 10, 2019 agreement to amend the Phase I Construction Facility. Subsequent to December 31, 2018 the Company had repaid $5,646,206 due under the Phase I Admin Building Facility and the Phase I Short Term Financing Facility. As such, all instalments related to Phase I Admin Building Facility and the Phase I Short Term Financing Facility due under the original repayment schedules up to September 10, 2019 were repaid. In addition, the Company agreed to assign to the lender all proceeds from the operation of the tanks and to pre-settle by December 31, 2019 AED 100,000,000 (($27,225,701) translated using the exchange rate as of December 31, 2019) of principal under the Phase I Construction Facilities from the proceeds received from the Business Combination. A payment of principal and interest due on October 31, 2019 under the Phase I Financing Facilities was not paid in full as a result of recent discussions between the Company and the lender pertaining to more favorable financing terms. This partial non-payment was an event of default, but, as in the past, the lender did not declare an event of default. A payment of principal and interest due on November 30, 2019 under the Phase I Financing Facilities was not paid as a result of recent discussions between BPGIC and FAB pertaining to more favorable financing terms. 

 

On December 30, 2019, BPGIC and FAB agreed to amend the Phase I Construction Facility to defer the installments due thereunder to later dates. The key changes resulting from the amendment were as follows:

 

1. an amount of $5,729,417.50 which was due on November 30, 2019 would be repayable on February 28, 2020;

 

  2. an amount of $1,765,553.50 which was due on January 31, 2020 would be payable in two installments: $882,776.75 on January 31, 2020 and $882,776.75 on February 28, 2020; and

 

  3. the Debt Service Reserve Account to be created by February 28, 2020; and

 

  4. testing of the Debt Service Coverage Ratio covenant to start on February 28, 2020 and to be conducted on each subsequent due date.

 

82

 

 

The terms of the Phase I Admin Building Financing Facility remained unchanged.

 

Note on Breach of Covenant for 2017 & 2018:

 

Under the Phase I Financing Facilities, the Company is subject to certain covenants requiring amongst other things, the maintenance of:

 

(i) a minimum debt service coverage ratio of 150% at all times and if the ratio decreases to 120% or less, it results in an event of default; and
     
(ii) an amount equivalent to one quarterly instalment including interest in a debt service reserve account at all times.

 

As of December 31, 2018:

 

The Company did not maintain a DSRA account and was not in compliance with the minimum debt service coverage ratio resulting in a breach of debt covenants requirement described above. Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the loan agreement, these breaches constituted an event of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the loan. As a result of this non-compliance and in accordance with guidance related to the classification of obligations that are callable by the lender, the December 31, 2018 statement of financial position classifies all of the Company’s bank loans as current liabilities. The Company’s lender has not requested any immediate repayment of these loans and the loan agreements have been amended on September 10, 2019 and subsequently, on December 30, 2019 and June 15, 2020, including revised repayment schedules.

 

As December 31, 2017:

 

During the year 2017, BPGIC had no operating income which is a primary requirement for computing DSCR. Further, the Phase I Construction Facilities were not fully drawn which is a primary requirement for determining the amount of one quarterly installment including interest to be placed in the DSRA. As such, BPGIC did not comply with the DSCR and DSRA covenants. These breaches constituted an event of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the amounts outstanding.

 

Phase I Construction Facility

 

In 2014, the Company obtained the Phase I Construction Facility, a secured Sharia compliant financing arrangement, in an aggregate amount of $84.6 million from FAB (as successor to National Bank of Abu Dhabi PJSC) to partially finance construction of Phase I. The loan has a notional amount of $84.6 million. During the year ended December 31, 2018, the Company drew down an additional $0.6 million from this facility. The loan was originally repayable in 48 quarterly instalments beginning 27 months after start of construction with final maturity not later than March 31, 2028 and is stated net of prepaid finance cost of $0.6 million.

 

In 2018, the Company entered into an agreement to amend the Phase I Construction Facility to provide that the facility is now to be repayable in 48 quarterly installments starting October 2018 with final maturity in July 2030. As amended, the facility has an interest rate equal to 3 month EIBOR + 3% as compared to interest at 6 month EIBOR + 3.5% previously.

 

83

 

 

On September 10, 2019, the Company entered into a restructuring agreement with FAB to amend the Phase I Construction Facility. As a result of the September 10th amendment, the Phase I Construction Facility became payable in 45 instalments starting October 31, 2019 with final maturity on July 30, 2030. One of the instalments of the Phase I Construction Facility included a one-time lump sum repayment of $5.7 million, which represented the cumulative instalments including interest outstanding from periods prior to this amendment of $5.5 million and an amendment fee of $0.2 million. All securities and covenants under the original Phase I Financing Facilities remained in effect under the amended agreements. Under the amended agreements, the Phase I Construction Facilities are also secured by assignment of the proceeds from operation of the tanks. In addition, the pre-Business Combination owners of BPGIC committed to partially pre-settle by December 31, 2019 AED 100 million ($27.2 million — translated using the exchange rate as of December 31, 2019) of the Phase I Construction Facilities from the proceeds of the Business Combination.

 

On December 30, 2019, BPGIC and FAB agreed to amend the Phase I Construction Facility (as defined in the Form F-4) to defer the installments due thereunder to later dates. The key changes resulting from the amendment were as follows:

 

  1. an amount of $5,729,417.50 which was due on November 30, 2019 will now be repayable on February 28, 2020;

 

  2. an amount of $1,765,553.50 which was due on January 31, 2020 will now be payable in two installments: $882,776.75 on January 31, 2020 and $882,776.75 on February 28, 2020; and

 

  3. the Debt Service Reserve Account to be created by February 28, 2020; and

 

  4. testing of the Debt Service Coverage Ratio covenant to start on February 28, 2020 and to be conducted on each subsequent due date.

 

BPGIC did not comply with the terms of the Phase I Construction Facilities as amended on December 30, 2019. A payment of principal and interest of $6.6 Million for the Phase I Construction Facility due on February 28, 2020 was not paid. Payments of principal and interest totaling $2.2 million for the Phase I Construction Facility due on April 30, 2020 were not made. The Debt Service Reserve Account did not maintain a balance in an amount equivalent to one quarterly instalment including interest by February 28, 2020. BPGIC did not maintain a minimum Debt Service Coverage Ratio of 150% beginning on February 28, 2020. These non-payments and failures to comply with covenants were events of default, but, as in the past, the lender did not declare an event of default.

 

On June 15, 2020, BPGIC entered into the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, an agreement with its lender to amend the Phase I Construction Facilities.

 

Pursuant to the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, BPGIC and the lender agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Construction Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from June 30, 2020 through December 31, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
June 30, 2020   $2.99 Million
July 31, 2020   $3.62 Million
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $1.01 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $3.87 Million
Total   $11.9  Million by end of 2020

 

84

 

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 30, 2030, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $1.77 Million

 

Testing of the Debt Service Ratio Covenant will start on December 31, 2020 and will be conducted on each subsequent payment date. A Debt Service Reserve Account containing at least 1 quarter of debt service amounts must be maintained with the lender by October 31, 2020 and at all times thereafter through the term of the Phase I Construction Facility or until BPGIC repays all liabilities owed under the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC pledged the account to the lender as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC, The Company and BPGIC Holdings undertook to have no other bank accounts except for the one that is the Debt Service Reserve Account until the Phase I Construction Facilities are repaid and to route all funds through the Debt Service Reserve Account. BPGIC further granted the lender a non-possessory mortgage over the Phase I Customer Agreement as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities.

 

Also pursuant to the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, BPGIC negotiated revised pricing terms as follows:

 

o Phase I Construction Facility: Enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021;

 

There is no change in the final maturity of Phase I Construction Facility which is July 30, 2030. BPGIC will pay FAB a transaction service fee of $0.14 million in connection with the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment,.

 

The security granted also includes the Phase I oil storage tanks, pledges over the earnings, an assignment of contracts, and a commercial mortgage over equipment of BPGIC including oil storage tanks. The financiers are entitled to enforce their security if there is an event of default under the financing documents which is continuing. The facility contains customary covenants and events of default, including covenants that may limit BPGIC’s ability to incur additional indebtedness and create liens, and covenants that limit BPGIC’s ability to consolidate, merge or dispose of all or substantially all of its assets.

 

Phase I Admin Building Facility

 

In 2017, the Company obtained the Phase I Admin Building Facility, a secured Shari’a compliant financing arrangement, in an aggregate total commitment amount of $11.1 million from FAB for the construction of an administrative building in Fujairah. The loan has a notional amount of AED 40.8 million. The Company drew down a total of $10.8 million on this facility during 2017. The loan was originally repayable over a maximum of 20 quarterly instalments starting after a 6 months’ grace period commencing in April 2017 and is stated net of prepaid finance cost of $0.1 million. The loan was drawn down in AED.

 

In 2018, the Company entered into an agreement to amend the Phase I Admin Building Facility. The facility is now repayable in over a maximum of 20 quarterly installments starting in October 2018 with final maturity in July 2023.As amended, the facility has an interest rate equal to 3 month EIBOR + 3% as compared to interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3.5% previously.

 

BPGIC did not comply with the terms of the Phase I Admin Building Facility as amended on December 30, 2019. A payment of principal and interest totaling $0.5 million for the Phase I Admin Building Facility due on April 30, 2020 was not made. The Debt Service Reserve Account did not maintain a balance in an amount equivalent to one quarterly instalment including interest by February 28, 2020. BPGIC did not maintain a minimum Debt Service Coverage Ratio of 150% beginning on February 28, 2020. These non-payments and failures to comply with covenants were events of default, but, as in the past, the lender did not declare an event of default.

 

85

 

 

On June 15, 2020, BPGIC entered into the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment to amend the Phase I Admin Building Facilities.

 

Pursuant to the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, BPGIC and the lender agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Admin Building Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from August 31, 2020 through December 21, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $0.41 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $0.80 Million
Total   $1.63  Million by end of 2020

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 31, 2023, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $0.54 Million.

 

Also pursuant to the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, BPGIC negotiated revised pricing terms as follows:

 

o Phase I Admin Building Facility: Enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021.

 

There is no change in the final maturity of Phase I Admin Building Facility which is July 31, 2023. BPGIC will pay FAB a transaction service fee of $0.14 million in connection with the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment.

 

The security granted also includes the Phase I oil storage tanks and the administrative building, an assignment of rental income generated from our administrative building in Fujairah, an advance payment guarantee and a performance guarantee. The financiers are entitled to enforce their security if there is an event of default under the financing documents which is continuing. The facility contains customary covenants and events of default, including covenants that limit BPGIC’s ability to incur additional indebtedness and create liens, and covenants that limit BPGIC’s ability to consolidate, merge or dispose of all or substantially all of its assets and enter into transactions with affiliates.

 

Phase I Short Term Financing Facility

 

In 2018, the Company obtained the Phase I Short Term Financing Facility, a secured Shari’a compliant financing arrangement, with the bank to settle accrued interest on the Phase I Construction Facility in an aggregate amount of $3.5 million. The loan is denominated in UAE currency and is notionally AED 13.0 million in amount. The new LME Murabaha facility carries interest at 1 month EIBOR + 2% margin and is repayable in 15 equal monthly installments commencing from date of disbursement. The security granted includes the security granted for the Phase I Construction Facility, the Phase I Admin Building Facility. The financiers are entitled to enforce their security if there is an event of default under the financing documents which is continuing. The facility contains customary covenants and events of default, including covenants that limit BPGIC’s ability to incur additional indebtedness and create liens, and covenants that limit BPGIC’s ability to consolidate, merge or dispose of all or substantially all of its assets and enter into transactions with affiliates. This facility was fully paid as of December 31, 2019.

 

86

 

 

Note on Going Concern

 

As of 31 December 2018, the Group had not paid USD 3.7 million of principal and accrued interest that was due under the Group’s Phase I Financing Facilities. Also, as of 31 December 2018, the Group was not in compliance with its debt covenants, including the debt service coverage ratio contained in the Group’s Phase I Financing Facilities. Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the loan agreements, these breaches constituted events of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the loans. Accordingly, as of 31 December 2018, the Group has classified its debt balance of USD 94.8 million as a current liability.

 

On 10 September 2019 and again on 30 December 2019 the Group entered into agreements with its lender to amend the Phase 1 Financing Facility such that on 31 December 2019 the Group was in compliance with the amended facility agreement. At 31 December 2019, the Group’s current liabilities exceeded its current assets by USD 57 million.

  

Subsequent to the year end, the Group defaulted on its commitments under its term loans and the Group was not in compliance with its debt covenants, including the debt service coverage ratio contained in the Group’s loan agreement. Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the loan agreements, these breaches constituted events of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the loans.

 

On 15 June 2020, the Group entered into an agreement with its lender to amend its Phase I Financing Facilities (note 15). The Group will have to pay principal and accrued interest of USD 8.8 million in 2020 which represents the cumulative instalments including interest outstanding from periods prior to this amended agreement and an amendment fee of USD 136,000. Term loan (1) and Term loan (2) is now payable in 46 and 16 instalments respectively starting 30 June 2020 with final maturity on 31 July 2030 and 31 July 2023, respectively.

  

During 2018, the Group signed a sales agreement for phase 2 to provide storage and ancillary services to an international commodity trading company, which was novated to a new party during the year. Phase 2 operations are scheduled to start in fourth quarter of 2020 and management expects this will generate significant operating cash flows. The Group is in receipt of a loan facility letter date 15 October 2018 from a lender. The Group intends to draw down from this facility to finance the payments due to the contractor in respect of Phase 2 construction in the third quarter of 2020. The ability of the Group to draw down on this facility is contingent upon a number of conditions agreed in the facility letter which will need to be assessed and approved by the bank prior to the disbursement of funds.

 

Based on the above noted, management has considered the going concern status of the Group and believes there to be a material uncertainty that casts significant doubt upon the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern. Based on management’s forecasts the capital expenditure requirements for phase 2 and debt servicing as described above will be funded by cash generated through the ongoing operations and further drawdowns from approved loan facilities. The Group’s management acknowledge that there is a risk that the quantum and timing of cash flows may not be achievable in line with the twelve months forecasts from the date of approval of the Group’s financial statements. Accordingly, there is significant doubt that the Group will be able to pay its obligations as they fall due and this significant doubt is not alleviated by management’s plans.

  

The financial statements have been prepared assuming that the Group will continue as a going concern. Accordingly, the consolidated financial statements do not include any adjustments relating to the recoverability and classification of recorded asset amounts, the amounts and classification of liabilities, or any other adjustments that might result in the event the Group is unable to continue as a going concern.

 

87

 

 

Phase II Financing Facility

 

During the year 2018, the Company obtained a new facility, the Phase II Financing Facility, from a commercial bank in the UAE amounting to $95.3 million (AED 350.0 million) to partially finance the construction of Phase II. The new facility carries interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3% margin.

 

The Phase II Financing Facility is secured by a mortgage on the Phase II storage tanks, step-in right to the leased land and assignment of the proceeds from operation of the tanks and insurance policies. The term loan is also secured by guarantees from Al Brooge Capital providing for Oil and Gas LLC and Emirates Investment LLC FZC.

 

Under the Phase II Financing Facility, the Company is subject to certain covenants requiring amongst other things, the maintenance of (i) a minimum facility service coverage ratio of 1.25:1, (ii) a participations to value ratio not exceeding 1.50:1 at all times, (iii) a participations to cost ratio not exceeding 57% at any date, and (iv) an amount equivalent to one instalment including interest in a facility service reserve account at all times or in the event of an initial public offering, the amount should be equivalent to the next two instalments including interest. The facility service coverage ratio is calculated as revenues minus expenses from the Phase II storage tanks divided by the current debt commitments on the Phase II Financing Facility including interest. The participations to value ratio at any date is calculated as total debt commitments on the Phase II Financing Facility as of that date divided by the most recent valuation of the Phase II storage tanks. The participations to cost ratio at any date is calculated as the total debt commitments on the Phase II Financing Facility as of that date as a percentage of the sum of actual constructions costs plus project expenses paid as of that date on the Phase II storage tanks.

 

The Phase II Financing Facility includes an initial condition precedent that requires evidence of initial equity contribution by the Company towards the Phase II storage tanks before the loan facility can be utilized. The Company has not made any drawings on the Phase II Financing Facility as of the date of issuance of these financial statements.

 

TREND INFORMATION

 

Stable Revenue & Margins

 

The Company began operation of the Phase I facility in December 2017 at reduced capacity while management undertook tests of the facility. As a result, the Phase I facility did not begin operating at full capacity, or performing ancillary services until April 2018. Since the Phase I facility became fully operational, BPGIC’s revenue, and revenue split between storage fees and ancillary services fees, have been relatively stable. This stability is largely attributable to the fixed storage fees, and relatively stable usage history we have experienced from our Initial Phase I End User. As a result, since commencing full operations from April 2018 through December 2019, the company has operated at fairly stable margins, averaging around 50.0% net margin in absence of onetime Non-cash listing expenses.

 

Management expects the Company’s operating margins to remain stable until the commencement of operations by the proposed BIA Refinery and the Phase II facility. In both cases, management anticipates margins will increase over a short period and then remain stable again at the higher levels.

 

Diversify Operations and Reduce Customer Concentration

 

In March 2019, BPGIC partnered with Sahara to develop and operate a modular refinery within the BPGIC Terminal with minimal capital expenditure by BPGIC. Under the terms of the parties agreement, Sahara would finance and arrange the development, construction and commissioning of a modular refinery capable of supplying IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur content shipping fuel with initial production capacity of 24,000 b/d.

 

88

 

 

In February 2020, BPGIC and Sahara mutually agreed to discontinue their joint development project to install a modular oil refinery at BPGIC’s terminal. Shortly thereafter, BPGIC entered into the Refinery Agreement, a new agreement with BIA which provides that the parties will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for the BIA Refinery, a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd operated by BPGIC. The parties further agreed to negotiate, within 30 days, the Refinery Operations Agreement, a sublease agreement and a joint venture agreement to govern the terms on which (i) BPGIC will sublease land to BIA to locate, (ii) BIA will construct, and (iii) BPGIC will operate the refinery. The parties subsequently agreed to extend the deadline for their negotiation of the Refinery Operations Agreement to August 4, 2020. Once operational, the BIA Refinery will diversify operations.

 

In May 2020, BIA agreed to release 129,000 m3 of the Phase I capacity, amounting to approximately one third of the total Phase I capacity, back to BPGIC. Pursuant to the Super Major Agreement, BPGIC leased this capacity to the Super Major. The Super Major is required to pay a monthly fixed storage fee to lease its storage capacity at Phase I. The Super Major paid the storage fee for the initial six month term of the Super Major Agreement up front. The Super Major Agreement is renewable for an additional six months with the mutual agreement of the parties. The Super Major Agreement has reduced some of the Company’s customer concentration risk and the Company will look to further diversify its customer base going forward

 

Completion of Phase II

 

The Company expects the construction of Phase II to be completed in 2020. The Company plans to focus Phase II’s operations primarily on the storage and blending of crude oil and thereby capitalize on the demand for crude oil storage. The Company expects to generate additional revenues and expenses in connection with Phase II’s operations. Similar to the commencement of operations for Phase I, the Company may initially commence operations of Phase II in accordance with certain required safety measures and ramp up utilization of its storage capacity and ancillary services over time to mitigate any potential operational risks. This would impact the amount of storage and ancillary service fees the Company would earn during the first quarter of operations under the Phase II Customer Agreement.

 

Contractual Obligations

 

As of December 31, 2019   Total     <1 year     1-3 years     3-5 years     >5 years  
Contractual Obligations     -       -       -       -       -  
Term Loans     89,257,873       14,542,038       18,432,856       15,732,897       40,550,082  
Lease Payments     225,749,200       2,359,590       4,861,699       5,058,111       213,469,800  
Total     312,741,809       14,636,364       23,294,555       20,791,008       254,019,882  

 

Off Balance Sheet Commitments and Arrangements

 

The Company does not have any off balance sheet commitments and arrangements.

 

Inflation

 

Inflation in the UAE has not materially affected our results of operations in recent years. Although we have not been affected by inflation in the past, we may be affected if any of the countries in which we do business now, or in the future, experience high rates of inflation.

 

Environmental, Health and Safety

 

Our operations are subject to extensive international, federal, state and local environmental laws and regulations, in the UAE, including those relating to the discharge of materials into the environment, waste management, remediation, the characteristics and composition of fuels, climate change and greenhouse gases. Our operations are also subject to extensive health, safety and security laws and regulations, including those relating to worker and pipeline safety, pipeline and storage tank integrity and operations security. Because more stringent environmental and safety laws and regulations are continuously being enacted or proposed, the level of expenditures required for environmental, health and safety matters is expected to increase in the future.

 

The Company does not have any exposure to environmental matters as of and for the years ended December 31, 2019 and December 31, 2018

 

89

 

 

Contingencies

 

We are not subject to any loss contingencies as we do not have any claims or any ongoing disputes or legal suits with any of the parties. Hence we believe that there would not be any material adverse effect on our results of operations, financial position or liquidity of the company as on any of the period ends in discussion nor in future.

 

RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

 

Upon consummation of the Business Combination, the board of directors adopted a code of ethics and business conduct that requires it, and its directors, officers and employees to avoid conflicts of interest, such as related party transactions, unless specifically authorized. The board of directors also adopted a related party transaction policy to govern the procedures for evaluation and authorization of related party transactions. Related party transactions, which require approval of the audit committee, are defined as any transaction, arrangement or relationship, or any series of similar transactions, arrangements or relationships, in which (i) the Group is or will be a participant, (ii) the aggregate amount involved will or may be expected to exceed $120,000 in any fiscal year, and (iii) any related party has or will have a direct or indirect interest. This also includes any material amendment or modification to an existing related party transaction.

The audit committee is responsible for reviewing and approving related party transactions to the extent the Company contemplates engaging in such a transaction. The audit committee will review all of the relevant facts and circumstances of all related party transactions that require its approval and either approve or disapprove of the entry into the related party transaction. The audit committee will approve the related party transaction only if it determines in good faith that, under all of the circumstances, the transaction is in the best interests of the Company and its shareholders. The audit committee, in its sole discretion, will impose such conditions as it deems appropriate on the Company or the related party in connection with the approval of the related party transaction. No director will be permitted to participate in the discussions or approval of a transaction in which he or she is a related party, but that director will be required to provide all material information concerning the related party transaction to the audit committee.

 

Transactions with related parties

 

Movements in shareholders’ account are as follows

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Contributions by the shareholders     77,090,648       951,539  
                 
Amounts paid on behalf of the Group by the shareholders*     1,135,484       7,850,431  
                 
Amounts paid by the Group on behalf of the shareholders     (1,647,064 )     (2,296,354 )
                 
Distributions to shareholders     (53,279,016 )     (29,209,289 )
                 
      23,300,052       (22,703,673 )

 

These amounts are repayable at the discretion of the Board of Directors of the Group and are interest free, therefore classified as part of equity.

 

* These include expenses paid on behalf of the Group which includes other operational expenses paid by the shareholders on behalf of the Group.

 

90

 

 

Changes in shareholders’ account is as follows:

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
At 1 January     47,717,763       70,421,436  
Net  contributions (distributions) during the year     23,300,052       (22,703,673 )
                 
At 31 December     71,017,815       47,717,763  

 

Movements in Other related parties are as follows:

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Expenses paid on behalf of related parties (note 10)     57,550       -  

 

Due from related parties:

 

 HBS Investments LP (shareholder)     13,388       -  
  H Capital International LP (shareholder)     11,056       -  
  O2 Investments Limited as GP (shareholder)     6,181       -  
  SBD International LP (shareholder)     13,760       -  
  SD Holding Limited as GP (shareholder)     6,984       -  
  Gyan Investments Ltd (shareholder)     6,181       -  
                 
      57,550       -  

 

Key management remuneration for the year ended 31 December 2019 amounted to USD 1,160,293 (2018: USD 677,291), charged to consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss). The full amount of the key management remuneration relates to short term employment benefits.

 

See the section titled “Item 7. Major Shareholders and Related Party Transactions ¾ Certain Relationships And Related Party Transactions — BPGIC Related Person Transactions and Policies” for information concerning other related party transactions in which BPGIC has participated.

 

91

 

 

OTHER RISK DISCLOSURES

 

A. Market Risk Disclosures

 

The main risks arising from the Company’s financial instruments are capital risk, interest rate risk, credit risk, currency risk and liquidity risk. The Senior Management team reviews and agrees policies for managing each of these risks which are summarized below.

 

B. Capital Risk

 

The Company’s objective when managing capital is to safeguard its ability to continue as a going concern in order to provide returns for holders of Ordinary Shares and benefits for other stakeholders and to maintain an optimal capital structure to reduce the cost of capital.

 

The Company’s capital structure consists of shareholders’ equity and debt, which as disclosed in the audited financial information for the period ended December 31, 2019 includes the borrowings under the Financing Facilities while excluding derivative financial liabilities.

 

Consistent with others in the industry, the Company monitors its debt levels including covenants contained within the Financing Facilities.

 

C. Interest Rate Risk

 

Interest rate risk is the risk that the fair value or future cash flows of a financial instrument will fluctuate because of changes in market interest rates.

 

The Group’s exposure to the risk of changes in market interest rates relates primarily to the Group’s balances with banks and interest bearing loans and borrowings at variable rates.

 

The following table demonstrates the sensitivity to a reasonably possible change in interest rates, with other variables held constant, of the Group’s profit for one year corresponding to the impact of the floating rate borrowings for one year. The effect of the interest rate swap has been excluded from the sensitivity as the Group does not apply hedge accounting.

 

    Effect on
profit
USD
 
2019      
       
+40 increase in basis points     347,971  
         
-40 decrease in basis points     (347,971 )
         
2018        
         
+40 increase in basis points     (381,713 )
         
-40 decrease in basis points     381,713  

 

92

 

 

D. Credit Risk

 

Credit risk is the risk that one party to a financial instrument will fail to discharge an obligation and cause the other party to incur a financial loss. The Group is exposed to credit risk on bank balances and receivables as reflected in the consolidated statement of financial position, with a maximum exposure equal to the carrying amount of these instruments. The expected credit loss on trade and other receivables are considered insignificant for 2019 and 2018.

 

The Group has a low credit risk exposure on its trade receivables based on established policy, procedures and controls relating to customer credit risk management. Credit quality of the customer is assessed as part of contract negotiations. Outstanding receivables are regularly monitored. The Group has only one customer as at 31 December 2019 (31 December 2018: one customer).

 

E. Currency Risk

 

The Company does not have any significant exposure to currency risk as most of its contracts, cash activities and financing arrangements are denominated in $ or AED, which is the currency of the UAE and pegged to the $.

 

F. Liquidity Risk

 

The Group monitors its risk to a shortage of funds using a recurring liquidity planning tool. This tool considers projected financing requirements of the Group during the construction phase and cash projections from operations with outstanding bank facilities and outstanding bank commitments as defined under the finance documents.

 

The Group manages its liquidity risk in relation to term loans to ensure compliance with all covenants for each specific facility. Refer note 2.2 for further details.

 

93

 

 

The table below summarizes the maturity profile of the Group’s financial liabilities at 31 December 2019 and 31 December 2018 based on contractual undiscounted payments.

 

    On     Less than     3 months     1 to 5              
    demand     3 months     to 1 year     years     > 5 years     Total  
    USD     USD     USD     USD     USD     USD  
                                     
31 December 2019                                    
                                     
Term loans (including accrued interest)     -       8,101,006       9,178,414       34,165,752       40,550,347       91,995,519  
                                                 
Lease liability     -       2,359,590       -       9,919,810       213,469,799       225,749,199  
                                                 
Derivative financial instruments     -       -       1,518,249       -       -       1,518,249  
                                               
Accounts payable, accruals and other payables (excluding accrued interest)     -       26,350,143       31,469,596       -       -       57,819,739  
                                                 
Total     -       36,810,739       42,166,259       44,085,562       254,020,146       377,082,706  
                                                 
31 December 2018                                                
                                                 
Bank overdraft     3,745,048       -       -       -       -       3,745,048  
                                                 
Term loans (including accrued interest)     95,702,779       -       -       -       -       95,702,779  
                                                 
Lease liability     -       2,313,323       -       9,725,304       216,023,896       228,062,523  
                                                 
Derivative financial instruments     -       -       1,190,073       -       -       1,190,073  
                                                 
Accounts payable, accruals and other payables (excluding accrued interest)     -       2,120,877       5,972,230       -       -       8,093,107  
                                                 
Total     99,447,827       4,434,200       7,162,303       9,725,304       216,023,896       336,793,530  

 

Refer to section on Going Concern for further details on Company’s loan arrangements

 

94

 

 

G. Operations Risk

 

The Company’s operations and assets are insured under an insurance program administered by Lockton Insurance Brokers - Dubai, an insurance broker. The program covers the Phase I facilities and related assets, and the liabilities of the Phase I operations and the Company. The major elements of this program are property damage, business interruption, terrorism and political violence, worker’s compensation, environmental liability, employer liability, directors’ and officers’ liability insurance, personal injury and third-party liability, including that of terminal operators. The Company additionally maintains local insurance, including healthcare and other insurance required by the Company’s jurisdiction.

 

Premiums are allocated based on the insured values, history of claims and type of risk. Management believes that the amount of coverage provided is comprehensive and appropriate for the Company’s type of business and meets the standard requirements to comply with all statutory requirements.

 

Critical Accounting Policies

 

Management’s discussion and analysis of our results of operations and liquidity and capital resources are based on our audited financial information. Our audited financial statements have been prepared in accordance with IFRS. We describe our significant accounting policies in Note 2 - Significant Accounting Policies, of the Notes to Financial Statements included in this report. Of particular significance are the following policies:

 

Business combinations

 

A ‘reverse acquisition’ is a business combination in which the legal acquirer - i.e. the entity that issues the securities (i.e. listed entity) becomes the acquiree for accounting purposes and the legal acquiree becomes the acquirer for accounting purposes. It is the application in accordance with IFRS 3 Business Combinations on identifying the acquirer, which results in the identification of the legal acquiree as the accounting acquirer in a reverse acquisition. Application in accordance with IFRS 3 Business Combinations on identifying the acquirer may result in identifying the listed entity as the accounting acquiree and the unlisted entity as the accounting acquirer.

 

95

 

 

In this case, if the listed entity is:

 

A business, IFRS 3 Business Combinations applies;

 

Not a business, IFRS 2 Share-based Payment applies to the transaction once the acquirer has been identified following the principles in accordance with IFRS 3 Business Combinations.

 

As the reverse acquisition of the Company did not constitute a business combination, the transaction was accounted for as an asset acquisition by the issuance of shares of the Company, for the net assets of the Company and its public listing. Accordingly, the transaction had been accounted for at the fair value of the equity instruments granted to the shareholders and warrant holders of the Company.

 

Management applied the following primary judgments in accounting for the reverse acquisition:

 

1. BPGIC was assessed as the accounting acquirer due to majority shareholding and representatives on the board of directors.

 

2. The accounting acquiree is not a business and not in scope of IFRS 3.

 

3. The acquisition has been accounted for in terms of IFRS 2 which is aligned to guidance issued by the IFRIC. The difference between the fair value of the consideration paid and the fair value of the net assets acquired. has been recognised in profit and loss. Refer to note 2.5 (iii) of Financial Statements.

 

4. Fair value of ordinary shares issued: Refer to note 25 of Financial Statements.

 

5. The fair value of the shares in escrow is not materially different from that of the shares which are not in escrow as the rights of these shares are similar to those of “normal ordinary shares”. Fair value of the shares in escrow: Refer to note 25 of Financial Statements.

 

6. Fair value of warrants issued: Refer to note 13 of Financial Statements.

 

7. Deemed share issue has been presented in the financing activities in the Statement of Cash Flows.

 

Revenue recognition

 

The Company generates revenue by charging fees for the storage, throughput and handling of fuel oil and clean products for its sole customer. Additional revenue is generated by charging fees for other ancillary services (excess throughput, heating, blending and other services).

 

The contract contains a lease and a service component. The lease component is accounted for under IFRS 16 and the service component is accounted for under IFRS 15. The contract has a minimum fixed monthly payment for both the lease and non-lease service components. The fixed consideration is allocated to the lease and service components based on their relative stand-alone selling price, which is based on an analysis of lease-related and service-related costs for the contract, adjusted for representative profit margins. The lease component is recognized on a straight-line basis over the term of the initial lease and the service component is recognized over time as the customer simultaneously receives and consumes the benefits provided by the Company’s performance. The contract also contains variable elements in the form of the other ancillary services. Revenue from the variable element of the contract is recognized based on the actual volumes transported, stored and processed in the period in which the services are provided. These services are generally billed the month after the services are performed.

 

96

 

 

Borrowing costs

 

Borrowing costs directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of qualifying assets, which are assets that necessarily take a substantial period of time to get ready for their intended use or sale, are added to the cost of those assets, until such time as the assets are substantially ready for their intended use or sale.

 

Investment income earned on the temporary investment of specific borrowings pending their expenditure on qualifying assets is deducted from the borrowing costs eligible for capitalization.

 

All other borrowing costs are recognized in the statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss) in the period during which they are incurred.

 

Property, plant and equipment

 

Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and accumulated impairment losses, if any. Capital work under progress is stated at cost and subsequently transferred to assets when it is available for use. Cost of an item of property plant and equipment comprises its acquisition cost including borrowing cost and all directly attributable costs of bringing the asset to working condition for its intended use. Such cost includes the cost of replacing part of the plant and equipment when that cost is incurred, if the recognition criteria are met. Likewise, when a major inspection is performed, its cost is recognized in the carrying amount of the plant and equipment as a replacement if the recognition criteria are satisfied. All other repair and maintenance costs are recognized in the statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss) as incurred. Depreciation is computed using the straight-line method based on the estimated useful lives of assets as follows:

 

Buildings   25 years
Tanks   50 years
Installation (Pipeline, pumps and other equipment)   20 – 25 years
Other equipment   5 years
Right-of-use asset – Land   60 years

 

The assets’ residual values and useful lives are reviewed and adjusted if appropriate, at each financial year end to determine whether there is an indication of impairment. If any such indication exists, an impairment loss is recognized in the statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss). For the purpose of assessing impairment, assets are grouped at the lowest levels for which there are separately identifiable cash flows (cash generating units).

 

The carrying amounts are reviewed at each reporting date to assess whether they are recorded in excess of their recoverable amounts, and where carrying values exceed this estimated recoverable amount, assets are written down to their recoverable amount, being the higher of their fair value less costs to sell and their value in use.

 

An item of property, plant and equipment is derecognized upon disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected from its use or disposal. Any gain or loss arising on derecognition of the asset (calculated as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset) is included in the statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss) in the year the asset is derecognized.

 

97

 

 

Leasing

 

At inception of a contract, the Company assesses whether the contract is, or contains, a lease. A contract is, or contains, a lease if the contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of time in exchange for consideration.

 

For a contract that is, or contains, a lease, the Company accounts for each lease component within the contract as a lease separately from non-lease components of the contract.

 

The Company determines the lease term as the non-cancellable period of a lease, together with both:

 

a) periods covered by an option to extend the lease if the lessee is reasonably certain to exercise that option; and

 

b) periods covered by an option to terminate the lease if the lessee is reasonably certain not to exercise that option.

 

In assessing whether a lessee is reasonably certain to exercise an option to extend a lease, or not to exercise an option to terminate a lease, the Company considers all relevant facts and circumstances that create an economic incentive for the lessee to exercise the option to extend the lease, or not to exercise the option to terminate the lease. The Company revises the lease term if there is a change in the non-cancellable period of a lease.

 

Company as a lessor

 

Leases where the Company does not transfer substantially all the risks and benefits of ownership of the asset are classified as operating leases. Initial direct costs incurred in negotiating an operating lease are added to the carrying amount of the leased asset and recognized over the lease term on the same bases as rental income. Contingent rents are recognized as revenue in the period in which they are earned.

 

Company as a lessee

 

For a contract that contains a lease component and one or more additional lease or non-lease components, the Company allocates the consideration in the contract to each lease component on the basis of the relative stand-alone price of the lease component and the aggregate stand-alone price of the non-lease components.

 

The relative stand-alone price of lease and non-lease components is determined on the basis of the price the lessor, or a similar supplier, would charge an entity for that component, or a similar component, separately. If an observable stand-alone price is not readily available, the Company estimates the stand-alone price, maximising the use of observable information.

 

For determination of the lease term, the Company reassesses whether it is reasonably certain to exercise an extension option, or not to exercise a termination option, upon the occurrence of either a significant event or a significant change in circumstances that:

 

a) is within the control of the Company; and

 

b) affects whether the Company is reasonably certain to exercise an option not previously included in its determination of the lease term, or not to exercise an option previously included in its determination of the lease term.

 

At the commencement date, the Company recognises a right-of-use asset classified within property, plant and equipment and a lease liability classified separately on the statement of financial position.

 

98

 

 

Short-term leases and leases of low-value assets

 

The Company has elected not to recognise right-of-use assets and lease liabilities for short-term leases that have a lease of 12 months or less and leases of low-value assets of $5,000 or less when new. The Company recognises the lease payments associated with these leases as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

 

Right-of-use assets

 

The right-of-use asset is initially recognized at cost comprising of:

 

a) the amount of the initial measurement of the lease liability;

 

b) any lease payments made at or before the commencement date, less any lease incentives received;

 

c) any initial direct costs incurred by the Company; and

 

d) an estimate of costs to be incurred by the Company in dismantling and removing the underlying asset, restoring the site on which it is located or restoring the underlying asset to the condition required by the terms and conditions of the lease. These costs are recognized as part of the cost of the right-of-use asset when the Company incurs an obligation for these costs. The obligation for these costs is incurred either at the commencement date or as a consequence of having used the underlying asset during a particular period.

 

After initial recognition, the Company amortises the right-of-use asset over the term of the lease. In addition the right of use asset is periodically reduced by impairment losses, if any, and adjusted for certain re-measurements of the lease liability.

 

Lease liability

 

The lease liability is initially recognized at the present value of the lease payments that are not paid at the commencement date. The lease payments are discounted using the interest rate implicit in the lease, if that rate can be readily determined. If that rate cannot be readily determined, the Company uses its incremental borrowing rate.

 

99

 

 

After initial recognition, the lease liability is measured by (a) increasing the carrying amount to reflect interest on the lease liability; (b) reducing the carrying amount to reflect the lease payments made; and (c) remeasuring the carrying amount to reflect any reassessment or lease modifications or to reflect revised in-substance fixed lease payments.

 

Where, (a) there is a change in the lease term as a result of the reassessment of certainty to exercise an option, or not to exercise a termination option as discussed above; or (b) there is a change in the assessment of an option to purchase the underlying asset, assessed considering the events and circumstances in the context of a purchase option, the Company remeasures the lease liabilities to reflect changes to lease payments by discounting the revised lease payments using a revised discount rate. The Company determines the revised discount rate as the interest rate implicit in the lease for the remainder of the lease term, if that rate can be readily determined, or its incremental borrowing rate at the date of reassessment, if the interest rate implicit in the lease cannot be readily determined.

 

Where, (a) there is a change in the amounts expected to be payable under a residual value guarantee; or (b) there is a change in future lease payments resulting from a change in an index or a rate used to determine those payments, including a change to reflect changes in market rental rates following a market rent review, the Company remeasures the lease liabilities by discounting the revised lease payments using an unchanged discount rate, unless the change in lease payments results from a change in floating interest rates. In such case, the Company uses a revised discount rate that reflects changes in the interest rate.

 

The Company recognises the amount of the re-measurement of the lease liability as an adjustment to the right-of-use asset. Where the carrying amount of the right-of-use asset is reduced to zero and there is a further reduction in the measurement of the lease liability, the Company recognises any remaining amount of the re-measurement in the statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss).

 

100

 

 

The Company accounts for a lease modification as a separate lease if both:

 

a) the modification increases the scope of the lease by adding the right to use one or more underlying assets; and

 

b) the consideration for the lease increases by an amount commensurate with the stand-alone price for the increase in scope and any appropriate adjustments to that stand-alone price to reflect the circumstances of the particular contract.

 

Critical Accounting Estimates

 

Certain of our accounting policies require that management apply significant judgments in defining the appropriate assumptions integral to financial estimates. On an ongoing basis, management reviews the accounting policies, assumptions, estimates and judgments to ensure that our financial statements are presented fairly and in accordance with IFRS. Judgments are based on historical experience, terms of existing contracts, industry trends and information available from outside sources, as appropriate. However, by their nature, judgments are subject to an inherent degree of uncertainty, and, therefore, actual results could differ from our estimates. We describe our significant accounting policies in Note 2.5 — significant accounting estimates and judgements, of the Notes to Brooge Energy Limited’s Financial Statements as of December 31, 2017, 2018 and 2019 included in this report. Of particular significance are the following estimates:

 

Useful lives of property, plant and equipment

 

The Company’s management determines the estimated useful lives of its property, plant and equipment for calculating depreciation. This estimate is determined after considering the expected usage of the asset or physical wear and tear and the impact of expected residual value. Management reviews the useful lives annually and the future depreciation charge would be adjusted where management believes that the useful lives differ from previous estimates. The depreciation period of the right-of-use asset has been determined to be over the lease term on the basis that the land is expected to be used for the whole period of the lease considering the existing assets and future expansion on the land.

 

Discount rate used for initial measurement of lease liability

 

The Company, as a lessee, measures the lease liability at the present value of the unpaid lease payments at the commencement date. The lease payments are discounted using the interest rate implicit in the lease, if that rate can be readily determined. If that rate cannot be readily determined, the Company on initial recognition of the lease uses its incremental borrowing rate. Incremental borrowing rate is the rate of interest that the Company would have to pay to borrow over a similar term, and with a similar security, the funds necessary to obtain an asset of a similar value to the right-of-use assets in similar economic environment. The Company determined its incremental borrowing rate at 9.5% in respect of the lease liability.

 

101

 

 

Decommissioning liabilities

 

As part of the land lease agreement between FOIZ and the Company, the Company has a legal obligation to remove the facilities at the end of its lease term. The Company initially records a provision for asset retirement obligations at the best estimate of the present value of the expenditure required to settle the obligation at the time a legal (or constructive) obligation is incurred, if the liability can be reliably estimated. When the provision is initially recorded, the carrying amount of the related asset is increased by the amount of the liability. Provisions are adjusted at each balance sheet date to reflect the current best estimate. The unwinding of the discount is recognized as finance cost. The Company’s operating assets generally consist of storage tanks and related facilities. These assets can be used for an extended period of time as long as they are properly maintained and/or upgraded. It is the Company’s current intent to maintain its assets and continue making improvements to those assets based on technological advances. There is no data or information that can be derived from past practice, industry practice or the Company’s intentions that could be used to make a reliable estimate of the decommissioning cost. Accordingly, the Company has not recorded a liability or corresponding asset as the amounts of such potential future costs are not reliably determinable.

 

ITEM 6. DIRECTORS, SENIOR MANAGEMENT AND EMPLOYEES

 

A. Directors and Executive Officers

 

The board of directors of the Company is comprised of six directors.

 

The Company’s Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association provide that persons standing for election as directors at a duly constituted general meeting with requisite quorum shall be elected by an Ordinary Resolution as a matter of Cayman Islands law.

 

The following sets forth certain information concerning the persons who serve as the Company’s directors and the Company’s, BPGIC’s and BPGIC International’s executive officers as of June 26, 2020

 

Directors and Executive Officers   Age   Position/Title
Dr. Yousef Alassaf   59   Chairman
Abu Bakar Chowdhury   53   Director
Nicolaas Paardenkooper   57   Chief Executive Officer and Director
Saleh Yammout   31   Director
Sa’eb El-Zein   61   Director
Dr. Simon Madgwick   52   Director
Lina S. Saheb   36   Chief Strategy Officer
Faisal Selim   45   Chief Marketing Officer
Syed Masood   44   Chief Financial Officer

 

Biographical information concerning the directors and executive officers listed above is set forth below.

 

102

 

 

Dr. Yousef Alassaf

 

Dr. Yousef Alassaf is the Chairman of the board of directors. Dr. Alassaf joined the parent company of BPGIC in October 2018. Dr. Alassaf is also the President of the Rochester Institute of Technology (Dubai). Prior to this, Dr. Alassaf held a range of other academic positions over the last 30 years, most recently as the Dean of the College of Engineering at the American University of Sharjah (from 2006 to 2013), which he joined as an Associate Professor in 1991. Dr. Alassaf started his academic career as a Research and Teaching Assistant at Oxford University from 1985 to 1987. Dr. Alassaf holds a BSc from Sussex University in Electrical Engineering, a PhD from Oxford University and completed the Executive Leadership Certificate Program from Cornell University in 2008.

 

Abu Bakar Chowdhury

 

Mr. Chowdhury is the Managing Director and Chief Financial Officer at ASMA Capital Partners B.S.C.(c) (“ASMA Capital”). He is a member of the Management Committee and is responsible for the finance function at ASMA Capital. He is also a member of the Board of Directors of a number of investee companies of the fund. Previously, Mr. Chowdhury was a Managing Partner at EMP Bahrain and was responsible for managing IDBIF I. Prior to EMP Bahrain, Mr. Chowdhury was with Credit Suisse and Deutsche Bank where he was responsible for managing and structuring Infrastructure and Asset-Backed Investments.

 

Nicolaas Paardenkooper

 

Nicolaas Paardenkooper is the Chief Executive Officer of BPGIC and holds the same position with the Company. Mr. Paardenkooper is also the Chief Executive Officer of BPGIC Holdings. Mr. Paardenkooper joined BPGIC in May 2017. Mr. Paardenkooper has over 30 years of experience in the oil and gas mid and downstream sector. Prior to joining the Company he was Terminal Manager at Oiltanking Odfjell Terminal, Oman beginning in October 2014. Prior to that, Mr. Paardenkooper worked in various positions at Emirates National Oil Company from 2010 to 2014 (including as Manager Terminal UAE and Operations Manager) and worked for 21 years at Royal Vopak N.V. (“Vopak” is a leading independent tank storage company headquartered in Rotterdam, the Netherlands, and listed on the Euronext Amsterdam stock exchange) in various roles. During his time at Vopak, Mr. Paardenkooper was part of the team that developed, implemented and supported a global terminal operations system. Mr. Paardenkooper has a nautical and maritime educational background. His nautical education began at the Hogere Zeevaartschool in Rotterdam and was continued at Koninklijke Onderwijs Fonds in the Netherlands. After completing his nautical education, he started his career working on board of several types of vessels, mainly tankers, and held various positions, including officer roles before joining a predecessor of Vopak, Van Ommeren Tank Terminals in 1989. In connection with his role at Van Ommeren Tank Terminals, Mr. Paardenkooper completed a 3-year terminal education program to become a fully-qualified terminal operating engineer. That program included all aspects of a terminal such as operations, maintenance, health, safety, environment, fire-fighting, first aid, and ship & shore interface activities. Thereafter, Mr. Paardenkooper underwent training for industrial fire-fighters and a program for certification as a Process Operator (Vapro B). Mr. Paardenkooper has also completed a situational leadership program, a three-part change management program, a technical project management course related to, amongst other things, terminal expansion and refurbishment projects, a budget and finance training, a jet fuel operations program, and several training programs in customer handling. Mr. Paardenkooper’s extensive education and training prepared him to become a fully-qualified general manager or terminal manager of a terminal.

 

103

 

 

Saleh Yammout

 

Saleh Yammout is the former Chief Financial Officer of BPGIC and the Company. Mr. Yammout joined BPGIC in October 2018. Mr. Yammout served as the Vice President (Finance & Administration) at the Rochester Institute of Technology (Dubai), having joined in 2014. Prior to this, he was a Senior Consultant at PwC from 2012 to 2014, and an Analyst at Al Hilal Bank from 2011 to 2012. Mr. Yammout holds a BSc in Economics with a concentration on International Relations from the Rochester Institute of Technology in New York.

 

Saeb El-Zein

 

Saeb El-Zein is an independent director of the Company and chairman of the audit committee. Mr. El-Zein joined the parent company of BPGIC in October 2018. He is also currently an independent investor in the emerging markets and an advisor and Board Member of Spinnaker Global Emerging Markets Fund. From 2008 to 2019 he was the Managing Partner for Spinnaker Capital (Middle East). From 1994 to 2008, he worked at Credit Suisse (London 1994-2007 and Dubai 2007-2008), becoming a Managing Director in the Investment Banking and Capital Markets divisions. Prior to this, he was a Director at Deutsche Bank AG (London) in the capital Markets Division from 1988 to 1994 and worked as a portfolio manager at Arab International Finance (London) from 1982 to 1988. Mr. El-Zein started his career as an Analyst at the Central Bank of Lebanon. Mr. El-Zein holds a BBA and an MBA from the American University of Beirut. Saeb has served on the board of a number of companies including Credit Suisse (Lebanon), BLOM Bank, Blominvest and Spinnaker Capital (Middle East). He also served as a member of various board committees including risk, strategy, audit and remuneration.

 

Dr. Simon Madgwick

 

Dr. Simon Madgwick is an independent director of the Company and a member of the audit and compensation committees. Dr. Madgwick joined the parent company of BPGIC in October 2018. Dr. Madgwick is also a partner of Portinate Consulting since 2017 and managing director of Protank Ltd since 2014. Prior to joining the Company, Dr. Madgwick was the Group Director of Strategy at LBC Tank Terminals Group until 2014, before which he was the Director of Asset Management at the Challenger Infrastructure Fund, a Principal in the London-based private equity team of Nikko Principal Investments Ltd and a Senior Manager at Celerant Consulting. Dr. Madgwick started his career at Pall Europe as an Engineer and Manager between 1990 and 1998. Dr. Madgwick holds a Bachelor of Engineering in Manufacturing Systems Engineering from the University of Portsmouth and a PhD in Change Management from Cranfield University. He also holds a qualification in corporate finance regulation from the Securities and Investment Institute.

 

Lina Saheb

 

Lina Saheb is the Chief Strategy Officer for BPGIC holds the same position with the Company. Ms. Saheb joined BPGIC in 2013. Prior to joining BPGIC, Ms. Saheb worked with the initial shareholders of BPGIC on many different ventures including the establishment of BPGIC in Fujairah in 2010. Ms. Saheb has a Bachelor’s degree in Software Engineering from Mansour University, and finished a course in Banking and Finance from Emirates College of Technology.

 

Faisal Selim

 

Faisal Selim is the Chief Marketing Officer for BPGIC and the Company. Mr. Selim joined BPGIC and the Company in December 2019. Mr. Selim holds a Bachelor of Commerce from Al Shams University and is a Certified Public Accountant. From 2011 to 2019 he served as a CFO Consultant for Mega Group LLC. Prior to this, he worked for Al Brooge Securities as a Finance Manager from 2006 to 2010 and as a Documentation Control Manager-Credit Administration for Abu Dhabi Commercial Bank from 2004 to 2006. Mr. Selim served as a Credit Policy Supervisor at First Gulf Bank from 2000 to 2004 and at Oriflame from 1999 to 2000.

 

Syed Masood

 

Syed Masood is the Chief Financial Officer for BPGIC and the Company. Mr. Syed joined BPGIC in April 2020. Prior to joining BPGIC and the Company, Mr. Syed worked with various local & regional banks and has extensive experience in Corporate & Institutional Banking. He has experience in leading and managing independent Treasury & Banking functions in the Middle East, Africa and Europe. Mr. Syed holds an MBA degree with a major in MIS from Newport University.

 

104

 

 

Family Relationships

 

There are no family relationships between any of the executive officers and directors.

 

Independence of Directors

 

The Company adheres to the rules of NASDAQ in determining whether a director is independent. The board of directors of the Company has consulted, and will consult, with its counsel to ensure that the board’s determinations are consistent with those rules and all relevant securities and other laws and regulations regarding the independence of directors. The Nasdaq listing standards define an “independent director” as a person, other than an executive officer of a company or any other individual having a relationship which, in the opinion of the issuer’s board of directors, would interfere with the exercise of independent judgment in carrying out the responsibilities of a director.

 

B. Compensation

 

BPGIC Executive Officer and Director Compensation

 

In the year ended December 31, 2019, $803,610 was paid as remuneration to the Senior Managers in their capacity as executive officers.

 

Name   Fees/basic
salary
($)
    Bonus
($)
    Benefits
($)
    Total
($)
 
Executive Officers                        
Nicolaas Paardenkooper     261,367       78,410       10,346       350,123  
Lina S. Saheb     217,806       ¾       57,011       274,816  
Saleh Yammout     123,877       ¾       6,354       130,231  
Faisal Selim     45,376       ¾       3,064       48,440  

 

In the year ended December 31, 2019 $302,326 was paid as remuneration to the Board Directors in their capacity as directors.

 

Name   Fees/basic
salary
($)
    Bonus
($)
    Benefits
($)
    Total
($)
 
Board of Directors                        
Dr. Yousef Alassaf     83,800       ¾       ¾       83,800  
Nicolaas Paardenkooper             ¾       ¾          
Saleh Yammout     62,903       ¾       ¾       62,903  
Abu Bakar Chowdhury     17,138       ¾       ¾       17,138  
Saeb El-Zein     70,907       ¾       ¾       70,907  
Dr. Simon Madgwick     67,577       ¾       ¾       67,577  

 

Other than end of service gratuity amounts required to be set aside pursuant to UAE labor laws, at December 31, 2019 no amounts were set aside or accrued by BPGIC to provide pension, retirement or other benefits to the directors or the senior managers.

 

105

 

 

Company Executive Officer and Director Compensation Following the Business Combination

 

The policies of the Company with respect to the compensation of its executive officers are administered by the Company’s board in consultation with its compensation committee. The compensation policies followed by the Company are intended to provide for compensation that is sufficient to attract, motivate and retain executives of the Company and BPGIC as well as potential other individuals and to establish an appropriate relationship between executive compensation and the creation of shareholder value. To meet these goals, the compensation committee is charged with recommending executive compensation packages to the Company’s board of directors.

 

It is anticipated that performance-based and equity-based compensation will be an important foundation in executive compensation packages as the Company believes it is important to maintain a strong link between executive incentives and the creation of shareholder value. The Company believes that performance and equity-based compensation can be an important component of the total executive compensation package for maximizing shareholder value while, at the same time, attracting, motivating and retaining high-quality executives. The Company plans to adopt a long-term incentive plan which will reflect what the Company believes is a focus on performance- and equity-based compensation. As the Company’s compensation committee was not formed until after the completion of the Business Combination, it has not yet adopted any formal guidelines for allocating total compensation between equity compensation and cash compensation for executives hired in the future.

 

The Company intends to be competitive with other similarly situated companies in its industry.

 

The compensation decisions regarding the Company’s executives will be based on the Company’s need to attract individuals with the skills necessary for the Company to achieve its business plan, to reward those individuals fairly over time, and to retain those individuals who continue to perform at or above the Company’s expectations.

 

Since the Company’s compensation committee was not formed until consummation of the Business Combination, the Company has not yet adopted any formal or informal policies or guidelines for allocating compensation between long-term and currently paid out compensation, between cash and non-cash compensation, or among different forms of compensation.

 

In addition to the guidance provided by its compensation committee, the Company has utilized and may continue to utilize the services of third parties from time to time in connection with the hiring and compensation awarded to executive employees. This could include subscriptions to executive compensation surveys and other databases. In particular, to ensure that the Company’s intended compensation is in line with the compensation offered by other similarly situated companies in its industry, the Company hired Tuscan Middle East, who conducted a comprehensive study on compensation levels. The compensation committee, and then the Board, discussed the results of the study in detail.

 

The Company’s compensation committee is charged with performing an annual review of the Company’s executive officers’ cash compensation and equity holdings to determine whether they provide adequate incentives and motivation to executive officers and whether they adequately compensate the executive officers relative to comparable officers in other companies.

 

Compensation Components

 

Base Salary.    The Company intends to preserve the cash compensation of its executive officers, until the recently formed compensation committee has adequate opportunity to assess its executive’s compensation. The Company will seek to maintain base salary amounts at or near the industry norms, while avoiding paying amounts in excess of what it believes is necessary to motivate executives to meet corporate goals. It is anticipated that base salaries will generally be reviewed annually, subject to terms of employment agreements, and that the compensation committee and board will seek to adjust base salary amounts to realign such salaries with industry norms after taking into account individual responsibilities, performance and experience.

 

106

 

 

Annual Bonuses.    The Company intends to utilize cash incentive bonuses for executives to focus them on achieving key operational and financial objectives within a yearly time horizon. Near the beginning of each year, the board, upon the recommendation of the compensation committee and subject to any applicable employment agreements, will determine performance parameters for appropriate executives. At the end of each year, the board and compensation committee will determine the level of achievement for each corporate goal.

 

Equity Awards.    The Company intends to establish an equity incentive plan to incentivize its employees.

 

Severance Benefit.    The Company currently has no severance benefits plan. The Company may consider the adoption of a severance plan for executive officers and other employees in the future.

 

Director Compensation.    The Company has a compensation plan for its directors. The Company, working with the compensation committee, has set director compensation at a level comparable with those directors with similar positions at comparable companies. Each non-executive director receives an annual cash retainer of £45,000. The Chairman of the Board receives an additional £15,000 per year, each director that serves as the chairman of a committee receives an additional £10,000 per year and each other member of a committee receives an additional £5,000 per year per committee.

 

C. Board Practices

 

Board Leadership Structure and Role in Risk Oversight

 

Dr. Yousef Alassaf is the Chairman of the Board and Nicolaas Paardenkooper is the Chief Executive Officer of the Company. The Company has determined that this structure, with separate Chairman and CEO roles, is in the best interests of the Company at this time. A number of factors support this leadership structure, including, among others:

 

The separation of the Chairman and CEO roles allows the CEO to focus his time and energy on operating and managing the Company and BPGIC and leverage the experience and perspectives of the Chairman.

 

The Chairman serves as a liaison between the board and senior management but having an independent chairman also enables non-management directors to raise issues and concerns for board consideration without immediately involving management.

 

The Chairman sets the agenda for, and presides over, board meetings and independent sessions and coordinates the work of the committees of our Board, providing independent oversight and streamlining the CEO’s duties.

 

The Company also believes in the importance of independent oversight. The Company looks to ensure that this oversight is truly independent and effective through a variety of means.

 

Terms of Office

 

Each director’s service on the Board began on December 20, 2019 upon the consummation of the Business Combination. Each director shall serve until he or she resigns or is removed. The Company intends to have its directors stand for reelection each year.

 

107

 

 

Directors’ Service Contracts

 

Each director who is not an employee of the Company or its subsidiaries provides their services pursuant to a Non-Executive Director Appointment Letter. Pursuant to each appointment letter, each non-executive director receives an annual cash retainer of £45,000. The Chairman receives an additional £15,000 per year, each director that serves as the chairman of a committee receives an additional £10,000 per year and each other member of a committee receives an additional £5,000 per year per committee.

 

Meetings and Committees of the Board of Directors

 

The Company has established separately standing audit committee and compensation committee.

 

Audit Committee Information

 

Effective upon consummation of the Business Combination, the Company established an audit committee comprised of independent directors. The audit committee consists of Saeb El-Zein, Dr. Simon Madgwick and Abu Bakar Chowdhury. Each of the members of the audit committee is independent under the applicable Nasdaq listing standards. The audit committee has a written charter. The purpose of the audit committee is, among other things, to appoint, retain, set compensation of, and supervise the Company’s independent accountants, review the results and scope of the audit and other accounting related services and review the Company’s accounting practices and systems of internal accounting and disclosure controls.

 

Financial Experts on Audit Committee

 

The audit committee is, and will at all times be, composed exclusively of “independent directors,” as defined for audit committee members under the Nasdaq listing standards and the rules and regulations of the SEC, who are “financially literate,” as defined under Nasdaq’s listing standards. Nasdaq’s listing standards define “financially literate” as being able to read and understand fundamental financial statements, including a company’s balance sheet, income statement and cash flow statement. In addition, the Company is required to certify to Nasdaq that the committee has, and will continue to have, at least one member who has past employment experience in finance or accounting, requisite professional certification in accounting, or other comparable experience or background that results in the individual’s financial sophistication.

 

Mr. Abu Bakar Chowdhury serves as a financial expert on the audit committee.

 

Compensation Committee Information

 

Effective upon consummation of the Business Combination, the board of directors of the Company established a compensation committee. The compensation committee consists of Dr. Yousef Alassaf, Dr. Simon Madgwick and Abu Bakar Chowdhury. The compensation committee has written charter. The purpose of the compensation committee is to review and approve compensation paid to the Company’s officers and directors and to administer the Company’s incentive compensation plans, including authority to make and modify awards under such plans.

 

The compensation committee assists the Board in determining its responsibilities in relation to remuneration, including, amongst other matters, making recommendations to the Board on the Company’s policy on executive compensation, determining the individual remuneration and benefits package of each of the executive directors and recommending and monitoring the remuneration of senior management below board level.

 

The Compensation Committee Charter provides that the compensation committee should consist of at least three members.

 

The membership of the compensation committee includes three independent directors (Dr. Simon Madgwick, Dr. Yousef Alassaf and Abu Bakar Chowdhury). The chairman of the compensation committee is Dr. Simon Madgwick.

 

The compensation committee meets formally three times a year and otherwise as required.

 

108

 

 

D. Employees

 

The following table sets out the number of employees and contractors employed by BPGIC at December 31, 2019, by main location.

 

Location                  
    As at December 31,  
    2017     2018     2019  
Fujairah Employees     6       7       9  
Fujairah Contractors     0       48       47  
Abu Dhabi Employees     3       8       7  
Abu Dhabi Contractors     0       0       0  
Total     9       63       63  

 

E. Share Ownership

 

Ownership of the Company’s shares by its executive officers and directors as of June 8, 2020 is set forth in Item 7.A of this Report.

 

ITEM 7. MAJOR SHAREHOLDERS AND RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS

 

A. Major Shareholders

 

The following table sets forth information regarding the beneficial ownership based on 109,587,854 Ordinary Shares outstanding as of June 8, 2020 based on information obtained from the persons named below, with respect to the beneficial ownership of our shares by:

 

each person known by us to be the beneficial owner of more than 5% of our outstanding shares;

 

each of our officers and directors; and

 

all our officers and directors as a group.

 

109

 

 

Except as indicated by the footnotes below, we believe that the persons named below have shared voting and dispositive power with respect to all shares that they beneficially own. The shares owned by the persons named below do not have voting rights different from the shares owned by other holders. We believe that none of the persons named below own shares of record in the United States of America.

 

Name and Address of Beneficial Owner   Number
of Shares
Beneficially
Owned
    % of
Class(16)
 
Directors and Executive Officers of the Company            
Dr. Yousef Alassaf            
Abu Bakar Chowdhury     8,333,333 (17)     7.6 %
Nicolaas Paardenkooper     94,052,044 (1)     85.8 %
Saleh Yammout            
Sa’eb El-Zein            
Dr. Simon Madgwick            
Lina S. Saheb            
Faisal Selim            
Syed Masood                
All executive officers and directors as a group (8 individuals)     94,052,044       85.8 %
                 
Five Percent Holders                
BPGIC Holdings Limited(2)     94,052,044       85.8 %
Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC(3)     94,052,044       85.8 %
SBD International LP(4)     53,536,634       48.9 %
SD Holding Limited(5)     53,536,634       48.9 %
Salman Dawood Salman Al-Ameri(6)     63,161,001       57.6 %
HBS Investments LP(7)     9,624,367       8.8 %
O2 Investments Limited(8)     9,624,367       8.8 %
H Capital International LP(9)     8,991,043       8.2 %
Gyan Investments Limited(10)     8,991,043       8.2 %
Hind Mohammed Muktar Ahmed(11)     8,991,043       8.2 %
His Highness Sheikh Mohammad bin Khalifa bin Zayed Al Nayhan(12)     21,900,000       20.0 %
MENA Energy Services Holdings Limited(13)     8,333,333       7.6 %
IDB Infrastructure Fund II B.S.C(c)(14)     8,333,333       7.6 %
ASMA Capital B.S.C.(c). (15)     8,333,333       7.6 %

 

(1) Represents the shares held by BPGIC Holdings Limited. Mr. Paardenkooper is the CEO of BPGIC Holdings, consequently, he may be deemed the beneficial owner of 100% of the shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Mr. Paardenkooper disclaims beneficial ownership of any shares other than to the extent he may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

(2) 20,000,000 Ordinary Shares beneficially owned by BPGIC Holdings are held in escrow and subject to forfeiture until the Company satisfies certain milestones. MENA Energy Services Holdings Limited (“MENA Energy”) holds convertible securities in BPGIC Holdings that entitle it to convert its securities in BPGIC Holdings into 8,333,333 of the Ordinary Shares of the Company owned by BPGIC Holdings. Accordingly, BPGIC Holdings has placed 8,333,333 Ordinary Shares into escrow for release to MENA Energy in the event it converts its securities in BPGIC Holdings. 1,500,000 Ordinary Shares beneficially owned by BPGIC Holdings have been placed in escrow as collateral for a guaranty by one of its shareholders, HBS Investments LP.

 

110

 

 

(3) Represents the shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC is the sole shareholder of BPGIC Holdings, consequently, it may be deemed to be the beneficial owner of 100% of the shares held by BPGIC Holdings. MENA Energy holds convertible securities in BPGIC Holdings that entitle it to convert its securities in BPGIC Holdings into 8,333,333 of the Ordinary Shares of the Company owned by BPGIC Holdings. Accordingly, BPGIC Holdings has placed 8,333,333 Ordinary Shares into escrow for release to MENA Energy in the event it converts its securities in BPGIC Holdings. 1,500,000 Ordinary Shares beneficially owned by BPGIC Holdings have been placed in escrow as collateral for a guaranty by one of its shareholders, HBS Investments LP. Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent it may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

(4) SBD International LP holds a controlling interest in Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC which is the sole shareholder of BPGIC Holdings. Its pro rata ownership of the Company’s Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings is 53,536,634 Ordinary Shares. SBD International LP’s pro rata portion of the Ordinary Shares held in escrow and subject to forfeiture until the Company satisfies certain milestones is 58.9%. SBD International LP disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent it may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

(5) Represents the interests of SBD International LP, as a shareholder of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, in the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. SD Holding Limited is the general partner of SBD International LP, consequently, it may be deemed the beneficial owner of 53,536,634 Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings Limited. SD Holding Limited disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent it may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

(6) Represents the interest of SBD International LP and HBS Investments LP, as shareholders of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, in the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Salman Dawood Salman Al-Ameri is the sole shareholder of SD Holding Limited (the general partner of SBD International LP) and the sole shareholder of O2 Investments Limited (the general partner of HBS Investments LP). Consequently, Mr. Al-Ameri may be deemed the beneficial owner of 63,161,001 of the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Mr. Al-Ameri disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent he may have a pecuniary interest therein. 1,500,000 Ordinary Shares that may be deemed to be beneficially owned by Mr. Al-Ameri as the sole shareholder of O2 Investments Limited (the general partner of HBS Investments LP) have been placed in escrow as collateral for a guaranty by HBS Investments LP.

 

(7) Represents the interests of HBS Investments LP, as a shareholder of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, in the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. HBS Investments LP’s pro rata portion of the Ordinary Shares held in escrow is 9.8%. HBS Investments LP disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent it may have a pecuniary interest therein. 1,500,000 Ordinary Shares that may be deemed to be beneficially owned by HBS Investments LP have been placed in escrow as collateral for a guaranty by HBS Investments LP.

 

(8) Represents the interests of HBS Investments LP, as a shareholder of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, in the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. O2 Investments Limited is the general partner of HBS Investments LP, consequently, it may be deemed the beneficial owner of 9,624,367 of the Ordinary shares held by BPGIC Holdings. O2 Investments Limited disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent it may have a pecuniary interest therein. 1,500,000 Ordinary Shares that may be deemed to be beneficially owned by O2 Investments Limited as the general partner of HBS Investments LP have been placed in escrow as collateral for a guaranty by HBS Investments LP.

 

(9) Represents the interests of H Capital International LP, as a shareholder of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, in the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. H Capital International LP’s pro rata portion of the Ordinary Shares held in escrow is 9.1%. H Capital International LP disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent it may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

111

 

 

(10) Represents the interests of H Capital International LP, as a shareholder of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, in the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Gyan Investments Limited is the general partner of H Capital International LP, consequently, it may be deemed the beneficial owner of 8,991,043, of the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Gyan Investments Limited disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent it may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

(11) Represents the interest of H Capital International LP, as a shareholder of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, in the shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Mrs. Hind Mohammed Muktar Ahmed is the sole shareholder of Gyan Holdings Limited, the general partner of H Capital International LP, consequently, she may be deemed the beneficial owner of 8,991,043 of the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Mrs. Hind Mohammed Muktar Ahmed disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent she may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

(12) Represents the interests of Mohammad Bin Khalifa bin Zayed Al Nahyan, as a shareholder of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, in the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Mohammad bin Khalifa bin Zayed Al Nahyan’s pro rata portion of the Ordinary Shares held in escrow is 22.2%.

 

(13) MENA Energy holds convertible securities in BPGIC Holdings that entitle it to convert its securities in BPGIC Holdings Limited into 8,333,333 of the Ordinary Shares of the Company owned by BPGIC Holdings.

 

(14) Represents the interest of MENA Energy in the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. IDB Infrastructure Fund II B.S.C(c) is the sole shareholder of MENA Energy, consequently it may be deemed the beneficial owner of the 8,333,333 Ordinary Shares of the Company that MENA Energy would receive upon conversion of its securities in BPGIC Holdings. IDB Infrastructure Fund II B.S.C(c) disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent it may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

(15) Represents the interest of MENA Energy in the Ordinary Shares held by BPGIC Holdings. ASMA Capital holds 99% of the equity of IDB Infrastructure Fund II B.S.C(c), the sole shareholder of MENA Energy, consequently it may be deemed the beneficial owner of the 8,333,333 Ordinary Shares of the Company that MENA Energy would receive upon conversion of its securities in BPGIC Holdings. ASMA Capital disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent it may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

(16) Based on 109,587,854 Ordinary Shares outstanding as of June 8, 2020. Does not reflect the 21,228,900 Ordinary Shares issuable upon exercise of the outstanding warrants issued in exchange for Twelve Seas warrants.

 

(17) Represents the interest of MENA Energy in the shares held by BPGIC Holdings. Mr. Chowdhury is the Managing Director and Chief Financial Officer of ASMA Capital which holds 99% of the equity of IDB Infrastructure Fund II B.S.C(c), the sole shareholder of MENA Energy, consequently he may be deemed the beneficial owner of the 8,333,333 Ordinary Shares of the Company that MENA Energy would receive upon conversion of its securities in BPGIC Holdings. Mr. Chowdhury disclaims beneficial ownership of any Ordinary Shares other than to the extent he may have a pecuniary interest therein.

 

112

 

 

Pursuant to certain letters from SBD International LP to nine individuals, BPGIC Holdings has undertaken to transfer an aggregate of 4,833,678 Ordinary Shares to such individuals in consideration of the valuable contributions they have made to the success of BPGIC. As SBD International LP and BPGIC Holdings have committed to complete this transaction, the beneficial ownerships reported above reflect the holdings of each beneficial owner after giving effect to these pending transactions.

 

As set forth above, BPGIC Holdings is the majority shareholder of the Company and holds 94,052,044 Ordinary Shares which is approximately 85.7% of the outstanding Ordinary Shares of the Company. BPGIC Holdings is wholly-owned by Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC. SBD International LP is the majority owner of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC. As the Chief Executive Officer of BPGIC Holdings and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, the Chief Executive Officer of the Company, Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper may be deemed to have beneficial ownership of the 94,052,044 Ordinary Shares owned by BPGIC Holdings.

 

The Company is not aware of any existing arrangements that may result in a change of control of the Company.

 

B. Related Party Transactions

 

BPGIC Related Party Transactions and Policies

 

Related Party Transactions

 

BIA was partially owned by Mrs. Hind Muktar. Mrs. Hind Muktar is also a limited partner of H Capital International LP and the sole shareholder of Gyan Investments Limited, the general partner of H Capital International LP.

 

The Phase I Customer Agreement provides for BIA to lease approximately two thirds of the total storage capacity of the Phase I facility for a fixed fee per cubic meter per month payable in advance on a monthly basis. The Phase I Customer Agreement also provides that BIA shall pay BPGIC a fixed fee per cubic meter per month for product throughput with a supplementary fee per metric ton of throughput in excess of agreed volume, a fixed blending fee per cubic meter per month, a fixed inter tank transfer fee per cubic meter per month, and a fixed heating fee per cubic meter per month. Further, BPGIC is entitled to pass through any tariffs, additional charges or fees imposed by the Port of Fujairah. BPGIC is entitled to review and seek to amend the fees every two years. This adjustment can result only in the fees remaining constant or increasing. The Company and BPGIC believe that the terms of this agreement are no less favorable to BPGIC than would result from a similar transaction with an unaffiliated third party. BIA is only allowed to sublease the Phase I storage tanks with BPGIC’s prior approval. H Capital International LP is a minority stakeholder in BPGIC and after sale of Mrs. Muktar’s shares in BIA, BIA is no longer a related party.

 

113

 

 

The Phase II Customer Agreement provides for BIA to lease all eight Phase II storage tanks for a fixed fee per cubic meter per month payable in advance on a monthly basis. The Phase II Customer Agreement also provides that BIA shall pay BPGIC a fixed fee per cubic meter per month for product throughput with a supplementary fee per metric ton of throughput in excess of agreed volume, a fixed blending fee per cubic meter per month, a fixed inter tank transfer fee per cubic meter per month, and a fixed heating fee per cubic meter per month. Further, BPGIC is entitled to pass through any tariffs, additional charges or fees imposed by the Port of Fujairah. BPGIC is entitled to review and seek to amend the fees every two years. This adjustment can result only in the fees remaining constant or increasing. The Company and BPGIC believe that the terms of this agreement are no less favorable to BPGIC than would result from a similar transaction with an unaffiliated third party. BIA is only allowed to sublease the Phase II storage tanks with BPGIC’s prior approval. H Capital International LP is a minority stakeholder in BPGIC and after sale of Mrs. Muktar’s shares in BIA, BIA is no longer a related party.

 

The Refinery Agreement provides that BIA and BPGIC will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for the BIA Refinery, a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd. The parties further agreed to negotiate, within 30 days, the Refinery Operations Agreement, a sublease agreement and a joint venture agreement to govern the terms on which BPGIC will sublease land to BIA to locate, BIA will construct, and BPGIC will operate the refinery. Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, the parties agreed to extend the period for their negotiations until August 4, 2020. BPGIC and BIA are still negotiating the Refinery Operations Agreement, however BPGIC expects that BIA will finance and arrange the development, construction and commissioning of a modular refinery on a parcel of BPGIC’s remaining unutilized land and will pay an ancillary service fee in connection with any ancillary services it uses. BPGIC believes that the terms of this agreement will be no less favorable to BPGIC than would result from a similar transaction with an unaffiliated third party. H Capital International LP is a minority stakeholder in BPGIC and following a planned sale of Mrs. Muktar’s shares in BIA, BIA is no longer be a related party.

 

During the year ended December 31, 2019, the shareholders of the Company transferred their ownership in the Company to BPGIC PLC, a company incorporated under the laws of England and Wales and owned by the same shareholders that previously owned the Company and in the same ownership proportion. Upon the change of ownership, the Company changed its name from Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC to Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE. As a result of the above, BPGIC PLC became the parent of the Company. The owners made net cash contributions to the extent of $32.6 million.

 

Subsequently, as part of a reorganization BPGIC PLC transferred 100% of the issued and outstanding ordinary shares of BPGIC to BPGIC Holdings. As a result, BPGIC Holdings became the parent of the Company.

 

Movements in shareholders’ account are as follows

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Contributions by the shareholders     77,090,648       951,539  
                 
Amounts paid on behalf of the Group by the shareholders*     1,135,484       7,850,431  
                 
Amounts paid by the Group on behalf of the shareholders     (1,647,064 )     (2,296,354 )
                 
Distributions to shareholders     (53,279,016 )     (29,209,289 )
                 
      23,300,052       (22,703,673 )

 

These amounts are repayable at the discretion of the Board of Directors of the Group and are interest free, therefore classified as part of equity.

 

* These include expenses paid on behalf of the Group which includes other operational expenses paid by the shareholders on behalf of the Group.

 

114

 

   

Changes in shareholders’ account is as follows:

      

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
At 1 January     47,717,763       70,421,436  
Net contributions (distributions) during the year     23,300,052       (22,703,673 )
                 
At 31 December     71,017,815       47,717,763  

 

Movements in other related parties are as follows:

  

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Expenses paid on behalf of related parties (note 10)     57,550       -  

 

Due from related parties:       

 

HBS Investments LP (shareholder)     13,388       -  
H Capital International LP (shareholder)     11,056       -  
O2 Investments Limited as GP (shareholder)     6,181       -  
SBD International LP (shareholder)     13,760       -  
SD Holding Limited as GP (shareholder)     6,984       -  
Gyan Investments Ltd (shareholder)     6,181       -  
                 
      57,550       -  

  

Key management remuneration for the year ended 31 December 2019 amounted to USD 1,160,293 (2018: USD 677,291), charged to consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss). The full amount of the key management remuneration relates to short term employment benefits.

 

Related Party Transaction Policies

 

Upon consummation of the Business Combination, the board of directors adopted a code of ethics and business conduct that requires it, and its directors, officers and employees to avoid conflicts of interest, such as related party transactions, unless specifically authorized. The board of directors also adopted a related party transaction policy to govern the procedures for evaluation and authorization of related party transactions. Related party transactions, which require approval of the audit committee, are defined as any transaction, arrangement or relationship, or any series of similar transactions, arrangements or relationships, in which (i) the Group is or will be a participant, (ii) the aggregate amount involved will or may be expected to exceed $120,000 in any fiscal year, and (iii) any related party has or will have a direct or indirect interest. This also includes any material amendment or modification to an existing related party transaction.

 

115

 

 

The audit committee is responsible for reviewing and approving related party transactions to the extent the Company contemplates engaging in such a transaction. The audit committee will review all of the relevant facts and circumstances of all related party transactions that require its approval and either approve or disapprove of the entry into the related party transaction. The audit committee will approve the related party transaction only if it determines in good faith that, under all of the circumstances, the transaction is in the best interests of the Company and its shareholders. The audit committee, in its sole discretion, will impose such conditions as it deems appropriate on the Company or the related party in connection with the approval of the related party transaction. No director will be permitted to participate in the discussions or approval of a transaction in which he or she is a related party, but that director will be required to provide all material information concerning the related party transaction to the audit committee.

 

C. Interests of Experts and Counsel

 

Not Applicable.

 

ITEM 8. FINANCIAL INFORMATION

 

A. Consolidated Statements and Other Financial Information

 

See Item 18 of this Report.

 

B. Significant Changes

 

BPGIC did not comply with the terms of the Phase I Construction Facilities as amended on December 30, 2019. A payment of principal and interest of $6.6 Million for the Phase I Construction Facility due on February 28, 2020 was not paid. Payments of principal and interest totaling $2.2 Million for the Phase I Construction Facility and the Phase I Admin Building Facility due on April 30, 2020 were not made. The Debt Service Reserve Account did not maintain a balance in an amount equivalent to one quarterly instalment including interest by February 28, 2020. BPGIC did not maintain a minimum Debt Service Coverage Ratio of 150% beginning on February 28, 2020. These non-payments and failures to comply with covenants were events of default, but, as in the past, the lender did not declare an event of default.

 

On June 15, 2020, BPGIC entered into an agreement with its lender to amend the Phase I Construction Facilities.

 

BPGIC and the lender agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Construction Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from June 30, 2020 through December 31, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
June 30, 2020   $2.99 Million
July 31, 2020   $3.62 Million
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $1.01 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $3.87 Million
Total   $11.9 Million by end of 2020

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 30, 2030, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $1.77 Million

 

116

 

 

BPGIC and the lender also agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Admin Building Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from August 31, 2020 through December 21, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $0.41 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $0.80 Million
Total   $1.63 Million by end of 2020

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 31, 2021, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $0.54 Million.

 

Testing of the Debt Service Ratio Covenant will start on December 31, 2020 and will be conducted on each subsequent payment date. A Debt Service Reserve Account containing at least 1 quarter of debt service amounts must be maintained with the lender by October 31, 2020 and at all times thereafter through the term of the Phase I Construction Facility or until BPGIC repays all liabilities owed under the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC pledged the account to the lender as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC, The Company and BPGIC Holdings undertook to have no other bank accounts except for the one that is the Debt Service Reserve Account until the Phase I Construction Facilities are repaid and to route all funds through the Debt Service Reserve Account. BPGIC further granted the lender a non-possessory mortgage over the Phase I Customer Agreement as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities.

 

Also pursuant to this amendment, BPGIC negotiated revised pricing terms as follows:

 

o Phase I Construction Facility: Enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021; and

 

o Phase I Admin Building Facility: Enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021.

 

There is no change in the final maturity of Phase I Construction Facility which is July 30, 2030 and Phase I Admin Building Facility which is July 31, 2023.

 

117

 

 

In March 2019, BPGIC partnered with Sahara to develop and operate a modular refinery within the BPGIC Terminal with minimal capital expenditure by BPGIC. Under the terms of the parties agreement, Sahara would finance and arrange the development, construction and commissioning of a modular refinery capable of supplying IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur content shipping fuel with initial production capacity of 24,000 b/d.

 

In February 2020, BPGIC and Sahara mutually agreed to discontinue their joint development project to install a modular oil refinery at BPGIC’s terminal. Shortly thereafter, BPGIC entered into the Refinery Agreement, a new agreement with BIA which provides that the parties will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for the BIA Refinery, a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd operated by BPGIC. The parties further agreed to negotiate, within 30 days, the Refinery Operations Agreement, a sublease agreement and a joint venture agreement to govern the terms on which BPGIC will sublease land to BIA to locate, BIA will construct, and BPGIC will operate the refinery. Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, the parties agreed to extend the period for their negotiations until August 4, 2020 and negotiations remain ongoing.

 

BPGIC is in the FEED stage of Phase III, a major expansion in the Port of Fujairah. In February 2020, BPGIC entered into the Phase III Land Lease Agreement securing the Phase III Land, a plot of land of approximately 450,000 m2 near its existing facilities. BPGIC believes that the Phase III Land can house additional storage capacity of up to 3,500,000 m3. BPGIC had an initial technical design with different layout options completed for the Phase III Land.

 

As BPGIC is in FEED stages of Phase III, it is not possible to reliably estimate the related capital expenditures. However, BPGIC anticipates the cost per m3 of Phase III to be approximately equal to the cost per m3 of Phase I and Phase II. As of the date of this Report, BPGIC does not yet have any planned capital expenditures in connection with Phase III, other than the costs of the ongoing FEED studies. BPGIC expects to be able to start projecting Phase III capital expenditures after it receives the results of the FEED studies in the Third Quarter of 2020. See “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Risks relating to BPGIC — BPGIC may be subject to significant risks and expenses when constructing Phase II, which could adversely affect BPGIC’s business, financial condition and results of operations.”

 

ITEM 9. THE OFFER AND LISTING

 

A. Offer and Listing Details

 

Our Ordinary Shares and warrants are listed on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbols BROG and BROGW, respectively. Holders of our Ordinary Shares and warrants should obtain current market quotations for their securities.

 

B. Plan of Distribution

 

Not applicable.

 

118

 

 

C. Markets

 

Our Ordinary Shares and warrants are listed on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the symbols BROG and BROGW, respectively.

 

D. Selling Shareholders

 

Not applicable.

 

E. Dilution

 

Not applicable.

 

F. Expenses of the Issue

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 10. ADDITIONAL INFORMATION

 

A. Share Capital

 

Not Applicable

 

B. Memorandum and Articles of Association

 

The Company was incorporated under the laws of the Cayman Islands as an exempted company. The Company’s objects are unrestricted and the Company shall have full power and authority to carry out any object not prohibited by the laws of the Cayman Islands. The Company’s objects can be found in paragraph number 3 of the Amended and Restated Memorandum of Association of the Company.

 

A director is free to vote in respect of any contract or transaction in which he or she is interested provided that the nature of the interest of such director in any such contract or transaction shall be disclosed by him or her at or prior to its consideration and any vote thereon. A director may give a general notice that he or she is a shareholder, director, officer or employee of any specified firm or company and is to be regarded as interested in any transaction with such firm or company. Such general notice is sufficient disclosure for the purposes of voting on a resolution in respect of a contract or transaction in which such director has an interest, and after such general notice, such director does not need to give special notice relating to any particular transaction. The directors’ power to vote compensation to be paid to themselves or any members of their body in the absence of an independent quorum is not restricted. The directors may exercise all the powers of the Company to borrow money and to mortgage or charge its undertaking, property and assets (present and future) and uncalled capital or any part thereof and to issue debentures, debenture shares, mortgages, bonds and other such securities whether outright or as security for any debt, liability or obligation of the Company or of any third party. Such borrowing powers can be varied by an amendment to the Articles of Association. There is no age at which directors are required to retire. A person is not required to hold shares of the Company to serve as a director.

 

Ordinary shares

 

The holders of Ordinary Shares are entitled to one vote for each Ordinary Share held of record on all matters to be voted on by shareholders. There is no cumulative voting with respect to the election of directors, with the result that the holders of more than 50% of the shares voted for the election of directors can elect all of the directors. Holders of the Company’s Ordinary Shares do not have any conversion, preemptive or other subscription rights and there are no sinking fund or redemption provisions applicable to the Ordinary Shares.

 

119

 

 

Preferred Shares

 

The Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association of the Company authorize the issuance of up to 50,000,000 blank check preferred shares with such designations, rights and preferences as may be determined from time to time by the Company’s board of directors. Accordingly, the Company’s board of directors is empowered, without shareholder approval, to issue preferred shares with dividend, liquidation, conversion, voting or other rights which could adversely affect the voting power or other rights of the holders of Ordinary Shares. In addition, the preferred shares could be utilized as a method of discouraging, delaying or preventing a change in control of the Company.

 

Variation of Rights of Shareholders

 

If at any time the share capital of the Company is divided into different classes of shares, all or any of the rights attached to any class (unless otherwise provided by the terms of issue of the shares of that class) may, whether or not the Company is being wound up, be varied without the consent of the holders of the issued shares of that class where such variation is considered by the directors not to have a material adverse effect upon such rights. In all other cases, variations shall be made only with the consent in writing of the holders of not less than two thirds of the issued shares of that class, or with the approval of a resolution passed by a majority of not less than two thirds of the votes cast at a separate meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. For the purposes of a separate class meeting, the directors may treat two or more or all the classes of shares as forming one class of shares if the directors consider that such class of shares would be affected in the same way by the proposals under consideration. The rights conferred upon the holders of the shares of any class issued with preferred or other rights shall not, unless otherwise expressly provided by the terms of issue of the shares of that class, be deemed to be varied by the creation or issue of further shares ranking pari passu therewith.

 

Meetings of Shareholders

 

The Company may, but shall not (unless required by Cayman Islands law) be obliged to, in each year hold a general meeting as its annual general meeting, and shall specify the meeting as such in the notices calling it. Any annual general meeting shall be held at such time and place as the directors shall appoint. At these meetings the report of the directors (if any) shall be presented. The directors may call general meetings. The directors are required to convene an extraordinary general meeting upon a requisition deposited by not less than twenty percent of par value of the issued shares which at that date carry the right to vote at general meetings. The requisition must state the objects of the meeting and must be signed by the depositing shareholders. Shareholders seeking to bring business before the annual general meeting or to nominate candidates for election as directors at the annual general meeting must deliver notice to the principal executive offices of the Company not later than the close of business on the 90th day nor earlier than the close of business on the 120th day prior to the scheduled date of the annual general meeting.

 

At least five clear days’ notice shall be given of any general meeting. Every notice shall specify the place, the day and the hour of the meeting and the general nature of the business to be conducted at the general meeting and shall be given in the manner hereinafter mentioned or in such other manner if any as may be prescribed by the Company, provided that a general meeting of the Company shall, whether or not the required notice has been given and whether or not the provisions of the Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association regarding general meetings have been complied with, be deemed to have been duly convened if it is so agreed: (i) in the case of an annual general meeting, by all of the shareholders entitled to attend and vote thereat; and (ii) in the case of an extraordinary general meeting, by a majority in number of the shareholders having a right to attend and vote at the meeting, together holding not less than ninety-five per cent in par value of the shares giving that right. The accidental omission to give notice of a general meeting to, or the non-receipt of notice of a general meeting by, any person entitled to receive such notice shall not invalidate the proceedings of that general meeting.

 

120

 

 

No business shall be transacted at any general meeting unless a quorum is present. The holders of a majority of the shares being individuals present in person or by proxy or if a corporation or other non-natural person by its duly authorized representative or proxy shall be a quorum. A person may participate at a general meeting by conference telephone or other communications equipment by means of which all the persons participating in the meeting can communicate with each other. Participation by a person in a general meeting in this manner is treated as presence in person at that meeting. If a quorum is not present within half an hour from the time appointed for the meeting to commence or if during such a meeting a quorum ceases to be present, the meeting, if convened upon a shareholders’ requisition, shall be dissolved and in any other case it shall stand adjourned to the same day in the next week at the same time and/or place or to such other day, time and/or place as the directors may determine, and if at the adjourned meeting a quorum is not present within half an hour from the time appointed for the meeting to commence, the shareholders present shall be a quorum.

 

The chairman of the meeting may, with the consent of a meeting at which a quorum is present (and shall if so directed by the meeting) adjourn the meeting from time to time and from place to place, but no business shall be transacted at any adjourned meeting other than the business left unfinished at the meeting from which the adjournment took place. When a general meeting is adjourned for thirty days or more, notice of the adjourned meeting shall be given as in the case of an original meeting. Otherwise it shall not be necessary to give any such notice of an adjourned meeting.

 

A resolution put to the vote of the meeting shall be decided on a poll. A poll shall be taken as the chairman of the meeting directs, and the result of the poll shall be deemed to be the resolution of the general meeting at which the poll was demanded. A poll demanded on the election of a chairman or on a question of adjournment shall be taken forthwith. A poll demanded on any other question shall be taken at such date, time and place as the chairman of the general meeting directs, and any business other than that upon which a poll has been demanded or is contingent thereon may proceed pending the taking of the poll. In the case of an equality of votes the chairman shall be entitled to a second or casting vote.

 

Limitations on Rights to Own Securities

 

There are no limitations on the rights to own securities in the Company.

 

Anti-Takeover Provisions

 

Certain provisions in the Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association of the Company, such as the super majority voting requirements for amendments thereto, may discourage unsolicited takeover proposals that the Company’s shareholders may consider to be in their best interest and may make the removal of the Company’s incumbent management more difficult. Other anti-takeover provisions under the Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association of the Company include:

 

  Undesignated Preferred Shares. The Company’s board of directors has the ability to designate and issue preferred shares with voting or other rights or preferences that could deter hostile takeovers or delay changes in its control or management.

 

  Directors Removed Only for Cause. The Company’s Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association provides that shareholders may remove directors only for cause.

 

For discussions on risks associated with the above anti-takeover provisions, please see “Item 3.D Risk Factors — Provisions in the Company’s amended and restated memorandum and articles of association may inhibit a takeover of us, which could limit the price investors might be willing to pay in the future for the Company’s securities and could entrench management.”

 

Bylaw Provision regarding Ownership Disclosure

 

There is no bylaw provision requiring shareholder ownership to be disclosed above a certain threshold.

 

121

 

 

Certain Differences of Cayman Islands Law

 

The Company’s corporate affairs are governed by its Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association, the Companies Law, and the common law of the Cayman Islands. The rights of shareholders to take action against the directors, actions by non-controlling shareholders and the fiduciary responsibilities of the Company’s directors to the Company under Cayman Islands law are to a large extent governed by the common law of the Cayman Islands. The common law of the Cayman Islands is derived in part from comparatively limited judicial precedent in the Cayman Islands as well as from English common law, which has persuasive, but not binding, authority on a court in the Cayman Islands. Your rights as a shareholders and the fiduciary responsibilities of the Company’s directors under Cayman Islands law are different from under statutes or judicial precedent in some jurisdictions in the United States. In particular, the Cayman Islands has a different body of securities laws from the United States and may provide significantly less protection to investors. In addition, some U.S. states, such as Delaware, have different bodies of corporate law than the Cayman Islands.

 

The Company has been advised by its Cayman Islands legal counsel, Maples and Calder, that the courts of the Cayman Islands are unlikely (i) to recognize or enforce against the Company judgments of courts of the United States predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the United States or any State and (ii) in original actions brought in the Cayman Islands, to impose liabilities against the Company predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the United States or any State, so far as the liabilities imposed by those provisions are penal in nature. In those circumstances, although there is no statutory enforcement in the Cayman Islands of judgments obtained in the United States, the courts of the Cayman Islands will recognize and enforce a foreign money judgment of a foreign court of competent jurisdiction without retrial on the merits based on the principle that a judgment of a competent foreign court imposes upon the judgment debtor an obligation to pay the sum for which judgment has been given provided certain conditions are met. For a foreign judgment to be enforced in the Cayman Islands, such judgment must be final and conclusive and for a liquidated sum, and must not be in respect of taxes or a fine or penalty, inconsistent with a Cayman Islands judgment in respect of the same matter, impeachable on the grounds of fraud or obtained in a manner, and/or be of a kind the enforcement of which is, contrary to natural justice or the public policy of the Cayman Islands (awards of punitive or multiple damages may well be held to be contrary to public policy). A Cayman Islands Court may stay enforcement proceedings if concurrent proceedings are being brought elsewhere. There is recent Privy Council authority (which is binding on the Cayman Islands Court) in the context of a reorganization plan approved by the New York Bankruptcy Court which suggests that due to the universal nature of bankruptcy/insolvency proceedings, foreign money judgments obtained in foreign bankruptcy/insolvency proceedings may be enforced without applying the principles outlined above. However, a more recent English Supreme Court authority (which is highly persuasive but not binding on the Cayman Islands Court), has expressly rejected that approach in the context of a default judgment obtained in an adversary proceeding brought in the New York Bankruptcy Court by the receivers of the bankruptcy debtor against a third party, and which would not have been enforceable upon the application of the traditional common law principles summarized above and held that foreign money judgments obtained in bankruptcy/insolvency proceedings should be enforced by applying the principles set out above, and not by the simple exercise of the Courts’ discretion. Those cases have now been considered by the Cayman Islands Court. The Cayman Islands Court was not asked to consider the specific question of whether a judgment of a bankruptcy court in an adversary proceeding would be enforceable in the Cayman Islands, but it did endorse the need for active assistance of overseas bankruptcy proceedings. The Company understands that the Cayman Islands Court’s decision in that case has been appealed and it remains the case that the law regarding the enforcement of bankruptcy/insolvency related judgments is still in a state of uncertainty.

 

The Company is incorporated in the Cayman Islands and following the Business Combination, will initially conduct all of its operations through its subsidiary, BPGIC, in the United Arab Emirates. All of the Company’s assets are located outside the United States. The Company’s officers and directors are expected to reside outside the United States and a substantial portion of the assets of those persons are located outside of the United States. As a result, it could be difficult or impossible for you to bring an action against the Company or against these individuals in the United States in the event that you believe that your rights have been infringed under the applicable securities laws or otherwise. Even if you are successful in bringing an action of this kind, the laws of the Cayman Islands and of the United Arab Emirates could render you unable to enforce a judgment against the Company’s assets or the assets of the Company’s directors and officers.

 

Shareholders of Cayman Islands exempted companies such as the Company have no general rights under Cayman Islands law to inspect corporate records and accounts or to obtain copies of lists of shareholders of these companies. The Company’s directors have discretion under Cayman Islands law to determine whether or not, and under what conditions, the Company’s corporate records could be inspected by the Company’s shareholders, but are not obliged to make them available to the Company’s shareholders. This could make it more difficult for you to obtain the information needed to establish any facts necessary for a shareholder motion or to solicit proxies from other shareholders in connection with a proxy contest.

 

122

 

 

As a result of all of the above, the Company shareholders might have more difficulty in protecting their interests in the face of actions taken by management, members of the board of directors or controlling shareholders than they would as public shareholders of a U.S. company.

 

C. Material Contracts

 

Phase I & II Land Lease

 

On March 10, 2013, BPGIC entered into the Phase I & II Land Lease, as amended by the Novation Agreement dated September 1, 2014. The amended agreement binds BPGIC and FOIZ for a total term of 60 years. The leased land has a total area of 153,916.93 m2. BPGIC used this land to build Phase I and is currently using the remaining portion of the site to build Phase II. Upon mutual agreement of the parties, the term of the Phase I & II Land Lease can be renewed or extended for a further period, the term of which is unspecified and therefore subject to agreement between the parties.

 

BPGIC began paying rent under the Phase I & II Land Lease in 2014. The rent for 2019 was $2,313,323 and rent increases by 2 percent per annum. Payments are required to be made in advance (the time period of which is unspecified) in four equal quarterly instalments. BPGIC is required to pay all taxes imposed by the federal government of the UAE or FOIZ; however, the leased premises are in a free zone and BPGIC is entitled to all benefits applying to free zone entities, including benefits in respect of taxes.

 

The Phase I & II Land Lease required BPGIC to enter into the Port Facilities Agreement, which grants it certain usage and access rights in connection with the Port’s facilities. The term of the Port Facilities Agreement, which BPGIC entered into on March 31, 2016, is 25 years and it automatically renews for another 25 years at the end of its term. The Port Facilities Agreement requires BPGIC to pay certain fees in connection with the use of the Port of Fujairah’s facilities; however, the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement provide that any fees charged by the Port of Fujairah in respect of services provided to BIA or the Super Major, including transportation, loading, unloading, use of berths, marine charges, administration charges, penalties and/or use of any of the Port of Fujairah’s facilities, shall be paid by BIA or the Super Major, respectively. Currently, the Phase I sublessees send BIA any such amounts to be paid, BIA delivers any such amounts to BPGIC, and BPGIC then sends such amounts to the Port. Once the BIA Refinery and Phase II become operational, BPGIC expects to follow a similar approach with BIA and the Phase II End User. The Super Major delivers any amounts payable to the Port of Fujairah to BPGIC, which passes the payments on to the Port. Pursuant to the Port Facilities Agreement, BPGIC is required to pay such amounts and is responsible for such amounts irrespective of whether the Super Major, the Phase I end users, the Phase II End User, or BIA pay such fees.

 

BPGIC is required to obtain the FOIZ’s prior permission in order to use the leased premises for any purpose other than in connection with Phase I and Phase II, or the BIA Refinery. The Phase I & II Land Lease contains representations and warranties, dispute resolution and indemnification clauses that are customary for the UAE and the oil storage industry. FOIZ can cancel the agreement if BPGIC fails to make certain required rental payments or fails to perform or meet in any material respect any material term, condition, covenant, agreement or obligation under the agreement.

 

The description of the Phase I & II Land Lease does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement as novated, and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreements, copies of which are attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibits 4.17 and 4.18.

 

123

 

 

Phase I End User Agreement, Phase I Customer Agreement and Super Major Agreement

 

In an effort to de-risk the start-up of operations of Phase I, BPGIC entered into the Phase I End User Agreement. The Phase I End User Agreement went into effect on December 12, 2017. Pursuant to the Phase I End User Agreement, the Initial Phase I End User leased all 14 oil storage tanks in Phase I from BPGIC. The Phase I End User Agreement provided that the Initial Phase I End User would pay BPGIC (i) a monthly fixed storage fee to lease all of Phase I’s storage capacity (irrespective of whether the Initial Phase I End User utilized any storage capacity) and (ii) monthly variable ancillary service fees based on the Initial Phase I End User’s usage of the following ancillary services: throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers. The Initial Phase I End User accounted for 100 percent of BPGIC’s revenue for the year ended December 31, 2018.

 

The Initial Phase I End User is an international energy trading company. Its activities include trading, financing, hedging, sourcing, storing, processing and transporting crude oil, fuel oil and clean petroleum products, including gas oil, gasoline and naphtha. Its goals are to provide quality services to its business partners, to leverage synergies with other companies and to identify and take advantage of new developments in its marketplace. The Initial Phase I End User primarily acts as an intermediary in the oil products and services supply chain by obtaining purchase or service orders for certain oil products (including fuel oil and refined petroleum products) from oil companies and then working with service providers like BPGIC to fulfil such orders.

 

In August 2019, BPGIC entered into the Phase I Customer Agreement to restructure its relationship with the Initial Phase I End User. Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement, BPGIC leased the Phase I facility to BIA on identical price terms and otherwise substantially similar terms as those of the Phase I End User Agreement, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed BPGIC’s rights and obligations under the Phase I End User Agreement. In 2020, BIA notified BPGIC that it had entered sublease arrangements for parts of the Phase I storage capacity with additional end users.

 

In May 2020, BIA agreed to release 129,000 m3 of the Phase I capacity, amounting to approximately one third of the total Phase I capacity, back to BPGIC. As a result of the strong demand for storage both globally and in Fujairah, BPGIC was able to lease this capacity to the Super Major for a 6 month period pursuant to the Super Major Agreement subject to renewal for an additional 6 month period with the mutual agreement of the parties.

 

BIA and the Super Major are required to pay (i) a monthly fixed storage fee to lease Phase I’s storage capacity and (ii) monthly variable ancillary service fees for the following ancillary services: throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers. BIA is required to satisfy any amounts due for the monthly fixed storage fee in advance for each applicable month, and the Super Major paid for the storage fees for the full 6 month term in advance. Because BIA subleases its storage capacity, BPGIC’s monthly revenue for ancillary services depends on the extent to which the Phase I sublessees and the Super Major utilize the ancillary services. Notwithstanding the sublease, BIA’s obligation to pay both the monthly fixed storage fee and the ancillary services fees to BPGIC is independent of is sublessees’ obligation to pay, and actual payment to, BIA.

 

Storage Fee

 

For the year ended December 31, 2017, December 31, 2018 and December 31, 2019, BPGIC respectively generated 100 percent, 57.9 percent and 54.3 percent of its revenue from monthly fees for storage services, which the Initial Phase I End User paid to reserve all the storage space in the 14 oil storage tanks of Phase I. The Initial Phase I End User was, and BIA is, required to pay BPGIC the contracted rate per m3 per month. These fees were, and are, owed to BPGIC regardless of the storage capacity actually used. Further, BIA is obligated to pay the storage fees to BPGIC whether or not BIA payment, in turn, from the Initial Phase I End User. As discussed in “Item 4.B Information on the Company — History and Development of the Company”, from the time BPGIC began its operations in December 2017 through February 28, 2018, BPGIC limited the availability of its storage capacity to 40 percent BPGIC then increased the availability of its storage capacity to approximately 70 percent on March 1, 2018 and to 100 percent on April 1, 2018. As a result of these limitations on the availability of storage capacity, BPGIC agreed with the Initial Phase I End User to pro-rate the monthly fixed storage fees to correspond with the amount of available storage capacity during each month prior to April 2018.

 

124

 

 

Ancillary Services

 

BPGIC charges BIA and the Super Major variable fees based on usage for the following ancillary services:

 

Throughput Fees.    Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement, BIA and the Super Major, respectively, are required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products delivered from the BPGIC Terminal to the Port of Fujairah’s berths or from the berths to the BPGIC Terminal during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. Each month BIA and the Super Major are each allocated an initial amount of throughput volume at no charge that corresponds with the storage capacity that they each lease. For BIA this amount is approximately 270,000 m3 each month and for the Super Major this amount is approximately 129,000 m3. Both BIA and the Super Major are required to pay BPGIC throughput fees on throughput volume to the extent the aggregate amount of throughput volume provided by BPGIC exceeds such initial amount. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees varies based upon, among other factors, the volume of oil products exiting the BPGIC Terminal. As BIA’s sublessees and the Super Major, utilize the ancillary services, which involves sending and receiving oil products to and from the BPGIC Terminal, it will lead to corresponding increases in the throughput volumes delivered to the extent BPGIC sends oil products to the Port of Fujairah’s berths. Upon mutual agreement, BPGIC could charge a supplementary fee to the extent BIA or the Super Major exceed an agreed amount of throughput volume.

 

Blending Fees.    Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement, BIA and the Super Major, respectively, are required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products blended during the blending processes performed during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. BIA and the Super Major are responsible for providing BPGIC with blend specifications, the component oil products and any additives in connection with any blend request. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees varies based upon the activity levels of BIA’s sublessees, and the Super Major.

 

Heating Fees.    Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement, BIA is required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products heated during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees varies based upon the activity levels of BIA’s sublessees. The Super Major does not contract for heating services.

 

Inter-Tank Transfer Fees.    Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement, BIA and the Super Major are required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products that they transferred between oil storage tanks during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees varies based upon the activity levels of BIA’s sublessees and the Super Major.

 

125

 

 

The term of the Super Major Agreement is six months and is renewable for an additional six months with the mutual agreement of the parties. Pursuant to the Super Major Agreement, following the Super Major’s failure to cure a default for non-payment or the commencement of insolvency proceedings against it (amongst other events of default), BPGIC could terminate the agreement. Following a termination for default, the Super Major would be required to pay BPGIC the equivalent of total storage fees that would have been charged to the Super Major had the agreement not been terminated.

 

The term of the Phase I Customer Agreement is four years and renews automatically for another five years, unless either party delivers to the other party a written termination notice not less than six months prior to the expiration date of the agreement. Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement, following BIA’s failure to cure a default for non-payment or the commencement of insolvency proceedings against it, BPGIC could terminate the agreement, and exercise any other remedies available at law or equity. Following a termination for default, BIA would be required to pay BPGIC the one-year equivalent of total service fees that would have been charged to BIA had the agreement not been terminated.

 

The Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement both provide that any fees charged by the Port of Fujairah in respect of BIA (or its sublessees) or the Super Major, as applicable, including transportation, loading, unloading, use of berths, marine charges, administration charges, penalties and/or use of any of the Port of Fujairah’s facilities, shall be paid by BIA or the Super Major, as applicable.

 

Every two years, BPGIC may elect to review and seek to amend the fees charged under the Phase I Customer Agreement to the fair market rate of the relevant services at such time. As a result of such review, the rates shall equal either (i) the then-current rates or (ii) the market rates agreed between the parties, but only if such rates are higher than the then-current rates.

 

Sublessees

 

The Phase I Customer Agreement contemplates that BIA, subject to BPGIC’s prior approval, may enter into sublease agreements from time to time to assign its rights under the Phase I Customer Agreement to sublessees. In 2020, BIA notified BPGIC that it had entered sublease arrangements for parts of the Phase I storage capacity with additional end users. Notwithstanding the sublease to the Phase I end users, BIA is responsible for both the storage fee and the ancillary service fee without regard to whether BIA receives payment from the Phase I end users. Similarly, the Super Major Agreement permits the Super Major, subject to BPGIC’s prior approval, to enter into sublease agreements from time to time to assign its rights under the Super Major Agreement to sublessees.

 

The fees under any such sublease agreements are generally expected to mirror the fees of the Phase I Customer Agreement and the Super Major Agreement, but may be higher in the event of increased demand for storage. Under the Phase I Customer Agreement, sublessees may engage directly with BPGIC such that BPGIC delivers services to them and they pay applicable fees to BPGIC for such services. BIA’s sublessees may also interface directly with BPGIC to file complaints and to arrange any surveyor inspections.

 

Prior to doing any business with BPGIC, BPGIC expects that each potential sublessee will perform an intensive inspection of the BPGIC Terminal. The inspections generally entail an examination of various components of the terminal, including the oil storage tanks, jetty pipelines, internal manifold and operational control room, and various aspects of the operations, including flow rates, contamination rates, oil losses and process documentation.

 

126

 

 

BPGIC plans to perform a background check on all potential sublessees prior to accepting them as sublessees. BPGIC also plans to coordinate with a third party to perform such background checks and, among other things, confirm that any potential sublessee is not a sanctioned entity.

 

Pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement, the product specifications of the sublessees’ oil products must be approved by BPGIC before any sublessees can deliver any oil products to the BPGIC Terminal. Such oil products must also be in compliance with the Port of Fujairah’s environmental standards, the relevant tank specifications, and must not be considered “hazardous”. BPGIC also retains the right pursuant to the Phase I Customer Agreement to refuse any oil products that are proven to be sanctioned, poor quality or hazardous. Similarly, under the Super Major Agreement, BPGIC has the right to refuse any oil products that do not conform with the description of the products provided by the Super Major, that may result in danger or damage to persons, goods, the BPGIC or property generally, that may cause environmental damage or that violate Port regulations or applicable laws.

 

The description of the Phase I Customer Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.66.

 

The description of the Super Major Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.90.

 

Refinery Agreement

 

In February 2020, BPGIC and Sahara mutually agreed to discontinue their joint development discussions to install a modular oil refinery at BPGIC’s terminal. Shortly thereafter, BPGIC entered into the Refinery Agreement with BIA which provides that the parties will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for the BIA Refinery, a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd. The parties further agreed to negotiate, within 30 days, the Refinery Operations Agreement, a sublease agreement and a joint venture agreement to govern the terms on which (i) BPGIC will sublease land to BIA to locate, (ii) BIA will construct, and (iii) BPGIC will operate the BIA Refinery. Due to the COVID-19 pandemic, the parties agreed to extend the period for their negotiations until August 4, 2020.

 

BPGIC is in discussion with BIA to develop and operate the BIA Refinery at minimal cost to BPGIC. BPGIC and BIA are still negotiating the Refinery Operations Agreement, however BPGIC expects that BIA will finance and arrange the development, construction and commissioning of a modular refinery on a parcel of BPGIC’s remaining unutilized land. BPGIC anticipates that BIA will engage an EPC Contractor to design and procure construction and commission of the BIA Refinery. BPGIC currently projects that the BIA Refinery will be completed by the Second Quarter of 2021, and will commence operations in the Third Quarter of 2021. The BIA Refinery is expected to be amongst the first refineries in the MENA region capable of supplying IMO 2020 compliant 0.5% sulphur content shipping fuel. The facility is initially expected to have an initial production capacity of 25,000 b/d.

 

The description of the Refinery Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement and the letter agreements related thereto, copies of which are attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibits 4.86, 4.87 and 4.88.

 

Phase II End User Agreement and Phase II Customer Agreement

 

As was the case with Phase I, in order to de-risk the start-up of operations of Phase II, on June 27, 2018, BPGIC entered into the Phase II End User Agreement with the Phase II End User, an international commodities trading company. The Phase II End User agreed to lease all eight oil storage tanks in Phase II. The Phase II End User Agreement provides that the Phase II End User will pay (i) a monthly fixed storage fee to lease all of Phase II’s storage capacity (irrespective of whether the Phase II End User uses any storage capacity) and (ii) monthly variable ancillary service fees based on the Phase II End User’s usage of the following ancillary services: throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers.

 

The Phase II End User is an international commodities trading company. Its activities include sourcing, marketing, trading and distributing crude oil and oil products. Generally, its goals are to continue to maintain its long-term business relationships, apply innovative trading solutions and help smooth worldwide energy markets. The Phase II End User primarily acts as an intermediary in the oil products and services supply chain by obtaining purchase or service orders for certain oil products (including crude oil) from oil companies and then working with service providers like BPGIC to fulfil such orders. BPGIC expects the Phase II End User to utilize BPGIC’s storage and ancillary services to fulfil the needs of its customers. BPGIC expects its revenue for its ancillary services to vary based on the orders the Phase II End User receives from its customers.

 

127

 

 

In September 2019, with the consent of the Phase II End User, BPGIC entered into the Phase II Customer Agreement to restructure its relationship with the Phase II End User. Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC has agreed to lease the Phase II facility, once operational, to BIA on identical price terms and otherwise substantially similar terms as those of the Phase II End User Agreement, and in connection therewith, BIA assumed BPGIC’s rights and obligations under the Phase II End User Agreement. BIA will become BPGIC’s customer with respect to Phase II once it becomes operational, which is expected to occur during second half of 2020. Like the Phase II End User, BIA will be required to pay (i) a monthly fixed storage fee to lease all of Phase II’s storage capacity and (ii) monthly variable ancillary service fees for the following ancillary services: throughput, blending, heating and inter-tank transfers. BIA is required to satisfy any amounts due for the monthly fixed storage fee in advance for each applicable month. Because BIA agreed to sublease the facility to the Phase II End User, BPGIC’s monthly revenue for ancillary services depends on the extent to which the Phase II End User utilizes the ancillary services. Notwithstanding the sublease, BIA’s obligation to pay both the monthly fixed storage fee and the ancillary services fees to BPGIC is independent of the Phase II End User’s obligation to pay, and actual payment to, BIA. Similar to the commencement of operations for Phase I, BPGIC may initially commence operations of Phase II in accordance with certain required safety measures and ramp up utilization of its storage capacity and ancillary services over time to mitigate any potential operational risks. This would impact the amount of storage and ancillary service fees BPGIC would earn during the first quarter of operations under the Phase II Customer Agreement.

 

Storage Fee

 

Upon the commencement of the Phase II Customer Agreement, BIA will be required to pay the contracted rate per m3 per month. Every two years, BPGIC will have the option to seek to adjust the storage fee to the applicable market price, as determined by mutual agreement. In connection with such determinations, BPGIC plans to consider various factors, including the availability of storage capacity in the Fujairah region and the storage rate charged by other crude oil storage companies in the region. BPGIC also plans to act reasonably and to provide BIA with supporting documentation to justify any proposed rate changes. Following an adjustment to the storage fee, BIA will then be required to pay the higher of: (i) the contracted floor price per mand (ii) the agreed market price for storage. These fees will be owed to BPGIC regardless of the storage capacity actually used by BIA.

 

Ancillary Services

 

Upon the commencement of the Phase II Customer Agreement, BPGIC will charge BIA variable fees based on usage for the following ancillary services:

 

Throughput Fees.    Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, BIA will be required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products delivered from the BPGIC Terminal to the Port of Fujairah’s berths and the VLCC jetty, or from the berths and the VLCC jetty to the BPGIC Terminal, as applicable, during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. Each month BIA will be allocated an initial amount of throughput volume at no charge that corresponds with the monthly storage capacity leased by it. As BIA will lease all the storage capacity of Phase II, the amount is approximately 601,261 m3 each month. BIA will be required to pay BPGIC throughput fees on throughput volume to the extent the aggregate amount of throughput volume provided by BPGIC exceeds such initial amount. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees will vary based upon, among other factors, the volume of oil products exiting the BPGIC Terminal. As BIA’s sublessee, the Phase II End User, utilizes the ancillary services, which involves sending and receiving oil products to and from Phase II, it will lead to corresponding increases in the throughput volumes delivered to the extent BPGIC sends oil products to the Port of Fujairah’s berths and the VLCC jetty, as applicable.

 

Blending Fees.    Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, BIA will be required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products blended during the blending processes performed during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. BIA is responsible for providing BPGIC with blend specifications, the component oil products and any additives in connection with any blend request. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees will vary based upon the activity levels of BIA’s sublessee, the Phase II End User.

 

Heating Fees.    Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, BIA will be required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products heated during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees will vary based upon the activity levels of BIA’s sublessee, the Phase II End User.

 

128

 

 

Inter-Tank Transfer Fees.    Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, BIA is required to pay BPGIC a monthly fee based upon the total volume of oil products transferred between oil storage tanks during an applicable month at the contracted rate per m3. The revenue BPGIC generates from such service fees will vary based upon the activity levels of BIA’s sublessee, the Phase II End User.

 

The term of the Phase II Customer Agreement, which will commence seven calendar days after BPGIC notifies BIA in writing that Phase II is ready to commence operations, is five years and renews automatically for another five years. Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, following BIA’s failure to cure a default for non-payment or the commencement of insolvency proceedings against it, BPGIC could terminate the agreement, prevent BIA from discharging any oil products from the oil storage tanks and exercise any other remedies available at law or equity. Following a termination for default, BIA would be required to pay BPGIC a termination fee equal to the aggregate amount that would have become due over the following year. In the event that insolvency proceedings are commenced against BPGIC or the expected completion time for the construction of Phase II is exceeded by Audex and BPGIC fails to provide BIA with regular updates on the readiness of Phase II well in advance of the expected construction completion time, BIA would have the option to terminate the Phase II Customer Agreement. Any delays in or failures of performance by either party will not constitute a default or give rise to liability to the extent that such delays or failures are caused by events or circumstances that would be considered a “force majeure” event under the Phase II Customer Agreement. Force majeure events include events that are not within the reasonable control of the parties and that the parties may be unable to foresee or prevent, including acts of war, terrorism and certain natural disasters.

 

The Phase II Customer Agreement provides that any fees charged by the Port of Fujairah in respect of BIA, including transportation, loading, unloading, use of berths, marine charges, administration charges, penalties and/or use of any of the Port of Fujairah’s facilities, shall be paid by BIA.

 

Sublessees

 

The Phase II Customer Agreement contemplates that BIA, subject to BPGIC’s prior approval, may enter into sublease agreements from time to time to assign its rights under the Phase II Customer Agreement to sublessees. By assuming BPGIC’s rights and obligations under the Phase II End User Agreement, BIA subleased the Phase II facility to the Phase II End User. Notwithstanding the sublease to the Phase II End User, BIA is responsible for both the storage fee and the ancillary service fee without regard to whether BIA receives payment from the Phase II End User.

 

The fees under any such sublease agreements are generally expected to mirror the fees of the Phase II Customer Agreement. Sublessees may engage directly with BPGIC such that BPGIC delivers services to them and they pay applicable fees to BPGIC for such services. Sublessees may also interface directly with BPGIC to file complaints and to arrange any surveyor inspections.

 

Prior to doing any business with BPGIC, BPGIC expects that each potential sublessee will perform an intensive inspection of the BPGIC Terminal. The inspections generally entail an examination of various components of the BPGIC Terminal, including the oil storage tanks, jetty pipelines, internal manifold and operational control room, and various aspects of the operations, including flow rates, contamination rates, oil losses and process documentation.

 

BPGIC plans to perform a background check on all potential sublessees prior to accepting them as sublessees. BPGIC also plans to coordinate with a third party to perform such background checks and, among other things, confirm that any potential sublessee is not a sanctioned entity.

 

Pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement, the product specifications of the sublessee’s oil products must be approved by BPGIC before any sublessees can deliver any oil products to the BPGIC Terminal. Such oil products must also be in compliance with the Port of Fujairah’s environmental standards, the relevant tank specifications, and must not be considered “hazardous”. BPGIC also retains the right pursuant to the Phase II Customer Agreement to refuse any oil products that are proven to be sanctioned, poor quality or hazardous. 

 

The description of the Phase II Customer Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.70.

 

129

 

 

Business Combination Agreement

 

On April 15, 2019, (i) Twelve Seas (now known as BPGIC International), (ii) the Company (f/k/a Brooge Holdings Limited), (iii) Merger Sub, and (iv) BPGIC, entered into the Business Combination Agreement, pursuant to which BPGIC Holdings also become a party thereafter pursuant to the Assignment and Joinder to Business Combination Agreement dated as of November 19, 2019 (as assignee of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC, which became a party to the Business Combination Agreement pursuant to a Joinder to Business Combination Agreement dated as of May 10, 2019) pursuant to which, subject to the terms and conditions thereof, upon the consummation of the transactions contemplated thereby upon the Closing, among other matters, (a) Twelve Seas merged with and into Merger Sub, with Twelve Seas continuing as the surviving entity with the name BPGIC International, and as a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company and with holders of the Twelve Seas’ securities receiving substantially equivalent securities of the Company, and (b) the Company acquired all of the issued and outstanding Ordinary Shares of BPGIC from BPGIC Holdings in exchange for 98,718,035 Ordinary Shares of the Company, subject to the withholding of the Seller Escrow Shares being deposited in the Seller Escrow Account in accordance with the terms and conditions of the Business Combination Agreement and the Seller Escrow Agreement and $13,225,827.22, and with BPGIC becoming a wholly-owned subsidiary of the Company.

 

Upon consummation of the Business Combination pursuant to the terms of the Business Combination Agreement, the Company’s Ordinary Shares and warrants to purchase Ordinary Shares became listed on The Nasdaq Stock Market.

 

The description of the Business Combination Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.58.

 

Amended Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement

 

On June 19, 2018, Twelve Seas entered into the Share Escrow Agreement, by and among Twelve Seas, the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders and Continental, as escrow agent (the “Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement”). On December 20, 2019, the Company entered into the Share Escrow Agreement Amendment, by and among the Company, Twelve Seas, the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders and Continental, as escrow agent (the Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement as amended by the Share Escrow Agreement Amendment, the “Amended Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement”).

 

The Amended Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement provides that 2,587,500 shares held by Twelve Seas Sponsor, (the “Founders’ Lock-Up Shares”) will be held in escrow, with 50% of such Founders’ Lock-Up Shares subject to possible release from escrow upon certain milestones being met prior to one year after the date of Closing, but in any event, all Founders’ Lock-Up Shares to be released one year after the date of the Closing. Further, the Founders’ Lock-Up Shares may also be released prior to one year after the date of Closing, if, subsequent to the Closing, the Company consummates a liquidation, merger, share exchange or other similar transaction which results in all of its shareholders having the right to exchange their Ordinary Shares for cash, securities or other property. During the Escrow Period (as defined in the Amended Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement), the only permitted transfers of the Founders’ Lock-Up Shares will be (i) for transfers to the Company’s officers, directors or their respective affiliates (including, where an Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder is an entity, as a distribution to partners, members or shareholders of such Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder upon its liquidation and dissolution) (ii) by bona fide gift to a member of the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder’s immediate family or to a trust, the beneficiary of which is the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder or a member of the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder’s immediate family for estate planning purposes, (iii) by virtue of the laws of descent and distribution upon death of the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder, (iv) pursuant to a qualified domestic relations order, (v) by certain pledges to secure obligations incurred in connection with purchases of the Company’s securities, (vi) by private sales made at or prior to the consummation of the transactions under the Business Combination Agreement at prices no greater than the price at which the Founders’ Lock-Up Shares were originally purchased or (vii) to the Company for cancellation or in connection with the consummation of the transactions under the Business Combination, in each case, except for clause (vii) or with the Company’s prior consent, on the condition that such transfers may be implemented only upon the respective transferee’s written agreement (in a form reasonably acceptable to the Company) to be bound, inter alia, by the terms and conditions of the Amended Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement.

 

The description of the Amended Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to both the full text of such agreement, a copy of which was filed by Twelve Seas as Exhibit 10.3 to the Current Report on Form 8-K, filed by Twelve Seas with the SEC on June 25, 2018 and is incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.7, and by reference to the full text of the amendment to such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.75.

 

130

 

 

A&R Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement

 

The Company entered into the Amended and Restated Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement (the “A&R Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement”), dated as of December 20, 2019, by and among the Company, Twelve Seas, EarlyBirdCapital, Inc. (“EBC”) and the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders (the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders and EBC, collectively the “Twelve Seas Insiders” and the securities held by the Twelve Seas Insiders the “Twelve Seas Insider Securities”).

 

Pursuant to the A&R Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement, the holders of a majority-in-interest of the Twelve Seas Insider Securities are entitled to make demands that the Company register such securities, however the Company is not obligated to effect more than an aggregate of two such demand registrations. With respect to such Twelve Seas Insider Securities which are subject to escrow under the Amended Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement, the holders of the majority-in-interest of the Twelve Seas Insider Securities can elect to exercise their registration rights at any time commencing two months prior to the date on which such securities are to be released from escrow under the Amended Founders’ Share Escrow Agreement. With respect to such Twelve Seas Insider Securities which are subject to escrow under the Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement, the holders of the majority-in-interest of the Twelve Seas Insider Securities can elect to exercise their registration rights when such securities are released from escrow under the Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement. With respect to such Twelve Seas Insider Securities which are not subject to any escrow, the registration rights may be exercised at any time on or after the date of Closing. Subject to certain exceptions, if the Company proposes to file a registration statement under the Securities Act with respect to the registration of or an offering of equity securities, under the A&R Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement, the Company shall give notice to the Twelve Seas Insiders and all other holders of Registrable Securities (as defined in the A&R Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement) as to the proposed filing and offer them an opportunity to register the sale of such number of Registrable Securities as requested by the holders in writing, subject to customary cut-backs. In addition, the A&R Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement provides that subject to certain exceptions, the holders of Registrable Securities shall be entitled under the A&R Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement to request in writing that the Company register the resale of any or all of such Registrable Securities on Form F-3 or S-3 and any similar short-form registration that may be available at such time. Under the A&R Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement, the Company agrees to indemnify the holders of Registrable Securities and certain persons or entities related to them, such as their officers, directors, employees, agents and representatives, against any losses or damages resulting from any untrue statement of a material fact or omission of a material fact in any registration statement or prospectus pursuant to which they sell such Registrable Securities, unless such liability arose from the Company’s reliance upon and conformity with information furnished in writing by such holder (or certain persons or entities related to them), for use in such documents. The holders of Registrable Securities will indemnify the Company and certain persons or entities related to the Company, such as its officers and directors and underwriters, against any losses that arise out of or are based upon such untrue statement of a material fact or omission to state a material fact, in any registration statement or prospectus pursuant to which they sell their Registrable Securities, where they were made (or not made) by the Company in reliance upon and in conformity with information furnished in writing to it by such holder.

 

The description of the A&R Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.74.

 

131

 

 

Seller Escrow Agreement

 

As contemplated by the Business Combination Agreement, at the Closing, the Seller Escrow Shares, which are Twenty Million (20,000,000) of the Company’s Ordinary Shares otherwise issuable to BPGIC Holdings at the Closing together with any equity securities paid as dividends or distributions with respect to such shares or into which such shares are exchanged or converted, were instead issued to BPGIC Holdings in escrow, and are held by Continental, as escrow agent for the benefit of BPGIC Holdings, to be held and controlled, along with any other Seller Escrow Property by Continental in a separate segregated escrow account (the “Seller Escrow Account”), and released in accordance with the Seller Escrow Agreement.

 

While the Seller Escrow Property is held in the Seller Escrow Account, BPGIC Holdings shall have all voting, consent and other rights (other than the rights to dividends, distributions or other income paid or accruing to the Seller Escrow Property). The Seller Escrow Agreement provides, however, that after the Closing, BPGIC Holdings shall be permitted to (i) pledge or otherwise encumber the Seller Escrow Property as collateral security for documented loans entered into by BPGIC Holdings, the Company or its subsidiaries, including BPGIC, after the Closing or (ii) transfer its rights to the Seller Escrow Property to a third party, provided, that (a) in each case of clauses (i) and (ii), that the lender’s or transferee’s rights to any such pledged or transferred Seller Escrow Property shall be subject to the provisions of the Seller Escrow Agreement and the sections of the Business Combination Agreement pertaining to the escrow, including the forfeiture provisions contained therein, and (b) in the event of a pledge or encumbrance of the Seller Escrow Property under clause (i) above, BPGIC Holdings may transfer the Seller Escrow Property to another escrow agent selected by BPGIC Holdings and reasonably acceptable to the Company.

 

The Seller Escrow Property will only become vested and not subject to forfeiture, and released to BPGIC Holdings, in the event that the Company meets the following performance or milestone requirements during the Seller Escrow Period, the period commencing from the Closing until the end of the twentieth (20th) fiscal quarter after the commencement date of the first full fiscal quarter beginning after the Closing:

 

(i) One-half (½) of the Seller Escrow Property shall become vested and no longer subject to forfeiture, and be released to BPGIC Holdings, in the event that either: (a) the Annualized EBITDA (as defined in the Seller Escrow Agreement) for any full fiscal quarter during the Seller Escrow Period beginning with the first Seller Escrow Quarter equals or exceeds $175,000,000 or (b) at any time during the Seller Escrow Period, the closing price of the Company Ordinary Shares equals or exceeds $12.50 per share (subject to equitable adjustment) for any ten (10) Trading Days (as defined in the Seller Escrow Agreement) within any twenty (20) Trading Day period during the Seller Escrow Period.

 

(ii) All Seller Escrow Property remaining in the Seller Escrow Account shall become vested and no longer subject to forfeiture, and be released to BPGIC Holdings, in the event that either: (a) the Annualized EBITDA for any Seller Escrow Quarter equals or exceeds $250,000,000 or (b) at any time during the Seller Escrow Period, the closing price of the Company Ordinary Shares equals or exceeds $14.00 per share (subject to equitable adjustment) for any ten (10) Trading Days within any twenty (20) Trading Day period during the Seller Escrow Period.

 

132

 

 

The Annualized EBITDA for each fiscal quarter is equal to four times the earnings before interest, income taxes, depreciation and amortization of the Company and its subsidiaries, on a consolidated basis, for such fiscal quarter, as determined in accordance with IFRS, consistently applied, but subject to certain adjustments set forth on Exhibit A to the Seller Escrow Agreement.

 

At the end of the Seller Escrow Period, if there is any Seller Escrow Property which has not vested and that BPGIC Holdings is not entitled to receive in accordance with the Seller Escrow Agreement and the Business Combination Agreement, such Seller Escrow Property will be forfeited and automatically surrendered by BPGIC Holdings and distributed to the Company from the Seller Escrow Account, for cancellation by the Company. All actions or determinations on behalf of the Company under the Seller Escrow Agreement after the Closing (other than certain reports to be delivered by the Company’s chief financial officer) will be exclusively made and determined by a majority of the independent directors then serving on the Company’s board of directors that are disinterested in the Seller Escrow Property.

 

The description of the Seller Escrow Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to both the full text of such agreement, a copy of which was filed by Twelve Seas as Exhibit 10.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K, filed by Twelve Seas with the SEC on May 13, 2019 and is incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.59, and by reference to the full text of the First Amendment to such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.72.

 

Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement

 

As contemplated by the Business Combination Agreement, at the Closing, One Million Five Hundred Fifty-Two Thousand Five Hundred (1,552,500) of the Company’s Ordinary Shares otherwise issuable to the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders at the Closing (together with any equity securities paid as dividends or distributions with respect to such Ordinary Shares or into which such Ordinary Shares are exchanged or converted, the “Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Shares” and together with the Founders’ Lock-Up Shares, the “Founders’ Shares”) were instead issued to the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders in escrow and are held by Continental, as escrow agent for the benefit of the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders to be held and controlled, along with any other Founder Escrow Property (as defined in the Initial Shareholder Earn-Out Escrow Agreement and together with the Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Shares, the “Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property”) by Continental in a separate segregated escrow account (the “Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Account”), and released in accordance with the Escrow Agreement, dated December 20, 2019 by and among the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders, Continental and the Company (the “Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement”).

 

While the Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property is held in the Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Account, the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders shall have all voting, consent and other rights (other than the rights to dividends, distributions or other income paid or accruing to the Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property). The Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement provides, however, that each Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder shall be permitted to (i) pledge or otherwise encumber such Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder’s portion of the Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property as collateral security for documented loans entered into by such Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder, the Company or its subsidiaries, including BPGIC, after the Closing or (ii) transfer its rights to the Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property to a third party, provided, that (a) in each case of clauses (i) and (ii), that the lender’s or transferee’s rights to any such pledged or transferred Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property shall be subject to the provisions of the Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement, the Voting Agreement (as applicable) and the Founder Share Letter (as defined in the Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement), including the forfeiture provisions contained therein, and (b) in the event of a pledge or encumbrance of the Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property under clause (i) above, such Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder may transfer such Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder’s portion of the Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property to another escrow agent selected by such Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder and reasonably acceptable to the Company.

 

133

 

 

The Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property will only become vested and not subject to forfeiture, and released to the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders (on the same proportional basis) upon the same events and milestones triggering, and at the same time as, the release of the Seller Escrow Property.

 

At the end of the Seller Escrow Period, if there is any Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property which has not vested and that the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders are not entitled to receive in accordance with the Founder Share Letter and the Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement (which will occur upon a determination being made under the Seller Escrow Agreement and the Business Combination Agreement that forfeitures shall be made with respect to the Seller Escrow Property), such Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Property will be forfeited and automatically surrendered by the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders and distributed to the Company from the Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Account, for cancellation by the Company.

 

In connection with an agreement between Twelve Seas Sponsor and Magnetar Financial LLC and certain of its affiliates (collectively, “Magnetar”) whereby Twelve Seas Sponsor pledged, inter alia, its Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Shares to Magnetar as collateral, the Company agreed that, if the other pledged collateral is not sufficient to cover Twelve Seas Sponsor’s obligations to Magnetar, the Company will waive the escrow release conditions and release up to 100% of Twelve Seas Sponsor’s Founders’ Earn-Out Escrow Shares, as necessary, to cover the remainder of Twelve Seas’ Sponsor’s obligations to Magnetar (such agreement the “Limited Waiver”).

 

The description of the Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to both the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.77 and the Limited Waiver of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.83.

 

The description of the Limited Waiver does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the Limited Waiver and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text thereof, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.83.

 

Seller Registration Rights Agreement

 

Pursuant to the Business Combination Agreement, the Company and BPGIC Holdings have entered into the registration rights agreement, dated December 20, 2019 (the “Seller Registration Rights Agreement”), which became effective upon the Closing, with respect to the Ordinary Shares of the Company received by BPGIC Holdings at the Closing (the “Seller Shares”). Under the Seller Registration Rights Agreement, BPGIC Holdings has registration rights that obligate the Company to register for resale under the Securities Act all or any portion of the Seller Shares (together with any securities issued as a dividend or distribution with respect thereto or in exchange therefor, the “Seller Registrable Securities”), except that the Company is not obligated to register Seller Registrable Securities subject to the Seller Escrow Agreement until they are released from the Seller Escrow Account. The holders of a majority-in-interest of the Seller Registrable Securities are entitled under the Seller Registration Rights Agreement to make written demands for registration under the Securities Act of all or part of their Seller Registrable Securities (provided, however, that the Company is not obligated to effect more than four (4) of such written demands), and the other holders of Seller Registrable Securities will be entitled to join in such demand registration. Subject to certain exceptions, if the Company proposes to file a registration statement under the Securities Act with respect to the registration of or an offering of equity securities, under the Seller Registration Rights Agreement, the Company shall give notice to BPGIC Holdings and all other holders of Seller Registrable Securities as to the proposed filing and offer them an opportunity to register the sale of such number of Registrable Securities as requested by the holders in writing, subject to customary cut-backs. In addition, the Seller Registration Rights Agreement provides that subject to certain exceptions, the holders of Seller Registrable Securities shall be entitled under the Seller Registration Rights Agreement to request in writing that the Company register the resale of any or all of such Seller Registrable Securities on Form F-3 or S-3 and any similar short-form registration that may be available at such time. Under the Seller Registration Rights Agreement, the Company agrees to indemnify the holders of Seller Registrable Securities and certain persons or entities related to them, such as their officers, directors, employees, agents and representatives, against any losses or damages resulting from any untrue statement of a material fact or omission of a material fact in any registration statement or prospectus pursuant to which they sell Seller Registrable Securities, unless such liability arose from the Company’s reliance upon and conformity with information furnished in writing by such holder (or certain persons or entities related to them), for use in such documents. The holders of Seller Registrable Securities will indemnify the Company and certain persons or entities related to the Company, such as its officers and directors and underwriters, against any losses that arise out of or are based upon such untrue statement of a material fact or omission to state to material fact, in any registration statement or prospectus pursuant to which they sell their Seller Registrable Securities, where they were made (or not made) by the Company in reliance upon and in conformity with information furnished in writing to it by such holder.

 

134

 

 

The description of the Seller Registration Rights Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.76.

  

Amendment to Warrant Agreement and Rights Agreement

 

On June 19, 2018, Twelve Seas entered into both the Warrant Agreement and the Rights Agreement with Continental, pursuant to which Continental agreed to act as Twelve Seas’ warrant agent with respect to the issuance, registration, transfer, exchange, redemption and exercise of Twelve Seas’ warrants, and to act as Twelve Seas’ rights agent with respect to the issuance, registration, transfer and exchange of Twelve Seas’ rights.

 

On December 20, 2019, the Company, Twelve Seas and Continental entered into the Amendment to Warrant Agreement and Rights Agreement pursuant to which the Company became party to each of the Warrant Agreement and the Rights Agreement and the parties revised the terms of such agreements in order to, amongst other things, reflect the conversion of each Twelve Seas warrant into a warrant of the Company having substantially the same terms and conditions as such original Twelve Seas warrant, and each Twelve Seas right converted into 1/10th of one Ordinary Share of the Company.

 

The description of the Amendment to Warrant Agreement and Rights Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreements and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of (i) the Warrant Agreement, a copy of which was filed by Twelve Seas as Exhibit 4.1 to the Current Report on Form 8-K, filed by Twelve Seas with the SEC on June 25, 2018 and is incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 2.3, (ii) the Rights Agreement, a copy of which was filed by Twelve Seas as Exhibit 4.2 to the Current Report on Form 8-K, filed by Twelve Seas with the SEC on June 25, 2018 and is incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 2.4, and (iii) the Amendment to Warrant Agreement and Rights Agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 2.5.

 

Business Combination Marketing Agreement Fee Amendment

 

Twelve Seas engaged EBC to assist it in connection with Twelve Seas’ initial business combination. Pursuant to this arrangement, EBC assisted Twelve Seas in holding meetings with Twelve Seas shareholders to discuss the Business Combination and BPGIC’s business attributes, introduced Twelve Seas to potential investors that may have been interested in purchasing Twelve Seas’ securities in connection with the Business Combination, assisted Twelve Seas in obtaining shareholder approval for the Business Combination and assisted Twelve Seas with its press releases and certain public filings in connection with the Business Combination. Pursuant to the original agreement, Twelve Seas agreed to pay EBC a cash fee equal to 3.5% of the gross proceeds received in its initial public offering for such services upon the consummation of its initial business combination (exclusive of any applicable finders’ fees which might become payable); provided that up to 1.0% of the gross proceeds of initial public offering could be allocated at Twelve Seas’ sole discretion to one or more advisors that assisted Twelve Seas in identifying and consummating an initial business combination. Twelve Seas also agreed to reimburse EBC for up to $20,000 of its reasonable costs and expenses incurred by it (including reasonable fees and disbursements of counsel) in connection with the performance of its services pursuant to the agreement; provided, however, all expenses in excess of $5,000 in the aggregate required Twelve Seas’ prior written approval, which approval would not be unreasonably withheld.

 

135

 

 

Pursuant to the Business Combination Agreement, on December 20, 2019, Twelve Seas, EBC, and the Company entered into the Business Combination Marketing Agreement Fee Amendment (the “BCMA Fee Amendment”) whereby the Company became party to the Business Combination Marketing Agreement solely with respect to the provision relating to EBC’s fees and EBC’s fees were amended. Pursuant to the Business Combination Marketing Agreement, as amended by the BCMA Fee Amendment, EBC received as full payment for any and all fees under the Business Combination Marketing Agreement, a cash fee equal to $3 million and a $1.5 million non-interest bearing promissory note of the Company due and payable on the earlier of (i) the first anniversary of the Closing and (ii) the consummation by the Company of a follow-on securities offering. After an event of default, the promissory note would bear interest at the rate of 10% per annum.

 

The description of the BCMA Fee Amendment does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of (i) the Business Combination Marketing Agreement, a copy of the form of which was filed by Twelve Seas as Exhibit 1.2 to the Registration Statement on Form S-1/A (File No. 001-225352), filed with the SEC on June 14, 2018 and is incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.13, (ii) the BCMA Fee Amendment, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.78, and (iii) the $1,500,000 Promissory Note issued to EBC, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.79.

 

Voting Agreement

 

Pursuant to the Business Combination Agreement, BPGIC Holdings and the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders entered into the Voting Agreement, dated December 20, 2019 in favor of BPGIC Holdings (the “Voting Agreement”). The Voting Agreement applies to the Ordinary Shares and other voting securities of the Company issued to the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders upon the consummation of the Business Combination (including upon the conversion, exercise, exchange of their securities in Twelve Seas) as well as other securities the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders acquired or agreed to acquire up to and including the time of Closing (collectively, the “Subject Shares”). The Voting Agreement provides that from and after the Closing until the Voting Agreement terminates with respect to each Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder, at each meeting of the shareholders of the Company and in each written consent or resolutions of the Company shareholders in which an Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder is entitled to vote, consent or approve, such Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder unconditionally and irrevocably agrees to be present for such meeting and vote its Subject Shares (in person or by proxy), as directed by BPGIC Holdings, or consent to any action by written consent or resolution with respect to all such matters, as directed by BPGIC Holdings. The Voting Agreement terminates upon the earlier to occur of (i) the mutual written consent of BPGIC Holdings and the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders and (ii) with respect to any Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder, automatically on the date such Initial Twelve Seas Shareholder no longer holds any Subject Shares.

 

The description of the Voting Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.73.

 

Dividend Waivers

 

Prior to the Closing, BPGIC Holdings, MENA Energy, the Twelve Seas Insiders and certain assignees of EBC (collectively the “Waiving Holders”) signed and delivered to the Company dividend waivers pursuant to which such Waiving Holders waived, for a period of two years from the date of Closing (the “Waiver Term”), their rights to any dividends with respect to (i) the Ordinary Shares received by BPGIC Holdings in exchange for the outstanding equity of BPGIC, (ii) the Founders’ Shares, and (iii) the ordinary shares issued to EBC and its affiliates in connection with Twelve Seas’ initial public offering. Each dividend waiver terminates upon the earliest to occur of (i) the expiration of the Waiver Term, and (ii) with respect to the Twelve Seas Insiders and EBC, if the Company and/or BPGIC Holdings or MENA Energy modify their waiver of their rights to dividends in any way.

 

136

 

 

The description of the Dividend Waiver does not purport to summarize all of the provisions thereof and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such waiver, a copy of the form of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.80.

 

Amendment to Phase I Construction Facilities Letter

 

On December 30, 2019, BPGIC and FAB agreed to amend the Phase I Construction Facilities to defer the installments due thereunder to later dates. The key changes resulting from the amendment were as follows:

 

1. an amount of $5,729,417.50 which was due on November 30, 2019 will now be repayable on February 28, 2020;

 

2. an amount of $1,765,553.50 which was due on January 31, 2020 will now be payable in two installments: $882,776.75 on January 31, 2020 and $882,776.75 on February 28, 2020; and

 

3. the Debt Service Reserve Account to be created by February 28, 2020; and

 

4. testing of the Debt Service Coverage Ratio covenant to start on February 28, 2020 and to be conducted on each subsequent due date.

 

The description of the December 30, 2019 amendment to the Phase I Construction Facilities does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.82.

 

BPGIC did not comply with the terms of the Phase I Construction Facilities as amended on December 30, 2019. A payment of principal and interest of $6.6 Million for the Phase I Construction Facility due on February 28, 2020 was not paid. Payments of principal and interest totaling $2.2 Million for the Phase I Construction Facility and the Phase I Admin Building Facility due on April 30, 2020 were not made. The Debt Service Reserve Account did not maintain a balance in an amount equivalent to one quarterly instalment including interest by February 28, 2020. BPGIC did not maintain a minimum Debt Service Coverage Ratio of 150% beginning on February 28, 2020. These non-payments and failures to comply with covenants were events of default, but, as in the past, the lender did not declare an event of default.

 

On June 15, 2020, BPGIC entered into the June 15 Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment with its lender to amend the Phase I Construction Facilities.

 

137

 

 

Pursuant to the June 15, Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, BPGIC and the lender agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Construction Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from June 30, 2020 through December 31, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
June 30, 2020   $2.99 Million
July 31, 2020   $3.62 Million
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $1.01 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $3.87 Million
Total   $11.9 Million by end of 2020

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 30, 2030, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $1.77 Million

 

Pursuant to the June 15, Phase I Construction Facilities Amendment, BPGIC and the lender also agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Admin Building Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from August 31, 2020 through December 21, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $0.41 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $0.80 Million
Total   $1.63 Million by end of 2020

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 31, 2021, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $0.54 Million.

 

Testing of the Debt Service Ratio Covenant will start on December 31, 2020 and will be conducted on each subsequent payment date. A Debt Service Reserve Account containing at least 1 quarter of debt service amounts must be maintained with the lender by October 31, 2020 and at all times thereafter through the term of the Phase I Construction Facility or until BPGIC repays all liabilities owed under the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC pledged the account to the lender as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC, The Company and BPGIC Holdings undertook to have no other bank accounts except for the one that is the Debt Service Reserve Account until the Phase I Construction Facilities are repaid and to route all funds through the Debt Service Reserve Account. BPGIC further granted the lender a non-possessory mortgage over the Phase I Customer Agreement as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities.

 

138

 

 

Also pursuant to this amendment, BPGIC negotiated revised pricing terms as follows:

 

o Phase I Construction Facility: Enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021; and

 

o Phase I Admin Building Facility: Enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021.

 

There is no change in the final maturity of Phase I Construction Facility which is July 30, 2030 and Phase I Admin Building Facility which is July 31, 2023. BPGIC

 

The description of the Amendment to Phase I Construction Facilities Letter, does not purport to summarize all of the provisions thereof and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, the Movable Asset Mortgage, dated as of June 15, 2020, by and between BPGIC and FAB and the Account Pledge (First Party), dated as of June 15, 2020, by and between BPGIC and FAB, copies of which are attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibits 4.93, 4.94 and 4.95, respectively.

 

Phase III Land Lease

 

On February 2, 2020, BPGIC entered into the Phase III Land Lease Agreement to secure the Phase III Land, a new plot of land of approximately 450,000 m2 near its existing facilities. The agreement provides for an initial 30 year term with an automatic 30 year renewal. Upon mutual agreement of the parties, the term of the Phase I & II Land Lease can be renewed or extended for a further period, the term of which is unspecified and therefore subject to agreement between the parties. BPGIC will begin paying rent under the Phase III Land Lease Agreement on the earlier of the date that is 18 months from the date of the Phase III Land Lease Agreement and the commissioning of the Phase III facility. The initial annual rent will be $6,126,467 and rent increases by 2 percent per annum. All amounts in respect of rent for each quarter shall be invoiced by and paid to FOIZ in Dirhams by immediately available funds due net thirty (30) days after receipt of invoice. BPGIC is required to pay all taxes imposed by the federal government of the UAE or FOIZ; however, the leased premises are in a free zone and BPGIC is entitled to all benefits applying to free zone entities, including benefits in respect of taxes.

 

BPGIC believes that the Phase III Land can house additional storage capacity and refinery of up to 3,500,000 m3. The Phase III Land is the subject of ongoing FEED studies, which, in parallel with prospective end-user discussions, will enable BPGIC to determine the optimal layout and product mix. Currently, BPGIC plans to use the Phase III Land to further increase its crude oil storage and refinery services capacity.

 

The description of the Phase III Land Lease Agreement does not purport to summarize all of the provisions of the agreement and is qualified in its entirety by reference to the full text of such agreement, a copy of which is attached hereto and incorporated by reference herein as Exhibit 4.85.

 

139

 

 

D. Exchange Controls and Other Limitations Affecting Security Holders

 

Under the laws of the Cayman Islands, there are currently no restrictions on the export or import of capital, including foreign exchange controls or restrictions that affect the remittance of dividends, interest or other payments to nonresident holders of our Ordinary Shares.

 

E. Taxation

 

The following description is not intended to constitute a complete analysis of all tax consequences relating to the ownership and disposition of our securities. You should consult your own tax advisor concerning the tax consequences of your particular situation, as well as any tax consequences that may arise under the laws of any state, local, foreign or other taxing jurisdiction.

 

United States of America

 

This section is addressed to U.S. Holders of ordinary shares of the Company. Unless otherwise indicated, “ordinary shares” refers to ordinary shares of the Company.

 

Taxation of Dividends and Other Distributions on Ordinary Shares

 

Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, the gross amount of distributions made by the Company to you with respect to its ordinary shares (including the amount of any taxes withheld therefrom) will generally be includable in your gross income as dividend income on the date of receipt by you, but only to the extent that the distribution is paid out of the Company’s current or accumulated earnings and profits (as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles). With respect to corporate U.S. Holders, the dividends will generally not be eligible for the dividends-received deduction allowed to corporations in respect of dividends received from other U.S. corporations.

 

With respect to non-corporate U.S. Holders, including individual U.S. Holders, dividends will be taxed at the lower capital gains rate applicable to qualified dividend income, provided that (1) our ordinary shares are readily tradable on an established securities market in the United States, or the Company is eligible for the benefits of an approved qualifying income tax treaty with the United States that includes an exchange of information program, (2) the Company is not a passive foreign investment company (as discussed below) for either the taxable year in which the dividend is paid or the preceding taxable year, and (3) certain holding period requirements are met. You are urged to consult your tax advisors regarding the availability of the lower rate for dividends paid with respect to the Company’s ordinary shares.

 

To the extent that the amount of the distribution exceeds the Company’s current and accumulated earnings and profits (as determined under U.S. federal income tax principles), it will be treated first as a tax-free return of your tax basis in your ordinary shares, and to the extent the amount of the distribution exceeds your tax basis, the excess will be taxed as capital gain. We do not intend to calculate the Company’s earnings and profits under U.S. federal income tax principles.

 

Therefore, a U.S. Holder should expect that a distribution will be treated as a dividend even if that distribution would otherwise be treated as a non-taxable return of capital or as capital gain under the rules described above.

 

140

 

 

Taxation of Dispositions of the Company’s Ordinary Shares

 

Subject to the passive foreign investment company rules discussed below, you will recognize taxable gain or loss on any sale, exchange or other taxable disposition of a Company ordinary share equal to the difference between the amount realized (in U.S. dollars) for the ordinary share and your tax basis (in U.S. dollars) in the ordinary share. The gain or loss will be capital gain or loss. If you are a non-corporate U.S. Holder, including an individual U.S. Holder, who has held the ordinary shares for more than one year, you may be eligible for reduced tax rates on any such capital gains. The deductibility of capital losses is subject to limitations.

 

Passive Foreign Investment Company

 

A foreign (i.e., non-U.S.) corporation will be a PFIC for U.S. tax purposes if at least 75% of its gross income in a taxable year of such foreign corporation, including its pro rata share of the gross income of any corporation in which it is considered to own at least 25% of the shares by value, is passive income. Alternatively, a foreign corporation will be a PFIC if at least 50% of its assets in a taxable year, ordinarily determined based on fair market value and averaged quarterly over the year, including its pro rata share of the assets of any corporation in which it is considered to own at least 25% of the shares by value, are held for the production of, or produce, passive income. Passive income generally includes dividends, interest, rents and royalties (other than certain rents or royalties derived from the active conduct of a trade or business) and gains from the disposition of passive assets. In determining the value and composition of its assets for purposes of the PFIC asset test, (1) the cash the Company owns at any time will generally be considered to be held for the production of passive income and (2) the value of the Company’s assets must be determined based on the market value of its ordinary shares from time to time, which could cause the value of its non-passive assets to be less than 50% of the value of all of its assets (including cash) on any particular quarterly testing date for purposes of the asset test.

 

A determination as to whether the Company is a PFIC with respect to any particular tax year will be made following the end of such tax year. If the Company is a PFIC for any year during which you hold the Company’s ordinary shares, it will continue to be treated as a PFIC for all succeeding years during which you hold ordinary shares. However, if the Company ceases to be a PFIC and you did not previously make a timely “mark-to-market” election as described below, you may avoid some of the adverse effects of the PFIC regime by making a “purging election” (as described below) with respect to the ordinary shares.

 

141

 

 

If the Company is determined to be a PFIC for any taxable year (or portion thereof) that is included in the holding period of a U.S. Holder of the Company securities and, in the case of the ordinary shares, the U.S. Holder did not make a timely “mark-to-market” election, as described below, such holder generally will be subject to special rules for regular U.S. federal income tax purposes with respect to:

 

  any gain recognized by the U.S. Holder on the sale or other disposition of the Company securities; and

 

  any “excess distribution” made to the U.S. Holder (generally, any distributions to such U.S. Holder during a taxable year of the U.S. Holder that are greater than 125% of the average annual distributions received by such U.S. Holder in respect of the Company securities during the three preceding taxable years of such U.S. Holder or, if shorter, such U.S. Holder’s holding period for such securities).

 

Under these rules,

 

  the U.S. Holder’s gain or excess distribution will be allocated ratably over the U.S. Holder’s holding period for such securities;

 

  the amount allocated to the U.S. Holder’s taxable year in which the U.S. Holder recognized the gain or received the excess distribution, or to the period in the U.S. Holder’s holding period before the first day of the Company’s first taxable year in which it is a PFIC, will be taxed as ordinary income;

 

  the amount allocated to other taxable years (or portions thereof) of the U.S. Holder and included in its holding period will be taxed at the highest tax rate in effect for that year and applicable to the U.S. Holder; and

 

  the interest charge generally applicable to underpayments of tax will be imposed in respect of the tax attributable to each such other taxable year(s) of the U.S. Holder.

 

142

 

 

If a U.S. Holder, at the close of its taxable year, owns (or is deemed to own) shares in a PFIC that are treated as marketable shares, the U.S. Holder may make a “mark-to-market” election with respect to such shares for such taxable year. If the U.S. Holder makes a valid mark-to-market election for the first taxable year of the U.S. Holder in which the U.S. Holder holds (or is deemed to hold) Company ordinary shares and for which the Company is determined to be a PFIC, such holder generally will not be subject to the PFIC rules described above in respect to its ordinary shares as long as such shares continue to be treated as marketable shares. Instead, in general, the U.S. Holder will include as ordinary income each year that the Company is treated as a PFIC the excess, if any, of the fair market value of such U.S. Holder’s ordinary shares at the end of its taxable year over the adjusted basis in its ordinary shares. The U.S. Holder also will be allowed to take an ordinary loss in respect of the excess, if any, of the adjusted basis of its Ordinary Shares over the fair market value of such shares at the end of the U.S. Holder’s taxable year (but only to the extent of the net amount of previously included income as a result of the mark-to-market election). The U.S. Holder’s adjusted tax basis in its ordinary shares will be adjusted to reflect any such income or loss amounts, and any further gain recognized on a sale or other taxable disposition of the shares in a taxable year in which the Company is treated as a PFIC will be treated as ordinary income. Special tax rules may also apply if a U.S. Holder makes a mark-to-market election for a taxable year after the first taxable year in which the U.S. Holder holds (or is deemed to hold) ordinary shares and for which the Company is treated as a PFIC.

 

The mark-to-market election is available only for stock that is regularly traded on a national securities exchange that is registered with the Securities and Exchange Commission, including Nasdaq Capital Market, or on a foreign exchange or market that the IRS determines has rules sufficient to ensure that the market price represents a legitimate and sound fair market value. U.S. Holders should consult their own tax advisors regarding the availability and tax consequences of a mark-to-market election in respect to the Company’s ordinary shares under their particular circumstances.

 

Alternatively, a U.S. Holder of stock in a PFIC may make a “qualified electing fund” election with respect to such PFIC to elect out of the tax treatment discussed above. A U.S. Holder who makes a valid qualified electing fund election with respect to a PFIC will generally include in gross income for a taxable year such holder’s pro rata share of the corporation’s earnings and profits for the taxable year. However, the qualified electing fund election is available only if such PFIC provides such U.S. Holder with certain information regarding its earnings and profits as required under applicable U.S. Treasury regulations. The Company does not currently intend to prepare or provide the information that would enable you to make a qualified electing fund election. If you hold ordinary shares in any taxable year in which the Company is a PFIC, you will be required to file U.S. Internal Revenue Service Form 8621 in each such year and provide certain annual information regarding such ordinary shares, including regarding distributions received on the ordinary shares and any gain realized on the disposition of the ordinary shares.

 

If you do not make a timely “mark-to-market” election (as described above), and if the Company were a PFIC at any time during the period you hold its ordinary shares, then such ordinary shares will continue to be treated as stock of a PFIC with respect to you even if the Company ceases to be a PFIC in a future year, unless you make a “purging election” for the year we cease to be a PFIC. A “purging election” creates a deemed sale of such ordinary shares at their fair market value on the last day of the last year in which the Company is treated as a PFIC. The gain recognized by the purging election will be subject to the special tax and interest charge rules treating the gain as an excess distribution, as described above. As a result of the purging election, you will have a new basis (equal to the fair market value of the ordinary shares on the last day of the last year in which the Company is treated as a PFIC) and holding period (which new holding period will begin the day after such last day) in your ordinary shares for tax purposes.

 

The rules dealing with PFICs and with the QEF and mark-to-market elections are very complex and are affected by various factors in addition to those described above. Accordingly, you are urged to consult your tax advisors regarding the application of the PFIC rules to your investment in the Company’s ordinary shares and the elections discussed above.

 

143

 

 

Information Reporting and Backup Withholding

 

Certain U.S. Holders are required to report information to the IRS relating to an interest in “specified foreign financial assets,” including shares issued by a non-U.S. corporation, for any year in which the aggregate value of all specified foreign financial assets exceeds US$50,000 (or a higher dollar amount prescribed by the IRS), subject to certain exceptions (including an exception for shares held in custodial accounts maintained with a United States financial institution). These rules also impose penalties if a U.S. Holder is required to submit such information to the IRS and fails to do so.

 

Dividend payments with respect to the Company’s ordinary shares and proceeds from the sale, exchange or redemption of the Company’s ordinary shares may be subject to information reporting to the IRS and possible U.S. backup withholding at a current rate of 24%. Backup withholding will not apply, however, to a U.S. Holder who furnishes a correct taxpayer identification number and makes any other required certification on IRS Form W-9 or who is otherwise exempt from backup withholding. U.S. Holders who are required to establish their exempt status generally must provide such certification on IRS Form W-9. U.S. Holders are urged to consult their tax advisors regarding the application of the U.S. information reporting and backup withholding rules.

 

Backup withholding is not an additional tax. Amounts withheld as backup withholding may be credited against your U.S. federal income tax liability, and you may obtain a refund of any excess amounts withheld under the backup withholding rules by timely filing the appropriate claim for refund with the IRS and timely furnishing any required information. Transactions effected through certain brokers or other intermediaries may be subject to withholding taxes (including backup withholding), and such brokers or intermediaries may be required by law to withhold such taxes.

 

F. Dividends and Paying Agents

 

Not Applicable

 

G. Statement by Experts

 

Not Applicable.

 

H. Documents on Display

 

We are subject to certain of the informational filing requirements of the Exchange Act. Since we are a “foreign private issuer,” we are exempt from the rules and regulations under the Exchange Act prescribing the furnishing and content of proxy statements, and our officers, directors and principal shareholders are exempt from the reporting and “short-swing” profit recovery provisions contained in Section 16 of the Exchange Act, with respect to their purchase and sale of our shares. In addition, we are not required to file reports and financial statements with the SEC as frequently or as promptly as U.S. companies whose securities are registered under the Exchange Act. However, we are required to file with the SEC an Annual Report on Form 20-F containing financial statements audited by an independent accounting firm. The SEC also maintains a website at http://www.sec.gov that contains reports and other information that we file with or furnish electronically with the SEC. You may read and copy any report or document we file, including the exhibits, at the SEC’s public reference room located at 100 F Street, N.E., Washington, D.C. 20549. Please call the SEC at 1-800-SEC-0330 for further information on the public reference room.

 

I. Subsidiary Information

 

Not applicable.

 

144

 

 

ITEM 11. QUANTITATIVE AND QUALITATIVE DISCLOSURES ABOUT MARKET RISKS

  

A. Market Risk Disclosures

 

The main risks arising from the Company’s financial instruments are capital risk, interest rate risk, credit risk, currency risk and liquidity risk. The Senior Management team reviews and agrees on policies for managing each of these risks which are summarized below. The Company’s instruments are entered into for purposes other than trading purposes.

 

B. Capital Risk

 

The Company’s objective when managing capital is to safeguard its ability to continue as a going concern in order to provide returns for holders of Ordinary Shares and benefits for other stakeholders and to maintain an optimal capital structure to reduce the cost of capital.

 

The Company’s capital structure consists of shareholders’ equity and debt, which as disclosed in the audited financial information for the period ended December 31, 2019 includes the borrowings under the Financing Facilities while excluding derivative financial liabilities.

 

Consistent with others in the industry, the Company monitors its debt levels including covenants contained within the Financing Facilities.

 

C. Interest Rate Risk

 

Interest rate risk is the risk that the fair value or future cash flows of a financial instrument will fluctuate because of changes in market interest rates.

 

The Group’s exposure to the risk of changes in market interest rates relates primarily to the Group’s balances with banks and interest bearing loans and borrowings at variable rates.

 

The following table demonstrates the sensitivity to a reasonably possible change in interest rates, with other variables held constant, of the Group’s profit for one year corresponding to the impact of the floating rate borrowings for one year. The effect of the interest rate swap has been excluded from the sensitivity as the Group does not apply hedge accounting.

 

    Effect on
profit
USD
 
       
2019      
       
+40 increase in basis points     347,971  
         
-40 decrease in basis points     (347,971 )
         
2018        
         
+40 increase in basis points     (381,713 )
         
-40 decrease in basis points     381,713  

 

145

 

 

D. Credit Risk

 

Credit risk is the risk that one party to a financial instrument will fail to discharge an obligation and cause the other party to incur a financial loss. The Group is exposed to credit risk on bank balances and receivables as reflected in the consolidated statement of financial position, with a maximum exposure equal to the carrying amount of these instruments. The expected credit loss on trade and other receivables are considered insignificant for 2019 and 2018.

 

The Group has a low credit risk exposure on its trade receivables based on established policy, procedures and controls relating to customer credit risk management. Credit quality of the customer is assessed as part of contract negotiations. Outstanding receivables are regularly monitored. The Group has only one customer as at 31 December 2019 (31 December 2018: one customer).

 

E. Currency Risk

 

The Company does not have any significant exposure to currency risk as most of its contracts, cash activities and financing arrangements are denominated in $ or AED, which is the currency of the UAE and pegged to the $.

 

F. Liquidity Risk

 

The Group monitors its risk to a shortage of funds using a recurring liquidity planning tool. This tool considers projected financing requirements of the Group during the construction phase and cash projections from operations with outstanding bank facilities and outstanding bank commitments as defined under the finance documents.

 

The Group manages its liquidity risk in relation to term loans to ensure compliance with all covenants for each specific facility. Refer note 2.2 for further details.

 

146

 

 

The table below summarizes the maturity profile of the Group’s financial liabilities at 31 December 2019 and 31 December 2018 based on contractual undiscounted payments.

 

    On
demand
USD
    Less than
3 months
USD
    3 months
to 1 year
USD
    1 to 5
years
USD
    > 5 years
USD
    Total
USD
 
                                     
31 December 2019                                    
                                     
Term loans (including accrued interest)     -       8,101,006       9,178,414       34,165,752       40,550,347       91,995,519  
                                                 
Lease liability     -       2,359,590       -       9,919,810       213,469,799       225,749,199  
                                                 
Derivative financial instruments     -       -       1,518,249       -       -       1,518,249  
                                                 
Accounts payable, accruals and other payables (excluding accrued interest)     -       26,350,143       31,469,596       -       -       57,819,739  
                                                 
Total     -       36,810,739       42,166,259       44,085,562       254,020,146       377,082,706  
                                                 
31 December 2018                                                
                                                 
Bank overdraft     3,745,048       -       -       -       -       3,745,048  
                                                 
Term loans (including accrued interest)     95,702,779       -       -       -       -       95,702,779  
                                                 
Lease liability     -       2,313,323       -       9,725,304       216,023,896       228,062,523  
                                                 
Derivative financial instruments     -       -       1,190,073       -       -       1,190,073  
                                                 
Accounts payable, accruals and other payables (excluding accrued interest)     -       2,120,877       5,972,230       -       -       8,093,107  
                                                 
Total     99,447,827       4,434,200       7,162,303       9,725,304       216,023,896       336,793,530  

 

G. Operations Risk

 

The Company’s operations and assets are insured under an insurance program administered by Lockton Insurance Brokers - Dubai, an insurance broker. The program covers the Phase I facilities and related assets, and the liabilities of the Phase I operations and the Company. The major elements of this program are property damage, business interruption, terrorism and political violence, worker’s compensation, environmental liability, employer liability, directors’ and officers’ liability insurance, personal injury and third-party liability, including that of terminal operators. The Company additionally maintains local insurance, including healthcare and other insurance required by the Company’s jurisdiction.

 

Premiums are allocated based on the insured values, history of claims and type of risk. Management believes that the amount of coverage provided is comprehensive and appropriate for the Company’s type of business and meets the standard requirements to comply with all statutory requirements.

 

ITEM 12. DESCRIPTION OF SECURITIES OTHER THAN EQUITY SECURITIES

 

Not applicable.

 

147

 

 

PART II

 

ITEM 13. DEFAULTS, DIVIDEND ARREARAGES AND DELINQUENCIES

 

As of December 31, 2018, the Company had not paid $$3,747,537 of principal and accrued interest that was due under the Company’s Phase I Financing Facilities. Also, as of December 31, 2018, the Company was not in compliance with its debt covenants, including the debt service coverage ratio contained in the Company’s Phase I Financing Facilities. Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the loan agreements, these breaches constituted events of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the loans. Accordingly, as of December 31, 2018, the Company has classified its debt balance of $94,792,088 as a current liability. As of December 31, 2018, the Company’s current liabilities exceeded its current assets by $108,536,113, respectively.

 

On September 10, 2019, the Company entered into an agreement with its lender to amend the Phase I Construction Facility. The principal and accrued interest of $5,494,063 outstanding under this facility as of July 31, 2019 as per the original repayment schedule would be due on November 30, 2019. The Phase I Construction Facility was payable in 45 instalments starting October 31, 2019 with final maturity on July 30, 2030. The Phase I Admin Building Financing Facility and the Phase I Short Term Financing Facility were not amended as part of the September 10, 2019 agreement to amend the Phase I Construction Facility. Subsequent to the period end, the Company had repaid $5,646,206 due under the Phase I Admin Building Facility and the Phase I Short Term Financing Facility. As such, all instalments related to Phase I Admin Building Facility and the Phase I Short Term Financing Facility due under the original repayment schedules up to September 10, 2019 were repaid. In addition, the Company agreed to assign to the lender all proceeds from the operation of the tanks and to pre-settle by December 31, 2019 AED 100,000,000 (($27,225,701) translated using the exchange rate as of December 31, 2019) of principal under the Phase I Construction Facilities from the proceeds received from the Business Combination. Payment of principal and interest due on October 31, 2019 under the Phase I Financing Facilities was not paid in full as a result of recent discussions between the Company and the lender pertaining to more favorable financing terms. This partial non-payment was an event of default, but, as in the past, the lender did not declared an event of default. A payment of principal and interest due on November 30, 2019 under the Phase I Financing Facilities was not paid as a result of recent discussions between BPGIC and lender pertaining to more favorable financing terms.

 

On December 30, 2019, BPGIC and lender agreed to amend the Phase I Construction Facilities to defer the installments due thereunder to later dates. The key changes resulting from the amendment were as follows:

 

1. an amount of $5,729,417.50 which was due on November 30, 2019 will now be repayable on February 28, 2020;

 

2. an amount of $1,765,553.50 which was due on January 31, 2020 will now be payable in two installments: $882,776.75 on January 31, 2020 and $882,776.75 on February 28, 2020; and

 

3. the Debt Service Reserve Account to be created by February 28, 2020; and

 

4. testing of the Debt Service Coverage Ratio covenant to start on February 28, 2020 and to be conducted on each subsequent due date.

 

148

 

 

BPGIC did not comply with the terms of the Phase I Construction Facilities as amended on December 30, 2019. A payment of principal and interest of $6.6 Million for the Phase I Construction Facility due on February 28, 2020 was not paid. Payments of principal and interest totaling $2.2 Million for the Phase I Construction Facility and the Phase I Admin Building Facility due on April 30, 2020 were not made. The Debt Service Reserve Account did not maintain a balance in an amount equivalent to one quarterly instalment including interest by February 28, 2020. BPGIC did not maintain a minimum Debt Service Coverage Ratio of 150% beginning on February 28, 2020. These non-payments and failures to comply with covenants were events of default, but, as in the past, the lender did not declare an event of default.

 

On June 15, 2020, BPGIC entered into an agreement with its lender to amend the Phase I Construction Facilities.

 

BPGIC and the lender agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Construction Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from June 30, 2020 through December 31, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
June 30, 2020   $2.99 Million
July 31, 2020   $3.62 Million
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $1.01 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $3.87 Million
Total   $11.9 Million by end of 2020

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 30, 2030, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $1.77 Million

 

BPGIC and the lender also agreed to a revised payment schedule for the Phase I Admin Building Facility that requires BPGIC to make the following payments from August 31, 2020 through December 21, 2020:

 

Date   Amount
August 31, 2020   $0.14 Million
September 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
October 31, 2020   $0.41 Million
November 30, 2020   $0.14 Million
December 31, 2020   $0.80 Million
Total   $1.63 Million by end of 2020

 

Thereafter, beginning on January 31, 2021 and ending on July 31, 2021, BPGIC will make quarterly payments of approximately $0.54 Million.

 

149

 

 

Testing of the Debt Service Ratio Covenant will start on December 31, 2020 and will be conducted on each subsequent payment date. A Debt Service Reserve Account containing at least 1 quarter of debt service amounts must be maintained with the lender by October 31, 2020 and at all times thereafter through the term of the Phase I Construction Facility or until BPGIC repays all liabilities owed under the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC pledged the account to the lender as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities. BPGIC, The Company and BPGIC Holdings undertook to have no other bank accounts except for the one that is the Debt Service Reserve Account until the Phase I Construction Facilities are repaid and to route all funds through the Debt Service Reserve Account. BPGIC further granted the lender a non-possessory mortgage over the Phase I Customer Agreement as security for the Phase I Construction Facilities.

 

Also pursuant to this amendment, BPGIC negotiated revised pricing terms as follows:

 

o Phase I Construction Facility: Enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 6M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021; and

 

o Phase I Admin Building Facility: Enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4% per annum [Minimum 5%] and to be further enhanced to 3M EIBOR + 4.5% per annum [Minimum 5%] beginning on January 1, 2021.

 

There is no change in the final maturity of Phase I Construction Facility which is July 30, 2030 and Phase I Admin Building Facility which is July 31, 2023.

 

ITEM 14. MATERIAL MODIFICATIONS TO THE RIGHTS OF SECURITY HOLDERS AND USE OF PROCEEDS

 

None

 

ITEM 15. CONTROLS AND PROCEDURES

 

(a) Disclosure Controls and Procedures

 

We maintain disclosure controls and procedures that are designed to provide reasonable assurance that material information required to be disclosed in our reports that we submit under the Exchange Act, is recorded, processed, summarized and reported within the time periods specified in the SEC’s rules and forms, and that such information is accumulated and communicated to our management, including our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer, as appropriate, to allow timely decisions regarding required financial disclosure. In designing and evaluating the disclosure controls and procedures, management recognized that a control system, no matter how well designed and operated, can provide only reasonable, not absolute, assurance that the objectives of the control system are met. Because of the inherent limitations in all control systems, no evaluation of controls can provide absolute assurance that all control issues and instances of fraud, if any, with a company have been detected. Based on their evaluation, our Chief Executive Officer and Chief Financial Officer have concluded that our disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in rules 13(a)-15(e) and 15(d)-15(e) under the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended), were not effective as of the end of the period covered by this Annual Report due to the material weaknesses in our internal control over financial reporting described below:

 

In connection with the preparation and external audit of the Company’s consolidated financial statements as of and for the years ended December 31, 2017, 2018 and 2019, the Company and Ernst and Young, independent registered public accounting firm, noted a material weakness in the Company’s internal control over financial reporting. The material weaknesses identified were (1) a lack of sufficient skilled personnel with requisite IFRS and SEC reporting knowledge and experience and (2) a lack of sufficient entity level and financial reporting policies and procedures that are commensurate with IFRS and SEC reporting requirements. These material weakness could allow errors to go undetected and resulted in corrected and uncorrected audit misstatements.

 

As a result of the identification of these material weakness, the Company will start implementing a number of measures from the second half year of 2020 to address the material weaknesses related to sufficient skilled personnel and internal controls over financial reporting. However, we can give no assurance that our planned remediation will be properly implemented or will be sufficient to eliminate such material weakness or that material weaknesses or significant deficiencies in our internal control over financial reporting will not be identified in the future. Our failure to implement and maintain effective internal controls over financial reporting could result in errors in our financial statements that could result in a restatement of our financial statements, cause us to fail to meet our reporting obligations and cause investors to lose confidence in our reported financial information, which may result in volatility in and a decline in the market price of our securities.

 

150

 

 

(b) Management’s annual report on internal control over financial reporting and (c) Attestation report of the registered public accounting firm.

 

This annual report does not include a report of management’s assessment regarding internal control over financial reporting or an attestation report of the company’s registered public accounting firm due to a transition period established by rules of the Securities and Exchange Commission for newly public companies.

 

(d) Changes in internal control over financial reporting

 

There was no change in our internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by this annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, our internal control over financial reporting.

 

ITEM 16A. AUDIT COMMITTEE FINANCIAL EXPERT

 

The Board of Directors has determined that Abu Bakar Chowdhury qualifies as an “audit committee financial expert,” as that term is defined in Item 16A of Form 20-F and is independent. See “Item 6.A¾Directors, Senior Management and Employees¾Directors and Senior Management” for Mr. Chowdhury’s experience and qualifications.

 

ITEM 16B. CODE OF ETHICS

 

The Company has a Code of Ethics and Business Conduct which establishes the practices that apply to all of our executive officers, directors and employees. The Code of Ethics and Business Conduct codifies the business and ethical principles that will govern all aspects of the Company’s business. A copy of the Company’s Code of Ethics and Business Conduct is filed herewith as an exhibit.

 

ITEM 16C. PRINCIPAL ACCOUNTANT FEES AND SERVICES

 

The audit committee has reviewed and discussed with management the audited financial statements for the year ended December 31, 2019. The audit committee also discussed all the matters required by professional auditing standards to be discussed with the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm, Ernst & Young, the matters required to be discussed by the applicable requirements of the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board and the Securities and Exchange Commission. In addition, the audit committee has received from the independent registered public accounting firm written disclosure required by the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board Ethics and Independence Rule 3526, and has discussed with the independent registered public accounting firm its independence from the Company and its management. Based on its review and discussions, including discussions without management or members of the independent registered public accounting firm present, the audit committee recommended to the Board of Directors of the Company, and the Board has approved, that the audited financial statements be included in the Company’s Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2019.

 

Audit Fees: Brooge Energy – $0.24 million

 

Audit-Related Fees: Nil.

 

Tax Fees: Nil.

 

All Other Fees: Nil.

 

Pre-approval Policy

 

To safeguard the continued independence of the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm, the audit committee has established a policy which requires all audit and non-audit services, subject to a de minimis exception pursuant to SEC Regulation S-X Rule 2-01(c)(7)(i)(C), to be performed by the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm, to be pre-approved by the audit committee prior to such services being performed. The policy also prohibits the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm from providing any services which would impair the accounting firm’s independence. The audit committee does not delegate to management its responsibilities to pre-approve services.

 

All audit services performed by the Company’s independent registered public accounting firm during the year ended December 31, 2019 were approved by the Board of Directors following recommendation of such approval by the audit committee.

 

151

 

 

ITEM 16D. EXEMPTION FROM THE LISTING STANDARDS FOR AUDIT COMMITTEES

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 16E. PURCHASES OF EQUITY SECURITIES BY THE ISSUER AND AFFILIATED PURCHASERS

 

Not applicable.

 

ITEM 16F. CHANGE IN REGISTRANT’S CERTIFYING ACCOUNTANT

 

In connection with the Business Combination, UHY LLP resigned as the independent registered public accounting firm of BPGIC International (f/k/a Twelve Seas Investment Company) effective as of January 8, 2020.

 

The reports of UHY LLP with respect to the audit of the financial statements of BPGIC International (f/k/a Twelve Seas Investment Company) as of December 31, 2018 and for the period from November 30, 2017 (inception) through December 31, 2018, did not contain an adverse opinion or a disclaimer of opinion, nor was such report qualified or modified as to uncertainty, audit scope or accounting principles, except for an explanatory paragraph describing the uncertainty as to BPGIC International’s ability to continue as a going concern.

 

During the period from November 30, 2017 (inception) through December 31, 2018 and the subsequent period through January 8, 2020, the date that UHY LLP resigned as the independent registered public accounting firm of BPGIC International, we did not have any disagreement with UHY LLP on any matter of accounting principles or practices, financial statement disclosure, or auditing scope or procedure.

 

During that time, there were no “reportable events” as set forth in Item 304(a)(1) of Regulation S-K adopted by the Securities and Exchange Commission.

 

We have provided UHY LLP with a copy of this Item 16.F prior to its filing with the Securities and Exchange Commission. UHY LLP has provided a letter to us, dated June 30, 2020 and addressed to the Securities and Exchange Commission, which is attached hereto as Exhibit 15.3 and is hereby incorporated herein by reference.

 

ITEM 16G. CORPORATE GOVERNANCE

 

As a foreign private issuer, the Company may generally follow home country practice with respect to certain matters of corporate governance in lieu of the comparable governance provisions of the Nasdaq Listing Rules, except for certain matters including the composition and responsibilities of the audit committee and the independence of its members within the meaning of the rules and regulations of the SEC.

 

152

 

 

The Company follows home country practice in lieu of Nasdaq corporate governance requirements with respect to the following Nasdaq requirements:

 

Executive Sessions. We are not required to and, in reliance on home country practice, we may not, comply with certain Nasdaq rules requiring the Company’s independent directors to meet in regularly scheduled executive sessions at which only independent directors are present. The Company follows Cayman Islands practice which does not require independent directors to meet regularly in executive sessions separate from the full board of directors.

 

Nomination of Directors. The Company’s director nominees may not be selected or recommended for the board of director’s selection by either (i) independent directors constituting a majority of the board’s independent directors in a vote in which only independent directors participate, or (ii) a nominations committee comprised solely of independent directors, as required under Nasdaq rules. The Company follows Cayman Islands practice which does not require director nominations to be made or recommended solely by independent directors. Further, the Company does not have a formal written charter or board resolution addressing the director nominations process. The Company follows Cayman Islands practice which does not require the Company to have a formal written charter or board resolution addressing the director nominations process.

 

Proxy Statements. We are not required to and, in reliance on home country practice, we may not, comply with certain Nasdaq rules regarding the provision of proxy statements for general meetings of shareholders. The Company will follow Cayman Islands practice which does not impose a regulatory regime for the solicitation of proxies.

 

Shareholder Approval. The Company is not required to and, in reliance on home country practice, it does not intend to, comply with certain Nasdaq rules regarding shareholder approval for certain issuances of securities under Nasdaq Rule 5635. In accordance with the provisions of the Company’s Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association, the Company’s board of directors is authorized to issue securities, including Ordinary Shares, warrants and convertible notes.

 

ITEM 16H. MINE SAFETY DISCLOSURE

 

Not applicable.

 

153

 

 

PART III

 

ITEM 17. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

See Item 18.

 

ITEM 18. FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

The consolidated financial statements of the Company, together with the report of the independent registered public accounting firm are included as the “F” pages to this annual report.

 

ITEM 19. EXHIBITS

 

EXHIBIT INDEX

 

Exhibit
No.
  Description
1.1*   Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association of Brooge Energy Limited.
2.1*   Specimen Ordinary Share Certificate of Brooge Energy Limited.
2.2*   Specimen Warrant Certificate of Brooge Energy Limited.
2.3   Warrant Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, between Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company and Twelve Seas Investment Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.1 of Twelve Seas Investment Company’s Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
2.4   Rights Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, between Twelve Seas Investment Company and Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 of Twelve Seas Investment Company’s Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
2.5   Amendment to Warrant Agreement and Rights Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2019, by and among Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company, Twelve Seas Investment Company, and Brooge Holdings Limited. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.5 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
2.6*  

Description of the Registrant’s Securities.

4.1   Letter Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, by and between Twelve Seas and Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
4.2   Letter Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, by and between Twelve Seas and Dimitri Elkin (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.6 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
4.3   Letter Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, by and between Twelve Seas, Gregory A. Stoupnitzky and Suneel G. Kaji (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
4.4   Letter Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, by and between Twelve Seas, Neil Richardson, Stephen A. Vogel, Bryant B. Edwards and Stephen N. Cannon (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.8 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
4.5   Investment Management Trust Account Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, between Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company and Twelve Seas (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).

 

154

 

 

4.6   Registration Rights Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, among Twelve Seas, Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC, Gregory Stoupnitzky, Suneel G. Kaji and EarlyBirdCapital, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.2 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
4.7   Share Escrow Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, by and among Twelve Seas, Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC, Gregory Stoupnitzky, Suneel G. Kaji and Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.3 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
4.8   Rights Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, between Twelve Seas and Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.2 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
4.9   Securities Subscription Agreement, dated December 11, 2017, between Twelve Seas and Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.5 of Twelve Seas’ Form S-1 (File No. 333-225352), filed with the SEC on June 1, 2018).
4.10   Amended and Restated Unit Subscription Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, by and between the Registrant and the Initial Shareholders for founders’ units (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.4 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
4.11   Form of Indemnity Agreement (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 of Twelve Seas’ Form S-1/A (File No. 333-225352), filed with the SEC on June 14, 2018).
4.12   Administrative Services Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, between Twelve Seas and Twelve Seas Capital, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.9 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on June 25, 2018).
4.13   Form of Business Combination Marketing Agreement between Twelve Seas and EarlyBirdCapital, Inc. (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 1.2 of Twelve Seas’ Form S-1/A (File No. 001-225352), filed with the SEC on June 14, 2018).
4.14   Letter Agreement, dated as of April 15, 2019, by and among Twelve Seas Investment Company, Brooge Petroleum And Gas Investment Company FZE, Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC, Suneel G. Kaji and Gregory Stoupnitzky (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on April 19, 2019).
4.15   Sponsor Promissory Note, dated December 11, 2017 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.7 of Twelve Seas’ Form S-1 (File No. 333-225352), filed with the SEC on June 1, 2018).
4.16   Sponsor Promissory Note, dated April 4, 2019 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on April 5, 2019).
4.17   Land Lease Agreement, dated March 10, 2013, by and between Fujairah Municipality and Brooge Petroleum & Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.20 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.18   Novation Agreement, dated September 1, 2014, by and among Fujairah Municipality, Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, and Brooge Petroleum & Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.21 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.19   Access to and Use of Port Facilities Agreement, undated, by and between Port of Fujairah and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.22 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.20#   Offer Letter, dated April 6, 2014, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and BPGIC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.23 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.21   Offer Letter (Addendum), dated July 24, 2014, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.24 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.22   Offer Letter (Addendum), dated November 13, 2014, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.25 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).

 

155

 

 

4.23   Offer Letter (Addendum), dated December 31, 2014, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.26 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.24#   No Objection Letter in Respect of the Oil Storage Terminal Project, dated April 13, 2015, by and between Fujairah Oil Industry Zone and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.27 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.25   Offer Letter (Addendum), dated June 24, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.28 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.26   Master Istisna’ Agreement, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.29 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.27#   Offer Letter, dated June 29, 2015 by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.30 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.28   Master Forward Lease Agreement, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.31 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.29   Forward Lease, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.32 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.30#†   Common Terms Agreement, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.33 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.31   Commercial Mortgage, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.34 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.32   Assignment of Contracts, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.35 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.33#†   Investment Agency Agreement, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.36 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.34   Service Agency Agreement, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.37 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.35   Purchase Undertaking, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.38 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.36   Sale Undertaking, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.39 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).

 

156

 

 

4.37   Seller Option Deed, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.40 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.38#   Account Pledge and Assignment, dated June 29, 2015, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.41 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.39   Conditional Waiver Letter, dated June 29, 2015 by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.42 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.40#   Common User Pipe Rack 3 Concession Agreement, dated March 31, 2016, by and between Port of Fujairah and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.43 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.41#†   The Service Agreement, dated April 1, 2017, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company and Flowi Facility Management LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.44 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.42#   Facility Offer Letter, dated April 9, 2017, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.45 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.43   Addendum to Forward Lease, dated April 26, 2017, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.46 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.44   Agreement, dated April 27, 2017, by and between National Bank of Abu Dhabi, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.47 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.45   Employment Agreement, dated May 21, 2017, by and between Nicolaas Paardenkooper and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.48 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.46   Employment Agreement Annexure, dated January 8, 2018, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC and Nicolaas Paardenkooper (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.49 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.47#   Facility Offer Letter, dated June 4, 2018, by and between First Abu Dhabi Bank, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.50 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.48   Murabaha Agreement for the Sale and Purchase of Commodities, undated, by and between First Abu Dhabi Bank, PJSC-Islamic Banking Division and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.51 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.48   Letter of Condition Waiver, dated June 21, 2018, by and between First Abu Dhabi Bank and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.52 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.49   Letter Agreement for Renewal of Service Agreement, dated July 1, 2018, by and between Flowi Facility Management LLC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.53 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.50   Contract for the Provision of Project Management Consultancy (PMC) Services Agreement, dated July 26, 2018, by and between MUC Oil & Gas Engineering Consultancy and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.54 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.51#†   The Contract Agreement, dated September 3, 2018, by and between Audex Fujairah LL FZE and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.55 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).

 

157

 

 

4.52   Master Istisna’ Agreement, dated October 15, 2018, by and between First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.56 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.53   Master Forward Lease Agreement, dated October 15, 2018, by and between First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.57 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.54#†   Common Terms Agreement, dated October 15, 2018, by and between First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.58 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.55   Title Agency Agreement, dated October 15, 2018, by and between First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.59 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.56   Indemnity Undertaking, dated October 15, 2018, by and between First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.60 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.57#   Refinery and Services Agreement, dated March 13, 2019 by and between Sahara Energy Resources DMCC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.61 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.58   Business Combination Agreement, dated April 15, 2019, by and among Twelve Seas, the Company, Merger Sub, BPGIC, and BPGIC Holdings entered into that certain Business Combination Agreement, pursuant to which BPGIC Holdings Limited (as assignee of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC), as amended (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 2.1 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.59   Escrow Agreement, dated as of May 10, 2019, by and among Brooge Holdings Limited, BPGIC Holdings Limited (as assignee of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC), and Continental Stock Transfer and Trust Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of Twelve Seas’ Form 8-K (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on May 13, 2019).
4.60   Joint Development Agreement, dated May 14, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and Sahara Energy Resources DMCC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.62 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.61   Chief Financial Officer Employment Offer Letter, dated May 27, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and Saleh Mohamed Yammout (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.65 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.62   Addendum to Joint Development Agreement, dated June 1, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and Sahara Energy Resources DMCC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.63 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.63   Second Addendum to Joint Development Agreement, dated July 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and Sahara Energy Resources DMCC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.64 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.64   Land Lease Initial Agreement, dated July 14, 2019 by and between Fujairah Oil Industry Zone and Brooge Petroleum & Gas Investment Company FZE (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.66 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.65   Employment Agreement, dated May 1, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and Lina Saheb (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.67 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.66#   Main Terminal Lease and Offtake Agreement - Phase I, dated August 1, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company and Al Brooge International Advisory LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.69 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.67   Chief Marketing Officer Employment Offer Letter, dated August 28, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and Faisal Elsaied Selim Hussain (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.70 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).

 

158

 

 

4.68   Third Addendum to Joint Development Agreement, dated September 6, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Investment Company FZE and Sahara Energy Resources DMCC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.68 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.69   Amendment to Facility Letter, dated September 10, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.71 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.70#   Main Terminal and Lease Offtake Agreement - Phase II, September 20, 2019, by and between by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company and Al Brooge International Advisory LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.72 of Brooge Holdings Limited’s Form F-4/A (File No. 333-233964), filed with the SEC on November 21, 2019).
4.71   Promissory Note, dated October 21, 2019, issued to Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 10.1 of Twelve Seas Investment Company’s Form 10-Q (File No. 001-38540), filed with the SEC on October 25, 2019).
4.72†   First Amendment to Escrow Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2019, by and among Brooge Holdings Limited, BPGIC Holdings Limited (as assignee of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company (BPGIC) PLC), and Continental Stock Transfer and Trust Company (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.72 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.73   Voting Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2019, by and among BPGIC Holdings Limited, Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC, Gregory Stoupnitzky and Suneel G. Kaji (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.73 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.74†   Amended and Restated Founders’ Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2019, by and among Brooge Holdings Limited, Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC, EarlyBirdCapital, Inc., Gregory Stoupnitzky and Suneel Kaji (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.74 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.75   Amendment to Share Escrow Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2019, by and among Brooge Holdings Limited, Twelve Seas Investment Company, Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC, Suneel G. Kaji and Gregory Stoupnitzky (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.75 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.76   BPGIC Registration Rights Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2019, by and between Brooge Holdings Limited and BPGIC Holdings Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.76 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.77†   Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement, dated as of December 20, 2019, by and between Brooge Holdings Limited, Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC, Suneel G. Kaji and Gregory Stoupnitzky (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.77 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).

 

159

 

 

4.78   Business Combination Marketing Agreement Fee Amendment, dated as of December 20, 2019, by and among Brooge Holdings Limited, Twelve Seas Investment Company and EarlyBirdCapital, Inc (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.78 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.79   $1,500,000 Promissory Note issued to EarlyBirdCapital, Inc., dated as of December 20, 2019 (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.79 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.80   Form of Dividend Waiver (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.80 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.81   Amendment to Promissory Notes dated October 21, 2019 and April 4, 2019, issued to Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.81 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.82   Amendment to Phase I Construction Facilities Letter, dated December 30, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.82 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.83   Limited Waiver of Initial Shareholder Escrow Agreement Earn-Out Conditions, dated as of December 17, 2019, by and between Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC and Brooge Holdings Limited (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.83 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.84   Amendment to the Master Forward Lease Agreement, dated as of December 29, 2019, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 4.84 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
4.85*#   Land Lease Agreement, dated as of February 2, 2020, by and between Fujairah Oil Industry Zone and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE.
4.86*   Refinery Agreement, dated as of February 23, 2020, by and between Al Brooge International Advisory LLC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE
4.87*   Extension of Refinery Agreement, dated April 2020, by and between Al Brooge International Advisory LLC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE.
4.88*   Extension of Refinery Agreement, dated June 2, 2020, by and between Al Brooge International Advisory LLC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE.
4.89*   Deed of Agreement, dated as of April 21, 2020, by and between Al Brooge International Advisory LLC and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE.
4.90*#   Commercial Storage Agreement, dated as of April 22, 2020, by and between Totsa Total Oil Trading SA and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE.
4.91*#   Proposal for Front End Engineering Design (FEED), dated April 20, 2020, by and between MUC Oil & Gas Engineering Consultancy and Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company.
4.92*  

Chief Financial Officer Offer Letter, dated as of April 27, 2020, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and Syed Masood Ali.

4.93*  

Amendment to Phase I Construction Facilities Letter, dated June 15, 2020, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC.

4.94*  

Movable Asset Mortgage, dated as of June 15, 2020, by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC.

4.95*  

Account Pledge (First Party), dated as of June 15, 2020, by and between by and between Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE and First Abu Dhabi Bank PJSC.

8.1*   List of Subsidiaries of the Company
11.1   Code of Ethics and Business Conduct (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 11.1 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).

 

160

 

 

12.1*   Certification of the Principal Executive Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
12.2*   Certification of the Principal Financial Officer pursuant to Rule 13a-14(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934.
13.1*   Certification of the Principal Executive Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. 1350.
13.2*   Certification of the Principal Financial Officer pursuant to 18 U.S.C. 1350.
15.1   Audit Committee Charter (incorporated by reference to Exhibit 15.1 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
15.2   Compensation Committee Charter incorporated by reference to Exhibit 15.2 of Brooge Energy Limited’s Shell Company Report on Form 20-F (File No. 001-39171), filed with the SEC on December 30, 2019).
15.3*   Letter from UHY LLP.
     
101.INS   XBRL Instance Document
101.SCH   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Schema Document
101.CAL   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Calculation Linkbase Document
101.DEF   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Definition Linkbase Document
101.LAB   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Label Linkbase Document
101.PRE   XBRL Taxonomy Extension Presentation Linkbase Document

 

* Filed Herewith

 

# Certain information has been redacted from this exhibit pursuant to Item 4 of the Instructions As To Exhibits of Form 20-F because it is both not material and would likely cause competitive harm to the registrant if publicly disclosed. The Registrant hereby agrees to furnish an unredacted copy of the exhibit and its materiality and competitive harm analyses to the Commission upon request.

 

Schedules to this exhibit have been omitted pursuant to the Instructions As To Exhibits of Form 20-F. The Registrant hereby agrees to furnish a copy of any omitted schedules to the Commission upon request.

 

+ The certifications attached as Exhibits 13.1 and 13.2 that accompany this Form 20-F are not deemed filed with the Securities and Exchange Commission and are not to be incorporated by reference into any filing of Brooge Energy Limited under the Securities Act or the Exchange Act, whether made before or after the date of this Form 20-F, irrespective of any general incorporation language contained in such filing.

 

161

 

  

SIGNATURES

 

The registrant hereby certifies that it meets all of the requirements for filing on Form 20-F and that it has duly caused and authorized the undersigned to sign this report on its behalf.

 

  BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED
   
June 30, 2020 By: /s/ Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper
    Name: Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper
    Title: Chief Executive Officer

 

162

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

(Formerly Brooge Holdings Limited)

 

CONSOLIDATED FINANCIAL STATEMENTS

 

31 DECEMBER 2019

 

F-1 

 

  

To the Shareholders and the Board of Directors of Brooge Energy Limited

 

Opinion on the Financial Statements

 

We have audited the accompanying consolidated statements of financial position of Brooge Energy Limited (the “Company”) as of 31 December 2019 and 2018, the related consolidated statements of comprehensive income, changes in equity and cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 31 December 2019, and the related notes (collectively referred to as the “consolidated financial statements”). In our opinion, the consolidated financial statements present fairly, in all material respects, the financial position of the Company at 31 December 2019 and 2018, and the results of its operations and its cash flows for each of the three years in the period ended 31 December 2019, in conformity with International Financial Reporting Standards (IFRS) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board.

 

The Company’s Ability to Continue as a Going Concern

 

The accompanying consolidated financial statements have been prepared assuming that the Company will continue as a going concern. As discussed in note 2.2 to the consolidated financial statements, the Company has a working capital deficiency and may not be able to repay debt instalments and capital expenditure requirements from projected financial resources. These conditions raise substantial doubt about the Company’s ability to continue as a going concern. Management’s evaluation of the events and conditions and management’s plans regarding these matters also are described in note 2.2. The consolidated financial statements do not include any adjustments that might result from the outcome of this uncertainty.

 

Basis for Opinion

 

These financial statements are the responsibility of the Company's management. Our responsibility is to express an opinion on the Company’s financial statements based on our audits. We are a public accounting firm registered with the Public Company Accounting Oversight Board (United States) (PCAOB) and are required to be independent with respect to the Company in accordance with the U.S. federal securities laws and the applicable rules and regulations of the Securities and Exchange Commission and the PCAOB.

 

We conducted our audits in accordance with the standards of the PCAOB. Those standards require that we plan and perform the audit to obtain reasonable assurance about whether the financial statements are free of material misstatement, whether due to error or fraud. The Company is not required to have, nor were we engaged to perform, an audit of its internal control over financial reporting. As part of our audits we are required to obtain an understanding of internal control over financial reporting but not for the purpose of expressing an opinion on the effectiveness of the Company's internal control over financial reporting. Accordingly, we express no such opinion.

 

Our audits included performing procedures to assess the risks of material misstatement of the financial statements, whether due to error or fraud, and performing procedures that respond to those risks. Such procedures included examining, on a test basis, evidence regarding the amounts and disclosures in the financial statements. Our audits also included evaluating the accounting principles used and significant estimates made by management, as well as evaluating the overall presentation of the financial statements. We believe that our audits provide a reasonable basis for our opinion.

 

 

/s/ Ernst & Young

 

We have served as the Company’s auditor since 2018.

 

Abu Dhabi, United Arab Emirates

 

30 June 2020

  

F-2 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF COMPREHENSIVE INCOME

For the year ended 31 December 2019

 

        2019     2018     2017  
    Notes   USD     USD     USD  
                       
Revenue   3     44,085,374       35,839,268       89,593  
Direct costs   4     (10,202,465 )     (9,607,360 )     (2,295,809 )
                             
GROSS PROFIT / (LOSS)         33,882,909       26,231,908       (2,206,216 )
                             
Listing expenses   5     (101,773,877 )     -       -  
General and administrative expenses   6     (2,608,984 )     (2,029,260 )     (574,266 )
Finance costs   7     (5,730,535 )     (6,951,923 )     (966,926 )
Changes in fair value of derivative financial instruments   18     (328,176 )     (1,190,073 )     -  
                             
(LOSS) PROFIT AND TOTAL COMPREHENSIVE (LOSS) INCOME FOR THE YEAR         (76,558,663 )     16,060,652       (3,747,408 )
                             
Basic and diluted (loss) / earnings per share   21     (0.95 )     0.20       (0.05 )

 

The attached notes 1 to 26 form part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-3 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF FINANCIAL POSITION

As at 31 December 2019

 

              (Restated)  
        2019     2018  
    Notes   USD     USD  
                 
ASSETS                    
Non-current assets                    
Property, plant and equipment   8     263,228,588       197,629,114  
Advances to contractors   10     21,664,764       -  
                     
          284,893,352       197,629,114  
                     
Current assets                    
Inventories   9     179,644       147,090  
Trade and other receivables   10     2,348,693       2,123,077  
Bank balances and cash   11     19,830,771       37,351  
                     
          22,359,108       2,307,518  
                     
TOTAL ASSETS         307,252,460       199,936,632  
                     
EQUITY AND LIABILITIES                    
Equity                    
Share capital   12     8,804       8,000  
Share premium   12     101,775,834       1,353,285  
Warrants   13     16,983,200       -  
Shareholders’ accounts   20     71,017,815       47,717,763  
General reserve   14     680,643       680,643  
(Accumulated losses) retained earnings         (65,340,421 )     11,218,242  
                     
Total equity         125,125,875       60,977,933  
                     
Non-current liabilities                    
Term loans   15     74,160,950       -  
Lease liability   16     28,624,259       28,108,801  
Provisions   17     13,941       6,267  
                     
          102,799,150       28,115,068  
                     
Current liabilities                    
Bank overdraft   11     -       3,745,048  
Term loans   15     14,539,187       94,792,088  
Accounts payable, accruals and other payables   19     61,115,121       9,003,798  
Derivative financial instruments   18     1,518,249       1,190,073  
Lease liability   16     2,154,878       2,112,624  
                     
          79,327,435       110,843,631  
                     
Total liabilities         182,126,585       138,958,699  
                     
TOTAL EQUITY AND LIABILITIES         307,252,460       199,936,632  

 

The attached notes 1 to 26 form part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-4 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CHANGES IN EQUITY

For the year ended 31 December 2019

  

                                  Accumulated        
                                 

(losses)/

       
    Share     Share           Shareholders’     Statutory     retained        
    capital     premium     Warrants     account     reserves     earnings     Total  
    USD     USD     USD     USD     USD     USD     USD  
                                           
Balance at 1 January 2017     1,361,285       -       -       57,039,100       -       (414,359 )     57,986,026  
Reverse acquisition re-nomination with exchange ratio 800,000:1     8,000       (8,000 )     -       -       -       -       -  
Elimination of capital stock of BPGIC FZE     (1,361,285 )     1,361,285       -     -       -       -       -  
Net contribution from the shareholders (note 18)     -       -       -       13,382,336       -       -       13,382,336  
Loss for the year     -       -       -       -       -       (3,747,408 )     (3,747,408 )
                                                         
Balance at 31 December 2017 (restated)     8,000       1,353,285       -       70,421,436       -       (4,161,767 )     67,620,954  
                                                         
At 1 January 2018 (restated)     8,000       1,353,285       -       70,421,436       -       (4,161,767 )     67,620,954  
Transfer to statutory reserve     -       -       -       -       680,643       (680,643 )     -  
Net distribution to the shareholders (note 20)     -       -       -       (22,703,673 )     -       -       (22,703,673 )
Profit for the year     -       -       -       -       -       16,060,652       16,060,652  
                                                         
Balance at 31 December 2018 (restated)     8,000       1,353,285       -       47,717,763       680,643       11,218,242       60,977,933  
                                                       
Balance at 1 January 2019 (restated)     8,000       1,353,285       -       47,717,763       680,643       11,218,242       60,977,933  
Shares issuance in connection with a merger (note 25)     932       114,022,421       -       -       -       -       114,023,353  
Cash election in lieu of shares (note 25)     (128 )     (13,599,872 )     -       -       -       -       (13,600,000 )
Issuance of warrants in connection with merger
(note 25)
    -       -       16,983,200       -       -       -       16,983,200  
Net Contribution by the shareholders (note 20)     -       -       -       23,300,052       -       -       23,300,052  
Loss for the year     -       -       -       -       -       (76,558,663 )     (76,558,663 )
                                                         
Balance at 31 December 2019     8,804       101,775,834       16,983,200       71,017,815       680,643       (65,340,421 )     125,125,875  

 

The attached notes 1 to 26 form part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-5 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

CONSOLIDATED STATEMENT OF CASH FLOWS

For the year ended 31 December 2019

 

        2019     2018     2017  
    Notes   USD     USD     USD  
                       
OPERATING ACTIVITIES                      
(Loss)/Profit for the year         (76,558,663 )     16,060,652       (3,747,408 )
                             
Adjustments to reconcile net (loss)/profit to net cash provided by (used in) operating activities:                            
Listing expenses   5     100,122,019       -       -  
Depreciation charge   4     5,785,745       5,716,063       692,528  
Finance costs   7     5,730,535       6,951,923       966,926  
Net changes in fair value of derivative financial instruments   18     328,176       1,190,073       -  
                             
          35,407,812       29,918,711       (2,087,954 )
Working capital changes:                            
(Increase) decrease in inventories         (32,554 )     29,561       (176,651 )
Increase in trade and other receivables         (225,616 )     (2,123,077 )     (618,700 )
Increase in provisions         7,674       5,616       365  
Increase in accounts payable, accruals and other payables   19   18,257,036       65,910       630,023  
                             
Net cash flows from (used in) operating activities         53,414,352       27,896,721       (2,252,917 )
                             
INVESTING ACTIVITIES                            
Advances paid to contractors         (21,664,764 )     -       -  
Purchase of property, plant and equipment         (38,690,498 )     (271,403 )     (21,924,553 )
                             
Net cash flow used in investing activities         (60,355,262 )     (271,403 )     (21,924,553 )
                             
FINANCING ACTIVITIES                            
Proceeds from term loans   15     -       4,038,024       16,700,441  
Repayment of term loans   15     (8,435,416 )     (3,487,876 )     -  
Interest paid on term loans         (1,536,503 )     (7,195,581 )     (3,429,143 )
Proceeds from issuance of ordinary shares         33,064,568       -       -  
Cash election by shareholders         (13,600,000 )     -       -  
Payment of lease liability         (2,313,323 )     -       -  
Payment of transaction costs on loans         -       -       (111,081 )
Net contribution from (distributions to) the shareholders   20     23,300,052       (24,971,637 )     11,158,842  
                             
Net cash flows from (used in) financing activities         30,479,378       (31,617,070 )     24,319,059  
                             
NET INCREASE (DECREASE) IN CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS         23,538,468       (3,991,752 )     141,589  
                             
Cash and cash equivalents at 1 January         (3,707,697 )     284,055       142,466  
                             
CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS AT 31 DECEMBER   11     19,830,771       (3,707,697 )     284,055  

 

The attached notes 1 to 26 form part of these consolidated financial statements.

 

F-6 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

1 ACTIVITIES

 

Brooge Energy Limited (the “Company”) formerly known as Brooge Holdings Limited, is a company with limited liability registered as an exempted company in the Cayman Islands. The Company and its subsidiaries are collectively referred to as the “Group”. The registered office of the Company is at P.O Box 309, Ugland House, Grand Cayman, KY1-1104, Cayman Islands. The Company’s principal executive office is located at P.O Box 50170, Al-Sodah, Khorr Fakkan Road, Fujairah, United Arab Emirates (“UAE”).

 

Subsequent to year end, on 07 April 2020, the Company changed its name from Brooge Holdings Limited to Brooge Energy Limited.

 

The Group provides oil storage and related services at the Port of Fujairah in the emirate of Fujairah in the UAE. The Group currently operates phase 1, comprising 14 tanks of total capacity of 399,324 cbm, fully operational for storage and other ancillary processes of clean oil. The Group’s phase 2 is under construction, which will comprise 8 tanks of total capacity of 600,000 cbm for storage and other ancillary services of crude oil.

 

Brooge Energy Limited was incorporated on 12 April 2019 for the sole purpose of consummating the business combination described further below. On 15 April 2019, Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE (“BPGIC FZE”) entered into a business combination agreement with Twelve Seas Investment Company (“Twelve Seas”), a company listed on National Association of Securities Dealers Automated Quotations (“NASDAQ”), the Company and BPGIC FZE’s shareholders. On 10 May 2019, BPGIC plc became party to the business combination agreement by execution of a joinder thereto.

 

The business combination was accounted for as a reverse acquisition in accordance with the International Financial Reporting Standards (“IFRSs”) as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board (“IASB”) as disclosed in note 25. Under this method of accounting, Brooge Energy and Twelve Seas are treated as the “acquired” company. This determination was primarily based on BPGIC FZE comprising the ongoing operations of the combined company, BPGIC FZE’s senior management comprising the senior management of the combined company, and BPGIC FZE’s stockholders having a majority of the voting power of the combined company. For accounting purposes, BPGIC FZE is deemed to be the accounting acquirer in the transaction and, consequently, the transaction is treated as a recapitalization of BPGIC FZE. Accordingly, the consolidated assets, liabilities and results of operations of BPGIC FZE are the historical financial statements of the combined company, and Brooge Energy and Twelve Sea’s assets, liabilities and results of operations are consolidated with BPGIC FZE beginning on the acquisition date.

 

As a result of the above transaction, the Company became the ultimate parent of BPGIC FZE and Twelve Seas on 20 December 2019, being the acquisition date. The Company’s common stock and warrants are traded on the NASDAQ Capital Market under the ticker symbols BROG and BROGW, respectively. Upon the closing of business combination, Twelve seas changed its name to ‘BPGIC International’.

 

The consolidated financial statements are prepared as a continuation of the financial statements of BPGIC FZE, the acquirer, and retroactively adjusted to reflect the legal capital of the legal parent/acquiree (Brooge Energy Limited). The comparative financial years included herein are derived from the consolidated financial statements of BPGIC FZE as adjusted to reflect the legal capital of the legal parent/acquiree (Brooge Energy Limited).

 

The consolidated financial statements of the Group were authorised for issue by the Board of Directors on June 30, 2020.

 

2.1 BASIS OF PREPARATION

 

The consolidated financial statements have been prepared in accordance with International Financial Reporting Standards as issued by the International Accounting Standards Board “IASB”.

 

These consolidated financial statements are presented in United States dollars (“USD”) which is the functional and presentation currency of the Group. All financial information presented in USD has been rounded to the nearest thousand, unless otherwise stated.

 

The consolidated financial statements are prepared under the historical cost convention, except for re-measurement at fair value of derivative financial instruments.

 

F-7 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.2 FUNDAMENTAL ACCOUNTING CONCEPT

 

As of 31 December 2018, the Group had not paid USD 3.7 million of principal and accrued interest that was due under the Group’s Phase I Financing Facilities. Also, as of 31 December 2018, the Group was not in compliance with its debt covenants, including the debt service coverage ratio contained in the Group’s Phase I Financing Facilities. Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the loan agreements, these breaches constituted events of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the loans. Accordingly, as of 31 December 2018, the Group has classified its debt balance of USD 94.8 million as a current liability.

 

On 10 September 2019 and again on 30 December 2019 the Group entered into agreements with its lender to amend the Phase 1 Financing Facility such that on 31 December 2019 the Group was in compliance with the amended facility agreement. At 31 December 2019, the Group’s current liabilities exceeded its current assets by USD 57 million.

 

Subsequent to the year end, the Group defaulted on its commitments under its term loans and the Group was not in compliance with its debt covenants, including the debt service coverage ratio contained in the Group’s loan agreement. Even though the lender did not declare an event of default under the loan agreements, these breaches constituted events of default and could have resulted in the lender requiring immediate repayment of the loans.

 

On 15 June 2020, the Group entered into an agreement with its lender to amend its Phase I Financing Facilities (note15). The Group will have to pay principal and accrued interest of USD 8.8 million in 2020 which represents the cumulative instalments including interest outstanding from periods prior to this amended agreement and an amendment fee of USD 136,000. Term loan (1) and Term loan (2) is now payable in 46 and 16 instalments respectively starting 30 June 2020 with final maturity on 31 July 2030 and 31 July 2023, respectively.

 

During 2018, the Group signed a sales agreement for phase 2 to provide storage and ancillary services to an international commodity trading company, which was novated to a new party during the year. Phase 2 operations are scheduled to start in fourth quarter of 2020 and management expects this will generate significant operating cash flows. The Group is in receipt of a loan facility letter date 15 October 2018 from a lender. The Group intends to draw down from this facility to to finance the payments due to the contractor in respect of Phase 2 construction in the third quarter of 2020. The ability of the Group to draw down on this facility is contingent upon a number of conditions agreed in the facility letter which will need to be assessed and approved by the bank prior to the disbursement of funds.

 

Based on the above noted, management has considered the going concern status of the Group and believes there to be a material uncertainty that casts significant doubt upon the Group’s ability to continue as a going concern. Based on management’s forecasts the capital expenditure requirements for phase 2 and debt servicing as described above will be funded by cash generated through the ongoing operations and further drawdowns from loan facilities.  The Group’s management acknowledge that there is a risk that the quantum and timing of cash flows may not be achievable in line with the twelve months forecasts from the date of approval of the Group’s financial statements. Accordingly, there is significant doubt that the Group will be able to pay its obligations as they fall due and this significant doubt is not alleviated by management’s plans.

 

The financial statements have been prepared assuming that the Group will continue as a going concern. Accordingly, the consolidated financial statements do not include any adjustments relating to the recoverability and classification of recorded asset amounts, the amounts and classification of liabilities, or any other adjustments that might result in the event the Group is unable to continue as a going concern.

 

2.3 CHANGES IN ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND DISCLOSURES

 

New and amended standards and interpretations

The Group applied certain standards, interpretations and amendments for the first time, which are effective for annual periods beginning on or after 1 January 2019. Except for IFRS 16, which was early adopted during the year ended 31 December 2016, the Group has not early adopted any other standard, interpretation or amendment that has been issued but is not yet effective.

 

IFRIC Interpretation 23 Uncertainty over Income Tax Treatments;
Amendments to IFRS 9 Prepayment Features with Negative Compensation;
Amendments to IAS 19 Plan Amendment, Curtailment or Settlement; and
Amendments to IAS 28 Long-term Interests in Associates and Joint Ventures.

 

F-8 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.3 CHANGES IN ACCOUNTING POLICIES AND DISCLOSURES continued

 

Annual Improvements 2015-2017 Cycle

IFRS 3 Business Combinations;
IFRS 11 Joint Arrangements;
IAS 12 Income Taxes; and
IAS 23 Borrowing Costs.

 

The adoption of above standards and amendments did not have any significant impact on the consolidated financial statements of the Group except the amendments in IAS 23. These amendments clarify that an entity treats as part of general borrowings any borrowing originally made to develop a qualifying asset when substantially all of the activities necessary to prepare that asset for its intended use or sale are complete. The entity applies the amendments to borrowing costs incurred on or after the beginning of the annual reporting period in which the entity first applies those amendments. An entity applies those amendments for annual reporting periods beginning on or after 1 January 2019. The implementation of the amendments resulted in USD 1,546,108 capitalisation of borrowing cost to Property, plant and equipment.

 

2.4 SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND JUDGEMENTS

 

The preparation of the Group’s consolidated financial statements requires management to make judgements, estimates and assumptions that affect the reported amounts of expenses, assets and liabilities, and the disclosure of contingent liabilities, at the reporting date. However, uncertainty about these assumptions and estimates could result in outcomes that could require a material adjustment to the carrying amount of the asset or liability affected in the future.

 

Estimation and assumptions

The key assumptions concerning the future and other key sources of estimation uncertainty at the reporting date, that have a significant risk of causing a material adjustment to the carrying amounts of assets and liabilities within the next financial year are discussed below:

 

Useful lives of property, plant and equipment

The Group’s management determines the estimated useful lives of its property, plant and equipment for calculating depreciation. This estimate is determined after considering the expected usage of the asset or physical wear and tear and the impact of expected residual value. Management reviews the useful lives annually and the future depreciation charge would be adjusted where management believes that the useful lives differ from previous estimates. The depreciation period of the right-of-use asset has been determined to be over the lease term on the basis that the land is expected to be used for the whole period of the lease considering the existing assets and future expansion on the land.

 

Asset retirement obligation

As part of the land lease agreement between Fujairah Municipality and the Group, the Group has a legal obligation to remove the plant at the end of its lease term. The Group initially records a provision for asset retirement obligations at the best estimate of the present value of the expenditure required to settle the obligation at the time a legal (or constructive) obligation is incurred, if the liability can be reliably estimated. When the provision is initially recorded, the carrying amount of the related asset is increased by the amount of the liability. Provisions are adjusted at each balance sheet date to reflect the current best estimate. The unwinding of the discount is recognised as finance cost. The Group’s operating assets generally consist of storage tanks and related facilities. These assets can be used for an extended period of time as long as they are properly maintained and/or upgraded. It is the Group’s current intent to maintain its assets and continue making improvements to those assets based on technological advances. There is no data or information that can be derived from past practice, industry practice or the Group’s intentions that could be used to make a reliable estimate of the decommissioning cost. Accordingly, the Group has not recorded a liability or corresponding asset as the amounts of such potential future costs are not reliably determinable.

 

F-9 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.4 SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND JUDGEMENTS continued

 

Estimation and assumptions continued

 

Discount rate used for initial measurement of lease liability

The Group, as a lessee, measures the lease liability at the present value of the unpaid lease payments at the commencement date. The lease payments are discounted using the interest rate implicit in the lease, if that rate can be readily determined. If that rate cannot be readily determined, the Group on initial recognition of the lease uses its incremental borrowing rate. Incremental borrowing rate is the rate of interest that the Group would have to pay to borrow over a similar term, and with a similar security, the funds necessary to obtain an asset of a similar value to the right-of-use assets in similar economic environment. The Group determined its incremental borrowing rate at 9.5% (2018: 9.5%) in respect of the lease liability (note 16).

 

Impairment of trade receivables

The Group uses the simplified approach under IFRS 9 to assess impairment of its trade receivables and calculates expected credit losses (ECLs) based on lifetime expected credit losses. The Group calculates the ECL based on Group historical credit loss experience, adjusted for forward-looking factors specific to the customer and the economic environment.

 

Valuation of derivative financial instruments

The Group has entered into derivative financial instruments (interest rate swaps) with a financial institution with investment grade credit rating. Interest rate swaps are valued using valuation techniques, which employ the use of market observable inputs. The most frequently applied valuation techniques include swap models using present value calculations. The models incorporate various inputs including the credit quality of counterparties and interest rate curves. The changes in counterparty credit risk had no material effect on the derivative financial instruments recognised at fair value.

 

Judgements

In the process of applying the Group’s accounting policies, management has made the following judgements which have the most significant effect on the amounts recognised in the consolidated financial statements:

 

Business combination (reverse acquisition)

As the reverse acquisition of Brooge Energy did not constitute a business combination, the transaction was accounted for as an asset acquisition by the issuance of shares of the Company, for the net assets of Twelve Seas and its public listing. Accordingly, the transaction had been accounted for at the fair value of the equity instruments granted to the shareholders and warrant holders of Twelve Seas.

 

Management applied the following primary judgments in accounting for the reverse acquisition:

 

1. BPGIC was assessed as the accounting acquirer due to majority shareholding and representatives on the board of directors.
2. The accounting acquiree is not a business and not in scope of IFRS 3.
3. The acquisition has been accounted for in terms of IFRS 2 which is aligned to guidance issued by the IFRIC. The difference between the fair value of the consideration paid and the fair value of the net assets acquired has been recognised in profit and loss. Refer to note 2.5 (iii).
4. Fair value of ordinary shares issued: Refer to note 25.
5. The fair value of the shares in escrow is not materially different from that of the shares which are not in escrow as the rights of these shares are similar to those of “normal ordinary shares”. Fair value of the shares in escrow: Refer to note 25.
6. Fair value of Warrants issued: Refer to note 13.
7. Deemed share issue has been presented in the financing activities in the Statement of Cash Flows.

 

F-10 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

  

2.4 SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING ESTIMATES AND JUDGEMENTS continued

 

Judgements continued

 

Operating lease commitments – Group as a lessor

The Group has entered into a five year storage rental agreement with a customer. Under the agreement, the Group has rented its full storage facility and receives fixed rental against the available storage capacity. The Group has determined the agreement to be a lease in accordance with IFRS 16 (Leases) and, based on the contractual arrangements in place, that it retains the principal risks and rewards of ownership of the storage facility and so accounts for the agreement as an operating lease.

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES

 

Basis of consolidation

(i) Subsidiaries

The consolidated financial statements comprise the financial statements of the Company and its subsidiaries as at 31 December 2019. Control is achieved when the Group is exposed, or has rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee and has the ability to affect those returns through its power over the investee.

 

Specifically, the Group controls an investee if and only if the Group has:

 

Power over the investee (i.e. existing rights that give it the current ability to direct the relevant activities of the investee);
Exposure, or rights, to variable returns from its involvement with the investee; and
The ability to use its power over the investee to affect its returns.

 

When the Group has less than a majority of the voting or similar rights of an investee, the Group considers all relevant facts and circumstances in assessing whether it has power over an investee, including:

 

The contractual arrangement with the other vote holders of the investee;
Rights arising from other contractual arrangements; and
The Group’s voting rights and potential voting rights.

 

The Group re-assesses whether or not it controls an investee if facts and circumstances indicate that there are changes to one or more of the three elements of control. Consolidation of a subsidiary begins when the Group obtains control over the subsidiary and ceases when the Group loses control. Assets, liabilities, income and expenses of a subsidiary acquired or disposed off during the year are included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income from the date the Group gains control until the date the Group ceases to control the subsidiary.

 

A change in the ownership interest of a subsidiary, without a loss of control, is accounted for as an equity transaction. If the Group loses control over a subsidiary, it:

 

Derecognises the assets (including goodwill) and liabilities of the subsidiary
Derecognises the carrying amount of any non-controlling interests
Derecognises the cumulative translation differences recorded in equity
Recognises the fair value of the consideration received
Recognises the fair value of any investment retained
Recognises any surplus or deficit in profit or loss
Reclassifies the parent’s share of components previously recognised in OCI to profit or loss or retained earnings, as appropriate, as would be required if the Group had directly disposed of the related assets or liabilities

 

F-11 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Basis of consolidation continued

 

(i) Subsidiaries continued

Details of subsidiaries as at 31 December 2019 and 31 December 2018 were as follows:

 

        Percentage of ownership  
Legal name   Country of incorporation   2019     2018  
                 
Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE   United Arab Emirates     100 %     -  
BPGIC International (formerly known as Twelve Seas) *   Cayman Islands     100 %     -  

 

*indirectly held

 

The financial statements of the subsidiary are prepared for the same reporting year as the Group. Consolidated financial statements are prepared using uniform accounting policies for like transactions and other events in similar circumstances.

 

The carrying amount of the Company’s investment in the subsidiary and the equity of the subsidiary is eliminated on consolidation. All significant intra-group balances, and income and expenses arising from intra-group transactions are also eliminated on consolidation.

 

(ii) Non-controlling interests (“NCI”)

NCI are measured at their proportionate share of the acquiree’s identifiable net assets at the date of acquisition. Changes in the Group’s interest in a subsidiary that do not result in a loss of control are accounted for as equity transactions.

 

(iii) Business combinations

Business combinations are accounted for using the acquisition method. The cost of an acquisition is measured as the aggregate of the consideration transferred measured at acquisition date fair value and the amount of any non-controlling interests in the acquiree. For each business combination, the Group elects whether to measure the non-controlling interests in the acquiree at fair value or at the proportionate share of the acquiree’s identifiable net assets. Acquisition-related costs are expensed as incurred and included in administrative expenses.

 

When the Group acquires a business, it assesses the financial assets and liabilities assumed for appropriate classification and designation in accordance with the contractual terms, economic circumstances and pertinent conditions as at the acquisition date. This includes the separation of embedded derivatives in host contracts by the acquiree.

 

If the business combination is achieved in stages, any previously held equity interest is re-measured at its acquisition date fair value and any resulting gain or loss is recognised in profit or loss. It is then considered in the determination of goodwill.

 

Any contingent consideration to be transferred by the acquirer will be recognised at fair value at the acquisition date. Contingent consideration classified as an asset or liability that is a financial instrument and within the scope of IFRS 9 Financial Instruments, is measured at fair value with changes in fair value recognised either in profit or loss or as a change to other comprehensive income. Contingent consideration that is classified as equity is not re-measured and subsequent settlement is accounted for within equity.

 

F-12 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Basis of consolidation continued

 

(iii) Business combinations continued

A ‘reverse acquisition’ is a business combination in which the legal acquirer - i.e. the entity that issues the securities (i.e. listed entity) becomes the acquiree for accounting purposes and the legal acquiree becomes the acquirer for accounting purposes. It is the application in accordance with IFRS 3 Business Combinations on identifying the acquirer, which results in the identification of the legal acquiree as the accounting acquirer in a reverse acquisition. Application in accordance with IFRS 3 Business Combinations on identifying the acquirer may result in identifying the listed entity as the accounting acquiree and the unlisted entity as the accounting acquirer. In this case, if the listed entity is:

 

A business, IFRS 3 Business Combinations applies;

Not a business, IFRS 2 Share-based Payment applies to the transaction once the acquirer has been identified following the principles in accordance with IFRS 3 Business Combinations. Under this approach, the difference between the fair value of the consideration paid less the fair value of the net assets acquired, is recognized as a listing expense in profit or loss.

 

Revenue recognition

The Group elected to early adopt IFRS 15 ‘Revenue from Contracts with Customers’ and IFRS 16 ‘Leases’ for the year ended 31 December 2016 using the full retrospective method for both standards.

 

The Group generates revenue by charging fees for the storage, throughput and handling of fuel oil and clean products for its sole customer. Additional revenue is generated by charging fees for other ancillary services (excess throughput, heating, blending and other services).

 

The contract contains a lease and a service component. The lease component is accounted for under IFRS 16 and the service component is accounted for under IFRS 15. The contract has a minimum fixed monthly payment for both the lease and non-lease service components. The fixed consideration is allocated to the lease and service components based on their relative stand-alone selling price, which is based on an analysis of lease-related and service-related costs for the contract, adjusted for representative profit margins. The lease component is recognised on a straight-line basis over the term of the initial lease and the service component is recognised over time as the customer simultaneously receives and consumes the benefits provided by the Group’s performance. The fixed payment is billed monthly in advance.

 

The contract also contains variable elements in the form of the other ancillary services. Revenue from the variable element of the contract is recognised based on the actual volumes transported, stored and processed in the period in which the services are provided. These services are generally billed the month after the services are performed.

 

Borrowing costs

Borrowing costs directly attributable to the acquisition, construction or production of qualifying assets, which are assets that necessarily take a substantial period of time to get ready for their intended use or sale, are added to the cost of those assets, until such time as the assets are substantially ready for their intended use or sale.

 

Investment income earned on the temporary investment of specific borrowings pending their expenditure on qualifying assets is deducted from the borrowing costs eligible for capitalisation.

 

All other borrowing costs are recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss) in the period during which they are incurred.

 

F-13 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Property, plant and equipment

Property, plant and equipment are stated at cost less accumulated depreciation and accumulated impairment losses, if any. Capital work under progress is stated at cost and subsequently transferred to assets when it is available for use. Cost of an item of property, plant and equipment comprises its acquisition cost including borrowing cost and all directly attributable costs of bringing the asset to working condition for its intended use. Such cost includes the cost of replacing part of the plant and equipment when that cost is incurred, if the recognition criteria are met. Likewise, when a major inspection is performed, its cost is recognised in the carrying amount of the plant and equipment as a replacement if the recognition criteria are satisfied. All other repair and maintenance costs are recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss) as incurred. Depreciation is computed using the straight-line method based on the estimated useful lives of assets as follows:

 

Buildings   25 years
Tanks   50 years
Installations (pipeline, pumps and other equipment)   20 - 25 years
Other equipment   5 years
Right-of-use asset - Land   60 years

 

The assets’ residual values and useful lives are reviewed and adjusted if appropriate, at each financial year end to determine whether there is an indication of impairment. If any such indication exists, an impairment loss is recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss). For the purpose of assessing impairment, assets are grouped at the lowest levels for which there are separately identifiable cash flows (cash generating units).

 

The carrying amounts are reviewed at each reporting date to assess whether they are recorded in excess of their recoverable amounts, and where carrying values exceed this estimated recoverable amount, assets are written down to their recoverable amount, being the higher of their fair value less costs to sell and their value in use.

 

An item of property, plant and equipment is derecognised upon disposal or when no future economic benefits are expected from its use or disposal. Any gain or loss arising on derecognition of the asset (calculated as the difference between the net disposal proceeds and the carrying amount of the asset) is included in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss) in the year the asset is derecognised.

 

Capital work in progress

Capital work in progress is stated at cost, which represents costs for the design, development, procurement, construction and commissioning of the asset under development. Cost includes borrowing cost capitalised and depreciation of the right of use asset during the construction phase. When the asset is in the location and condition necessary to operate in the manner intended by management, capital work in progress is transferred to the appropriate property, plant and equipment category and depreciated in accordance with the Group’s policies.

 

Impairment of non-financial assets

At each reporting date, the Group reviews the carrying amounts of its tangible assets to determine whether there is any indication that those assets have suffered an impairment loss. If any such indication exists, the recoverable amount of the asset is estimated in order to determine the extent of the impairment loss (if any). Where it is not possible to estimate the recoverable amount of an individual asset, the Group estimates the recoverable amount of the cash-generating unit to which the asset belongs. Where a reasonable and consistent basis of allocation can be identified, corporate assets are also allocated to individual cash-generating units, or otherwise they are allocated to the smallest cash-generating units for which a reasonable and consistent allocation basis can be identified.

 

Recoverable amount is the higher of fair value less costs of disposal and value in use. In assessing value in use, the estimated future cash flows are discounted to their present value using a discount rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the asset.

 

F-14 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Impairment of non-financial assets continued

 

If the recoverable amount of an asset (or cash-generating unit) is estimated to be less than its carrying amount, the carrying amount of the asset (cash-generating unit) is reduced to its recoverable amount. An impairment loss is recognised immediately in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss).

 

Where an impairment loss subsequently reverses, the carrying amount of the asset (cash- generating unit) is increased to the revised estimate of its recoverable amount, such that the increased carrying amount does not exceed the carrying amount that would have been determined had no impairment loss been recognised for the asset (cash-generating unit) in prior years.

 

Cash and cash equivalents

For the purpose of the consolidated statement of cash flows, cash and cash equivalents consist of cash in hand, bank balances and short-term deposits with original maturity of three months or less, net of bank overdraft.

 

Inventories

Inventories are valued at the lower of cost, determined on the basis of weighted average cost, and net realizable value. Costs are those expenses incurred in bringing each item to its present location and condition. Net realisable value is valued at selling prices net of selling costs.

 

Leasing

The Group had elected to early adopt IFRS 16 during the year ended 31 December 2016, from its lease commencement dates using the full retrospective method.

 

At inception of a contract, the Group assesses whether the contract is, or contains, a lease. A contract is, or contains, a lease if the contract conveys the right to control the use of an identified asset for a period of time in exchange for consideration.

 

For a contract that is, or contains, a lease, the Group accounts for each lease component within the contract as a lease separately from non-lease components of the contract.

 

The Group determines the lease term as the non-cancellable period of a lease, together with both:

 

a) periods covered by an option to extend the lease if the lessee is reasonably certain to exercise that option; and
b) periods covered by an option to terminate the lease if the lessee is reasonably certain not to exercise that option.

 

In assessing whether a lessee is reasonably certain to exercise an option to extend a lease, or not to exercise an option to terminate a lease, the Group considers all relevant facts and circumstances that create an economic incentive for the lessee to exercise the option to extend the lease, or not to exercise the option to terminate the lease. The Group revises the lease term if there is a change in the non-cancellable period of a lease.

 

Group as a lessor

Leases where the Group does not transfer substantially all the risks and benefits of ownership of the asset are classified as operating leases. Initial direct costs incurred in negotiating an operating lease are added to the carrying amount of the leased asset and recognised over the lease term on the same bases as rental income. Contingent rents are recognised as revenue in the period in which they are earned.

 

F-15 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Leasing continued

 

Group as a lessee

For a contract that contains a lease component and one or more additional lease or non-lease components, the Group allocates the consideration in the contract to each lease component on the basis of the relative stand-alone price of the lease component and the aggregate stand-alone price of the non-lease components.

 

The relative stand-alone price of lease and non-lease components is determined on the basis of the price the lessor, or a similar supplier, would charge an entity for that component, or a similar component, separately. If an observable stand-alone price is not readily available, the Group estimates the stand-alone price, maximising the use of observable information.

 

For determination of the lease term, the Group reassesses whether it is reasonably certain to exercise an extension option, or not to exercise a termination option, upon the occurrence of either a significant event or a significant change in circumstances that:

 

a) is within the control of the Group; and
b) affects whether the Group is reasonably certain to exercise an option not previously included in its determination of the lease term, or not to exercise an option previously included in its determination of the lease term.

 

At the commencement date, the Group recognises a right-of-use asset classified within property, plant and equipment and a lease liability classified separately on the consolidated statement of financial position.

 

Short-term leases and leases of low-value assets

The Group has elected not to recognise right-of-use assets and lease liabilities for short-term leases that have a lease of 12 months or less and leases of low-value assets of USD 5,000 or less when new. The Group recognises the lease payments associated with these leases as an expense on a straight-line basis over the lease term.

 

Right-of-use assets

The right-of-use asset is initially recognised at cost comprising of:

 

a) the amount of the initial measurement of the lease liability;
b) any lease payments made at or before the commencement date, less any lease incentives received;
c) any initial direct costs incurred by the Group; and
d) an estimate of costs to be incurred by the Group in dismantling and removing the underlying asset, restoring the site on which it is located or restoring the underlying asset to the condition required by the terms and conditions of the lease. These costs are recognised as part of the cost of the right-of-use asset when the Group incurs an obligation for these costs. The obligation for these costs is incurred either at the commencement date or as a consequence of having used the underlying asset during a particular period.

 

After initial recognition, the Group amortises the right-of-use asset over the term of the lease. In addition the right of use asset is periodically reduced by impairment losses, if any, and adjusted for certain re-measurements of the lease liability.

 

Lease liability

The lease liability is initially recognised at the present value of the lease payments that are not paid at the commencement date. The lease payments are discounted using the interest rate implicit in the lease, if that rate can be readily determined. If that rate cannot be readily determined, the Group uses its incremental borrowing rate.

 

After initial recognition, the lease liability is measured by (a) increasing the carrying amount to reflect interest on the lease liability; (b) reducing the carrying amount to reflect the lease payments made; and (c) remeasuring the carrying amount to reflect any reassessment or lease modifications or to reflect revised in-substance fixed lease payments.

 

F-16 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Leasing continued

 

Lease liability continued

Where, (a) there is a change in the lease term as a result of the reassessment of certainty to exercise an option, or not to exercise a termination option as discussed above; or (b) there is a change in the assessment of an option to purchase the underlying asset, assessed considering the events and circumstances in the context of a purchase option, the Group remeasures the lease liabilities to reflect changes to lease payments by discounting the revised lease payments using a revised discount rate. The Group determines the revised discount rate as the interest rate implicit in the lease for the remainder of the lease term, if that rate can be readily determined, or its incremental borrowing rate at the date of reassessment, if the interest rate implicit in the lease cannot be readily determined.

 

Where, (a) there is a change in the amounts expected to be payable under a residual value guarantee; or (b) there is a change in future lease payments resulting from a change in an index or a rate used to determine those payments, including a change to reflect changes in market rental rates following a market rent review, the Group remeasures the lease liabilities by discounting the revised lease payments using an unchanged discount rate, unless the change in lease payments results from a change in floating interest rates. In such case, the Group uses a revised discount rate that reflects changes in the interest rate.

 

The Group recognises the amount of the re-measurement of the lease liability as an adjustment to the right-of-use asset. Where the carrying amount of the right-of-use asset is reduced to zero and there is a further reduction in the measurement of the lease liability, the Group recognises any remaining amount of the re-measurement in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss).

 

The Group accounts for a lease modification as a separate lease if both:

 

a) the modification increases the scope of the lease by adding the right to use one or more underlying assets; and
b) the consideration for the lease increases by an amount commensurate with the stand-alone price for the increase in scope and any appropriate adjustments to that stand-alone price to reflect the circumstances of the particular contract.

 

Financial assets

Classification and measurement

The Group initially measures a financial asset at its fair value plus, in the case of a financial asset not at fair value through profit or loss, transaction costs.

 

Under IFRS 9, debt financial instruments are subsequently measured at fair value through profit or loss (FVPL), amortised cost, or fair value through other comprehensive income (FVOCI). The classification is based on two criteria: the Group’s business model for managing the assets; and whether the instruments’ contractual cash flows represent ‘solely payments of principal and interest’ on the principal amount outstanding (the ‘SPPI criterion’).

 

The classification and measurement of the Group’s debt financial assets are, as follows:

Debt instruments at amortised cost for financial assets that are held within a business model with the objective to hold the financial assets in order to collect contractual cash flows that meet the SPPI criterion. This category includes the Group’s trade and other receivables.
Debt instruments at FVOCI, with gains or losses recycled to profit or loss on derecognition. Financial assets in this category that meet the SPPI criterion and are held within a business model both to collect cash flows and to sell.

 

Financial assets at amortised cost are subsequently measured using the effective interest (EIR) method and are subject to impairment. Gains and losses are recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income when the asset is derecognised, modified or impaired.

 

F-17 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Financial assets continued

 

Derecognition

A financial asset (or, where applicable a part of a financial asset or part of a Group of similar financial assets) is derecognised when:

 

- The rights to receive cash flows from the asset have expired, or
- The Group has transferred its rights to receive cash flows from the asset or has assumed an obligation to pay the received cash flows in full without material delay to a third party under a ‘pass-through’ arrangement; and either (a) the Group has transferred substantially all the risks and rewards of the asset, or (b) the Group has neither transferred nor retained substantially all the risks and rewards of the asset, but has transferred control of the asset.

 

When the Group has transferred its rights to receive cash flows from an asset or has entered into a pass-through arrangement, and has neither transferred nor retained substantially all the risks and rewards of the asset nor transferred control of the asset, the asset is recognised to the extent of the Group’s continuing involvement in the asset. In that case, the Group also recognises an associated liability. The transferred asset and the associated liability are measured on a basis that reflects the rights and obligations that the Group has retained. Continuing involvement that takes the form of a guarantee over the transferred asset, is measured at the lower of the original carrying amount of the asset and the maximum amount of consideration that the Group could be required to repay.

 

Impairment of financial assets

Under IFRS 9, the Group records an allowance for Expected Credit Loss (ECL) for all loans and debt financial assets not held at FVPL.

 

ECLs are based on the difference between the contractual cash flows due in accordance with the contract and all the cash flows that the Group expects to receive. The shortfall is then discounted at an approximation to the asset’s original effective interest rate.

 

For trade and other receivables, the Group has applied the standard’s simplified approach and has calculated ECLs based on lifetime expected credit losses. The Group calculates the ECL based on the Group’s historical credit loss experience, adjusted for forward-looking factors specific to the customer and the economic environment.

 

The Group considers a financial asset in default when contractual payments are 90 days past due. However, in certain cases, the Group may also consider a financial asset to be in default when internal or external information indicates that the Group is unlikely to receive the outstanding contractual amounts in full before taking into account any credit enhancements held by the Group.

 

Equity instruments

An equity instrument is any contract that evidences a residual interest in the assets of an entity after deducting all of its liabilities. Equity instruments issued by the Group comprising of share capital, share premium, warrants and shareholders’ accounts are recorded at the proceeds received, net of direct issue costs.

 

Warrants are accounted for as equity instruments. The cost of warrants is determined by the fair value at the date of the transaction using either the quoted price or appropriate valuation model. The warrants issued as part of the Business Combination allow the holder to subscribe for the ordinary shares of the Company at 1:1 basis at an exercise price of USD 11.50. The warrants shall lapse and expire after five years from the closing of the Business Combination (note 25).

 

Escrow shares issued as part of the Business Combination are subject to meeting certain financial milestones during the vesting period as disclosed in note 25. The fair value of the shares in escrow is not materially different from that of the shares which are not in escrow as the rights of these shares are similar to those of “normal ordinary shares”.

 

F-18 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Financial liabilities

 

Initial recognition

Financial liabilities within the scope of IFRS 9 are classified as financial liabilities at fair value through profit or loss, loans and borrowings, or as derivatives designated as hedging instruments in an effective hedge, as appropriate. The Group determines the classification of its financial liabilities at initial recognition.

 

Financial liabilities are recognised initially at fair value and in the case of loans and borrowings fair value of the consideration received less directly attributable transaction costs.

 

The Group’s financial liabilities include trade and other payables, lease liability and term loans.

 

Subsequent measurement

The measurement of financial liabilities depends on their classification as follows:

 

Accounts payable

Liabilities are recognised for amounts to be paid in the future for goods and services received, whether billed by the supplier or not.

 

Loans and borrowings

All loans and borrowings are initially recognised at the fair values less directly attributable transaction costs. After initial recognition, interest bearing loans and borrowings are subsequently measured at amortised cost using the effective interest method. Gains and losses are recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss) when liabilities are derecognized.

 

Derecognition

A financial liability is derecognised when the obligation under the liability is discharged or cancelled or expires. When an existing financial liability is replaced by another from the same lender on substantially different terms, or the terms of an existing liability are substantially modified, such an exchange or modification is treated as a derecognition of the original liability and the recognition of a new liability, and the difference in the respective carrying amounts is recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss).

 

A non-substantial modification to a financial liability is not treated as a derecognition of the original liability. The difference between the carrying amount and the net present value of the modified terms is recognised in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss)

 

Offsetting of financial instruments

Financial assets and financial liabilities are offset and the net amount reported in the consolidated statement of financial position if, and only if, there is a currently enforceable legal right to offset the recognised amounts and there is an intention to settle on a net basis, or to realise the assets and settle the liabilities simultaneously.

 

Amortised cost of financial instruments

Amortised cost is computed using the effective interest method less any allowance for impairment and principal repayment or reduction. The calculation takes into account any premium or discount on acquisition and includes transaction costs and fees that are an integral part of the effective interest rate.

 

Derivative financial instruments

The Group uses derivative financial instruments, interest rate swaps, to hedge its interest risks. Such derivative financial instruments are initially recognised at fair value on the date on which a derivative contract is entered into and are subsequently remeasured at fair value. Derivatives are carried as financial assets when the fair value is positive and as financial liabilities when the fair value is negative.

 

Any gains or losses arising from changes in the fair value of derivatives are taken directly to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss) as the Group has not designated derivative financial instruments under hedging arrangements.

 

F-19 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Provisions

Provisions are recognised when the Group has a legal or constructive obligation as a result of a past event, it is probable that an outflow of resources will be required to settle the obligation, and the amount can be reliably estimated.

 

Provisions are measured at the present value of the expenditures expected to be required to settle the obligation at the end of the reporting period, using a rate that reflects current market assessments of the time value of money and the risks specific to the obligation.

 

When some or all of the economic benefits required to settle a provision are expected to be recovered from a third party, a receivable is recognised as an asset if it is virtually certain that a reimbursement will be received and the amount of the receivable can be measured reliably.

 

Decommissioning liabilities

As part of the land lease agreement between Fujairah Municipality and the Group, the Group has a legal obligation to remove the plant at the end of its lease term. The Group initially records a provision for asset retirement obligations at the best estimate of the present value of the expenditure required to settle the obligation at the time a legal (or constructive) obligation is incurred, if the liability can be reliably estimated. When the provision is initially recorded, the carrying amount of the related asset is increased by the amount of the liability. Provisions are adjusted at each balance sheet date to reflect the current best estimate. The unwinding of the discount is recognised as finance cost. The Group’s operating assets generally consist of storage tanks and related facilities. These assets can be used for an extended period of time as long as they are properly maintained and/or upgraded. It is the Group’s current intent to maintain its assets and continue making improvements to those assets based on technological advances. There is no data or information that can be derived from past practice, industry practice or the Group’s intentions that could be used to make a reliable estimate of the decommissioning cost. Accordingly, the Group has not recorded a liability or corresponding asset as the amounts of such potential future costs are not reliably determinable.

 

Value added tax

Expenses and assets are recognised net of the amount of value added tax, except:

 

When the value added tax incurred on a purchase of assets or services is not recoverable from the taxation authority, in which case, the value added tax is recognised as part of the cost of acquisition of the asset or as part of the expense item, as applicable
When receivables and payables are stated with the amount of value added tax included

 

The net amount of value added tax recoverable from, or payable to, the taxation authority is included as part of receivables or payables in the consolidated statement of financial position.

 

Foreign currencies

Transactions in foreign currencies are recorded at the rate ruling at the date of the transaction. Monetary assets and liabilities denominated in foreign currencies are retranslated at the rate of exchange ruling at the reporting date. All differences are taken to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss). Non-monetary items that are measured in terms of historical cost in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates as at the dates of the initial transactions. Non-monetary items measured at fair value in a foreign currency are translated using the exchange rates at the date when the fair value is determined.

 

Employees’ end of service benefits

The Group provides end of service benefits to its employees. The entitlement to these benefits is based upon the employees’ final salary and length of service, subject to the completion of a minimum service period. The expected costs of these benefits are accrued over the period of employment.

 

F-20 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.5 SUMMARY OF SIGNIFICANT ACCOUNTING POLICIES continued

 

Fair value

Fair value is the price that would be received to sell an asset or paid to transfer a liability in an orderly transaction between market participants at the measurement date. The fair value measurement is based on the presumption that the transaction to sell the asset or transfer the liability takes place either:

 

In the principal market for the asset or liability, or
In the absence of a principal market, in the most advantageous market for the asset or liability.

 

The principal or the most advantageous market must be accessible to the Group.

 

The fair value of an asset or a liability is measured using the assumptions that market participants would use when pricing the asset or liability, assuming that market participants act in their economic best interest.

 

A fair value measurement of a non-financial asset takes into account a market participant’s ability to generate economic benefits by using the asset in its highest and best use or by selling it to another market participant that would use the asset in its highest and best use.

 

The Group uses valuation techniques that are appropriate in the circumstances and for which sufficient data are available to measure fair value, maximising the use of relevant observable inputs and minimising the use of unobservable inputs.

 

In addition, for financial reporting purposes, fair value measurements are categorised into Level 1, 2 or 3 based on the degree to which the inputs to the fair value measurements are observable and the significance of the inputs to the fair value measurement in its entirety, which are described as follows:

 

Level 1 inputs are quoted prices (unadjusted) in active markets for identical assets or liabilities that the entity can access at the measurement date;
Level 2 inputs, other than quoted prices included within Level 1 that are observable for the asset or liability, either directly or indirectly; and
Level 3 inputs are unobservable inputs for the asset or liability.

 

Current versus non-current classification

The Group presents assets and liabilities in consolidated statement of financial position based on current/non-current classification. An asset is current when it is:

 

Expected to be realised or intended to be sold or consumed in a normal operating cycle
Held primarily for the purpose of trading
Expected to be realised within twelve months after the reporting period,
Or
Cash or cash equivalent unless restricted from being exchanged or used to settle a liability for at least twelve months after the reporting period

 

All other assets are classified as non-current.

 

A liability is current when it is:

 

Expected to be settled in normal operating cycle
Held primarily for the purpose of trading
Due to be settled within twelve months after the reporting period,
Or
There is no unconditional right to defer the settlement of the liability for at least twelve months after the reporting period

 

The Group classifies all other liabilities as non-current.

 

F-21 

 

  

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

2.6 FUTURE CHANGES IN ACCOUNTING POLICIES – STANDARDS ISSUED BUT NOT YET EFFECTIVE

 

The standards and interpretations that are issued, but not yet effective, up to the date of issuance of the Group’s consolidated financial statements are disclosed below.

 

Amendments to References to the Conceptual Framework in IFRS Standards;
Amendments to IFRS 3: Definition of a Business;
Amendments to IFRS 9, IAS 39 and IFRS 7: Interest Rate Benchmark Reform;
Amendments to IAS 1 and IAS 8: Definition of Material;
Amendments to IAS 1 Presentation of Financial Statements: Classification of Liabilities as Current or Non-current;
Amendments to IAS 16 Property, plant and equipment: Proceeds before intended use;
Amendments to IAS 37 Provisions, contingent liabilities and contingent assets – onerous contracts—cost of fulfilling a contract;
Amendments to IFRS 3 Business combinations – References to the conceptual framework;
Amendments to IFRS 16 Leases -COVID-19 related rent concessions;
Amendments to IFRS 3 Business combinations – References to the conceptual framework;
The Conceptual Framework for Financial Reporting;
IFRS 17 Insurance Contracts; and
Annual Improvements Cycle - 2018-2020.

 

The Group does not expect these new standards and amendments to have any significant impact on the consolidated financial statements, when implemented in future periods.

 

F-22 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

3 REVENUE

 

    2019     2018     2017  
    USD     USD     USD  
                   
Revenue recognised under IFRS 16                  
Fixed consideration – leasing component     16,846,481       14,586,315       62,995  
                         
Revenue recognised under IFRS 15                        
Fixed consideration – service component     7,112,959       6,158,667       26,598  
Ancillary services     20,125,934       15,094,286       -  
                         
      27,238,893       21,252,953       26,598  
                         
Total revenue     44,085,374       35,839,268       89,593  

 

The Group has only one segment at the reporting date. Revenue generation from leasing of storage capacity of tanks and other ancillary services started in December 2017. The Group has only one customer since the inception of the operations in 2017 and as such all revenues have been derived from one customer.

 

In August 2019, a novated agreement was signed with a new party Al Brooge International Advisory LLC for four years in which the lessor, the Group, consents to lease to the lessee its oil storage capacity of 399,324 cubic meters in order to serve the lessee’s oil trading activities. The period shall be automatically extended by a further 5 years unless either party notifies the other in writing not less than six months prior to any such expiry date of its intention. Other than the terms mentioned above, all the terms and conditions remain same in the new contract. Based on an assessment in accordance with IFRS 15, the Group concluded that the only material change in the commercial arrangement was the additional extension of seven months for the lease with similar monthly rates (selling price) to those in previous periods. This has therefore, not resulted in a material change to the Group’s revenue recognition profile since the extended period (1 January 2023 to 31 July 2023) will be accounted for as a separate contract.

 

Group as lessor

Future storage fee income to be received by the Group under the sales agreement based on projected storage availability are as follows:

 

    2019     2018     2017  
    USD     USD     USD  
                   
Within one year     23,959,440       23,959,440       23,869,847  
After one year but not more than 5 years     61,895,220       71,878,320       95,837,760  
                         
      85,854,660       95,837,760       119,707,607  

 

F-23 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

4 DIRECT COSTS

 

    2019     2018     2017  
    USD     USD     USD  
                   
Employee costs and related benefits     3,074,727       2,808,702       1,518,794  
Depreciation (note 8)     5,785,745       5,716,063       692,528  
Spare parts and consumables used (note 9)     788,792       592,471       50,891  
Insurance     323,702       377,053       31,304  
Others     229,499       113,071       2,292  
                         
      10,202,465       9,607,360       2,295,809  

 

5 LISTING EXPENSES

 

    2019     2018     2017  
    USD     USD     USD  
                   
IFRS 2 listing expenses (note 25)     98,622,019       -       -  
Other listing expenses*     3,151,858       -       -  
                         
      101,773,877       -       -  

 

* Other listing expenses represents promissory note of USD 1.5 million, fees paid to legal advisors, consultants, and other necessary expenses incurred in relation to the Group’s listing on the US market.

 

6 GENERAL AND ADMINISTRATIVE EXPENSES

 

    2019     2018     2017  
    USD     USD     USD  
                   
Employee costs and related benefits     1,471,974       1,178,919       287,481  
Consultancy expenses     535,275       337,491       54,529  
Recruitment expenses     1,360       33,362       53,912  
Travel and related expenses     52,506       11,515       16,544  
Rent on low value and short term leases     10,346       22,325       43,380  
Advertisement and subscriptions     131,494       116,495       37,223  
Printing and stationery     25,954       22,713       12,636  
Licence costs     18,502       19,249       22,872  
Communication expenses     35,465       19,773       9,379  
Other expenses     326,108       267,418       36,310  
                         
      2,608,984       2,029,260       574,266  

  

7 FINANCE COSTS

 

    2019     2018     2017  
    USD     USD     USD  
                   
Interest on lease liability (note 16)     1,412,796       1,387,612       318,957  
Finance costs on term loans     4,002,772       5,564,311       647,969  
Bank charges     314,967       -       -  
                         
      5,730,535       6,951,923       966,926  

 

F-24 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

8 PROPERTY, PLANT AND EQUIPMENT

 

                                  Capital        
                      Other     Right-of-use     work in        
    Buildings     Tanks     Installations     equipment     asset (land)     progress     Total  
    USD     USD     USD     USD     USD     USD     USD  
                                           
2019                                          
Cost:                                                        
At 1 January 2019     28,037,886       76,100,795       65,868,246       213,843       27,540,969       8,344,847       206,106,586  
Additions     -       -       9,883       4,984       -       71,603,465       71,618,332  
                                                         
At 31 December 2019     28,037,886       76,100,795       65,878,129       218,827       27,540,969       79,948,312       277,724,918  
                                                         
Depreciation:                                                        
At 1 January 2019     1,250,566       1,746,725       3,148,665       36,436       2,295,080       -       8,477,472  
Charge for the year     1,121,515       1,565,419       2,829,671       43,237       459,016       -       6,018,858  
                                                         
At 31 December 2019     2,372,081       3,312,144       5,978,336       79,673       2,754,096       -       14,496,330  
                                                         
Net carrying amount:                                                        
At 31 December 2019     25,665,805       72,788,651       59,899,793       139,154       24,786,873       79,948,312       263,228,588  
                                                         
2018                                                        
Cost:                                                        
At 1 January 2018     28,037,886       76,100,795       65,860,351       79,645       27,540,969       294,403       197,914,049  
Additions     -       -       7,895       134,198       -       8,050,444       8,192,537  
                                                         
At 31 December 2018     28,037,886       76,100,795       65,868,246       213,843       27,540,969       8,344,847       206,106,586  
                                                         
Depreciation:                                                        
At 1 January 2018     129,051       181,306       325,525       3,232       1,836,064       -       2,475,178  
Charge for the year     1,121,515       1,565,419       2,823,140       33,204       459,016       -       6,002,294  
                                                         
At 31 December 2018     1,250,566       1,746,725       3,148,665       36,436       2,295,080       -       8,477,472  
                                                         
Net carrying amount:                                                        
At 31 December 2018     26,787,320       74,354,070       62,719,581       177,407       25,245,889       8,344,847       197,629,114  

 

Capital work in progress at 31 December 2019 includes total amount capitalised relating to the construction of phase 2 and includes an amount of USD 1,458,069 related to finance charge on lease liability and an amount of USD 233,113 related to depreciation charge on right-of-use asset capitalised.

 

The capitalized borrowing costs have been included under “additions” in the table above. The capitalisation rate used to determine these finance costs was 6.1%. (2018: Nil).

 

Tanks and related assets with a carrying value of USD 158,493,403 (2018: USD 164,038,378) are mortgaged as security against loans obtained in 2014 and 2017 (note 15). Further, as security against the term loan (2), a step-in right to use the leased land, has been provided to the commercial bank.

 

The depreciation charge for the year is allocated to the consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss) and capital work in progress as follows:

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Direct costs (note 4)     5,785,745       5,716,063  
Property, plant and equipment     233,113       286,231  
                 
      6,018,858       6,002,294  

 

F-25 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

9 INVENTORIES

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
                 
Spare parts and consumables     179,644       147,090  

 

Cost of inventories recognised during the year amounted to USD 788,792 (2018: USD 592,471). No provision is required for inventories at 31 December 2019 (2018: nil).

 

10 TRADE AND OTHER RECEIVABLES

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Trade receivables     1,507,660       1,877,887  
Prepayments and other receivables     783,483       245,190  
Due from related parties (note 20)     57,550       -  
                 
      2,348,693       2,123,077  

 

At 31 December 2019, all trade receivables were neither past due nor impaired.

 

Receivables are due within 14 days of invoicing.

 

Unimpaired trade receivables are expected to be fully recoverable. It is not the practice of the Group to obtain collateral over receivables and the vast majority is, therefore, unsecured.

 

Furthermore, included in non-current assets in statement of financial position is an amount of USD 21,664,764 million. This amount relates to advances paid to a contractor (Audex) for future services in relation to phase 2.

 

11 CASH AND CASH EQUIVALENTS

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Bank balances and cash     19,830,771       37,351  
Bank overdraft     -       (3,745,048 )
                 
Cash and cash equivalents     19,830,771       (3,707,697 )

 

The group has no restricted cash balances.

 

Significant non-cash transactions, which have been excluded from the consolidated statement of cash flows, are as follows:

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Capital accruals     31,469,596       5,972,230  
                 
Purchase of property, plant and equipment financed through  advances paid to contractors     8,335,236       231,571  
                 

Listing expenses (note 5)

    100,122,019       -  
                 
Lease payments made by shareholders     -       2,818,714  

 

F-26 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

12 ISSUED CAPITAL AND RESERVES

 

    2019     2018  
    No. of shares     No. of shares  
             
Authorized                
Ordinary shares     450,000,000       450,000,000  

 

At BPGIC FZE

 

    No. of shares     USD  
             
At 1 January 2018     100       1,361,285  
                 
At Brooge Energy                
                 
At inception     1       n.m.*  
Conversion of 100 BPGIZ FZE ordinary shares at 1 for 1 million to the legal acquirer, Brooge Energy (note 25)     80,000,000 **     8,000  
                 
At 31 December 2018     80,000,000       8,000  
                 
Cash election     (1,281,965 )     (128 )
Changes in share capital due to business combination (note 25)     9,347,219 **     932  
                 
At 31 December 2019     88,065,254       8,804  

 

* not meaningful

 

** Ordinary shares held in escrow (20,000,000 shares held by BPGIC and 1,552,000 shares held by the original founders of Twelve Seas) have been excluded from the share capital in the table above. Additional information on escrow shares are included in note 25.

 

Share premium

 

    USD  
       
At 1 January 2018     -  
Reverse acquisition adjustment     1,353,285  
         
At 31 December 2018     1,353,285  
         
Ordinary shares issued on merger with Twelve Seas     114,022,421  
Cash election     (13,599,872 )
         
At 31 December 2019     101,775,834  

 

13 Warrants

 

In connection with the completion of the business combination on 20 December 2019, each of Twelve Sea’s 21,229,000 outstanding warrants were converted into the Group’s warrants at 1:1 ratio. The warrants allow the holder to subscribe for the ordinary shares of the Company at 1:1 basis at an exercise price of USD 11.50. The warrants shall lapse and expire after five years from the closing of the business combination.

 

As the exercise price and maximum number of ordinary shares from which the Warrants are converted into ordinary shares of the Company is a fixed ratio and will be gross settled, the Warrants are accounted for as equity instruments.

 

The Fair value has been determined using the quoted price of the warrants on the date of the business combination and amounted to USD 17.0 million. These warrants were accounted for as part of the consideration transferred under IFRS 2. Additional information is provided in note 25.

 

Between, the reporting date and the date of authorization of these financial statements, holders of 100 warrants have exercised their rights and converted the warrants into ordinary shares. 

 

F-27 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

14 GENERAL RESERVE

 

As required by the Articles of Association of BPGIC FZE, 10% of the profit for the year must be transferred to the general reserve. The subsidiary has resolved to discontinue such annual transfers as the reserve has reached 50% of the subsidiary’s issued share capital. The general reserve is not available for distribution to the shareholders.

 

15 TERM LOANS

 

              2019     2018  
    Interest rate   Maturity     USD     USD  
                       
Non-current                            
Term loan (1)   3 month EIBOR + 3% margin     2030       68,271,743       -  
Term loan (2)   3 month EIBOR + 3% margin     2023       5,889,207       -  
                             
                  74,160,950       -  
                             
Current                            
Term loan (1)   3 month EIBOR + 3% margin     2020       10,135,939       82,245,595  
Term loan (2)   3 month EIBOR + 3% margin     2020       2,138,248       10,165,703  
Term loan (3)   1 month EIBOR + 2% margin     -       -       2,380,790  
Promissory notes         2020       2,265,000       -  
                             
                  14,539,187       94,792,088  

 

Term loan 1

In 2014, the Group obtained term loan facility (1) amounting to USD 84,595,154 (AED: 310,718,000) from a commercial bank in the UAE to partially finance the construction of phase 1 (14 oil storage tanks in Fujairah). During the year 2019, the Group has not drawn down any amounts (2018: USD 550,445) from this facility. The loan was repayable in 48 quarterly instalments, commencing 27 months after the start of the construction with final maturity not exceeding 31 March 2028 and is stated net of prepaid finance cost of USD 499,158 (2018: USD 559,607). The interest is due on a quarterly basis from the loan drawdown date. The loan was drawn down in AED.

 

In 2018, the Group entered into an agreement to amend term loan facility (1). As a result of this amendment the loan was repayable in 48 quarterly instalments starting October 2018 with final maturity in July 2030. The loan carries interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3% as compared to interest at 6 month EIBOR + 3.5% previously.

 

On 10 September 2019, the Group entered into an agreement with the bank to again amend term loan facility (1). The loan was payable in 45 instalments starting 31 October 2019 with final maturity on 30 July 2030. One of the instalments included a one-time lump sum repayment of USD 5,729,418 which represented the cumulative instalments including interest outstanding from periods prior to this amended agreement of USD 5,494,063 and an amendment fee of USD 235,355.

 

On 30 December 2019, the Group entered into another amendment by revoking the previous amendment for term loan facility (1). The loan is now payable in 44 instalments starting 31 January 2020 with final maturity on 30 July 2030. One of the instalments includes a one-time lump sum repayment of USD 6,612,194, which represents the cumulative instalments including interest outstanding from periods prior to this amended agreement of USD 6,520,130 and an amendment fee of USD 92,064.

 

F-28 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

15 TERM LOANS continued

 

Term loan 2

During 2017, the Group obtained an additional term loan facility (2) of USD 11,108,086 (AED 40,800,000) from a commercial bank in the UAE for the construction of an administrative building in Fujairah. The loan was repayable in 20 quarterly instalments starting after a 6 months grace period commencing in April 2017 and is stated net of prepaid finance cost of USD 58,578 (2018: USD 76,606). The interest is due on a quarterly basis from the loan drawdown date. The loan was drawn down in AED.

 

During the year 2018, the Group has entered in to an agreement to amend term loan facility (2). The loan was repayable in 20 quarterly instalments starting October 2018 with final maturity in July 2023.The loan carried interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3% as compared to interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3.5% previously.

 

Term loan (2) was not amended as part of the 10 September 2019 and 30 December agreement to amend loan (1). In 2019, the Group repaid all instalments due under the repayment schedule.

 

Term loans 1 and 2

The term loans are secured by a mortgage on the tanks and the office/administration building, step-in right to the leased land and assignment of insurance policies.

 

Under the term loan facility agreements, the Group is subject to certain covenants requiring amongst other things, the maintenance of:

 

(i) a minimum debt service coverage ratio of 150% at all times and if the ratio decreases to 120% or less, it results in an event of default; the debt service coverage ratio (DSCR) is defined as net operating income divided by total debt service and;
(ii) an amount equivalent to one quarterly instalment including interest in a debt service reserve account at all times.

 

Under the amended agreement signed on 30 December 2019, the maintenance of above covenants is required to be complied from 28 February 2020. As of 31 December 2019, the Group was in compliance with its commitments under the loan agreements and has accordingly classified the balance between current and non-current liability based on the loan agreements in effect at 31 December 2019.

 

Subsequent to year end, the Group has again defaulted on the instalments due under the loan agreements and are also in breach of the loan covenants. The lender has not declared an event of default under the loan agreement.

 

The Group negotiated another amendment to the term loan facilities (1) and (2) on 15 June 2020. Loans (1) and (2) are now payable in 46 and 16 instalments, respectively, with the first installment starting from 30 June 2020 with final maturity in 30 July 2030 and 31 July 2023, respectively. The loan 1 carries interest at 6 months EIBOR + 4% (minimum 5%) and to be further increased to 6 month EIBOR + 4.5% (minimum 5%) from January 2021 as compared to interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3% previously, and, the loan 2 carries interest at 3 months EIBOR + 4% (minimum 5%) and to be further increased to 3 month EIBOR + 4.5% (minimum 5%) as compared to interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3% previously The Group has to pay USD 8.8 million for term loan (1) and (2) in 2020 which represents the cumulative instalments including interest outstanding from periods prior to this amended agreement and an amendment fee of USD 136,000. All securities and covenants under the original agreements remain in effect under the amended agreement except debt service reserve account (DSRA) balance to be maintained from 31 October 2020 and debt service coverage ratio (DSCR) to be commenced from 31 December 2020. Under this agreement, term loans (1) and (2) are also secured by assignment of the proceeds from operation of the tanks of phase 1 and 2.

 

Term loan 3

In 2018, the Group has obtained a facility from a commercial bank in the UAE to settle accrued interest on term loan (1) amounting to USD 3,539,341(AED 13,000,000). The facility carried interest at 1 month EIBOR + 2% margin and was repayable in 15 equal monthly instalments commencing from date of disbursement. The loan was drawn down in AED. The facility has been fully settled during the year.

 

F-29 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

15 TERM LOANS continued

 

Term loan 4

In 2018, the Group obtained a new facility from a commercial bank in the UAE amounting to USD 95,290,000 (AED 350,000,000) to partially finance the construction of phase 2. The new facility carries interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3% margin and is repayable in 17 bi-annual instalments commencing 6 months after the date of completion of phase 2.

 

The term loan facility (4) is secured by a mortgage on the phase 2 storage tanks, step-in right to the leased land and assignment of the proceeds from operation of the tanks and insurance policies.

 

Under the term loan facility agreement, the Group is subject to certain covenants requiring amongst other things, the maintenance of (i) a minimum facility service coverage ratio of 1.25:1, (ii) a participations to value ratio not exceeding 1.50:1 at all times, (iii) a participations to cost ratio not exceeding 57% at any date, and (iv) an amount equivalent to one instalment including interest in a facility service reserve account at all times or in the event of an initial public offering, the amount should be equivalent to the next two instalments including interest. The facility service coverage ratio is calculated as revenues minus expenses from the phase 2 storage tanks divided by the current debt commitments on term loan (4) including interest. The participations to value ratio at any date is calculated as total debt commitments on term loan facility (4) as of that date divided by the most recent valuation of the phase 2 storage tanks. The participations to cost ratio at any date is calculated as the total debt commitments on term loan facility (4) as of that date as a percentage of the sum of actual constructions costs plus project expenses paid as of that date on the phase 2 storage tanks.

 

The term loan facility (4) agreement includes an initial condition precedent that requires evidence of initial equity contribution by the Group towards the phase 2 storage tanks before the loan facility can be utilised. The Group has not made any drawdowns on the term loan facility (4) as of the date of issuance of these consolidated financial statements.

 

The term loans are repayable as follows:

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Payable within 1 year     14,541,774       95,428,301  
Payable within 1 and 2 years     9,216,973       -  
Payable within 2 and 5 years     24,948,779       -  
Payable after 5 years     40,550,347       -  
                 
      89,257,873       95,428,301  

 

Promissory notes

Pursuant to the Business Combination Agreement, on December 20, 2019, Twelve Seas, Early Bird Capital (EBC), and the Company entered into the Business Combination Marketing Agreement Fee Amendment (the “BCMA Fee Amendment”) whereby the Company became party to the Business Combination Marketing Agreement solely with respect to the provision relating to EBC’s fees and EBC’s fees were amended. Pursuant to the Business Combination Marketing Agreement, as amended by the BCMA Fee Amendment, EBC received as full payment for any and all fees under the Business Combination Marketing Agreement, a cash fee equal to USD 3,0 million and a USD 1.5 million non-interest bearing promissory note of the Company due and payable on the earlier of (i) the first anniversary of the Closing and (ii) the consummation by the Company of a follow-on securities offering. In case of default, the promissory note would bear interest at the rate of 10% per annum.

 

There is an additional promissory note of USD 0.8 million that was issued by Twelve Seas prior to the Business Combination payable to Twelve Seas sponsors which was included in the net assets contributed by Twelve Seas as part of the Business Combination, further details disclosed in note 25.

 

F-30 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

15 TERM LOANS continued

 

Changes in liabilities arising from term loans are as follows:

 

    1 January     Cash flows     Other*     31 December  
    USD     USD     USD     USD  
                         
2019                        
Current     94,792,088       (8,435,416 )     (71,817,485 )     14,539,187  
Non-current     -       -       74,160,950       74,160,950  
                                 
Total     94,792,088       (8,435,416 )     2,343,465       88,700,137  
                                 
2018                                
Current     94,163,751       550,148       78,189       94,792,088  
Non-current     -       -       -       -  
                                 
Total     94,163,751       550,148       78,189       94,792,088  

 

*The ‘Other’ column includes the effect of amortisation of prepaid finance costs on term loans, promissory notes and reclassification between current and non-current portion.

 

16 LEASE LIABILITY

 

During 2013, the Group entered into a land lease agreement with the Municipality of Fujairah for a period of 30 years, extendable for another 30 years at the option of the Group. The Group has concluded that they have the right-to-use of the asset and accordingly, recorded a lease liability as per the requirements of IFRS 16. Given the use of the land, it is reasonably certain that the Group will continue to lease the land till the end of the lease period (i.e. 60 years) and accordingly the below lease rentals cover a period up to 60 years discounted at the rate of 9.5% (2018: 9.5%) as an incremental borrowing rate for the Group. Annual lease rental is increased by 2% on an annual basis as per the agreement.

 

Changes in the lease liability are as follows:

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
At 1 January     30,221,425       29,670,675  
Interest charge     2,871,035       2,818,714  
Amount paid during the year     (2,313,323 )     (2,267,964 )
                 
At 31 December     30,779,137       30,221,425  

 

The lease liability is classified in the consolidated statement of financial position as follows:

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Current     2,154,878       2,112,624  
Non-current     28,624,259       28,108,801  
                 
    30,779,137       30,221,425  

 

F-31 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

16 LEASE LIABILITY continued

 

The maturity of the lease liability is as follows:

 

          Present value of  
    Lease payments     Minimum lease payments  
    2019     2018     2019     2018  
    USD     USD     USD     USD  
                         
Not later than one year     2,359,590       2,313,323       2,154,877       2,112,624  
Later than one year and not later than five years     9,919,810       9,725,304       7,241,240       7,099,255  
Later than five years     213,469,800       216,023,896       21,383,020       21,009,546  
                                 
      225,749,200       228,062,523       30,779,137       30,221,425  
Finance costs     (194,970,063 )     (197,841,098 )     -       -  
                                 
Present value of minimum lease payments     30,779,137       30,221,425       30,779,137       30,221,425  

 

Additional information relating to the right of use asset and Group’s lease is provided in notes 7 and 8 to the consolidated financial statements.

 

17 PROVISIONS

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
                 
Provision for employees’ end of service benefits     13,941       6,267  

 

18 DERIVATIVE FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
                 
Interest rate swaps     1,518,249       1,190,073  

 

In 2018, the Group entered into an interest rate swap with a commercial bank exchanging variable interest for fixed interest at specified dates on its term loan 1 (note 15). The interest rate swap matures in June 2023.

 

The Company is exposed to variability in future interest cash flows on terms loan and Islamic ijara loan which bears interest at a variable rate.

 

In order to reduce its exposure to interest rates fluctuations on the loans, the Group has entered into an interest rate arrangement with counter-party banks for a notional amount that mirrors the draw down schedule of the loans, covering not less than 90% of the outstanding term loan. At 31 December 2019 the fixed interest rates varied from 2.78% to 4.756% (2018: 2.78% to 4.756%). The floating interest rate is based on EIBOR. The notional amount outstanding at 31 December 2019 was USD 79.2 million (2018: USD 83.8 million). The interest rate swap match the terms of the fixed rate loan (i.e., notional amount, maturity, payment and reset dates).

 

The details of these derivative financial instruments are as follows:

 

    Notional     Fair value     Fair value  
    Amount     asset     liability  
    USD     USD     USD  
                   
31 December 2019                        
Designated at FVTPL                        
Interest rate swaps     79,253,015       -       1,518,249  
                         
31 December 2018                        
Designated at FVTPL                        
Interest rate swaps     83,855,305       -       1,190,073  

 

F-32 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

19 ACCOUNTS PAYABLE, ACCRUALS AND OTHER PAYABLES

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Accounts payable*     25,989,961       1,565,035  
Accrued interest on term loans     3,387,446       910,691  
Capital accruals**     31,469,596       5,972,230  
Accrued expenses     268,118       555,842  
                 
      61,115,121       9,003,798  

 

* Accounts payables primarily represent payables to Audex (Phase 2 contractor) amounting to USD 21.5 million.

** Capital accruals represents contractor’s capital accruals for Phase 2

 

20 RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES

 

Upon consummation of the Business Combination, the board of directors adopted a code of ethics and business conduct that requires it, and its directors, officers and employees to avoid conflicts of interest, such as related party transactions, unless specifically authorized. The board of directors also adopted a related party transaction policy to govern the procedures for evaluation and authorization of related party transactions. Related party transactions, which require approval of the audit committee, are defined as any transaction, arrangement or relationship, or any series of similar transactions, arrangements or relationships, in which (i) the Group is or will be a participant, (ii) the aggregate amount involved will or may be expected to exceed $120,000 in any fiscal year, and (iii) any related party has or will have a direct or indirect interest. This also includes any material amendment or modification to an existing related party transaction.

The audit committee is responsible for reviewing and approving related party transactions to the extent the Group contemplates engaging in such a transaction. The audit committee will review all of the relevant facts and circumstances of all related party transactions that require its approval and either approve or disapprove of the entry into the related party transaction. The audit committee will approve the related party transaction only if it determines in good faith that, under all of the circumstances, the transaction is in the best interests of the Group and its shareholders. The audit committee, in its sole discretion, will impose such conditions as it deems appropriate on the Group or the related party in connection with the approval of the related party transaction. No director will be permitted to participate in the discussions or approval of a transaction in which he or she is a related party, but that director will be required to provide all material information concerning the related party transaction to the audit committee.

 

F-33 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

20 RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES continued

 

Transactions with related parties

Movements in shareholders’ account are as follows

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Contributions by the shareholders     77,090,648       951,539  
Amounts paid on behalf of the Group by the shareholders*     1,135,484       7,850,431  
Amounts paid by the Group on behalf of the shareholders     (1,647,064 )     (2,296,354 )
Distributions to shareholders     (53,279,016 )     (29,209,289 )
                 
      23,300,052       (22,703,673 )

 

These amounts are repayable at the discretion of the Board of Directors of the Group and are interest free, therefore classified as part of equity.

 

* These include expenses paid on behalf of the Group which includes other operational expenses paid by the shareholders on behalf of the Group.

 

Changes in shareholders’ account is as follows:

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
At 1 January     47,717,763       70,421,436  
Net contributions (distributions) during the year     23,300,052       (22,703,673 )
                 
At 31 December     71,017,815       47,717,763  

 

F-34 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

20 RELATED PARTY TRANSACTIONS AND BALANCES continued

 

Transactions with related parties continued

Movements in other related parties are as follows:

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Expenses paid on behalf of related parties (note 10)     57,550       -  
                 
Due from related parties:                
HBS Investments LP (shareholder)     13,388       -  
H Capital International LP (shareholder)     11,056       -  
O2 Investments Limited as GP (shareholder)     6,181       -  
SBD International LP (shareholder)     13,760       -  
SD Holding Limited as GP (shareholder)     6,984       -  
Gyan Investments Ltd (shareholder)     6,181       -  
                 
      57,550       -  

 

Key management remuneration for the year ended 31 December 2019 amounted to USD 1,160,293 (2018: USD 677,291), charged to consolidated statement of comprehensive income (within profit and loss). The full amount of the key management remuneration relates to short term employment benefits.

 

21 EARNINGS PER SHARE

 

Basic EPS is calculated by dividing the profit/(loss) for the year attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year.

 

Diluted EPS is calculated by dividing the profit attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent by the weighted average number of ordinary shares outstanding during the year plus the weighted average number of ordinary shares that would be issued on conversion of all the dilutive potential ordinary shares into ordinary shares.

 

The following table reflects the income and share data used in the basic and diluted EPS calculations:

 

    2019     2018     2017  
    USD     USD     USD  
                         
(Loss) / Profit attributable to ordinary equity holders of the parent     (76,558,663 )     16,060,652       (3,747,408 )

 

    2019     2018     2017  
    No of shares     No of shares     No of shares  
          (Restated)     (Restated)  
                         
Weighted average number of ordinary shares     80,264,186       80,000,000       80,000,000  

 

As part of the business combination (note 25) warrants and ordinary shares subjected to escrow has been issued. In the calculation of diluted earnings per shares, the warrants have been excluded as the average market price of ordinary shares during the period exceeded the exercise price of the warrants i.e they are not in the money.

 

The number of contingently issuable shares (escrow shares) to be included in the diluted earnings per shares calculation is based on the number of shares that would be issuable if the end of the period were the end of the contingency period. No ordinary shares would have been issuable on 31 December 2019 as the conditions attached to the escrow shares have not been met at reporting date. As a result, the escrow shares have been excluded from the calculation of diluted earnings per share for 31 December 2019 and the weighted average number of ordinary shares for basic earnings per share and diluted earnings per shares are the same.

 

Between, the reporting date and the date of authorization of these financial statements, holders of 100 warrants have exercised their rights and converted the warrants into ordinary shares.

 

F-35 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019 

 

22 COMMITMENTS

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Capital commitments:                
Within one year     79,334,742       144,027,770  
More than 1 year and less than 5 years     -       16,534,876  
                 
    79,334,742       160,562,646  

 

Capital commitments relate to construction of phase 2 which is expected to be completed by the end of last quarter of 2020.

 

23 FAIR VALUE OF FINANCIAL INSTRUMENTS

 

Management considers that the fair value of financial assets and financial liabilities in the consolidated financial statements approximate their carrying amounts at the reporting date.

 

Fair value hierarchy

The following table provides an analysis of financial instruments that are measured subsequent to initial recognition at fair value, grouped into Levels 1 to 3 based on the degree to which the fair value is observable.

  

                      Total  
    Level 1     Level 2     Level 3     fair value  
    USD     USD     USD     USD  
                         
Liabilities measured at fair value:                                
                                 
31 December 2019                                
Derivative financial instruments         -       1,518,249           -       1,518,249  
                                 
31 December 2018                                
Derivative financial instruments     -       1,190,073       -       1,190,073  

 

The fair values of the financial liabilities measured at fair value included in the Level 2 category above, have been determined in accordance with generally accepted pricing models based on a discounted cash flow analysis. The models incorporate various inputs including interest rate curves and forward rate curves of the underlying instruments.

 

During the year ended 31 December 2019 and 2018, there were no transfers between Level 1 and Level 2 fair value measurements.

 

24 FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT AND POLICIES

 

The main risks arising from the Group’s financial instruments are interest rate risk, credit risk, currency risk and liquidity risk. Management reviews and agrees policies for managing each of these risks which are summarized below.

 

Interest rate risk

Interest rate risk is the risk that the fair value or future cash flows of a financial instrument will fluctuate because of changes in market interest rates.

 

The Group’s exposure to the risk of changes in market interest rates relates primarily to the Group’s balances with banks and interest bearing loans and borrowings at variable rates.

 

F-36 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

24 FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT AND POLICIES continued

 

Interest rate risk continued

 

Interest rate sensitivity

The following table demonstrates the sensitivity to a reasonably possible change in interest rates, with other variables held constant, of the Group’s profit for one year corresponding to the impact of the floating rate borrowings for one year. The effect of the interest rate swap has been excluded from the sensitivity as the Group does not apply hedge accounting.

 

    Effect on  
    profit  
    USD  
       
2019        
+40 increase in basis points     347,971  
-40 decrease in basis points     (347,971 )
         
2018        
+40 increase in basis points     (381,713 )
-40 decrease in basis points     381,713  

 

Currency risk

The Group does not have any significant exposure to currency risk as most of its assets and liabilities are denominated in USD or UAE Dirhams, which are pegged to the USD.

 

Credit risk

Credit risk is the risk that one party to a financial instrument will fail to discharge an obligation and cause the other party to incur a financial loss. The Group is exposed to credit risk on bank balances and receivables as reflected in the consolidated statement of financial position, with a maximum exposure equal to the carrying amount of these instruments. The expected credit loss on trade and other receivables are considered insignificant for 2019 and 2018.

 

The Group has a low credit risk exposure on its trade receivables based on established policy, procedures and controls relating to customer credit risk management. Credit quality of the customer is assessed as part of contract negotiations. Outstanding receivables are regularly monitored. The Group has only one customer as at 31 December 2019 (31 December 2018: one customer).

 

Liquidity risk

The Group monitors its risk to a shortage of funds using a recurring liquidity planning tool. This tool considers projected financing requirements of the Group during the construction phase and cash projections from operations with outstanding bank facilities and outstanding bank commitments as defined under the finance documents.

 

The Group manages its liquidity risk in relation to term loans to ensure compliance with all covenants for each specific facility. Refer note 2.2 for further details.

 

F-37 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

24 FINANCIAL RISK MANAGEMENT AND POLICIES continued

 

Liquidity risk continued

 

The table below summarizes the maturity profile of the Group’s financial liabilities at 31 December 2019 and 31 December 2018 based on contractual undiscounted payments.

 

    On     Less than     3 months     1 to 5              
    demand     3 months     to 1 year     years     > 5 years     Total  
    USD     USD     USD     USD     USD     USD  
                                     
31 December 2019                                                
Term loans (including accrued interest)     -       8,101,006       9,178,414       34,165,752       40,550,347       91,995,519  
Lease liability     -       2,359,590       -       9,919,810       213,469,799       225,749,199  
Derivative financial instruments     -       -       1,518,249       -       -       1,518,249  
Accounts payable, accruals and other payables (excluding accrued interest)     -       26,350,143       31,469,596       -       -       57,819,739  
                                                 
Total     -       36,810,739       42,166,259       44,085,562       254,020,146       377,082,706  
                                                 
31 December 2018                                                
Bank overdraft     3,745,048       -       -       -       -       3,745,048  
Term loans (including accrued interest)     95,702,779       -       -       -       -       95,702,779  
Lease liability     -       2,313,323       -       9,725,304       216,023,896       228,062,523  
Derivative financial instruments     -       -       1,190,073       -       -       1,190,073  
Accounts payable, accruals and other payables (excluding accrued interest)     -       2,120,877       5,972,230       -       -       8,093,107  
                                                 
Total     99,447,827       4,434,200       7,162,303       9,725,304       216,023,896       336,793,530  

 

Capital management

The primary objective of the Group’s capital management is to ensure that it maintains healthy capital ratios in order to support its business and maximize shareholder’s value and to meet its loan covenants.

 

The Group manages its capital structure and makes adjustments to it, in light of changes in economic conditions. To maintain or adjust the capital structure, the Group may adjust future distribution policy to shareholders, issue new shares or shareholders’ contributions.

 

The Group monitors capital using a gearing ratio, which is net debt divided by total capital plus net debt. The Group includes within net debt, the lease liability, term loans, and trade and other payables, less cash and cash equivalents. Capital includes share capital, shareholders’ accounts, general reserve and (accumulated losses) retained earnings. Refer to note 15 for discussion on Group’s debt covenants.

 

    2019     2018  
    USD     USD  
             
Term loans     88,700,137       94,792,088  
Lease liability     30,779,137       30,221,425  
Less: cash and cash equivalents     (19,830,771 )     3,707,697  
                 
Net debt     99,648,503       128,721,210  
                 
Total capital     125,125,875       60,977,933  
                 
Capital and net debt     224,774,378       189,699,143  
                 
Gearing ratio     44 %     68 %

F-38 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

25 BUSINESS COMBINATION

 

In connection with the Business Combination as described in note 1, the following occurred:

 

Twelve Seas:

Each outstanding ordinary share of Twelve Seas has been exchanged for one (1) ordinary share of Brooge Energy.

Each outstanding warrant of Twelve Seas has been exchanged for one warrant of Brooge Energy.

As part of the Business Combination, 10,869,719 shares were issued to Twelve Seas which included 1.5 million Escrow shares subject to meeting certain financial milestones stated in this note below. Further, 21,229,000 warrants were issued to Twelve Seas in exchange ratio stated above and further details disclosed in note 13.

In connection with the closing of the Business Combination, holders of 16,997,181 ordinary shares of Twelve Seas sold in Twelve Seas’s Initial Public Offering (“IPO”) exercised their right to redeem such shares at a price of $10.31 per share, for an aggregate redemption amount of approximately USD 175.36 million.

 

Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE:

Twelve Seas issued a total of 100 million shares (inclusive of 20 million of escrowed shares) to BPGIC in exchange for 100 ordinary shares of BPGIC. All 100 million shares were simultaneously replaced with Brooge Energy shares at the ratio of 1:1.

 

The fair value of the shares that were swapped between the parties above was based on the closing share price of Brooge Energy’s as traded on NASDAQ on 20 December 2019 which was USD 10.49 per share.

 

The fair value of the warrants that were swapped between the parties above was based on the closing price of Brooge Energy’s as traded on NASDAQ on 20 December 2019 which was USD 0.80 per warrant.

 

As part of the above-mentioned business combination, Twelve Seas’ net assets of USD 32.4 million (see below) were assumed by the Company and the issuance of ordinary shares and warrants by the Company was recognized at fair value of USD 131.0 million, with the resulting difference amounting to USD 98.6 million representing the listing expense recognized on the transaction. In addition, the Group incurred other listing expenses such as lawyers and consultants fees of USD 3.1 million, resulting in a total listing expense of USD 101.9 million as reflected in the consolidated statement of comprehensive income.

  

The net assets of USD 32,383,588 were assumed on 20 December 2019 comprised of:

 

    USD  
       
Cash and cash equivalent     33,064,568  
Current assets     84,000  
Accounts payable     (765,000 )

 

Shares issued to Twelve Seas as part of the Business Combination included escrow shares of 1,552,000 being 30% of the founder shares which are subject to meeting certain financial milestones as mentioned below. The fair value of the shares in escrow is not materially different from that of the shares which are not in escrow as the rights of these shares are similar to those of “normal ordinary shares” since, management has a reasonable expectation that the subject financial milestones will be met.

 

F-39 

 

 

Brooge Energy Limited

 

NOTES TO THE FINANCIAL CONSOLIDATED STATEMENTS

31 December 2019

 

25 BUSINESS COMBINATION continued

 

The total shares issued by Brooge Energy to BGPIC was 98,718,035 (inclusive of the 20 million shares in escrow) after reduction of 1,281,965 shares due to the 40% cash election exercised by BPGIC. 20,000,000 of the Exchange Shares (“Escrow Property”) otherwise issuable to BPGIC is set aside in escrow until released upon the satisfaction of certain financial milestones and share price targets below:

 

One-half (½) of the Escrow Property shall become vested and no longer subject to forfeiture, and be released to the seller, in the event that either: (a) the Annualized EBITDA (as defined in the Escrow Agreement) for any full fiscal quarter during the Escrow Period (beginning with the first full fiscal quarter beginning after the Closing) (an “Escrow Quarter”) equals or exceeds USD 175,000,000 or (b) at any time during the Escrow Period, the closing price of the Brooge Energy ordinary shares equals or exceeds $12.50 per share (subject to equitable adjustment) for any ten (10) Trading Days (as defined in the Escrow Agreement) within any twenty (20) Trading Day period during the Escrow Period.

 

All Escrow Property remaining in the Escrow Account shall become vested and no longer subject to forfeiture, and be released to the seller, in the event that either: (a) the Annualized EBITDA for any Escrow Quarter equals or exceeds $250,000,000 or (b) at any time during the Escrow Period, the closing price of the Brooge Energy ordinary shares equals or exceeds $14.00 per share (subject to equitable adjustment) for any ten (10) Trading Days within any twenty (20) Trading Day period during the Escrow Period.

 

The same conditions mentioned above applied for the escrow founder shares.

 

26 SUBSEQUENT EVENTS

 

The outbreak of Novel Coronavirus (COVID 19) continues to progress and evolve. Therefore, it is challenging now, to predict the full extent and duration of its business and economic impact. The outbreak of Covid-19 has had an impact on demand for oil and petroleum products. Recent global developments in March 2020 have caused further volatility in commodity markets.

 

The extent and duration of such impacts remain uncertain and dependent on future developments that cannot be accurately predicted at this time, such as the transmission rate of the coronavirus and the extent and effectiveness of containment actions taken. Given the ongoing economic uncertainty, a reliable estimate of the impact cannot be made at the date of authorisation of these consolidated financial statements. These developments could impact our future financial results, cash flows and financial condition.

 

The Group has entered into a land lease agreement, dated as of 2 February 2020 (the “Phase III Land Lease Agreement”), by and between Group and the Fujairah Oil Industry Zone (“FOIZ”) to lease an additional plot of land that has a total area of approximately 450,000 m2 (the “Phase III Land”). Group intends to use the relevant land to expand its crude oil storage and service and refinery capacity (“Phase III”).

 

In February 2020, the Group and Sahara Energy Resources DMCC mutually agreed to discontinue their joint development discussions to install a modular oil refinery at Group’s terminal. Shortly thereafter, the Group entered into a new agreement with BIA (the “Refinery Agreement”) which provides that the parties will use their best efforts to finalize the technical and design feasibility studies for a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd (the “BIA Refinery”).

 

On 07 April 2020, the Company changed its name from Brooge Holding Limited to Brooge Energy Limited.

 

In May 2020, BIA agreed to release 129,000 m3 of the Phase I capacity, amounting to approximately one third of the total Phase I capacity, back to BPGIC. BPGIC leased this capacity to, Totsa Total Oil Trading SA (the “Super Major”), for a 6 month period (the “Super Major Agreement”) subject to renewal for an additional 6 month period with the mutual agreement of the parties. On expiration of the agreement, BPGIC has to return back 129,000 m3 to BIA.

 

The Group negotiated another amendment to the term loan facilities (1) and (2) on 15 June 2020. Loans (1) and (2) are now payable in 46 and 16 instalments, respectively, with the first installment starting from 30 June 2020 with final maturity in 30 July 2030 and 31 July 2023, respectively. The loan 1 carries interest at 6 months EIBOR + 4% (minimum 5%) and to be further enhanced to 6 month EIBOR + 4.5% (minimum 5%) from January 2021 as compared to interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3% previously, and, the loan 2 carries interest at 3 months EIBOR + 4% (minimum 5%) and to be further enhanced to 3 month EIBOR + 4.5% (minimum 5%) as compared to interest at 3 month EIBOR + 3% previously The Group has to pay USD 8.8 million for term loan (1) and (2) in 2020 which represents the cumulative instalments including interest outstanding from periods prior to this amended agreement and an amendment fee of USD 136,000. All securities and covenants under the original agreements remain in effect under the amended agreement except debt service reserve account (DSRA) balance to be maintained from 31 October 2020 and debt service coverage ratio (DSCR) to be commenced from 31 December 2020. Under this agreement, term loans (1) and (2) are also secured by assignment of the proceeds from operation of the tanks of phase 1 and 2.

 

 

F-40 

Exhibit 1.1

 

THE COMPANIES LAW (2020 Revision)

 

OF THE CAYMAN ISLANDS

 

COMPANY LIMITED BY SHARES

 

AMENDED AND RESTATED

 

MEMORANDUM AND ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

 

OF

 

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED

 

(ADOPTED BY SPECIAL RESOLUTION DATED 7 April 2020 AND EFFECTIVE ON 7 April 2020)

 

1

 

 

THE COMPANIES LAW (2020 Revision)

 

OF THE CAYMAN ISLANDS

 

COMPANY LIMITED BY SHARES

 

AMENDED AND RESTATED

 

MEMORANDUM OF ASSOCIATION

 

OF

 

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED

 

(adopted by special resolution dated 7 April 2020 and effective on 7 April 2020)

 

1 The name of the Company is Brooge Energy Limited

 

2 The Registered Office of the Company shall be at the offices of Maples Corporate Services Limited, PO Box 309, Ugland House, Grand Cayman, KY1-1104, Cayman Islands, or at such other place within the Cayman Islands as the Directors may decide.

 

3 The objects for which the Company is established are unrestricted and the Company shall have full power and authority to carry out any object not prohibited by the laws of the Cayman Islands.

 

4 The liability of each Member is limited to the amount unpaid on such Member’s shares.

 

5 The share capital of the Company is US$50,000 divided into 450,000,000 ordinary shares of a par value of US$0.0001 each and 50,000,000 preferred shares of a par value of US$0.0001 each.

 

6 The Company has power to register by way of continuation as a body corporate limited by shares under the laws of any jurisdiction outside the Cayman Islands and to be deregistered in the Cayman Islands.

 

7 Capitalised terms that are not defined in this Memorandum of Association bear the respective meanings given to them in the Articles of Association of the Company.

   

2

 

 

THE COMPANIES LAW (2020 Revision)

 

OF THE CAYMAN ISLANDS

 

COMPANY LIMITED BY SHARES

 

AMENDED AND RESTATED

 

ARTICLES OF ASSOCIATION

 

OF

 

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED

 

(ADOPTED BY SPECIAL RESOLUTION DATED 7 April 2020 AND EFFECTIVE ON 7 April 2020)

 

1 Interpretation

 

1.1 In the Articles Table A in the First Schedule to the Statute does not apply and, unless there is something in the subject or context inconsistent therewith:

 

  Articles means these articles of association of the Company.
     
  Audit Committee means the audit committee of the Company formed pursuant to the Articles, or any successor audit committee.
     
  Auditor means the person for the time being performing the duties of auditor of the Company (if any).
     
  clearing house a clearing house recognised by the laws of the jurisdiction in which the Shares (or depositary receipts therefor) are listed or quoted on a stock exchange or interdealer quotation system in such jurisdiction.
     
 

Company

means the above named company.
     
  Designated Stock Exchange means any national securities exchange including NASDAQ Capital Market or NASDAQ.
     
  Directors means the directors for the time being of the Company.
     
  Dividend means any dividend (whether interim or final) resolved to be paid on Shares pursuant to the Articles.
     
  Electronic Record has the same meaning as in the Electronic Transactions Law.

 

3

 

 

  Electronic Transactions Law means the Electronic Transactions Law (2003 Revision) of the Cayman Islands.
     
  Member has the same meaning as in the Statute.
     
  Memorandum means the memorandum of association of the Company.
     
  Ordinary Resolution means a resolution passed by a simple majority of the Members as, being entitled to do so, vote in person or, where proxies are allowed, by proxy at a general meeting. In computing the majority when a poll is demanded regard shall be had to the number of votes to which each Member is entitled by the Articles.
     
  Ordinary Share means an ordinary share of a par value of US$0.0001 in the share capital of the Company.
     
  Preferred Share means a preferred share of a par value of US$0.0001 in the share capital of the Company.
     
  Register of Members means the register of Members maintained in accordance with the Statute and includes (except where otherwise stated) any branch or duplicate register of Members.
     
  Registered Office means the registered office for the time being of the Company.
     
  Seal means the common seal of the Company and includes every duplicate seal.
     
  SEC means the United States Securities and Exchange Commission.
     
  Share means an Ordinary Share or a Preferred Share and includes a fraction of a share in the Company.
     
  Special Resolution has the same meaning as in the Statute.
     
  Statute means the Companies Law (2020 Revision) of the Cayman Islands.
     
  Treasury Share means a Share held in the name of the Company as a treasury share in accordance with the Statute.

 

1.2 In the Articles:

 

(a) words importing the singular number include the plural number and vice versa;

 

4

 

 

(b) words importing the masculine gender include the feminine gender;

 

(c) words importing persons include corporations as well as any other legal or natural person;

 

(d) “written” and “in writing” include all modes of representing or reproducing words in visible form, including in the form of an Electronic Record;

 

(e) “shall” shall be construed as imperative and “may” shall be construed as permissive;

 

(f) references to provisions of any law or regulation shall be construed as references to those provisions as amended, modified, re-enacted or replaced;

 

(g) any phrase introduced by the terms “including”, “include”, “in particular” or any similar expression shall be construed as illustrative and shall not limit the sense of the words preceding those terms;

 

(h) the term “and/or” is used herein to mean both “and” as well as “or.” The use of “and/or” in certain contexts in no respects qualifies or modifies the use of the terms “and” or “or” in others. The term “or” shall not be interpreted to be exclusive and the term “and” shall not be interpreted to require the conjunctive (in each case, unless the context otherwise requires);

 

(i) headings are inserted for reference only and shall be ignored in construing the Articles;

 

(j) any requirements as to delivery under the Articles include delivery in the form of an Electronic Record;

 

(k) any requirements as to execution or signature under the Articles including the execution of the Articles themselves can be satisfied in the form of an electronic signature as defined in the Electronic Transactions Law;

 

(l) sections 8 and 19(3) of the Electronic Transactions Law shall not apply;

 

(m) the term “clear days” in relation to the period of a notice means that period excluding the day when the notice is received or deemed to be received and the day for which it is given or on which it is to take effect; and

 

(n) the term “holder” in relation to a Share means a person whose name is entered in the Register of Members as the holder of such Share.

 

2 Commencement of Business

 

2.1 The business of the Company may be commenced as soon after incorporation of the Company as the Directors shall see fit.

 

5

 

 

2.2 The Directors may pay, out of the capital or any other monies of the Company, all expenses incurred in or about the formation and establishment of the Company, including the expenses of registration.

 

3 Issue of Shares

 

3.1 Subject to the provisions, if any, in the Memorandum (and to any direction that may be given by the Company in general meeting) and, where applicable, the rules of the Designated Stock Exchange, the SEC and/or any other competent regulatory authority, and without prejudice to any rights attached to any existing Shares, the Directors may allot, issue, grant options over or otherwise dispose of Shares (including fractions of a Share) with or without preferred, deferred or other rights or restrictions, whether in regard to Dividend or other distribution, voting, return of capital or otherwise and to such persons, at such times and on such other terms as they think proper, and may also (subject to the Statute and the Articles) vary such rights.

 

3.2 The Company may issue rights, options, warrants or convertible securities or securities of similar nature conferring the right upon the holders thereof to subscribe for, purchase or receive any class of Shares or other securities in the Company on such terms as the Directors may from time to time determine.

 

3.3 The Company shall not issue Shares to bearer.

 

4 Register of Members

 

4.1 The Company shall maintain or cause to be maintained the Register of Members in accordance with the Statute.

 

4.2 The Directors may determine that the Company shall maintain one or more branch registers of Members in accordance with the Statute. The Directors may also determine which register of Members shall constitute the principal register and which shall constitute the branch register or registers, and to vary such determination from time to time.

 

5 Fixing Record Date

 

The Directors shall fix in advance a date as the record date for any such determination of Members entitled to notice of, or to vote at any meeting of the Members or any adjournment thereof, or for the purpose of determining the Members entitled to receive payment of any Dividend or other distribution, or in order to make a determination of Members for any other purpose.

 

6 Certificates for Shares

 

6.1 A Member shall only be entitled to a share certificate if the Directors resolve that share certificates shall be issued. Share certificates representing Shares, if any, shall be in such form as the Directors may determine. Share certificates shall be signed by one or more Directors or other person authorised by the Directors. The Directors may authorise certificates to be issued with the authorised signature(s) affixed by mechanical process. All certificates for Shares shall be consecutively numbered or otherwise identified and shall specify the Shares to which they relate. All certificates surrendered to the Company for transfer shall be cancelled and, subject to the Articles, no new certificate shall be issued until the former certificate representing a like number of relevant Shares shall have been surrendered and cancelled.

 

6

 

 

6.2 The Company shall not be bound to issue more than one certificate for Shares held jointly by more than one person and delivery of a certificate to one joint holder shall be a sufficient delivery to all of them.

 

6.3 If a share certificate is defaced, worn out, lost or destroyed, it may be renewed on such terms (if any) as to evidence and indemnity and on the payment of such expenses reasonably incurred by the Company in investigating evidence, as the Directors may prescribe, and (in the case of defacement or wearing out) upon delivery of the old certificate.

 

6.4 Every share certificate sent in accordance with the Articles will be sent at the risk of the Member or other person entitled to the certificate. The Company will not be responsible for any share certificate lost or delayed in the course of delivery.

 

6.5 Share certificates shall be issued within the relevant time limit as prescribed by the Statute, if applicable, or as the Designated Stock Exchange may from time to time determine, whichever is shorter, after the allotment or, except in the case of a Share transfer which the Company is for the time being entitled to refuse to register and does not register, after lodgement of a Share transfer with the Company.

 

7 Transfer of Shares

 

7.1 Subject to the terms of the Articles, any Member may transfer all or any of his Shares by an instrument of transfer provided that such transfer complies with applicable rules of the Designation Stock Exchange and the SEC and federal and state securities laws of the United States. If the Shares in question were issued in conjunction with rights, options or warrants issued pursuant to Article 3 on terms that one cannot be transferred without the other, the Directors shall refuse to register the transfer of any such Share without evidence satisfactory to them of the like transfer of such option or warrant.

 

7.2 The instrument of transfer of any Share shall be in writing in the usual or common form or in a form prescribed by the Designated Stock Exchange and the SEC or in any other form approved by the Directors and shall be executed by or on behalf of the transferor (and if the Directors so require, signed by or on behalf of the transferee) and may be under hand or, if the transferor or transferee is a clearing house or its nominee(s), by hand or by machine imprinted signature or by such other manner of execution as the Directors may approve from time to time. The transferor shall be deemed to remain the holder of a Share until the name of the transferee is entered in the Register of Members.

 

7

 

 

8 Redemption, Repurchase and Surrender of Shares

 

8.1 Subject to the provisions of the Statute, and, where applicable, the rules of the Designated Stock Exchange, the SEC and/or any other competent regulatory authority, the Company may issue Shares that are to be redeemed or are liable to be redeemed at the option of the Member or the Company. The redemption of such Shares shall be effected in such manner and upon such other terms as the Company may, by Special Resolution, determine before the issue of the Shares.

 

8.2 Subject to the provisions of the Statute, and, where applicable, the rules of the Designated Stock Exchange, the SEC and/or any other competent regulatory authority, the Company may purchase its own Shares (including any redeemable Shares) in such manner and on such other terms as the Directors may agree with the relevant Member.

 

8.3 The Company may make a payment in respect of the redemption or purchase of its own Shares in any manner permitted by the Statute, including out of capital.

 

8.4 The Directors may accept the surrender for no consideration of any fully paid Share.

 

9 Treasury Shares

 

9.1 The Directors may, prior to the purchase, redemption or surrender of any Share, determine that such Share shall be held as a Treasury Share.

 

9.2 The Directors may determine to cancel a Treasury Share or transfer a Treasury Share on such terms as they think proper (including, without limitation, for nil consideration).

 

10 Variation of Rights of Shares

 

10.1 If at any time the share capital of the Company is divided into different classes of Shares, all or any of the rights attached to any class (unless otherwise provided by the terms of issue of the Shares of that class) may, whether or not the Company is being wound up, be varied without the consent of the holders of the issued Shares of that class where such variation is considered by the Directors not to have a material adverse effect upon such rights; otherwise, any such variation shall be made only with the consent in writing of the holders of not less than two thirds of the issued Shares of that class, or with the approval of a resolution passed by a majority of not less than two thirds of the votes cast at a separate meeting of the holders of the Shares of that class. For the avoidance of doubt, the Directors reserve the right, notwithstanding that any such variation may not have a material adverse effect, to obtain consent from the holders of Shares of the relevant class. To any such meeting all the provisions of the Articles relating to general meetings shall apply mutatis mutandis.

 

10.2 For the purposes of a separate class meeting, the Directors may treat two or more or all the classes of Shares as forming one class of Shares if the Directors consider that such class of Shares would be affected in the same way by the proposals under consideration, but in any other case shall treat them as separate classes of Shares.

 

8

 

 

10.3 The rights conferred upon the holders of the Shares of any class issued with preferred or other rights shall not, unless otherwise expressly provided by the terms of issue of the Shares of that class, be deemed to be varied by the creation or issue of further Shares ranking pari passu therewith.

 

11 Commission on Sale of Shares

 

The Company may, in so far as the Statute permits, pay a commission to any person in consideration of his subscribing or agreeing to subscribe (whether absolutely or conditionally) or procuring or agreeing to procure subscriptions (whether absolutely or conditionally) for any Shares. Such commissions may be satisfied by the payment of cash and/or the issue of fully or partly paid-up Shares. The Company may also on any issue of Shares pay such brokerage as may be lawful.

 

12 Non Recognition of Trusts

 

The Company shall not be bound by or compelled to recognise in any way (even when notified) any equitable, contingent, future or partial interest in any Share, or (except only as is otherwise provided by the Articles or the Statute) any other rights in respect of any Share other than an absolute right to the entirety thereof in the holder.

 

13 Lien on Shares

 

13.1 The Company shall have a first and paramount lien on all Shares (whether fully paid-up or not) registered in the name of a Member (whether solely or jointly with others) for all debts, liabilities or engagements to or with the Company (whether presently payable or not) by such Member or his estate, either alone or jointly with any other person, whether a Member or not, but the Directors may at any time declare any Share to be wholly or in part exempt from the provisions of this Article. The registration of a transfer of any such Share shall operate as a waiver of the Company’s lien thereon. The Company’s lien on a Share shall also extend to any amount payable in respect of that Share.

 

13.2 The Company may sell, in such manner as the Directors think fit, any Shares on which the Company has a lien, if a sum in respect of which the lien exists is presently payable, and is not paid within fourteen clear days after notice has been received or deemed to have been received by the holder of the Shares, or to the person entitled to it in consequence of the death or bankruptcy of the holder, demanding payment and stating that if the notice is not complied with the Shares may be sold.

 

13.3 To give effect to any such sale the Directors may authorise any person to execute an instrument of transfer of the Shares sold to, or in accordance with the directions of, the purchaser. The purchaser or his nominee shall be registered as the holder of the Shares comprised in any such transfer, and he shall not be bound to see to the application of the purchase money, nor shall his title to the Shares be affected by any irregularity or invalidity in the sale or the exercise of the Company’s power of sale under the Articles.

 

9

 

 

13.4 The net proceeds of such sale after payment of costs, shall be applied in payment of such part of the amount in respect of which the lien exists as is presently payable and any balance shall (subject to a like lien for sums not presently payable as existed upon the Shares before the sale) be paid to the person entitled to the Shares at the date of the sale.

 

14 Call on Shares

 

14.1 Subject to the terms of the allotment and issue of any Shares, the Directors may make calls upon the Members in respect of any monies unpaid on their Shares (whether in respect of par value or premium), and each Member shall (subject to receiving at least fourteen clear days’ notice specifying the time or times of payment) pay to the Company at the time or times so specified the amount called on the Shares. A call may be revoked or postponed, in whole or in part, as the Directors may determine. A call may be required to be paid by instalments. A person upon whom a call is made shall remain liable for calls made upon him notwithstanding the subsequent transfer of the Shares in respect of which the call was made.

 

14.2 A call shall be deemed to have been made at the time when the resolution of the Directors authorising such call was passed.

 

14.3 The joint holders of a Share shall be jointly and severally liable to pay all calls in respect thereof.

 

14.4 If a call remains unpaid after it has become due and payable, the person from whom it is due shall pay interest on the amount unpaid from the day it became due and payable until it is paid at such rate as the Directors may determine (and in addition all expenses that have been incurred by the Company by reason of such non-payment), but the Directors may waive payment of the interest or expenses wholly or in part.

 

14.5 An amount payable in respect of a Share on issue or allotment or at any fixed date, whether on account of the par value of the Share or premium or otherwise, shall be deemed to be a call and if it is not paid all the provisions of the Articles shall apply as if that amount had become due and payable by virtue of a call.

 

14.6 The Directors may issue Shares with different terms as to the amount and times of payment of calls, or the interest to be paid.

 

14.7 The Directors may, if they think fit, receive an amount from any Member willing to advance all or any part of the monies uncalled and unpaid upon any Shares held by him, and may (until the amount would otherwise become payable) pay interest at such rate as may be agreed upon between the Directors and the Member paying such amount in advance.

 

14.8 No such amount paid in advance of calls shall entitle the Member paying such amount to any portion of a Dividend or other distribution payable in respect of any period prior to the date upon which such amount would, but for such payment, become payable.

 

10

 

 

15 Forfeiture of Shares

 

15.1 If a call or instalment of a call remains unpaid after it has become due and payable the Directors may give to the person from whom it is due not less than fourteen clear days’ notice requiring payment of the amount unpaid together with any interest which may have accrued and any expenses incurred by the Company by reason of such non-payment. The notice shall specify where payment is to be made and shall state that if the notice is not complied with the Shares in respect of which the call was made will be liable to be forfeited.

 

15.2 If the notice is not complied with, any Share in respect of which it was given may, before the payment required by the notice has been made, be forfeited by a resolution of the Directors. Such forfeiture shall include all Dividends, other distributions or other monies payable in respect of the forfeited Share and not paid before the forfeiture.

 

15.3 A forfeited Share may be sold, re-allotted or otherwise disposed of on such terms and in such manner as the Directors think fit and at any time before a sale, re-allotment or disposition the forfeiture may be cancelled on such terms as the Directors think fit. Where for the purposes of its disposal a forfeited Share is to be transferred to any person the Directors may authorise some person to execute an instrument of transfer of the Share in favour of that person.

 

15.4 A person any of whose Shares have been forfeited shall cease to be a Member in respect of them and shall surrender to the Company for cancellation the certificate for the Shares forfeited and shall remain liable to pay to the Company all monies which at the date of forfeiture were payable by him to the Company in respect of those Shares together with interest at such rate as the Directors may determine, but his liability shall cease if and when the Company shall have received payment in full of all monies due and payable by him in respect of those Shares.

 

15.5 A certificate in writing under the hand of one Director or officer of the Company that a Share has been forfeited on a specified date shall be conclusive evidence of the facts stated in it as against all persons claiming to be entitled to the Share. The certificate shall (subject to the execution of an instrument of transfer) constitute a good title to the Share and the person to whom the Share is sold or otherwise disposed of shall not be bound to see to the application of the purchase money, if any, nor shall his title to the Share be affected by any irregularity or invalidity in the proceedings in reference to the forfeiture, sale or disposal of the Share.

 

15.6 The provisions of the Articles as to forfeiture shall apply in the case of non payment of any sum which, by the terms of issue of a Share, becomes payable at a fixed time, whether on account of the par value of the Share or by way of premium as if it had been payable by virtue of a call duly made and notified.

 

16 Transmission of Shares

 

16.1 If a Member dies, the survivor or survivors (where he was a joint holder), or his legal personal representatives (where he was a sole holder), shall be the only persons recognised by the Company as having any title to his Shares. The estate of a deceased Member is not thereby released from any liability in respect of any Share, for which he was a joint or sole holder.

 

11

 

 

16.2 Any person becoming entitled to a Share in consequence of the death or bankruptcy or liquidation or dissolution of a Member (or in any other way than by transfer) may, upon such evidence being produced as may be required by the Directors, elect, by a notice in writing sent by him to the Company, either to become the holder of such Share or to have some person nominated by him registered as the holder of such Share. If he elects to have another person registered as the holder of such Share he shall sign an instrument of transfer of that Share to that person. The Directors shall, in either case, have the same right to decline or suspend registration as they would have had in the case of a transfer of the Share by the relevant Member before his death or bankruptcy or liquidation or dissolution, as the case may be.

 

16.3 A person becoming entitled to a Share by reason of the death or bankruptcy or liquidation or dissolution of a Member (or in any other case than by transfer) shall be entitled to the same Dividends, other distributions and other advantages to which he would be entitled if he were the holder of such Share. However, he shall not, before becoming a Member in respect of a Share, be entitled in respect of it to exercise any right conferred by membership in relation to general meetings of the Company and the Directors may at any time give notice requiring any such person to elect either to be registered himself or to have some person nominated by him be registered as the holder of the Share (but the Directors shall, in either case, have the same right to decline or suspend registration as they would have had in the case of a transfer of the Share by the relevant Member before his death or bankruptcy or liquidation or dissolution or any other case than by transfer, as the case may be). If the notice is not complied with within ninety days of being received or deemed to be received (as determined pursuant to the Articles), the Directors may thereafter withhold payment of all Dividends, other distributions, bonuses or other monies payable in respect of the Share until the requirements of the notice have been complied with.

 

17 Amendments of Memorandum and Articles of Association and Alteration of Capital

 

17.1 The Company may by Ordinary Resolution:

 

(a) increase its share capital by such sum as the Ordinary Resolution shall prescribe and with such rights, priorities and privileges annexed thereto, as the Company in general meeting may determine;

 

(b) consolidate and divide all or any of its share capital into Shares of larger amount than its existing Shares;

 

(c) convert all or any of its paid-up Shares into stock, and reconvert that stock into paid-up Shares of any denomination;

 

(d) by subdivision of its existing Shares or any of them divide the whole or any part of its share capital into Shares of smaller amount than is fixed by the Memorandum or into Shares without par value; and

 

(e) cancel any Shares that at the date of the passing of the Ordinary Resolution have not been taken or agreed to be taken by any person and diminish the amount of its share capital by the amount of the Shares so cancelled.

 

12

 

 

17.2 All new Shares created in accordance with the provisions of the preceding Article shall be subject to the same provisions of the Articles with reference to the payment of calls, liens, transfer, transmission, forfeiture and otherwise as the Shares in the original share capital.

 

17.3 Subject to the provisions of the Statute, the provisions of the Articles as regards the matters to be dealt with by Ordinary Resolution, the Company may by Special Resolution:

 

(a) change its name;

 

(b) alter or add to the Articles;

 

(c) alter or add to the Memorandum with respect to any objects, powers or other matters specified therein; and

 

(d) reduce its share capital or any capital redemption reserve fund.

 

18 Offices and Places of Business

 

Subject to the provisions of the Statute, the Company may by resolution of the Directors change the location of its Registered Office. The Company may, in addition to its Registered Office, maintain such other offices or places of business as the Directors determine.

 

19 General Meetings

 

19.1 All general meetings other than annual general meetings shall be called extraordinary general meetings.

 

19.2 The Company may, but shall not (unless required by the Statute) be obliged to, in each year hold a general meeting as its annual general meeting, and shall specify the meeting as such in the notices calling it. Any annual general meeting shall be held at such time and place as the Directors shall appoint. At these meetings the report of the Directors (if any) shall be presented.

 

19.3 The Directors may call general meetings, and they shall on a Members’ requisition forthwith proceed to convene an extraordinary general meeting of the Company.

 

19.4 A Members’ requisition is a requisition of Members holding at the date of deposit of the requisition not less than twenty per cent in par value of the issued Shares which as at that date carry the right to vote at general meetings of the Company.

 

19.5 The Members’ requisition must state the objects of the meeting and must be signed by the requisitionists and deposited at the Registered Office, and may consist of several documents in like form each signed by one or more requisitionists.

 

13

 

 

19.6 If there are no Directors as at the date of the deposit of the Members’ requisition or if the Directors do not within twenty-one days from the date of the deposit of the Members’ requisition duly proceed to convene a general meeting to be held within a further twenty-one days, the requisitionists, or any of them representing more than one-half of the total voting rights of all of the requisitionists, may themselves convene a general meeting, but any meeting so convened shall be held no later than the day which falls three months after the expiration of the said twenty-one day period.

 

19.7 A general meeting convened as aforesaid by requisitionists shall be convened in the same manner as nearly as possible as that in which general meetings are to be convened by Directors.

 

19.8 Members seeking to bring business before the annual general meeting or to nominate candidates for election as Directors at the annual general meeting must deliver notice to the principal executive offices of the Company not later than the close of business on the 90th day nor earlier than the close of business on the 120th day prior to the scheduled date of the annual general meeting.

 

20 Notice of General Meetings

 

20.1 At least five clear days’ notice shall be given of any general meeting. Every notice shall specify the place, the day and the hour of the meeting and the general nature of the business to be conducted at the general meeting and shall be given in the manner hereinafter mentioned or in such other manner if any as may be prescribed by the Company, provided that a general meeting of the Company shall, whether or not the notice specified in this Article has been given and whether or not the provisions of the Articles regarding general meetings have been complied with, be deemed to have been duly convened if it is so agreed:

 

(a) in the case of an annual general meeting, by all of the Members entitled to attend and vote thereat; and

 

(b) in the case of an extraordinary general meeting, by a majority in number of the Members having a right to attend and vote at the meeting, together holding not less than ninety-five per cent in par value of the Shares giving that right.

 

20.2 The accidental omission to give notice of a general meeting to, or the non receipt of notice of a general meeting by, any person entitled to receive such notice shall not invalidate the proceedings of that general meeting.

 

21 Proceedings at General Meetings

 

21.1 No business shall be transacted at any general meeting unless a quorum is present. The holders of a majority of the Shares being individuals present in person or by proxy or if a corporation or other non-natural person by its duly authorised representative or proxy shall be a quorum.

 

21.2 A person may participate at a general meeting by conference telephone or other communications equipment by means of which all the persons participating in the meeting can communicate with each other. Participation by a person in a general meeting in this manner is treated as presence in person at that meeting.

 

14

 

 

21.3 If a quorum is not present within half an hour from the time appointed for the meeting to commence or if during such a meeting a quorum ceases to be present, the meeting, if convened upon a Members’ requisition, shall be dissolved and in any other case it shall stand adjourned to the same day in the next week at the same time and/or place or to such other day, time and/or place as the Directors may determine, and if at the adjourned meeting a quorum is not present within half an hour from the time appointed for the meeting to commence, the Members present shall be a quorum.

 

21.4 The Directors may, at any time prior to the time appointed for the meeting to commence, appoint any person to act as chairman of a general meeting of the Company or, if the Directors do not make any such appointment, the chairman, if any, of the board of Directors shall preside as chairman at such general meeting. If there is no such chairman, or if he shall not be present within fifteen minutes after the time appointed for the meeting to commence, or is unwilling to act, the Directors present shall elect one of their number to be chairman of the meeting.

 

21.5 If no Director is willing to act as chairman or if no Director is present within fifteen minutes after the time appointed for the meeting to commence, the Members present shall choose one of their number to be chairman of the meeting.

 

21.6 The chairman may, with the consent of a meeting at which a quorum is present (and shall if so directed by the meeting) adjourn the meeting from time to time and from place to place, but no business shall be transacted at any adjourned meeting other than the business left unfinished at the meeting from which the adjournment took place.

 

21.7 When a general meeting is adjourned for thirty days or more, notice of the adjourned meeting shall be given as in the case of an original meeting. Otherwise it shall not be necessary to give any such notice of an adjourned meeting.

 

21.8 A resolution put to the vote of the meeting shall be decided on a poll.

 

21.9 A poll shall be taken as the chairman directs, and the result of the poll shall be deemed to be the resolution of the general meeting at which the poll was demanded.

 

21.10 A poll demanded on the election of a chairman or on a question of adjournment shall be taken forthwith. A poll demanded on any other question shall be taken at such date, time and place as the chairman of the general meeting directs, and any business other than that upon which a poll has been demanded or is contingent thereon may proceed pending the taking of the poll.

 

21.11 In the case of an equality of votes the chairman shall be entitled to a second or casting vote.

 

15

 

 

22 Votes of Members

 

22.1 Subject to any rights or restrictions attached to any Shares, every Member present in any such manner shall have one vote for every Share of which he is the holder.

 

22.2 In the case of joint holders the vote of the senior holder who tenders a vote, whether in person or by proxy (or, in the case of a corporation or other non-natural person, by its duly authorised representative or proxy), shall be accepted to the exclusion of the votes of the other joint holders, and seniority shall be determined by the order in which the names of the holders stand in the Register of Members.

 

22.3 A Member of unsound mind, or in respect of whom an order has been made by any court, having jurisdiction in lunacy, may vote by his committee, receiver, curator bonis, or other person on such Member’s behalf appointed by that court, and any such committee, receiver, curator bonis or other person may vote by proxy.

 

22.4 No person shall be entitled to vote at any general meeting unless he is registered as a Member on the record date for such meeting nor unless all calls or other monies then payable by him in respect of Shares have been paid.

 

22.5 No objection shall be raised as to the qualification of any voter except at the general meeting or adjourned general meeting at which the vote objected to is given or tendered and every vote not disallowed at the meeting shall be valid. Any objection made in due time in accordance with this Article shall be referred to the chairman whose decision shall be final and conclusive.

 

22.6 Votes may be cast either personally or by proxy (or in the case of a corporation or other non-natural person by its duly authorised representative or proxy). A Member may appoint more than one proxy or the same proxy under one or more instruments to attend and vote at a meeting. Where a Member appoints more than one proxy the instrument of proxy shall specify the number of Shares in respect of which each proxy is entitled to exercise the related votes.

 

22.7 A Member holding more than one Share need not cast the votes in respect of his Shares in the same way on any resolution and therefore may vote a Share or some or all such Shares either for or against a resolution and/or abstain from voting a Share or some or all of the Shares and, subject to the terms of the instrument appointing him, a proxy appointed under one or more instruments may vote a Share or some or all of the Shares in respect of which he is appointed either for or against a resolution and/or abstain from voting a Share or some or all of the Shares in respect of which he is appointed.

 

23 Proxies

 

23.1 The instrument appointing a proxy shall be in writing and shall be executed under the hand of the appointor or of his attorney duly authorised in writing, or, if the appointor is a corporation or other non natural person, under the hand of its duly authorised representative. A proxy need not be a Member.

 

16

 

 

23.2 The Directors may, in the notice convening any meeting or adjourned meeting, or in an instrument of proxy sent out by the Company, specify the manner by which the instrument appointing a proxy shall be deposited and the place and the time (being not later than the time appointed for the commencement of the meeting or adjourned meeting to which the proxy relates) at which the instrument appointing a proxy shall be deposited. In the absence of any such direction from the Directors in the notice convening any meeting or adjourned meeting or in an instrument of proxy sent out by the Company, the instrument appointing a proxy shall be deposited physically at the Registered Office not less than 48 hours before the time appointed for the meeting or adjourned meeting to commence at which the person named in the instrument proposes to vote.

 

23.3 The chairman may in any event at his discretion declare that an instrument of proxy shall be deemed to have been duly deposited. An instrument of proxy that is not deposited in the manner permitted, or which has not been declared to have been duly deposited by the chairman, shall be invalid.

 

23.4 The instrument appointing a proxy may be in any usual or common form (or such other form as the Directors may approve) and may be expressed to be for a particular meeting or any adjournment thereof or generally until revoked. An instrument appointing a proxy shall be deemed to include the power to demand or join or concur in demanding a poll.

 

23.5 Votes given in accordance with the terms of an instrument of proxy shall be valid notwithstanding the previous death or insanity of the principal or revocation of the proxy or of the authority under which the proxy was executed, or the transfer of the Share in respect of which the proxy is given unless notice in writing of such death, insanity, revocation or transfer was received by the Company at the Registered Office before the commencement of the general meeting, or adjourned meeting at which it is sought to use the proxy.

 

24 Corporate Members

 

24.1 Any corporation or other non-natural person which is a Member may in accordance with its constitutional documents, or in the absence of such provision by resolution of its directors or other governing body, authorise such person as it thinks fit to act as its representative at any meeting of the Company or of any class of Members, and the person so authorised shall be entitled to exercise the same powers on behalf of the corporation which he represents as the corporation could exercise if it were an individual Member.

 

24.2 If a clearing house (or its nominee(s)), being a corporation, is a Member, it may authorise such persons as it sees fit to act as its representative at any meeting of the Company or at any meeting of any class of Members provided that the authorisation shall specify the number and class of Shares in respect of which each such representative is so authorised. Each person so authorised under the provisions of this Article shall be deemed to have been duly authorised without further evidence of the facts and be entitled to exercise the same rights and powers on behalf of the clearing house (or its nominee(s)) as if such person was the registered holder of such Shares held by the clearing house (or its nominee(s)).

 

17

 

 

25 Shares that May Not be Voted

 

Shares in the Company that are beneficially owned by the Company shall not be voted, directly or indirectly, at any meeting and shall not be counted in determining the total number of outstanding Shares at any given time.

 

26 Directors

 

There shall be a board of Directors consisting of not less than one person provided however that the Company may by Ordinary Resolution increase or reduce the limits in the number of Directors.

 

27 Powers of Directors

 

27.1 Subject to the provisions of the Statute, the Memorandum and the Articles and to any directions given by Special Resolution, the business of the Company shall be managed by the Directors who may exercise all the powers of the Company. No alteration of the Memorandum or Articles and no such direction shall invalidate any prior act of the Directors which would have been valid if that alteration had not been made or that direction had not been given. A duly convened meeting of Directors at which a quorum is present may exercise all powers exercisable by the Directors.

 

27.2 All cheques, promissory notes, drafts, bills of exchange and other negotiable or transferable instruments and all receipts for monies paid to the Company shall be signed, drawn, accepted, endorsed or otherwise executed as the case may be in such manner as the Directors shall determine by resolution.

 

27.3 The Directors on behalf of the Company may pay a gratuity or pension or allowance on retirement to any Director who has held any other salaried office or place of profit with the Company or to his widow or dependants and may make contributions to any fund and pay premiums for the purchase or provision of any such gratuity, pension or allowance.

 

27.4 The Directors may exercise all the powers of the Company to borrow money and to mortgage or charge its undertaking, property and assets (present and future) and uncalled capital or any part thereof and to issue debentures, debenture stock, mortgages, bonds and other such securities whether outright or as security for any debt, liability or obligation of the Company or of any third party.

 

28 Appointment and Removal of Directors

 

28.1 The Company may by Ordinary Resolution appoint any person to be a Director or may by Ordinary Resolution remove any Director.

 

28.2 The Directors may appoint any person to be a Director, either to fill a vacancy or as an additional Director provided that the appointment does not cause the number of Directors to exceed any number fixed by or in accordance with the Articles as the maximum number of Directors.

 

18

 

 

29 Vacation of Office of Director

 

The office of a Director shall be vacated if:

 

(a) the Director gives notice in writing to the Company that he resigns the office of Director; or

 

(b) the Director absents himself (for the avoidance of doubt, without being represented by proxy) from three consecutive meetings of the board of Directors without special leave of absence from the Directors, and the Directors pass a resolution that he has by reason of such absence vacated office; or

 

(c) the Director dies, becomes bankrupt or makes any arrangement or composition with his creditors generally; or

 

(d) the Director is found to be or becomes of unsound mind; or

 

(e) all of the other Directors (being not less than two in number) determine that he should be removed as a Director, either by a resolution passed by all of the other Directors at a meeting of the Directors duly convened and held in accordance with the Articles or by a resolution in writing signed by all of the other Directors.

 

30 Proceedings of Directors

 

30.1 The quorum for the transaction of the business of the Directors may be fixed by the Directors, and unless so fixed shall be two if there are two or more Directors, and shall be one if there is only one Director.

 

30.2 Subject to the provisions of the Articles, the Directors may regulate their proceedings as they think fit. Questions arising at any meeting shall be decided by a majority of votes. In the case of an equality of votes, the chairman shall have a second or casting vote.

 

30.3 A person may participate in a meeting of the Directors or any committee of Directors by conference telephone or other communications equipment by means of which all the persons participating in the meeting can communicate with each other at the same time. Participation by a person in a meeting in this manner is treated as presence in person at that meeting. Unless otherwise determined by the Directors, the meeting shall be deemed to be held at the place where the chairman is located at the start of the meeting.

 

30.4 A resolution in writing (in one or more counterparts) signed by all the Directors or all the members of a committee of the Directors or, in the case of a resolution in writing relating to the removal of any Director or the vacation of office by any Director, all of the Directors other than the Director who is the subject of such resolution shall be as valid and effectual as if it had been passed at a meeting of the Directors, or committee of Directors as the case may be, duly convened and held.

 

30.5 A Director may, or other officer of the Company on the direction of a Director shall, call a meeting of the Directors by at least two days’ notice in writing to every Director which notice shall set forth the general nature of the business to be considered unless notice is waived by all the Directors either at, before or after the meeting is held. To any such notice of a meeting of the Directors all the provisions of the Articles relating to the giving of notices by the Company to the Members shall apply mutatis mutandis.

 

19

 

 

30.6 The continuing Directors (or a sole continuing Director, as the case may be) may act notwithstanding any vacancy in their body, but if and so long as their number is reduced below the number fixed by or pursuant to the Articles as the necessary quorum of Directors the continuing Directors or Director may act for the purpose of increasing the number of Directors to be equal to such fixed number, or of summoning a general meeting of the Company, but for no other purpose.

 

30.7 The Directors may elect a chairman of their board and determine the period for which he is to hold office; but if no such chairman is elected, or if at any meeting the chairman is not present within five minutes after the time appointed for the meeting to commence, the Directors present may choose one of their number to be chairman of the meeting.

 

30.8 All acts done by any meeting of the Directors or of a committee of the Directors shall, notwithstanding that it is afterwards discovered that there was some defect in the appointment of any Director, and/or that they or any of them were disqualified, and/or had vacated their office and/or were not entitled to vote, be as valid as if every such person had been duly appointed and/or not disqualified to be a Director and/or had not vacated their office and/or had been entitled to vote, as the case may be.

 

30.9 A Director may be represented at any meetings of the board of Directors by a proxy appointed in writing by him. The proxy shall count towards the quorum and the vote of the proxy shall for all purposes be deemed to be that of the appointing Director.

 

31 Presumption of Assent

 

A Director who is present at a meeting of the board of Directors at which action on any Company matter is taken shall be presumed to have assented to the action taken unless his dissent shall be entered in the minutes of the meeting or unless he shall file his written dissent from such action with the person acting as the chairman or secretary of the meeting before the adjournment thereof or shall forward such dissent by registered post to such person immediately after the adjournment of the meeting. Such right to dissent shall not apply to a Director who voted in favour of such action.

 

32 Directors’ Interests

 

32.1 A Director may hold any other office or place of profit under the Company (other than the office of Auditor) in conjunction with his office of Director for such period and on such terms as to remuneration and otherwise as the Directors may determine.

 

32.2 A Director may act by himself or by, through or on behalf of his firm in a professional capacity for the Company and he or his firm shall be entitled to remuneration for professional services as if he were not a Director.

 

20

 

 

32.3 A Director may be or become a director or other officer of or otherwise interested in any company promoted by the Company or in which the Company may be interested as a shareholder, a contracting party or otherwise, and no such Director shall be accountable to the Company for any remuneration or other benefits received by him as a director or officer of, or from his interest in, such other company.

 

32.4 No person shall be disqualified from the office of Director or prevented by such office from contracting with the Company, either as vendor, purchaser or otherwise, nor shall any such contract or any contract or transaction entered into by or on behalf of the Company in which any Director shall be in any way interested be or be liable to be avoided, nor shall any Director so contracting or being so interested be liable to account to the Company for any profit realised by or arising in connection with any such contract or transaction by reason of such Director holding office or of the fiduciary relationship thereby established. A Director shall be at liberty to vote in respect of any contract or transaction in which he is interested provided that the nature of the interest of any Director in any such contract or transaction shall be disclosed by him at or prior to its consideration and any vote thereon.

 

32.5 A general notice that a Director is a shareholder, director, officer or employee of any specified firm or company and is to be regarded as interested in any transaction with such firm or company shall be sufficient disclosure for the purposes of voting on a resolution in respect of a contract or transaction in which he has an interest, and after such general notice it shall not be necessary to give special notice relating to any particular transaction.

 

33 Minutes

 

The Directors shall cause minutes to be made in books kept for the purpose of recording all appointments of officers made by the Directors, all proceedings at meetings of the Company or the holders of any class of Shares and of the Directors, and of committees of the Directors, including the names of the Directors present at each meeting.

 

34 Delegation of Directors’ Powers

 

34.1 The Directors may delegate any of their powers, authorities and discretions, including the power to sub-delegate, to any committee consisting of one or more Directors. Any such delegation may be made subject to any conditions the Directors may impose and either collaterally with or to the exclusion of their own powers and any such delegation may be revoked or altered by the Directors. Subject to any such conditions, the proceedings of a committee of Directors shall be governed by the Articles regulating the proceedings of Directors, so far as they are capable of applying.

 

34.2 The Directors may establish any committees, local boards or agencies or appoint any person to be a manager or agent for managing the affairs of the Company and may appoint any person to be a member of such committees, local boards or agencies. Any such appointment may be made subject to any conditions the Directors may impose, and either collaterally with or to the exclusion of their own powers and any such appointment may be revoked or altered by the Directors. Subject to any such conditions, the proceedings of any such committee, local board or agency shall be governed by the Articles regulating the proceedings of Directors, so far as they are capable of applying.

 

21

 

 

34.3 The Directors may by power of attorney or otherwise appoint any person to be the agent of the Company on such conditions as the Directors may determine, provided that the delegation is not to the exclusion of their own powers and may be revoked by the Directors at any time.

 

34.4 The Directors may by power of attorney or otherwise appoint any company, firm, person or body of persons, whether nominated directly or indirectly by the Directors, to be the attorney or authorised signatory of the Company for such purpose and with such powers, authorities and discretions (not exceeding those vested in or exercisable by the Directors under the Articles) and for such period and subject to such conditions as they may think fit, and any such powers of attorney or other appointment may contain such provisions for the protection and convenience of persons dealing with any such attorneys or authorised signatories as the Directors may think fit and may also authorise any such attorney or authorised signatory to delegate all or any of the powers, authorities and discretions vested in him.

 

34.5 The Directors may appoint such officers of the Company (including, for the avoidance of doubt and without limitation, any chairman of the board of Directors, chief executive officer, president, chief financial officer, vice-presidents, secretary, assistant secretary, treasurer or any other officers as may be determined by the Directors) as they consider necessary on such terms, at such remuneration and to perform such duties, and subject to such provisions as to disqualification and removal as the Directors may think fit. Unless otherwise specified in the terms of his appointment an officer of the Company may be removed by resolution of the Directors or Members. An officer of the Company may vacate his office at any time if he gives notice in writing to the Company that he resigns his office.

 

35 No Minimum Shareholding

 

The Company in general meeting may fix a minimum shareholding required to be held by a Director, but unless and until such a shareholding qualification is fixed a Director is not required to hold Shares.

 

36 Remuneration of Directors

 

36.1 The remuneration to be paid to the Directors, if any, shall be such remuneration as the Directors shall determine. The Directors shall also be entitled to be paid all travelling, hotel and other expenses properly incurred by them in connection with their attendance at meetings of Directors or committees of Directors, or general meetings of the Company, or separate meetings of the holders of any class of Shares or debentures of the Company, or otherwise in connection with the business of the Company or the discharge of their duties as a Director, or to receive a fixed allowance in respect thereof as may be determined by the Directors, or a combination partly of one such method and partly the other.

 

36.2 The Directors may by resolution approve additional remuneration to any Director for any services which in the opinion of the Directors go beyond his ordinary routine work as a Director. Any fees paid to a Director who is also counsel, attorney or solicitor to the Company, or otherwise serves it in a professional capacity shall be in addition to his remuneration as a Director.

 

22

 

 

37 Seal

 

37.1 The Company may, if the Directors so determine, have a Seal. The Seal shall only be used by the authority of the Directors or of a committee of the Directors authorised by the Directors. Every instrument to which the Seal has been affixed shall be signed by at least one person who shall be either a Director or some officer of the Company or other person appointed by the Directors for the purpose.

 

37.2 The Company may have for use in any place or places outside the Cayman Islands a duplicate Seal or Seals each of which shall be a facsimile of the common Seal of the Company and, if the Directors so determine, with the addition on its face of the name of every place where it is to be used.

 

37.3 A Director or officer, representative or attorney of the Company may without further authority of the Directors affix the Seal over his signature alone to any document of the Company required to be authenticated by him under seal or to be filed with the Registrar of Companies in the Cayman Islands or elsewhere wheresoever.

 

38 Dividends, Distributions and Reserve

 

38.1 Subject to the Statute and this Article and except as otherwise provided by the rights attached to any Shares, the Directors may resolve to pay Dividends and other distributions on Shares in issue and authorise payment of the Dividends or other distributions out of the funds of the Company lawfully available therefor. A Dividend shall be deemed to be an interim Dividend unless the terms of the resolution pursuant to which the Directors resolve to pay such Dividend specifically state that such Dividend shall be a final Dividend. No Dividend or other distribution shall be paid except out of the realised or unrealised profits of the Company, out of the share premium account or as otherwise permitted by law.

 

38.2 Except as otherwise provided by the rights attached to any Shares, all Dividends and other distributions shall be paid according to the par value of the Shares that a Member holds. If any Share is issued on terms providing that it shall rank for Dividend as from a particular date, that Share shall rank for Dividend accordingly.

 

38.3 The Directors may deduct from any Dividend or other distribution payable to any Member all sums of money (if any) then payable by him to the Company on account of calls or otherwise.

 

38.4 The Directors may resolve that any Dividend or other distribution be paid wholly or partly by the distribution of specific assets and in particular (but without limitation) by the distribution of shares, debentures, or securities of any other company or in any one or more of such ways and where any difficulty arises in regard to such distribution, the Directors may settle the same as they think expedient and in particular may issue fractional Shares and may fix the value for distribution of such specific assets or any part thereof and may determine that cash payments shall be made to any Members upon the basis of the value so fixed in order to adjust the rights of all Members and may vest any such specific assets in trustees in such manner as may seem expedient to the Directors.

 

23

 

 

38.5 Except as otherwise provided by the rights attached to any Shares, Dividends and other distributions may be paid in any currency. The Directors may determine the basis of conversion for any currency conversions that may be required and how any costs involved are to be met.

 

38.6 The Directors may, before resolving to pay any Dividend or other distribution, set aside such sums as they think proper as a reserve or reserves which shall, at the discretion of the Directors, be applicable for any purpose of the Company and pending such application may, at the discretion of the Directors, be employed in the business of the Company.

 

38.7 Any Dividend, other distribution, interest or other monies payable in cash in respect of Shares may be paid by wire transfer to the holder or by cheque or warrant sent through the post directed to the registered address of the holder or, in the case of joint holders, to the registered address of the holder who is first named on the Register of Members or to such person and to such address as such holder or joint holders may in writing direct. Every such cheque or warrant shall be made payable to the order of the person to whom it is sent. Any one of two or more joint holders may give effectual receipts for any Dividends, other distributions, bonuses, or other monies payable in respect of the Share held by them as joint holders.

 

38.8 No Dividend or other distribution shall bear interest against the Company.

 

38.9 Any Dividend or other distribution which cannot be paid to a Member and/or which remains unclaimed after six months from the date on which such Dividend or other distribution becomes payable may, in the discretion of the Directors, be paid into a separate account in the Company’s name, provided that the Company shall not be constituted as a trustee in respect of that account and the Dividend or other distribution shall remain as a debt due to the Member. Any Dividend or other distribution which remains unclaimed after a period of six years from the date on which such Dividend or other distribution becomes payable shall be forfeited and shall revert to the Company.

 

39 Capitalisation

 

The Directors may at any time capitalise any sum standing to the credit of any of the Company’s reserve accounts or funds (including the share premium account and capital redemption reserve fund) or any sum standing to the credit of the profit and loss account or otherwise available for distribution; appropriate such sum to Members in the proportions in which such sum would have been divisible amongst such Members had the same been a distribution of profits by way of Dividend or other distribution; and apply such sum on their behalf in paying up in full unissued Shares for allotment and distribution credited as fully paid-up to and amongst them in the proportion aforesaid. In such event the Directors shall do all acts and things required to give effect to such capitalisation, with full power given to the Directors to make such provisions as they think fit in the case of Shares becoming distributable in fractions (including provisions whereby the benefit of fractional entitlements accrue to the Company rather than to the Members concerned). The Directors may authorise any person to enter on behalf of all of the Members interested into an agreement with the Company providing for such capitalisation and matters incidental or relating thereto and any agreement made under such authority shall be effective and binding on all such Members and the Company.

 

24

 

 

40 Books of Account

 

40.1 The Directors shall cause proper books of account (including, where applicable, material underlying documentation including contracts and invoices) to be kept with respect to all sums of money received and expended by the Company and the matters in respect of which the receipt or expenditure takes place, all sales and purchases of goods by the Company and the assets and liabilities of the Company. Such books of account must be retained for a minimum period of five years from the date on which they are prepared. Proper books shall not be deemed to be kept if there are not kept such books of account as are necessary to give a true and fair view of the state of the Company’s affairs and to explain its transactions.

 

40.2 The Directors shall determine whether and to what extent and at what times and places and under what conditions or regulations the accounts and books of the Company or any of them shall be open to the inspection of Members not being Directors and no Member (not being a Director) shall have any right of inspecting any account or book or document of the Company except as conferred by Statute or authorised by the Directors or by the Company in general meeting.

 

40.3 The Directors may cause to be prepared and to be laid before the Company in general meeting profit and loss accounts, balance sheets, group accounts (if any) and such other reports and accounts as may be required by law.

 

41 Audit

 

41.1 The Directors may appoint an Auditor of the Company who shall hold office on such terms as the Directors determine.

 

41.2 Without prejudice to the freedom of the Directors to establish any other committee, if the Shares (or depositary receipts therefor) are listed or quoted on the Designated Stock Exchange, and if required by the Designated Stock Exchange, the Directors shall establish and maintain an Audit Committee as a committee of the Directors and shall adopt a formal written Audit Committee charter and review and assess the adequacy of the formal written charter on an annual basis. The composition and responsibilities of the Audit Committee shall comply with the rules and regulations of the SEC and the Designated Stock Exchange. The Audit Committee shall meet at least once every financial quarter, or more frequently as circumstances dictate.

 

41.3 If the Shares (or depositary receipts therefor) are listed or quoted on the Designated Stock Exchange, the Company shall conduct an appropriate review of all related party transactions on an ongoing basis and shall utilise the Audit Committee for the review and approval of potential conflicts of interest.

 

25

 

 

41.4 The remuneration of the Auditor shall be fixed by the Audit Committee (if one exists).

 

41.5 If the office of Auditor becomes vacant by resignation or death of the Auditor, or by his becoming incapable of acting by reason of illness or other disability at a time when his services are required, the Directors shall fill the vacancy and determine the remuneration of such Auditor.

 

41.6 Every Auditor of the Company shall have a right of access at all times to the books and accounts and vouchers of the Company and shall be entitled to require from the Directors and officers of the Company such information and explanation as may be necessary for the performance of the duties of the Auditor.

 

41.7 Auditors shall, if so required by the Directors, make a report on the accounts of the Company during their tenure of office at the next annual general meeting following their appointment in the case of a company which is registered with the Registrar of Companies as an ordinary company, and at the next extraordinary general meeting following their appointment in the case of a company which is registered with the Registrar of Companies as an exempted company, and at any other time during their term of office, upon request of the Directors or any general meeting of the Members.

 

42 Notices

 

42.1 Notices shall be in writing and may be given by the Company to any Member either personally or by sending it by courier, post, cable, telex, fax or e-mail to him or to his address as shown in the Register of Members (or where the notice is given by e-mail by sending it to the e-mail address provided by such Member). Notice may also be served in accordance with the requirements of the Designated Stock Exchange.

 

42.2 Where a notice is sent by courier, service of the notice shall be deemed to be effected by delivery of the notice to a courier company, and shall be deemed to have been received on the third day (not including Saturdays or Sundays or public holidays) following the day on which the notice was delivered to the courier. Where a notice is sent by post, service of the notice shall be deemed to be effected by properly addressing, pre paying and posting a letter containing the notice, and shall be deemed to have been received on the fifth day (not including Saturdays or Sundays or public holidays in the Cayman Islands) following the day on which the notice was posted. Where a notice is sent by cable, telex or fax, service of the notice shall be deemed to be effected by properly addressing and sending such notice and shall be deemed to have been received on the same day that it was transmitted. Where a notice is given by e-mail service shall be deemed to be effected by transmitting the e-mail to the e-mail address provided by the intended recipient and shall be deemed to have been received on the same day that it was sent, and it shall not be necessary for the receipt of the e-mail to be acknowledged by the recipient.

 

42.3 A notice may be given by the Company to the person or persons which the Company has been advised are entitled to a Share or Shares in consequence of the death or bankruptcy of a Member in the same manner as other notices which are required to be given under the Articles and shall be addressed to them by name, or by the title of representatives of the deceased, or trustee of the bankrupt, or by any like description at the address supplied for that purpose by the persons claiming to be so entitled, or at the option of the Company by giving the notice in any manner in which the same might have been given if the death or bankruptcy had not occurred.

 

26

 

 

42.4 Notice of every general meeting shall be given in any manner authorised by the Articles to every holder of Shares carrying an entitlement to receive such notice on the record date for such meeting except that in the case of joint holders the notice shall be sufficient if given to the joint holder first named in the Register of Members and every person upon whom the ownership of a Share devolves by reason of his being a legal personal representative or a trustee in bankruptcy of a Member where the Member but for his death or bankruptcy would be entitled to receive notice of the meeting, and no other person shall be entitled to receive notices of general meetings.

 

43 Winding Up

 

43.1 If the Company shall be wound up, the liquidator shall apply the assets of the Company in satisfaction of creditors’ claims in such manner and order as such liquidator thinks fit. Subject to the rights attaching to any Shares, in a winding up:

 

(a) if the assets available for distribution amongst the Members shall be insufficient to repay the whole of the Company’s issued share capital, such assets shall be distributed so that, as nearly as may be, the losses shall be borne by the Members in proportion to the par value of the Shares held by them; or

 

(b) if the assets available for distribution amongst the Members shall be more than sufficient to repay the whole of the Company’s issued share capital at the commencement of the winding up, the surplus shall be distributed amongst the Members in proportion to the par value of the Shares held by them at the commencement of the winding up subject to a deduction from those Shares in respect of which there are monies due, of all monies payable to the Company for unpaid calls or otherwise.

 

43.2 If the Company shall be wound up the liquidator may, subject to the rights attaching to any Shares and with the approval of a Special Resolution of the Company and any other approval required by the Statute, divide amongst the Members in kind the whole or any part of the assets of the Company (whether such assets shall consist of property of the same kind or not) and may for that purpose value any assets and determine how the division shall be carried out as between the Members or different classes of Members. The liquidator may, with the like approval, vest the whole or any part of such assets in trustees upon such trusts for the benefit of the Members as the liquidator, with the like approval, shall think fit, but so that no Member shall be compelled to accept any asset upon which there is a liability.

 

44 Indemnity and Insurance

 

44.1 Every Director and officer of the Company (which for the avoidance of doubt, shall not include auditors of the Company), together with every former Director and former officer of the Company (each an “Indemnified Person”) shall be indemnified out of the assets of the Company against any liability, action, proceeding, claim, demand, costs, damages or expenses, including legal expenses, whatsoever which they or any of them may incur as a result of any act or failure to act in carrying out their functions other than such liability (if any) that they may incur by reason of their own actual fraud or wilful default. No Indemnified Person shall be liable to the Company for any loss or damage incurred by the Company as a result (whether direct or indirect) of the carrying out of their functions unless that liability arises through the actual fraud or wilful default of such Indemnified Person. No person shall be found to have committed actual fraud or wilful default under this Article unless or until a court of competent jurisdiction shall have made a finding to that effect.

 

27

 

 

44.2 The Company shall advance to each Indemnified Person reasonable attorneys’ fees and other costs and expenses incurred in connection with the defence of any action, suit, proceeding or investigation involving such Indemnified Person for which indemnity will or could be sought. In connection with any advance of any expenses hereunder, the Indemnified Person shall execute an undertaking to repay the advanced amount to the Company if it shall be determined by final judgment or other final adjudication that such Indemnified Person was not entitled to indemnification pursuant to this Article. If it shall be determined by a final judgment or other final adjudication that such Indemnified Person was not entitled to indemnification with respect to such judgment, costs or expenses, then such party shall not be indemnified with respect to such judgment, costs or expenses and any advancement shall be returned to the Company (without interest) by the Indemnified Person.

 

44.3 The Directors, on behalf of the Company, may purchase and maintain insurance for the benefit of any Director or other officer of the Company against any liability which, by virtue of any rule of law, would otherwise attach to such person in respect of any negligence, default, breach of duty or breach of trust of which such person may be guilty in relation to the Company.

 

45 Financial Year

 

Unless the Directors otherwise prescribe, the financial year of the Company shall end on 31st December in each year and, following the year of incorporation, shall begin on 1st January in each year.

 

46 Transfer by Way of Continuation

 

If the Company is exempted as defined in the Statute, it shall, subject to the provisions of the Statute and with the approval of a Special Resolution, have the power to register by way of continuation as a body corporate under the laws of any jurisdiction outside the Cayman Islands and to be deregistered in the Cayman Islands.

 

47 Mergers and Consolidations

 

The Company shall have the power to merge or consolidate with one or more other constituent companies (as defined in the Statute) upon such terms as the Directors may determine and (to the extent required by the Statute) with the approval of a Special Resolution.

 

 

28

 

 

Exhibit 2.1

 

SPECIMEN ORDINARY SHARE CERTIFICATE

 

NUMBER SHARES

C_________

 

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED

INCORPORATED UNDER THE LAWS OF THE CAYMAN ISLANDS

ORDINARY SHARES

 

SEE REVERSE FOR

CERTAIN DEFINITIONS

THIS CERTIFIES THAT CUSIP G1611B 107

IS THE OWNER OF

 

FULLY PAID AND NON-ASSESSABLE ORDINARY SHARES OF THE PAR VALUE OF

$0.0001 EACH OF

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED

 

transferable on the books of the Company in person or by duly authorized

attorney upon surrender of this Certificate properly endorsed. This Certificate is not valid unless

countersigned by the Transfer Agent and registered by the Registrar. Witness the facsimile signatures of its duly authorized director(s) and/or officer(s).

 

Dated:

 

     
Chief Executive Officer   Director

 

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED

 

The Company will furnish without charge to each shareholder who so requests the powers, designations, preferences and relative, participating, optional or other special rights of each class of share or series thereof of the Company and the qualifications, limitations, or restrictions of such preferences and/or rights. This Certificate and the shares represented thereby are issued and shall be held subject to all the provisions of the Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association of the Company and all amendments thereto and resolutions of the Board of Directors providing for the issue of shares of Preferred Shares (copies of which may be obtained from the secretary of the Company), to all of which the holder of this Certificate by acceptance hereof assents.

 

The following abbreviations, when used in the inscription on the face of this Certificate, shall be construed as though they were written out in full according to applicable laws or regulations:

 

TEN COM - as tenants in common

 

TEN ENT - as tenants by the entireties

 

JT TEN - as joint tenants with right of survivorship and not as tenants in common

 

UNIF GIFT MIN ACT -   Custodian    
  (Cust)   (Minor)  

 

    under Uniform Gifts to Minors Act    
       
         
    (State)    

 

Additional abbreviations may also be used though not in the above list.

 

For value received, ___________________________ hereby sell, assign and transfer unto

 

 

 

 

PLEASE INSERT SOCIAL SECURITY OR OTHER IDENTIFYING NUMBER OF ASSIGNEE

   
   
 
(PLEASE PRINT OR TYPEWRITE NAME AND ADDRESS, INCLUDING ZIP CODE, OF ASSIGNEE)
 
 

___________________________________________shares of the capital stock represented by the within Certificate, and do(es) hereby irrevocably constitute and appoint ______________________________________________________Attorney to transfer the said share on the books of the within named Company will full power of substitution in the premises.

 

Dated    
  NOTICE: The signature to this assignment must correspond with the name as written upon the face of the Certificate in every particular, without alteration or enlargement or any change whatsoever.
         

Signature(s) Guaranteed:

 

THE SIGNATURE(S) MUST BE GUARANTEED BY AN ELIGIBLE GUARANTOR INSTITUTION (BANKS, STOCKBROKERS, SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATIONS AND CREDIT UNIONS WITH MEMBERSHIP IN AN APPROVED SIGNATURE GUARANTEE MEDALLION PROGRAM, PURSUANT TO S.E.C. RULE 17Ad-15).

 

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 2.2

 

SPECIMEN WARRANT CERTIFICATE

 

NUMBER [●] WARRANTS
WA-  

 

BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED

 

CUSIP G1611B 115

 

WARRANT

 

THIS WARRANT CERTIFIES THAT, for value received , or registered agents, is the registered holder of a Warrant or Warrants (the “Warrant”), expiring on a date which is five (5) years from the date of issuance, to purchase one fully paid and non-assessable ordinary share (the “Warrant Shares”), par value US$0.0001 per share (the “Ordinary Shares”), of BROOGE ENERGY LIMITED, a Cayman Islands exempted company (the “Company”), for each Warrant evidenced by this Warrant Certificate. This Warrant Certificate is subject to and shall be interpreted under the terms and conditions of the Warrant Agreement (as defined below).

 

The Warrant entitles the holder thereof to purchase from the Company, from time to time, in whole or in part, commencing on the hereof, such number of Warrant Shares at the price of US$11.50 per share (the “Warrant Price”), upon surrender of this Warrant Certificate and payment of the Warrant Price at the office or agency of Continental Stock Transfer & Trust Company (the “Warrant Agent”), such payment to be made subject to the conditions set forth herein and in the Warrant Agreement, dated June 19, 2018, between the Twelve Seas Investment Company and the Warrant Agent, as assigned from Twelve Seas Investment Company to the Company, by the assignment agreement, dated December 20, 2019, by and among Twelve Seas Investment Company, the Warrant Agent and the Company (the “Warrant Agreement”). In no event shall the registered holder(s) of this Warrant be entitled to receive a net-cash settlement in lieu of physical settlement in Warrant Shares of the Company. The Warrant Agreement provides that, upon the occurrence of certain events, the Warrant Price and the number of Warrant Shares purchasable hereunder, set forth on the face hereof, may be adjusted, subject to certain conditions. The term Warrant Price as used in this Warrant Certificate refers to the price per Warrant Share at which Warrant Shares may be purchased at the time the Warrant is exercised.

 

This Warrant will expire on the date first referenced above if it is not exercised prior to such date by the registered holder pursuant to the terms of the Warrant Agreement or if it is not redeemed by the Company prior to such date.

 

No fraction of a Share will be issued upon any exercise of a Warrant. If, upon exercise of a Warrant, a holder would be entitled to receive a fractional interest in a Share, the Company will, upon exercise, issue or cause to be issued only the largest whole number of Warrant Shares issuable on such exercise (and such fraction of a Share will be disregarded).

 

Upon any exercise of the Warrant for less than the total number of full Warrant Shares provided for herein, there shall be issued to the registered holder(s) hereof or its assignee(s) a new Warrant Certificate covering the number of Warrant Shares for which the Warrant has not been exercised.

 

Warrant Certificates, when surrendered at the office or agency of the Warrant Agent by the registered holder(s) hereof in person or by attorney duly authorized in writing, may be exchanged in the manner and subject to the limitations provided in the Warrant Agreement, but without payment of any service charge, for another Warrant Certificate or Warrant Certificates of like tenor and evidencing in the aggregate a like number of Warrants.

 

Upon due presentment for registration of transfer of the Warrant Certificate at the office or agency of the Warrant Agent, a new Warrant Certificate or Warrant Certificates of like tenor and evidencing in the aggregate a like number of Warrants shall be issued to the transferee(s) in exchange for this Warrant Certificate, subject to the limitations provided in the Warrant Agreement, without charge except for any applicable tax or other governmental charge.

 

The Company and the Warrant Agent may deem and treat the registered holder(s) as the absolute owner(s) of this Warrant Certificate (notwithstanding any notation of ownership or other writing hereon made by anyone) for the purpose of any exercise hereof, of any distribution to the registered holder(s), and for all other purposes, and neither the Company nor the Warrant Agent shall be affected by any notice to the contrary.

 

 

 

 

This Warrant does not entitle the registered holder(s) to any of the rights of a shareholder of the Company.

 

After the Warrant becomes exercisable and prior to its expiration date, the Company reserves the right to call the Warrant at any time, with a notice of call in writing to the holder(s) of record of the Warrant, giving 30 days’ notice of such call if the last reported sale price of the Warrant Shares has been equal to or greater than US$18.00 per share of the Warrant Price for any 20 trading days within a 30 consecutive trading day period ending on the third business day prior to the date on which notice of such call is given, provided that (i) a registration statement under the Act with respect to the Ordinary Shares issuable upon exercise must be effective and a current prospectus must be available for use by the registered holders hereof or (ii) the Warrants may be exercised on cashless basis as set forth in the Warrant Agreement and such cashless exercise is exempt from registration under the United States Securities Act of 1933, as amended. The call price is US$0.01 per Warrant Share.

 

If the foregoing conditions are satisfied and the Company calls the Warrant for redemption, each holder will then be entitled to exercise his, her or its Warrant prior to the date scheduled for redemption; provided that the Company may require the Registered Holder who desires to exercise the Warrant, to elect cashless exercise as set forth in the Warrant Agreement, and such Registered Holder must exercise the Warrants on a cashless basis if the Company so requires. Any Warrant either not exercised or tendered back to the Company by the end of the date specified in the notice of call shall be canceled on the books of the Company and have no further value except for the $0.01 call price.

 

This Warrant shall be governed and construed in accordance with the internal laws of the State of New York, without regard to conflicts of laws principles thereof.

 

COUNTERSIGNED:

 

CONTINENTAL STOCK TRANSFER & TRUST COMPANY

WARRANT AGENT

 

BY:  
AUTHORIZED OFFICER  
   
DATED:  
   
(Signature)  
CHIEF EXECUTIVE OFFICER  
   
(Signature)  
SECRETARY  

 

2

 

  

[REVERSE OF CERTIFICATE]

 

SUBSCRIPTION FORM

 

To Be Executed by the Registered Holder(s) in Order to Exercise Warrants

 

The undersigned hereby irrevocably elects to exercise the right, represented by this Warrant Certificate, to receive Ordinary Shares in accordance with the terms of this Warrant Certificate and pursuant to the method selected below. Capitalized terms used herein and not otherwise defined have the respective meanings set forth in the Warrant Certificate. PLEASE CHECK ONE METHOD OF PAYMENT:

 

      a “Cash Exercise” with respect to Warrant Shares; and/or

 

      a “Cashless Exercise” with respect to Warrant Shares because on the date of this exercise, there is no effective registration statement registering the Warrant Shares, or the prospectus contained therein is not available for the resale of the Warrant Shares, in which event the Company shall deliver to the registered holder(s) Ordinary Shares pursuant to Section 3.3.2 of the Warrant Agreement.
     
     
     

 

The undersigned requests that a certificate for such shares be registered in the name(s) of

 

   
(PLEASE TYPE OR PRINT NAME(S) AND ADDRESS)  
   
   
   
   
   
   
(SOCIAL SECURITY OR TAX IDENTIFICATION NUMBER(S))  

 

and be delivered to    
    (PLEASE PRINT OR TYPE NAME(S) AND ADDRESS)

 

and, if such number of Warrants shall not be all the Warrants evidenced by this Warrant Certificate, that a new Warrant Certificate for the balance of such Warrants be registered in the name of, and delivered to, the registered holder(s) at the address(es) stated below:

 

Dated:

 

   
(SIGNATURE(S))  
   
   
(ADDRESS(ES))  
   
   
   
   
(TAX IDENTIFICATION NUMBER(S))  

 

3

 

 

ASSIGNMENT

 

To Be Executed by the Registered Holder in Order to Assign Warrants

 

For Value Received, hereby sell(s), assign(s), and transfer(s) unto

 

   
(PLEASE TYPE OR PRINT NAME(S) AND ADDRESS(ES))  
   
   
   
   
   
   
(SOCIAL SECURITY OR TAX IDENTIFICATION NUMBER(S))  

 

and to be delivered to    
    (PLEASE PRINT OR TYPE NAME(S) AND ADDRESS(ES))    

 

   
   
   
(SOCIAL SECURITY OR TAX IDENTIFICATION NUMBER(S))  

 

of the Warrants represented by this Warrant Certificate, and hereby irrevocably constitute and appoint Attorney to transfer this Warrant Certificate on the books of the Company, with full power of substitution in the premises.

 

Dated:  
   
   
(SIGNATURE(S))  

 

NOTICE: THE SIGNATURE(S) TO THIS ASSIGNMENT MUST CORRESPOND WITH THE NAME AS WRITTEN UPON THE FACE OF THE CERTIFICATE IN EVERY PARTICULAR, WITHOUT ALTERATION OR ENLARGEMENT OR ANY CHANGE WHATEVER.

 

Signature(s) Guaranteed:

 

By    

 

THE SIGNATURE(S) MUST BE GUARANTEED BY AN ELIGIBLE GUARANTOR INSTITUTION (BANKS, STOCKBROKERS, SAVINGS AND LOAN ASSOCIATIONS AND CREDIT UNIONS WITH MEMBERSHIP IN AN APPROVED SIGNATURE GUARANTEE MEDALLION PROGRAM, PURSUANT TO S.E.C. RULE 17Ad-15).

 

 

4

 

 

Exhibit 2.6

 


DESCRIPTION OF THE REGISTRANT’S SECURITIES

 

REGISTERED PURSUANT TO SECTION 12 OF THE

 

SECURITIES EXCHANGE ACT OF 1934

 

As of June 26, 2020, Brooge Energy Limited has two classes of securities registered under Section 12 of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934, as amended (the “Exchange Act”), its ordinary shares and warrants to purchase ordinary shares.

 

The following is a summary of information concerning capital stock of Brooge Energy Limited (the “Company”). The summaries and descriptions below do not purport to be complete statements of the relevant provisions of the Company’s Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Incorporation, and are entirely qualified by that document.

 

We are authorized to issue 450,000,000 ordinary shares, $0.0001 par value per share (the “Ordinary Shares”), and 50,000,000 preferred shares, $0.0001 par value per share.

 

Common Stock

 

Shares Outstanding. The Company is authorized to issue up to 450 million ordinary shares, par value $0.0001 per share. As of June 26, 2020, there were 109,587, 854 Ordinary Shares outstanding.

 

Dividends. Subject to the rights of holders of preferred shares, if any, the holders of Ordinary Shares are entitled to receive dividends, if any, as may be declared from time to time by the Board of Directors in its discretion out of funds legally available for the payment of dividends.

 

Voting Rights. The holders of Ordinary Shares are entitled to one vote for each Ordinary Share held of record on all matters to be voted on by shareholders. There is no cumulative voting with respect to the election of directors, with the result that the holders of more than 50% of the shares voted for the election of directors can elect all of the directors.

 

Liquidation Rights. Subject to any preferential rights of outstanding preferred shares, holders of Ordinary Shares will share ratably in all assets legally available for distribution to our shareholders in the event of dissolution.

 

Other Rights. Holders of the Company’s Ordinary Shares do not have any conversion, preemptive or other subscription rights and there are no sinking fund or redemption provisions applicable to the Ordinary Shares.

 

Fully Paid. The issued and outstanding Ordinary Shares are fully paid and non-assessable. This means the full purchase price for the outstanding Ordinary Shares has been paid and the holders of such Ordinary Shares will not be assessed any additional amounts for such Ordinary Shares.

 

Listing. The Ordinary Shares are traded on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the trading symbol “BROG”.

 

 

 

 

Warrants

 

Warrants Outstanding. As of June 26, 2020, there were 21,228,900 warrants outstanding

 

Ordinary Shares Issuable. A total of 21,228,900 Ordinary Shares are issuable upon exercise of the outstanding warrants. Each outstanding warrant is exercisable to purchase one Ordinary Share.

 

Term. The outstanding warrants are exercisable beginning on January 19, 2020 and ending on December 20, 2024.

 

Exercise Price. Each outstanding warrant is exercisable at a price of $11.50 per share. The exercise price and number of Ordinary Shares issuable on exercise of the warrants may be adjusted in certain circumstances including in the event of a share dividend, extraordinary dividend or our recapitalization, reorganization, merger or consolidation. However, the warrants will not be adjusted for issuances of Ordinary Shares at a price below their respective exercise prices.

 

Cashless Exercise. No Company warrants issued to persons or entities other than Twelve Seas Sponsors I LLC, Suneel G. Kaji and Gregory Stoupnitzky (collectively, the “Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders”) are exercisable for cash unless the Company has an effective and current registration statement covering the Ordinary Shares issuable upon exercise of the warrants and a current prospectus relating to such Ordinary Shares. Notwithstanding the foregoing, during any period when we shall have failed to maintain an effective registration statement, exercise warrants on a cashless basis in the same manner as if we called the warrants for redemption and required all holders to exercise their warrants on a “cashless basis.” In such event, each holder would pay the exercise price by surrendering the warrants for that number of Ordinary Shares equal to the quotient obtained by dividing (x) the product of the number of Ordinary Shares underlying the warrants, multiplied by the difference between the exercise price of the warrants and the “fair market value” (defined below) by (y) the fair market value. The “fair market value” for this purpose will mean the average reported last sale price of the Ordinary Shares for the ten (10) trading days ending on the trading day prior to the date of exercise.

 

Private Warrants. The Company warrants issued to the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders are identical to the other warrants issued, except that the warrants issued to the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders are exercisable for cash (even if a registration statement covering the Ordinary Shares issuable upon exercise of such warrants is not effective) or on a cashless basis, at the holder’s option, and will not be redeemable by us, in each case so long as they are still held by the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders or their affiliates.

 

Redemption. We may call the warrants for redemption (excluding the warrants issued to the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders provided such warrants are still held by the Initial Twelve Seas Shareholders or their affiliates), in whole and not in part, at a price of $0.01 per warrant,

 

at any time while the warrants are exercisable;

 

upon not less than 30 days’ prior written notice of redemption to each warrant holder;

 

if, and only if, the reported last sale price of the Ordinary Shares equals or exceeds $18.00 per share, for any 20 trading days within a 30-day trading period ending on the third business day prior to the notice of redemption to warrant holders; and

 

if, and only if, there is a current registration statement in effect with respect to the Ordinary Shares underlying such warrants commencing five business days prior to the 30-day trading period and continuing each day thereafter until the date of redemption.

 

2

 

 

The right to exercise will be forfeited unless the warrants are exercised prior to the date specified in the notice of redemption. On and after the redemption date, a record holder of a warrant will have no further rights except to receive the redemption price for such holder’s warrant upon surrender of such warrant. The redemption criteria for the Company’s warrants have been established at a price which is intended to provide warrant holders a reasonable premium to the initial exercise price and provide a sufficient differential between the then-prevailing share price and the warrant exercise price so that if the share price declines as a result of our redemption call, the redemption will not cause the share price to drop below the exercise price of the warrants.

 

If we call the warrants for redemption as described above, Company management will have the option to require all holders that wish to exercise warrants to do so on a “cashless basis.” In such event, each holder would pay the exercise price by surrendering the warrants for that number of Ordinary Shares equal to the quotient obtained by dividing (x) the product of the number of Ordinary Shares underlying the warrants, multiplied by the difference between the exercise price of the warrants and the “fair market value” (defined below) by (y) the fair market value. In this case, the “fair market value” shall mean the average reported last sale price of the Ordinary Shares for the 10 trading days ending on the third trading day prior to the date on which the notice of redemption is sent to the holders of warrants. Whether we will exercise our option to require all holders to exercise their warrants on a “cashless basis” will depend on a variety of factors including the price of our Ordinary Shares at the time the warrants are called for redemption, our cash needs at such time and concerns regarding dilutive stock issuances.

 

Mechanics of Exercise. The warrants may be exercised upon surrender of the warrant certificate on or prior to the expiration date at the offices of the warrant agent, with the exercise form on the reverse side of the warrant certificate completed and executed as indicated, accompanied by full payment of the exercise price, by certified or official bank check payable to us, for the number of warrants being exercised. No fractional shares will be issued upon exercise of the warrants. If, upon exercise of the warrants, a holder would be entitled to receive a fractional interest in a share, we will, upon exercise, round up or down to the nearest whole number the number of Ordinary Shares to be issued to the warrant holder. Warrant holders may elect to be subject to a restriction on the exercise of their warrants such that an electing warrant holder would not be able to exercise their warrants to the extent that, after giving effect to such exercise, such holder would beneficially own in excess of 9.8% of the Ordinary Shares outstanding.

 

No Rights as Shareholder: The warrant holders do not have the rights or privileges of holders of Ordinary Shares and any voting rights until they exercise their warrants and receive Ordinary Shares. After the issuance of Ordinary Shares upon exercise of the warrants, each holder will be entitled to one vote for each Ordinary Share held of record on all matters to be voted on by shareholders.

 

Listing. The warrants are traded on the Nasdaq Capital Market under the trading symbol “BROGW”.

 

Preferred Shares

 

The Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association of the Company authorize the issuance of up to 50,000,000 blank check preferred shares with such designations, rights and preferences as may be determined from time to time by the Company’s board of directors. Accordingly, the Company’s board of directors will be empowered, without shareholder approval, to issue preferred shares with dividend, liquidation, conversion, voting or other rights which could adversely affect the voting power or other rights of the holders of Ordinary Shares. In addition, the preferred shares could be utilized as a method of discouraging, delaying or preventing a change in control of the Company.

 

3

 

 

Variation of Rights of Shareholders

 

If at any time the share capital of the Company is divided into different classes of shares, all or any of the rights attached to any class (unless otherwise provided by the terms of issue of the shares of that class) may, whether or not the Company is being wound up, be varied without the consent of the holders of the issued shares of that class where such variation is considered by the Board of Directors not to have a material adverse effect upon such rights. In all other cases, variations shall be made only with the consent in writing of the holders of not less than two thirds of the issued shares of that class, or with the approval of a resolution passed by a majority of not less than two thirds of the votes cast at a separate meeting of the holders of the shares of that class. For the purposes of a separate class meeting, the Board of Directors may treat two or more or all the classes of shares as forming one class of shares if the directors consider that such class of shares would be affected in the same way by the proposals under consideration. The rights conferred upon the holders of the shares of any class issued with preferred or other rights shall not, unless otherwise expressly provided by the terms of issue of the shares of that class, be deemed to be varied by the creation or issue of further shares ranking pari passu therewith.

 

Anti-Takeover Provisions

 

Certain provisions in the Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association of the Company, such as the super majority voting requirements for amendments thereto, may discourage unsolicited takeover proposals that the Company’s shareholders may consider to be in their best interest and may make the removal of the Company’s incumbent management more difficult. Other anti-takeover provisions under the Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association of the Company include:

 

Undesignated Preferred Shares. The Company’s Board of Directors has the ability to designate and issue preferred shares with voting or other rights or preferences that could deter hostile takeovers or delay changes in its control or management.

 

Directors Removed Only for Cause. The Company’s Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association provides that shareholders may remove directors only for cause.

 

Bylaw Provision regarding Ownership Disclosure

 

There is no bylaw provision requiring shareholder ownership to be disclosed above a certain threshold.

 

Certain Differences of Cayman Islands Law

 

The Company’s corporate affairs will be governed by its Amended and Restated Memorandum and Articles of Association, the Cayman Islands Companies Law, and the common law of the Cayman Islands. The rights of shareholders to take action against the directors, actions by non-controlling shareholders and the fiduciary responsibilities of the Company’s directors to the Company under Cayman Islands law are to a large extent governed by the common law of the Cayman Islands. The common law of the Cayman Islands is derived in part from comparatively limited judicial precedent in the Cayman Islands as well as from English common law, which has persuasive, but not binding, authority on a court in the Cayman Islands. Your rights as a shareholders and the fiduciary responsibilities of the Company’s directors under Cayman Islands law are different from under statutes or judicial precedent in some jurisdictions in the United States. In particular, the Cayman Islands has a different body of securities laws from the United States and may provide significantly less protection to investors. In addition, some U.S. states, such as Delaware, have different bodies of corporate law than the Cayman Islands.

 

4

 

 

The Company has been advised by its Cayman Islands legal counsel, Maples and Calder, that the courts of the Cayman Islands are unlikely (i) to recognize or enforce against the Company judgments of courts of the United States predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the United States or any State and (ii) in original actions brought in the Cayman Islands, to impose liabilities against the Company predicated upon the civil liability provisions of the securities laws of the United States or any State, so far as the liabilities imposed by those provisions are penal in nature. In those circumstances, although there is no statutory enforcement in the Cayman Islands of judgments obtained in the United States, the courts of the Cayman Islands will recognize and enforce a foreign money judgment of a foreign court of competent jurisdiction without retrial on the merits based on the principle that a judgment of a competent foreign court imposes upon the judgment debtor an obligation to pay the sum for which judgment has been given provided certain conditions are met. For a foreign judgment to be enforced in the Cayman Islands, such judgment must be final and conclusive and for a liquidated sum, and must not be in respect of taxes or a fine or penalty, inconsistent with a Cayman Islands judgment in respect of the same matter, impeachable on the grounds of fraud or obtained in a manner, and/or be of a kind the enforcement of which is, contrary to natural justice or the public policy of the Cayman Islands (awards of punitive or multiple damages may well be held to be contrary to public policy). A Cayman Islands Court may stay enforcement proceedings if concurrent proceedings are being brought elsewhere. There is recent Privy Council authority (which is binding on the Cayman Islands Court) in the context of a reorganization plan approved by the New York Bankruptcy Court which suggests that due to the universal nature of bankruptcy/insolvency proceedings, foreign money judgments obtained in foreign bankruptcy/insolvency proceedings may be enforced without applying the principles outlined above. However, a more recent English Supreme Court authority (which is highly persuasive but not binding on the Cayman Islands Court), has expressly rejected that approach in the context of a default judgment obtained in an adversary proceeding brought in the New York Bankruptcy Court by the receivers of the bankruptcy debtor against a third party, and which would not have been enforceable upon the application of the traditional common law principles summarized above and held that foreign money judgments obtained in bankruptcy/insolvency proceedings should be enforced by applying the principles set out above, and not by the simple exercise of the Courts’ discretion. Those cases have now been considered by the Cayman Islands Court. The Cayman Islands Court was not asked to consider the specific question of whether a judgment of a bankruptcy court in an adversary proceeding would be enforceable in the Cayman Islands, but it did endorse the need for active assistance of overseas bankruptcy proceedings. The Company understands that the Cayman Islands Court’s decision in that case has been appealed and it remains the case that the law regarding the enforcement of bankruptcy/insolvency related judgments is still in a state of uncertainty.

 

The Company is incorporated in the Cayman Islands and currently conducts all of its operations through its subsidiary, Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE, in the United Arab Emirates. All of the Company’s assets are located outside the United States. The Company’s officers and directors are expected to reside outside the United States and a substantial portion of the assets of those persons are located outside of the United States. As a result, it could be difficult or impossible for you to bring an action against the Company or against these individuals in the United States in the event that you believe that your rights have been infringed under the applicable securities laws or otherwise. Even if you are successful in bringing an action of this kind, the laws of the Cayman Islands and of the United Arab Emirates could render you unable to enforce a judgment against the Company’s assets or the assets of the Company’s directors and officers.

 

Shareholders of Cayman Islands exempted companies such as the Company have no general rights under Cayman Islands law to inspect corporate records and accounts or to obtain copies of lists of shareholders of these companies. The Company’s directors have discretion under Cayman Islands law to determine whether or not, and under what conditions, the Company’s corporate records could be inspected by the Company’s shareholders, but are not obliged to make them available to the Company’s shareholders. This could make it more difficult for you to obtain the information needed to establish any facts necessary for a shareholder motion or to solicit proxies from other shareholders in connection with a proxy contest.

 

As a result of all of the above, the Company shareholders might have more difficulty in protecting their interests in the face of actions taken by management, members of the board of directors or controlling shareholders than they would as public shareholders of a U.S. company.

 

 

4

 

Exhibit 4.85

 

Execution Copy

 

Land Lease Agreement

 

between

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone

 

and

 

Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company

 

     

 

Relating to the

Oil Storage Terminal & Refinery Project

In

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone

in

The Emirate of Fujairah

United Arab Emirates

     

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 1 of 26 

 

 

TABLE OF CONTENTS

 

1.0 Definitions; Construction and Interpretation 3
2.0 Leased Premises 7
3.0 Access to the Leased Premises, Utilities and Formalities 8
4.0 Term 9
5.0 Rent 10
6.0 Consents and other documents 11
7.0 Taxes and other covenants 11
8.0 Representations and Warranties of the Lessee 13
9.0 Representations and Warranties of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone 15
10.0 Indemnification 17
11.0 Dispute Resolution 18
12.0 Lessee Events of Default; Fujairah Oil Industry Zone’s Remedies 19
13.0 Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Events of Default; Lessee’s Remedies 21
14.0 Surrender of Leased Premises 21
15.0 Miscellaneous Provisions 22

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 2 of 26 

 

 

THIS LAND LEASE AGREEMENT is made on the day of 02 February, 2020 in the Emirate of Fujairah, United Arab Emirates

 

BETWEEN

 

FUJAIRAH OIL INDUSTRY ZONE, [FOIZ], a petroleum zone specialized in all affairs of petroleum, petroleum products and hydro carbon industries, including the oil and gas industries established in the Emirate of Fujairah under the provisions of Law No. (4) of 2011 Establishing Fujairah Oil Industry Zone “FOIZ”

 

and

 

BROOGE PETROLEUM & GAS INVESTMENT COMPANY FZE with Company Registration No. 13-FZC-1117, a company incorporated in UAE and having its registered office at Fujairah Free Zone in the Emirate Of Fujairah, United Arab Emirates, with postal address P.O. Box 50170, Fujairah, UAE, all in accordance with the local and federal laws of the UAE on the date of this agreement, and its successor(s) and/or permitted assign(s) (hereinafter referred to as the “Lessee”),

 

referred to collectively as the “Parties” and each individually as a “Party”.

 

RECITALS:

 

WHEREAS, the Lessee desires to construct a facility for the oil storage terminal having a capacity of up to 3,500,000 cu.m., and/or an oil refinery with a refining capacity of up to 250,000 bbl /d at the Leased Premises, and Fujairah Oil Industry Zone agrees to grant a lease to the Lessee of the Leased Premises on the terms and conditions of this Agreement.

 

NOW, THEREFORE, in consideration of the mutual covenants set forth in this Agreement the Parties covenant and agree as follows:

 

1. Definitions; Construction and Interpretation

 

1.1 Definitions

 

In this Agreement, the following capitalised words, terms and phrases used specifically have the following meanings unless the context otherwise requires:

 

“Affiliate” (of Lessee) means a corporate entity in which Lessee or a direct or an indirect parent company of the Lessee holds at least fifty percent (50%) of the shares or voting rights in the corporate entity.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 3 of 26 

 

  

“Agreement” means this Land Lease Agreement.

 

“Business Day” means any day excluding Friday and Saturday and any day that shall be in the United Arab Emirates or the Emirate of Fujairah a legal holiday or a day on which banking institutions in the Emirate of Ftijairah are authorised or required by law or other governmental action to be closed.

 

“Claims” means with respect to any Person, any and all suits, sanctions, legal proceedings, claims, assessments, judgements, damages, penalties, fines, liabilities, demands, reasonable out-of-pocket expenses of whatever kind and losses incurred or sustained by or against such Person (but excluding any lost profits or other special, incidental, indirect, punitive or consequential damages suffered by that Person).

 

“Concession” means the right granted to the Lessee to develop, finance, design, execute, manage and operate the Project on the Leased Premises in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

 

“Day” means the 24-hour period beginning and ending at 00:00 midnight United Arab Emirates time.

 

“Dirhams” or “Dhs.” means the lawful currency of the United Arab Emirates.

 

“Earlier Termination Date” has the meaning set forth in Clause 4.2.

 

“Effective Date” means the date of this Agreement.

 

“Environmental Law” means the Federal Law No.24 (1999) of the United Arab Emirates.

 

“Fils” means one hundredth of a Dirham.

 

“Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Event of Default” has the meaning set forth in Clause 13.0.

 

“Governmental Authorisation” means any authorisation, consent, decree, permit, waiver, privilege, approval from and filings with any Governmental Instrumentality.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 4 of 26 

 

 

“Governmental Instrumentality” means the Federal Government of the United Arab Emirates, the Government of Fujairah, Fujairah Oil Industry Zone or any department, authority or political subdivision thereof, and any Person under direct or indirect control of any such government exercising executive, legislative, judicial, regulatory or administrative functions of or pertaining to government or any other governmental entity, instrumentality, agency, authority, corporation, committee or commission, or any independent regulatory authority, in each case within the Emirate of Fujairah or the United Arab Emirates, and any successor to or any assignee of any of the foregoing.

 

“Law” means any decree, resolution, law, statute, act, ordinance, rule, directive (to the extent having the force of law), order, treaty, code or regulation (including any of the foregoing relating to health or safety matters or any Environmental Law) or any interpretation of the foregoing, as enacted, issued or promulgated by any Governmental Instrumentality including amendments, modifications, extensions, replacements or re-enactments thereof.

 

“Lease Expiration Date” has the meaning set forth in Clause 4.

 

“Lessee” means Brooge Petroleum & Gas Investment Company FZE and/ or its nominee(s) and/ or its successor(s) and/ or permitted assign(s).

 

“Leased Premises,” means the parcels of land as described in the attached site plan shown in Annex 1 and to be leased to the Lessee under the terms of this Agreement.

 

“Lessee Event of Default” has the meaning set forth in Clause 12.

 

“Legal Requirements” means all applicable Laws, Governmental Authorisations and other licenses, permits, approvals and agreements, and any injunction or final non appealable judgement directly applicable to the relevant Party, of any Governmental Instrumentality having jurisdiction over the matter in question.

 

“Lien” means any mortgage, pledge, lien, security interest, option agreement, claim, charge or encumbrance of any kind.

 

“Person” means any individual, corporation, joint stock company, limited liability company, partnership, joint venture, association, trust, unincorporated organisation, Governmental Instrumentality, or other entity.

 

Plant” means, in its simplest definition, the facility of either a combination of oil storage terminal of up to 3,500,000 cubic meters and a refinery of up to 250,000 bpd or a full storage facility of up to 3,500,000 cubic meters to be constructed by or on behalf of the Lessee at the Plant Site with such additions, deletions, enhancements, and facilities as the Lessee may decide during the Term.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 5 of 26 

 

 

“Plant Site” means the area or areas identified in the attached site plan with amendments as agreed between the Parties.

 

“Project” means the construction, ownership, management, operation and maintenance of the Plant.

 

“Rent” has the meaning set forth in Clause 5.

 

“Rights of Way” mean the rights and easements as further described in Clause 3.1

 

“Taxes” means any tax, charge, impost, tariff, duty or fee of any kind charged, imposed or levied, directly or indirectly, by any Governmental Instrumentality, including any value-added tax, sales tax, stamp duty, impo11 duty, withholding tax (whether on income, dividends, interest payments, fees, equipment rentals or otherwise), tax on foreign currency loans or foreign exchange transactions, excise tax, property tax, registration fee or license, water tax or environmental, energy or fuel tax including any interest, penalties or other additions thereon.

 

“Term” has the meaning given in Clause 4.1.

 

“Utilities” means water, sewage, gas, electricity, telecommunications and all other services and utilities required by the Lessee for the Project.

 

1.2 Construction and Interpretation.

 

Unless the context otherwise requires:

 

A. words of any gender include each other gender;

 

B. words using the singular or plural number also include the plural or singular number, respectively;

 

C. the terms ” hereof,” “herein,” “hereby,” “hereto” and similar words refer to this entire Agreement and not to any particular Article, Section, Clause, Exhibit, Appendix or Schedule or any other subdivision of this Agreement;

 

D. references to ” Article,” “Section,” “Clause,” “Exhibit,” ” Appendix” or “Schedule” are to the Articles, Sections, Clauses, Exhibits, Appendices and Schedules , respectively, of this Agreement;

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 6 of 26 

 

 

E. the words ” include” or “including” shall be deemed to be followed by “without limitation” or “but not limited to” whether or not they are followed by such phrases of like import;

 

F. references to “this Agreement” shall be construed as a reference to the Agreement as amended, modified or supplemented and in effect from time to time and shall include a reference to any document which amends, modifies or supplements it, or is entered into, made or given pursuant to or in accordance with its terms;

 

G. whenever this Agreement refers to a number of days, such number shall refer to calendar days unless Business Days are specified;

 

H. all periods of time shall be based on, and computed according to, the Gregorian calendar: and

 

I. whenever this Agreement specifies the consent of a party should be obtained, such Party will not unreasonably withhold, delay or condition its consent.

 

2. Leased Premises

 

2.1 Leased Premises

 

In consideration of the Rent to be paid and the terms, covenants, conditions, agreements and obligations to be performed and observed by the Lessee as provided in this Land Lease, and on the terms and subject to the conditions of this Land Lease, Fujairah Oil Industry Zone hereby grants and leases to the Lessee, and the Lessee hereby hires and takes from Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, the Leased Premises.

 

2.2 Quiet Enjoyment

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone covenants with the Lessee that upon the Lessee paying the Rent (and all other charges required to be paid by the Lessee hereunder) and performing, observing and keeping all of the terms, covenants, conditions, agreements and obligations of this Agreement on the Lessee’s part to be so performed, observed and kept and conforming to the stipulations ofFOIZ HSEQ Management System Manual and Codes of Practice, the Lessee shall peaceably and quietly hold, occupy and enjoy the Leased Premises during the Term without undue interference from Fujairah Oil Industry Zone or from any Person authorised by or claiming to be an authorised representative of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone. Fujairah Oil Industry Zone covenants with the Lessee that the Lessee shall have, subject to any restrictions imposed under this Agreemen,t full control over the operations and management of the Plant.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 7 of 26 

 

 

2.3 Sublet or Assignment of Leased Premises

 

The Lessee shall not sublet, assign or charge any portion of the Leased Premises to any third party or Person, without the consent of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone (such consent shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed).

 

For the avoidance of any doubt the land shall not be subject to any Lien.

 

2.4 Delivery of Possession; Condition of Leased Premises

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall deliver possession of the Leased Premises to the Lessee by the Effective Date, free and clear of all Liens; however, the Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall retain responsibility for any conditions existing prior to the Effective Date.

 

2.5 Warranty as to Use

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone warrants that the use of the Leased Premises or any land over which easements or rights are granted pursuant to clauses 3.1 and 3.2 by the Lessee as contemplated by this Agreement will not violate any restrictions, reservations, or Laws in relation to the Leased Premises.

 

3. Access to the Leased Premises, Utilities and Formalities

 

3.1 Access to the Leased Premises

 

For the purpose of providing access to the Leased Premises by individuals and vehicles as well as pipelines and ancillary facilities that interconnect to the Port of Fujairah, the Fujairah Oil Industry Zone hereby grants the Lessee and its representatives, employees, contractors a free non-exclusive easement for the Term of the Agreement, over and across the land contiguous to the Lease Premises for vehicular and pedestrian ingress and egress to, from and among the Leased Premises to and from the public rights-of-way, including temporary roads needed for the Project to access the Leased Premises. The easement shall also include such permissions, rights for the use and access to service corridors with pipelines passing through all those lands located between the Leased Premises and the Port of Fujairah, as may be necessary to interconnect the Leased Premises with the Port of Fujairah by a routing proposed by FOIZ and the Port, & in accordance with the planned utility corridors of FOIZ.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 8 of 26 

 

 

3.2 Utilities procured by the Lessee

 

The Lessee shall be responsible for the procurement of the Utilities from various service providers. Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall identify and make available service corridor for the necessary service connection to the Leased Premises. The Lessee shall be responsible for all costs associated with the procurement, consumption and use of the Utilities and the obligation for the design, installation, and maintenance rests with the Lessee and Utilities service provider.

 

3.3 Formalities

 

At the Lessee’s request and in accordance with all Laws, Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall issue relevant official documents necessary for the Lessee and its employees, representatives or contractors to perform their duties in relation to the Project in a reasonable time frame after receiving such request provided that the Lessee, its employees, representatives or contractors shall have complied with all required Laws in relation to the obtaining and maintaining such official documents.

 

4. Term

 

4.1 The Term

 

Unless this Agreement is earlier terminated pursuant to the provisions hereof, the term of this lease shall be for an initial period of thirty (30) consecutive years of operation, which period shall commence on and as of the Effective Date (the “Initial Term”). Thereafter, the lease shall be automatically extend for a further period of thirty (30) consecutive years (the “Extended Term”) following which the lease shall expire, without notice or any other action on the part of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, the Lessee or any other Person, at 11:59:59 p.m. Fujairah time on the last Day of the month in which the sixtieth (60th) anniversary of operations occurs (the “Lease Expiration Date”).

 

The Parties may agree to extend the lease beyond the Lease Expiration Date upon terms and condition to be mutually agreed with the Lessee having the right of first refusal to extend the lease beyond the Lease Expiration Date.

 

4.2 Earlier Termination.

 

This Agreement may be terminated on a date (herein referred to as the “Earlier Termination Date” ) prior to the Lease Expiration Date under the following circumstances:

 

A. by mutual agreement of the Parties;

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 9 of 26 

 

 

B. by Fujairah Oil Industry Zone in accordance with the provisions of Clause 12 (Lessee Events of Default; Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Remedies) upon the occurrence of a Lessee Event of Default;

 

C. by the Lessee in accordance with the·provisions of Clause 13 (Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Events of Default; Lessee Remedies) upon the occurrence of a Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Event of Default; or

 

D. by the Lessee without penalty or further obligation if the Lessee is not able to execute a satisfactory and definitive Port Use Agreement with the Port ofFujairah for the use of the Port’ s inbound and outbound petroleum wharf facilities within three months of the Effective Date of this Agreement unless extended by mutual agreement of the Parties;

 

E. by either Party if the parties are unable to mutually agree to the Rights of Way and easements granted by the Fujairah Oil Industry Zone under Clause 3.1.

 

F. by the Lessee without penalty or further obligation if the Plant is destroyed or damaged to the extent that it is incapable of operating, and in the reasonable opinion of the Lessee it is not commercially viable to restore or repair the Plant so that it is operational, provided however, the Lessee pledges that the Plant and Equipment that shall be installed is brand new without any cannibalized component[s].

 

5.0 Rent

 

5.1 Storage and Refinery Site

 

In consideration for the grant, demise and lease by Fujairah Oil Industry Zone of the Leased Premises, having an area of 450,074.73 sq. m and in the location shown in Annex 1, the Lessee shall pay to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone rent (herein referred to as “Rent”). Rent during the Term shall be an amount equal to Dirhams Fifty (Dhs. 50.00) per square meter per annum for the Storage and Refinery Site.

 

During the Term of this Land Lease, the Rent shall be increased at the end of each year. The increase in the Rent shall correspond to two (2) percent increase over the preceding Rent. The Rent shall be paid by the Lessee to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone beginning 18 (eighteen) months from the Effective Date or upon First Commissioning of the Plant, whichever occurs earlier.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 10 of 26 

 

 

5.2 Other Charges

 

Contribution for the Storm Water Drainage System, Culvert Project, Emergency Fire-Fighting Response Facilities and other common facilities shall be paid separately on a pro rata basis.

 

5.3 Place of Payment.

 

All amounts in respect of Rent for each quarter year shall be invoiced by and paid to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone in Dirhams by immediately available funds due net thirty (30) days after receipt of invoice, on demand and without counterclaim, deduction or set off of any kind, at such place and in such manner as Fujairah Oil Industry Zone may from time to time designate by prior written notice to the Lessee.

 

6.0 Consents and other documents.

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone undertakes upon the reasonable request of the Lessee, to sign any consent or acknowledgement with Lessee and any other Party that the Lessee may reasonably designate, as may be required from time to time to construct, operate, and/or market the Project and provided that any such consent shall not provide the relevant Third Party with any more rights than those provided to the Lessee under this Land Lease. The Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall use all reasonable endeavours to sign such consents or acknowledgements within a reasonable time frame.

 

7.0 Taxes and other covenants

 

7.1 Responsibility for Taxes

 

The Lessee shall be responsible to pay all Taxes that are imposed on it by the Federal Government of the United Arab Emirates or Fujairah Oil Industry Zone . Such Taxes shall be payable by the Lessee in addition to the Rent notwithstanding the Parties acknowledge that the Leased Premises is a free trade zone and that the Lessee will be entit led to all benefits applying to free zone entities, including benefits in respect of Taxes.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 11 of 26 

 

 

7.2 Lessee Covenants

 

The Lessee covenants with Fujairah Oil Industry Zone that throughout the Term it will:

 

(a) carry out an Environmental Impact Assessment Study of the Project in accordance with the stipulations of Federal Law (24) of 1999 not later than eight (8) months from the Effective Date for submission and approval by FOIZ, such approval may not be withheld by FOIZ, if the study and the proposed measures to be adopted thereof, are not in breach or conflict with the stipulations of stated Environmental Standards and Guidelines; Similarly, lessee undertakes to complete the FEED within a period of 6 (six) months.

 

(b) conform to the stipulations of FOIZ HSEQ Management System Manual and Codes of Practice;

 

(c) pay its contribution to FOIZ for the common infrastructure, such as storm water drainage channel and emergency fire-fighting response on a pro-rata basis;

 

(d) ensure that the Leased Premises are maintained, and the Plant is operated, in accordance with all Laws, good industrial practices and in a manner that would not be injurious to health or cause damage to property;

 

(e) not use the Leased Premises for any purpose other than the operations related to the Project

 

(f) ensure that appropriate security arrangements, as determined by Lessee, for the Leased Premises are in place at all times;

 

(g) not construct any buildings or other facilities on the Leased Premises other than are considered necessary by the Lessee for the purposes of the Project;

 

(h) not do anything in or outside the Leased Premises which are not normal and customary for facilities of this type that might cause nuisance, damage or annoyance to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone or any Person;

 

(i) effect such insurance as is normal and customary in facilities of this type and is determined to be adequate by the Lessee at all times in relation to the Plant and all other activities carried out by the Lessee on the Leased Premises on terms and conditions acceptable to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, whose terms, conditions, and acceptance of same shall not be unreasonable, and deliver to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone within three months from the Effective Date and on the date of each renewal of any insurance policy, copies of all insurance policies, slips and cover notes;

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 12 of 26 

 

 

(j) comply within ninety (90) days with any reasonable written request (no more than once per year) from Fujairah Oil Industry Zone for the delivery of non-confidential information, data or their documentation relating to the Project and the operation of the Plant (“Requested Information”) so that the Fujairah Oil Industry Zone can assure itself that the Lessee is in conformance with its obligations under this Agreement and subject to the condition that the standard of assessing confidentiality of the Requested Information shall be that of the Lessee;

 

(k) throughout the term except to the extent of any exemptions which may have been granted to the Lessee from time to time to keep in force and effect all such trade or other licenses, consents, approvals and permissions as may be required for the proper and lawful operation of the Plant provided that if, having made all reasonable endeavours to obtain all such licences, consents and permits necessary for the construction of the Plant and the operation of the Project, it is not possible to obtain these within a reasonable period, the Lessee may terminate this Agreement.

 

7.3 Fujairah Oil Industry Zone’s Covenants

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone hereby covenants that as and from the date hereof and for the duration of the Term it shall permit and cooperate with the Lessee (after consultation between Fujairah Oil Industry Zone and the Lessee) on a timely and good faith basis in and about the authorization of the constmction and completion of any extensions, additions and improvements to the Plant as the Lessee may from time to time determine is appropriate.

 

8.0 Representations and Warranties of the Lessee

 

The Lessee hereby represents and warrants to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone as of the Effective Date as follows:

 

8.1 Legal and Valid Obligations

 

The obligations expressed to be assumed by the Lessee under this Agreement are legal and valid obligations binding on the Lessee in accordance with the terms hereof.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 13 of 26 

 

 

8.2 Third Party Consents

 

To the best of the Lessee’s knowledge, no consents of third parties are required to be obtained in order for the Lessee to perform the Lessee’s obligations under this Agreement.

 

8.3 Litigation

 

A. The Lessee is not involved in any pending action, suit, investigation, arbitration or other proceeding which, if determined adversely to the Lessee, would impair the ability of the Lessee to perform his obligations under this Agreement, and to the best of the Lessee’s knowledge, no such action, suit, investigation, arbitration or other proceeding is threatened against the Lessee.

 

B. To the best of the Lessee’ s knowledge, there are no writs, judgements, injunctions, decrees or similar orders of any Governmental Instrumentality outstanding against the Lessee, which would materially adversely affect the use, operation or maintenance of the Leased Premises by the Lessee.

 

8.4 No Conflicts, Violations or Breaches

 

The Lessee has not received any notice from any Governmental Instrunmentality of any violation or potential violation of any Law pertaining to or affecting or that would reasonably be likely to affect the Lessee’s intended use or occupancy of the Leased Premises or the Lessee’s intended ownership or operation of the Project on the Leased Premises.

 

8.5 Continuing Warranties

 

The warranties in Clauses 8.1 to 8.4 above shall be deemed to be repeated by the Lessee on and as of December 31 of each year during the Term as if made with reference to the facts and circumstances on such date and shall survive the payment of each instalment of Rent under Clause 5. The Lessee shall promptly notify Fujairah Oil Industry Zone in writing if any of the warranties given by the Lessee in Clauses 8.1 to 8.4 ceases to be true in any material respect. However if, after the Effective Date, the Lessee is not able to give the warranties in Clauses 8.1 to 8.4 on December 31 of each year during the Term, then provided that the Lessee is in compliance with his other obligations under this agreement, then the lack of such warranties shall have no effect on this Agreement, shall not give rise to any claim for damages, and shall not be cause for termination by the Fujairah Oil Industry Zone.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 14 of 26 

 

 

9.0 Representations and Warranties ofFujairah Oil Industry Zone

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone hereby represents and warrants to the Lessee as of the Effective Date as follows:

 

9.1 Power and Authority

 

A. Fujairah Oil Industry Zone has the power and has received all necessary consents and approvals required to enable it to enter into the Agreement, to grant a lease of the Leased Premises and to perform of all of its obligations and covenants set out in this Agreement.

 

B. The obligations expressed to be assumed by Fujairah Oil Industry Zone under this Agreement are legal and valid obligations binding on it in accordance with the terms of this Agreement.

 

C. Fujairah Oil Industry Zone acknowledges that the Lessee has represented that it intends to avail itself of the tax-free privileges of the Fujairah Free Zone by entering into appropriate agreements with either the Government of Fujairah and/or the Fujairah Free Zone Authority).

 

D. Fujairah Oil Industry Zone agrees to perform in a timely manner and without costs to the Lessee any obligations of a recurring or continuing nature that are appropriate to the discharge of the Fujairah Oil Industry Zone’ s responsibilities under this Agreement which, while not spelled out specifically in this Agreement, may nevertheless occur from time to time during the Term.

 

9.2 Third Party Consents

 

No consents of third parties are required to be obtained in order for Fujairah Oil Industry Zone to enter into this Agreement and to perform its obligations under this Agreement.

 

9.3 Litigation

 

A. Fujairah Oil Industry Zone is involved in no pending action, suit, investigation, arbitration or other proceeding which, if determined adversely to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, would impair the ability of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone to perform its obligations under this Agreement, and to the best of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone’s knowledge, no such action, suit, investigation, arbitration or other proceeding is threatened against it.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 15 of 26 

 

 

B. At the Effective Date, there are no writs, judgements, injunctions, decrees or similar orders of any Governmental Instrumentality outstanding against Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, which would materially adversely affect the use, operation or maintenance of the Leased Premises by the Lessee.

 

9.4 Title

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone is the owner of the Leased Premises and upon the Effective Date, (i) the Lessee will have a valid leasehold estate in and to the Leased Premises, (ii) the Leased Premises will not be subject to any Liens (iii) no other party can pre-empt the Lessee’s rights under this Agreement, and (iv) there are no pre-existing ecological or environmental issues or liabilities that will transfer or be assigned to the Lessee as a result of this Agreement.

 

9.5 No Conflicts, Violations or Breaches

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone has not received any notice from any Governmental Instrumentality of any violation or potential violation of any Law pertaining to or affecting or that would reasonably be likely to affect the Lessee’s intended use or occupancy of the Leased Premises or the Lessee’ s intended ownership or operation of the Project on the Leased Premises.

 

9.6 Continuing Warranties.

 

The warranties in Clauses 9.1 to 9.5 above shall be deemed to be repeated by Fujairah Oil Industry Zone on and as of December 31 of each year during the Term as if made with reference to the facts and circumstances on such date. Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall promptly notify the Lessee in writing if any of the warranties given by it in clauses 9.1 to 9.5 ceases to be true in any material respect.

 

9.7 No Agents.

 

No agent, broker or finder has been engaged by Fujairah Oil Industry Zone in connection with the transactions contemplated by this Agreement. If any Claim for any agent’ s, broker’s or finder’s fees or commissions is asserted in connection with the negotiation, execution or consummation of this Agreement or of any of the transactions contemplated hereby through Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, then Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall protect, indemnify, hold harmless and defend the Lessee from and against such Claim.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 16 of 26 

 

 

9.8 Easements

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone is the owner of any land over, under or through which easements or other similar rights of access are required in order for the Lessee to connect to the utilities, or otherwise for access to the Land and the proper operation of the Project.

 

10.0 Indemnification

 

10.1 Indemnification by the Lessee.

 

The Lessee shall indemnify, defend and hold harmless Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, its officials, employees and representatives and its Affiliates, agents, contractors or licensees and their respective officers, directors, and employees (herein referred to as the “Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Parties”), from and against all Claims made against or suffered by any Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Parties that arise from:

 

(a) any injury to persons or damage to property that results from the negligent acts or omissions of the Lessee, or any Person representing the Lessee on, or arising out of the use of, the Leased Premises during the Term; and/or

 

(b) relating to any breach by the Lessee of any of its obligations under this Agreement.

 

For the avoidance of doubt, the petroleum fluid cargoes stored in the Leased Premises are not the property of the Lessee and cannot be pledged by the Lessee nor seized by the Fujairah Oil Industry Zone as remedies for any breach of this Agreement.

 

10.2 Indemnification by Fujairah Oil Industry Zone.

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall indemnify, defend and hold harmless the Lessee from and against all Claims made against or suffered by the Lessee relating to any breach by Fujairah Oil Industry Zone of any of its obligations under this Agreement.

 

10.3 Neither Party shall be liable in an action initiated by one against the other for special, indirect or consequential damages resulting from or arising out of this Agreement, including, without limitation, loss of profit or business interruptions, however same may be caused.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 17 of 26 

 

 

11.0 Dispute Resolution

 

11.1 Negotiations

 

A. The Parties hereto agree to attempt to resolve any dispute, controversy, difference or claim (“Dispute”) between them in connection with this Agreement promptly, equitably and in a good faith manner.

 

B. If any Dispute is not resolved between the Parties pursuant to Clause 11.lA within thirty (30) Days from the date on which one Party receives written notification from the other Party that a Dispute exists in connection with this Agreement, then such Dispute shall be settled exclusively and finally by arbitration in accordance with Clause 11.2.

 

11.2 Arbitration

 

A. It is specifically understood and agreed that any Dispute in connection with this Agreement that has not been resolved between the Parties pursuant to Clause 11.1 may be submitted to arbitration at the Fujairah Arbitration Centre of Fujairah Chamber of Commerce irrespective of the amount in Dispute. This Agreement and the rights and obligations of the Parties shall remain in full force and effect pending the award in such arbitration proceeding, which award, if appropriate, shall determine whether and when any termination shall become effective.

 

B. Each arbitration between the Parties shall be held and finally settled in the United Arab Emirates and shall be conducted pursuant to the Rules of Conciliation and of Arbitration of the Arbitration Centre of Fujairah Chamber of Commerce in force when the arbitration commences.

 

C. The arbitration shall be conducted before an arbitral tribunal (the “Tribunal”) composed of three (3) arbitrators. Each Party shall nominate an arbitrator, and the two Party-appointed arbitrators shall jointly nominate the third (who shall be the chairperson) within thirty (30) Days after the confirmation of the second arbitrator, failing which the chairman shall be appointed by the Director of Fujairah Chamber of Commerce.

 

D. Any arbitration commenced hereunder shall be completed within two hundred forty (240) Days of the appointment of the Tribunal absent agreement of the Parties to such arbitration. The Parties shall be entitled to discovery of documents only upon a finding of good cause by the Tribunal. All direct testimony shall be offered by way of affidavit. The Party submitting an affidavit shall make the affidavit available for cross-examination before the Tribunal. The Parties waive any claim to any damages in the nature of punitive, exemplary or statutory damages in excess of compensatory damages, and the Tribunal is specifically divested of any power to award such damages. The award of the Tribunal shall be final and binding on the Parties (i.e. not subject to appeal) and the Parties agree that an arbitration award may be entered in any court having jurisdiction thereof. The Tribunal shall have the right and authority to grant injunctive, declaratory and other equitable relief.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 18 of 26 

 

 

E. Only Persons who are engineers, attorneys; financial advisors, former judges, managers, executives and other professionals with relevant technical or legal experience with graduate-level education and qualifications shall be appointed as arbitrators. No arbitrator shall be a present employee or agent of, or consultant or counsel to, either Party or any Affiliate of either Party.

 

F. The Parties shall each pay one-half of any advances on costs set by the Tribunal. The Tribunal shall be entitled to allocate the costs of arbitration between the Parties, which costs shall be borne by each Party as determined in any arbitral award or awards by the Tribunal.

 

12.0 Lessee Events of Default; Fujairah Oil Industry Zone’s Remedies

 

12.1 Lessee Events of Default

 

The occurrence of any of the following events shall constitute a “Lessee Event of Default” on the part of the Lessee under this Agreement:

 

A. the Lessee fails to pay any amount in respect of Rent within thirty (30) Days after the date when such amounts are due, taken into account any event of force majeure, that prevent the Lessee from fulfilling its payment obligations; or

 

B. the Lessee fails to perform or meet in any material respect any material term, condition, covenant, agreement or obligation on the part of the Lessee to be performed or met under this Agreement, and such failure continues for a period of sixty (60) Days after notice thereof is given by Fujairah Oil Industry Zone to the Lessee; provided that a Lessee Event of Default shall not be deemed to have occurred hereunder if such failure cannot reasonably be cured within sixty (60) Day period and the Lessee has commenced and is diligently pursuing such cure within such sixty (60) Day period to the reasonable satisfaction of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, in which case the Lessee shall have an additional period of time (not to exceed one hundred and twenty (120) Days after receipt of written notice of such default) to cure such default (the “Extended Cure Period”) and Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall not terminate this Agreement during such Extended Cure Period.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 19 of 26 

 

 

12.2 Fujairah Oil Industry Zone’s Remedies.

 

A. Upon the occurrence of any Lessee Event of Default and provided that the same is continuing and subject to any grace periods provided for in Clause 12.l(B) of this Agreement, Fujairah Oil Industry Zone may, at its option and without prejudice to any other right, remedy or recourse afforded to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone under any provision hereof or at Law, elect to terminate this Agreement by giving written notice of termination to the Lessee and/or Fujairah Oil Industry Zone may exercise any other right or remedy it may have at Law or in equity on account of such Lessee Event of Default. In such event, the Earlier Termination Date shall be the date specified in such notice of termination. At any time on or after the Earlier Termination Date, Fujairah Oil Industry Zone or Fujairah Oil Industry Zone’s officials, employees, agents or representatives may, unless prevented by court order or Law and upon not less then fifteen (15) Days written notice to the Lessee, re-enter the Leased Premises, remove all Persons and demand the Lessee remove all or any property therefrom, in advance of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone’ s right to repossess and enjoy the Leased Premises, and all modifications made to the same during the Term.

 

B. In addition to the rights and remedies provided in Clause 12.2 A above, and whether or not the Leased Premises or any part thereof shall have been re-let, the Lessee shall pay to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone all amounts due and owing under this Agreement up to the Earlier Termination Date.

 

C. The exercise by Fujairah Oil Industry Zone of any right or remedy against the Lessee or the Leased Premises shall not preclude the simultaneous or successive exercise against the Lessee or the Leased Premises of any other right or remedy provided for herein or permitted by Law or in equity, whether or not such rights or remedies are consistent or inconsistent with any other right or remedy.

  

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 20 of 26 

 

 

13.0 Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Events of Default; Lessee’s Remedies

 

13.1 Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Events of Default

 

The occurrence of any of the following events shall constitute a ” Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Event of Default” on the part of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone under this Land Lease:

 

Fujairah Oil Industry Zone fails to perform or meet in any material respect any other material term, condition, covenant, agreement or obligation on the part of Fujairah Oil Industry Zone to be performed or met under this Agreement, and such failure continues for a period of sixty (60) Days after notice thereof is given by the Lessee to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, provided that a Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Event of Default shall not be deemed to have occurred hereunder if such failure cannot reasonably be cured within such sixty (60) Day period and Fujairah Oil Industry Zone has commenced and is diligently pursuing such cure within such sixty (60) Day period, in which case Fujairah Oil Industry Zone shall have an Extended Cure Period and the Lessee may not terminate this Agreement during such Extended Cure Period.

 

13.2 Lessee’s Remedies.

 

A. Upon the occurrence of any Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Event of Default hereunder, the Lessee may, at its option, elect to terminate this Agreement by giving written notice of termination to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone and/or the Lessee may exercise any other right or remedy it may have at Law or in equity on account of such Fujairah Oil Industry Zone Event of Default. In such event, the Earlier Termination Date shall be the date specified in such notice of termination subject to any grace periods provided for in Clause 13.1A of this Agreement.

 

B. The exercise by the Lessee of any right or remedy against Fujairah Oil Industry Zone or the Leased Premises shall not preclude the simultaneous or successive exercise against Fujairah Oil Industry Zone or the Leased Premises of any other right or remedy provided for herein or permitted by Law or in equity, whether or not such rights or remedies are consistent or inconsistent with any other right or remedy.

 

14.0 Surrender of Leased Premises

 

The Lessee shall, upon the Lease Expiration Date or Earlier Termination Date, whichever shall first occur, surrender the Leased Premises to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone without delay, free and clear of all tenancies and occupancies and free and clear of all Liens, and the Lessee shall execute and deliver to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone any and all documents, whether in recordable form or otherwise, required to evidence the termination of this Agreement. This Clause 14 shall be without prejudice and subject always to Clause 4.1.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 21 of 26 

 

 

15.0 Miscellaneous Provisions

 

15.1 Notices

 

Any notice or other communication from one Party to the other Party which is required or permitted to be made under the provisions of this Land Lease shall be:

 

A. made in writing;

 

B. delivered personally (by hand delivery or by courier) to the address of the other Party which is shown below or to such other address as the other Party shall by notice require, or sent by facsimile transmission (with receipt of transmission confirmation) to the facsimile number of the other Party which is shown below or to such other facsimile number as the other Party shall by notice require; and

 

C. marked for the attention of the person(s) designated below or to such other person(s) as the other Party shall by notice require. Any notice or other communication made by one Party to the other Party in accordance with the foregoing provisions of this Clause 15 shall be deemed to be received by the other Party, if delivered by hand or by courier, on the Day on which it is left at that Party’s address, or if sent by facsimile transmission, on the next Business Day following the Day on which it is sent to that Party’s address.

 

If to Fujairah Oil Industry Zone, to:

 

FUJAIRAH OIL INDUSTRY ZONE

 

Attention: Capt. Salem Al Afkham Al Hamoudi

Facsimile: 09 22 44 111 Email: Capt.Salem@foiz.gov.ae

 

If to the Lessee, to:

 

BROOGE PETROLEUM & GAS INVESTMENT COMPANY FZE

 

Attention: Nicolaas Pardenkooper

 

Email: nico.paardenkooper@bpgic.com

 

Either Party from time to time may change its address, or other information for the purpose of notices to such Party by giving notice specifying such change to the other Party.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 22 of 26 

 

 

15.2 Entire Agreement

 

On the Effective Date, this Agreement constitutes the entire agreement and understanding between the Parties with respect to the subject matter hereof, and supersedes any and all previous or contemporaneous understandings, proposals, negotiations, agreements, commitments and representations, whether written or oral.

 

15.3 Waiver

 

Any term or condition of this Agreement may be waived at any time by the Party hereto that is entitled to the benefit thereof, but no such waiver shall be effective unless set forth in a written instrument duly executed by all Parties. The failure or delay of any Party to require performance by any other Party of any provision of this Agreement shall not affect its right to require performance of such provision unless and until such performance has been waived by such Party in writing in accordance with the terms hereof. No waiver by any Party of any term or condition of this Agreement, in any one or more instances, shall be deemed to be or construed as a waiver of the same or any other term or condition of this Agreement on any future occasion. All remedies, either under this Agreement or by Law or otherwise afforded, shall be cumulative and not alternative.

 

15.4 Amendment

 

No modification, amendment or waiver of any provisions of this Agreement shall be valid unless it is in writing and signed by all Parties hereto.

 

15.5 Assignment

 

A. Neither Party may assign any of its rights or obligations, in part or in whole, under this Agreement (collectively, an “Assignment”) without the prior written consent of the other Party, save that nothing in this Agreement will prevent the Lessee from granting any sub-lease or assigning in accordance with Clause 2.3

 

B. No Assignment shall be effective unless and until the assignor has procured the proposed assignee to covenant directly with the other Party to observe and perform all the terms and conditions of this Agreement and has provided to the other Party a certified copy of the Assignment.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 23 of 26 

 

 

15.6 Headings

 

The headings contained in this Agreement are solely for the convenience of the Parties hereto and should not be used or relied upon in any manner in the construction or interpretation of this Agreement.

 

15.7 Invalidity

 

The invalidity or unenforceability of any provisions of this Agreement shall be determined in accordance with Clause 11.2. The Parties hereby agree to use good faith efforts to negotiate an equitable adjustment to any provision of this Agreement determined to be invalid or unenforceable, with a view toward effecting the purpose of this Agreement, and the validity or enforceability of the remaining provisions of this Agreement shall not be affected thereby.

 

15.8 Governing Law

 

This Agreement shall be governed by and construed in accordance with the Federal Laws of the United Arab Emirates and Fujairah Law.

 

15.9 Fridays and Holidays

 

Whenever the date for the performance of any term, condition, obligation, covenant, agreement or provision required or provided under this Agreement falls on a Friday, Saturdays or legal holiday in the Emirate of Fujairah, such date shall be extended to the next succeeding Business Day.

 

15.10 Confidentiality

 

Each Party shall hold, and shall use its best efforts to cause its representatives, to hold, in strict confidence from any other Person (other than any such representative or Financing Party) all documents and information concerning the other Party or any of its representatives furnished to it by the other Party in connection with this Agreement or the transactions contemplated hereby unless:

 

A. required to disclose any such information by judicial or administrative process (including in connection with obtaining from any Governmental Instrumentality the necessary approvals of this Agreement, and the transactions contemplated hereby) or by other requirements of Law;

 

B. required to disclose any such information to comply with regulatory reporting requirements including those set forth by the U.S. Securities and Exchange Commission;

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 24 of 26 

 

 

C. required to disclose any such information to comply with the requirements of any stock exchange.

 

D. disclosed to Persons providing or proposing to provide financing to a Party; or

 

E. disclosed in an action or proceeding brought by either Party in pursuit of its rights or in the exercise of its remedies hereunder. Notwithstanding the foregoing, this Clause 15.10 shall not apply to such documents or information that was:

 

1) previously known by the Party rece1vmg such documents or information;

 

2) in the public domain (either prior to or after the furnishing of such documents or information hereunder) through no fault of such receiving Party; or

 

3) later acquired by such receiving Party from another source if such receiving Party is not aware that such source is under an obligation to the other Party to keep such documents and information confidential.

 

15.11 Further Assurances

 

The Parties shall at all times do all such further acts and execute and deliver such further deeds and documents as shall be reasonably required in order to perform and carry out the provisions of this Agreement.

 

15.12 Survival

 

The agreements of the Parties contained in Clauses 7.1 and in Clauses 5, 10, 11 and 15 shall survive, as the case may be, any termination of this Agreement that occurs prior to the Lease Expiration Date, for a period of two (2) years after such termination or expiration of this Agreement.

 

15.13 Binding Effect

 

This Agreement shall be binding upon and inure to the benefit of the Parties hereto and their respective successors and permitted assigns. IN WITNESS WHEREOF, the Parties hereto have caused this Agreement to be executed by their respective duly authorised representatives as of the date first written above.

 

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

Page 25 of 26 

 

 

ON BEHALF OF

FUJAIRAH OIL INDUSTRY ZONE

 

   
Name: Capt. Salem Al Aflkam Al Hamoudi  
Title: Director, FOIZ  
     
Date: 02-02-2020  

 

ON BEHALF OF BROOGE PETROLEUM

AND GAS INVESTMENT COMPANY

 

  /s/ Nicolaas Pardenkooper  
     
Name: Nicolaas Pardenkooper  
Title: Chief Executive Officer  
Date: 02-02-2020  

 

 

Land Lease Agreement FOIZ_AL BROOGE PHASE III

 

 

Page 26 of 26

 

 

 

Exhibit 4.86

 

 

REFINERY AGREEMENT

 

between

 

AL BROOGE INTERNATIONAL ADVISORY LLC (“BIA”)

 

and

 

BROOGE PETROLEUM AND GAS INVESTMENT COMPANY FZE

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Page 1 | 4

 

 

This Agreement is entered into on 23rd Feb, 2020

 

Between:

 

Al Brooge International Advisory LLC, P.O. Box 29939, Abu Dhabi, United Arab Emirates (hereinafter referred to as “BIA”)

 

And

 

Brooge Petroleum & Gas Investment Company FZC (BPGIC), PO Box 50170, Fujairah, United Arab Emirates (hereinafter referred to as “BPGIC”)

 

together referred to as the “Parties”, or individually as “Party”.

 

WHEREAS:

 

A- BPGIC is an oil storage and service provider strategically located in the Port ofFujairah in the Emirate of Fujairah of the UAE. BPGIC’s existing terminal is consistent of Phase I which is fully operational, and Phase II under constrnction stage, both of which are located on the same plot ofland (“Developed Land”).
B- BIA is interested in constructing a refinery with a capacity of 25,000 bpd on the Developed Land to benefit from the adjacent facility of Phase I, and to address and produce low sulfur fuel oil in compliance with the IMO 2020 requirements, and in accordance with the international NFPA, and UAE adapted standards for safety requirements (the “Project”).
C- BPGIC is interested in the possibility of subleasing a carve out of its Developed Land to BIA, and in operating the Project once is handed over for operations.
D- The Parties agree and acknowledge the mutual interest and wish to agree on a long-term joint venture agreement (the “JV”) in accordance with the terms and conditions as set forth below.

 

NOW, THEREFORE, it is agreed as follows:

 

1- FRAMEWORK OF COOPERATION

 

1.1 Both Patties agree and acknowledge that they shall use their best endeavors to finalize the technical and design feasibility of the Project to be constructed on the Developed Land. The Parties agree that this Agreement sets forth the outlines of the cooperation as of the date between the Patties hereto.

 

1.2 the Parties shall agree on and determine the interface of cooperation in order to assure a coordinated communication leading to the final terms and conditions of the sublease and the commercial aspects of the N within 30 working days.

 

Page 2 | 4

 

 

2 - ASSIGNMENT

 

BPGIC hereby provide BIA the right to enter into an back to back joint venture agreement with internationally reputed counterparts subject to obtaining BPGIC’s prior approval and having proper due diligences in place, however such assignment shall not in any way release BIA from its financial and legal obligations arising from its JV with BPGIC.

 

3- MISCELLANEOUS

 

a) This Agreement and any of its provisions may only be altered or amended if in writing and signed by both Parties.
b) This Agreement is not intended, nor shall create, express or imply, any legal relationship between the Patties that may be construed as an agency or partnership or otherwise and no Patty shall be authorized to bind the other Party or to act in its name.
c) Nothing in this Agreement shall be construed to grant, transfer or assign a Party any right or license under any intellectual property right (whether registered or unregistered), patent, know-how, trade secret, invention, discovery or improvement belonging to the other Party.
d) This Agreement may be entered into in any number of counterparts all of which, taken together, shall form one and the same agreement and either Party may enter into this Agreement by executing a counterpart.
e) A person who is not a Party has no rights under applicable laws to enforce or enjoy the benefit of any provision of this Agreement.

 

4- GOVERNING LAW AND JURISDICTION

 

This Agreement shall be governed by and constmed, enforced and performed in accordance with the laws the Free zone of the Emirate of Fujairah.

 

Page 3 | 4

 

 

IN WITNESS WHEREOF the Parties hereto have set their hands the day and year first above written.

 

SIGNED:   SIGNED:
 
     
For and on behalf of   For and on behalf of
Al Brooge International Advisory LLC (BIA)   Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE (BPGIC)
     

 

 

Page 4 | 4

 

Exhibit 4.87

 

 

Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE (“BPGIC”)

PO Box 50170

Fujairah

United Arab Emirates

 

April 2020
 

Al Brooge International Advisory LLC (“BIA”)

PO Box 29939

Abu Dhabi

United Arab Emirates

 

Refinery Agreement

 

Dear Sirs

 

We refer to the refinery agreement executed by BIA and BPGIC and dated 23 February 2020 (the “Refinery Agreement”) pursuant to which BIA and BPGIC agreed finalise the terms of a joint venture with regard to the Project (as defined in the Refinery Agreement) within 30 working days.

 

In light of ongoing discussions regarding the Project, BIA and BPGIC have mutually agreed to extend the deadline for the negotiation and execution of the final terms of the sublease and the commercial aspects of the joint venture in respect of the Project through to Thursday 4 June 2020.

 

The provisions of Sections 3 and 4 of the Refinery Agreement shall have effect in relation to this letter agreement as if set out herein in full.

 

In witness whereof the parties have caused this letter agreement to be executed on the date first above mentioned.

 

Exhibit 4.88

 

 

Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE (“BPGIC”)

PO Box 50170

Fujairah

United Arab Emirates

 

2nd June 2020

 

Al Brooge International Advisory LLC (“BIA”)

PO Box 29939

Abu Dhabi

United Arab Emirates

 

Refinery Agreement

 

Dear Sirs

 

We refer to the refinery agreement executed by BIA and BPGIC and dated 23 February 2020 (the “Refinery Agreement”) pursuant to which BIA and BPGIC agreed to finalise the terms of a joint venture with regard to the Project (as defined in the Refinery Agreement) within 30 working days. We also refer to the letter agreement executed by BIA and BPGIC and dated April 2020 pursuant to which the deadline was extended to Thursday 4 June 2020.

 

In light of ongoing discussions regarding the Project, BIA and BPGIC have mutually agreed to extend the deadline for the negotiation and execution of the final terms of the joint venture in respect of the Project through to Tuesday 4 August 2020 without effecting the ongoing technical and engineering progress taking place in parallel.

 

The provisions of Sections 3 and 4 of the Refinery Agreement shall have effect in relation to this letter agreement as if set out herein in full.

 

In witness whereof the parties have caused this letter agreement to be executed on the date first above mentioned.

 

SIGNED:

 

 

 

For and on behalf of Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE

 

SIGNED:

 

 

 

For and on behalf of Al Brooge International Advisory LLC

Exhibit 4.89

 

Dated 2020

 

 

 

 

 

 

Brooge Petroleum & Gas Investment Company FZE

 

- and -

 

Al Brooge International Advisory LLC

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

DEED OF AGREEMENT

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Matter ref    160754/000010

DUBLIB01/FULLERCH/272744

 

Hogan Lovells (Middle East) LLP

19th Floor, Al Fattan Currency Tower, Dubai International Financial Centre, PO Box 506602, Dubai,

UAE

 

 

 

 

This Deed of Agreement is made on 21st April 2020

 

Between:

 

(1) Brooge Petroleum & Gas Investment Company FZE, a company incorporated and regulated in accordance with the laws of the Fujairah Free Zone Authority under commercial registration no. 13-FZC-1117, whose registered office is at P.O. Box 50170,Fujairah Free Zone, United Arab Emirates (“BPGIC”); and

 

(2) Al Brooge International Advisory LLC, a company incorporated under the laws of the United Arab Emirates, having its registered office at PO Box 29939, Abu Dhabi, United Arab Emirates (the “BIA”),

 

(together, the “Parties”),

 

Whereas:

 

(A) The Parties entered into an agreement (the “Offtake Agreement”) dated 1 August 2019, whereby BPGIC leased to BIA the entire 399,324 cubic metres of storage capacity (the “Original Storage Capacity”) of Phase 1 of its oil storage facility located in Fujairah on the terms set out therein.

 

(B) The Parties have agreed that BIA shall release and assign back to BPGIC the sole and exclusive right to use and lease to its customers on any terms it shall decide in its absolute discretion the BPGIC Allocated Storage on a staggered basis on the terms set out in this Deed of Agreement.

 

It is agreed:

 

1. Definitions

 

In this Deed, unless the context otherwise requires, the provisions in this Clause 1 shall apply:

 

“BPGIC Allocated Storage” means the Initial Allocated Storage and the Subsequent Allocated Storage;

 

“BPGIC Usage Period” has the meaning given in Clause 4.1;

 

“Dispute” has the meaning given in Clause 13;

 

“Effective Date” shall mean 28 April 2020;

 

“Initial Allocated Storage” means an aggregate of 61,072 cubic metres of storage capacity, comprising two tanks of 30,536 cubic metres storage capacity each;

 

“Initial Term” has the meaning given in Clause 4.1;

 

“Offtake Agreement” has the meaning given in Recital (A);

 

“Original Storage Capacity” has the meaning given in Recital (A);

 

“Rules” has the meaning given in Clause 14.1; and

 

“Subsequent Allocated Storage” means an aggregate of 67,928 cubic metres of storage capacity;

 

 

 

 

2. BPGIC Allocated Storage

 

2.1 With effect from the Effective Date, BIA agrees and confirms that BPGIC shall have the sole and exclusive right to use and lease to its customers on any terms it shall decide in its absolute discretion the Initial Allocated Storage for the BPGIC Usage Period.

 

2.2 With effect from 8 May 2020, BIA agrees and confirms that BPGIC shall have the sole and exclusive right to use and lease to its customers on any terms it shall decide in its absolute discretion the Subsequent Allocated Storage for the rest of the BPGIC Usage Period.

 

3. Release of Obligations and Liabilities

 

3.1 The Parties agree to release each other from all undischarged obligations owed to the other under the Offtake Agreement in respect of (i) the Initial Allocated Storage for the duration of the BPGIC Usage Period and (ii) the Subsequent Allocated Storage with effect from 8 May 2020 for the rest of the BPGIC Usage Period.

 

4. Term and Termination

 

4.1 The Parties agree that this Deed of Agreement shall commence on the Effective Date and terminate on 8 November 2020 (the “Initial Term”) provided that with the mutual written approval of the Parties, the Initial Term may be extended by a further [6 calendar months]. The Initial Term, including any extension agreed pursuant to this Clause 4.1 shall be referred to as the “BPGIC Usage Period”.

 

4.2 Following termination of this Deed of Agreement pursuant to Clause 4.1, the BPGIC Allocated Storage shall once again form part of Original Storage Capacity and with effect from the date of termination of this Deed of Agreement, BPGIC shall return the BPGIC Allocated Storage to BIA and the terms of the Offtake Agreement shall be construed accordingly.

 

5. Continuity of Offtake Agreement

 

Save as provided in this Deed of Agreement in respect of the BPGIC Allocated Storage, the Parties confirm that the terms of the Offtake Agreement shall remain in full force and effect.

 

6. Further Assurance

 

Each Party must, and must ensure that any necessary third party will, execute all documents and do all acts and things as may reasonably be required to give full effect to the provisions of this Deed of Agreement.

 

7. Entire Agreement

 

This Deed of Agreement and the Offtake Agreement contain the entire agreement and understanding of the Parties and supersede all prior agreements, understandings or arrangements (both oral and written) relating to the subject matter of this Deed of Agreement and the Offtake Agreement.

 

- 2 -

 

 

8. Variation

 

No variation, supplement, deletion or replacement of or from this Deed of Agreement or any of its terms shall be effective unless made in writing and signed by or on behalf of each Party.

 

9. Invalidity

 

If a provision of this Deed of Agreement is found to be illegal, invalid or unenforceable, then to the extent it is illegal, invalid or unenforceable, that provision will be given no effect and will be treated as though it were not included in this Deed of Agreement, but the validity or enforceability of the remaining provisions of this Deed of Agreement will not be affected.

 

10. Costs

 

Each Party must bear its own costs and expenses in relation to the negotiation, preparation, execution and implementation of this Deed of Agreement.

 

11. Counterparts

 

This Deed of Agreement may be entered into in any number of counterparts and any Party may enter into this Deed of Agreement by executing any counterpart. A counterpart constitutes an original of this Deed of Agreement and all executed counterparts together have the same effect as if each Party had executed the same document.

 

12. Third Party Rights

 

A person who is not a party to this Deed of Agreement has no right under the contracts to enforce this Deed of Agreement.

 

13. Governing Law

 

This Deed of Agreement and any dispute, difference, controversy or claim arising out of or relating to this Deed of Agreement including the negotiation, existence, validity, invalidity, enforceability, breach or termination thereof regardless of whether the same shall be regarded as contractual or not (a “Dispute”), shall be governed by the federal laws of the United Arab Emirates and the law of the Emirate of Fujairah.

 

14. Jurisdiction

 

14.1 Any Dispute shall be referred to and finally resolved by arbitration under the DIFC-LCIA Arbitration Centre Rules (the “Rules”) which (save as modified by this Clause 14) are deemed to be incorporated by reference into this Clause 14. Capitalised terms used in this Clause 14 and not otherwise defined in this Deed of Agreement have the meanings given to them in the Rules.

 

14.2 The seat, or legal place, of arbitration shall be the Dubai International Financial Centre, Dubai, United Arab Emirates.

 

14.3 The number of arbitrators shall be three. The claimant shall nominate one arbitrator and the respondent shall nominate one arbitrator, in each case in accordance with the Rules. The third arbitrator, who will act as a chairperson of the arbitral tribunal, shall be nominated jointly by the two co-arbitrators, provided that if the third arbitrator has not been so nominated within 30 Business Days of the time-limit for service of the response, the third arbitrator shall be appointed by the LCIA Court.

 

- 3 -

 

 

This Deed of Agreement has been executed and delivered on the date stated at the beginning of it.

 

   
Executed as a deed of agreement by )  
Brooge Petroleum & Gas )  
Investment Company FZE )  
     
   
Executed as a deed of agreement by )  
Al Brooge International Advisory )  
LLC )  

 

 

- 4 -

 

 

Exhibit 4.90

 

 

Dated 22nd APRIL 2020

 

 

 

  

Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company

as Operator

 

 

 

 

and –

 

 

 

 

 

TOTSA TOTAL OIL TRADING SA

as Customer

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Commercial Storage Agreement

 

 

 

 

 

  

The parties listed below agree, in this Commercial Storage Agreement (the “Agreement”) dated as of 22nd April 2020 and executed in Abu Dhabi, UAE, the following:

 

Key Commercial Terms
1. Operator Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company, a company incorporated in Fujairah Free Zone, having registration number13-FZC-1117 and registered PO Box 50170 Fujairah United Arab Emirates (the “Operator” or “BPGIC”).
2. Customer Totsa Total Oil Trading SA, a company incorporated in Switzerland and registered office at 10, route de l’aéroport, CH 1215 Geneva Switzerland (the “Customer”).
3. Agreement to provide Services The Operator agrees to provide the Services in relation to the Product at the Terminal, and the Customer wishes to store the Product at the Terminal and desires to purchase storage related handling services from the Operator on the terms and conditions set out in this Agreement.
4. Agreement This Agreement comprises these Key Commercial Terms and the General Terms and Conditions (“GTCs”) which are attached to this Agreement and are hereby incorporated by reference in this Agreement as if they were set out in full and shall apply to the provisions of this Agreement, subject to Clause 1.4 of the GTCs.

 

 

  

Hogan Lovells (Middle East) LLP

19th Floor, Al Fattan Currency Tower, Dubai International Financial Centre, PO Box 506602, Dubai,

UAE

 

-1-

 

 

5. Definitions In this Agreement, capitalised words and expressions have the meanings set out for them (whether by incorporation, cross-reference or otherwise) in the GTCs, unless otherwise defined in this Agreement or the context otherwise requires. In addition,
       
    1. Circulation Charges” means the charges described in Box 16 of these Key Commercial Terms:
       
    2. Clause(s)” means the provision(s) and stipulation(s) of the GTCs;
       
    3. Commencement Date” means: 28th April 2020
       
    4. Excess Throughput Charges” means the charges described in Box 14 of these Key Commercial Terms:
       
    5. Fee” means, in respect of each month an amount equal to the aggregate of the Rental and Handling Charge, the Excess Throughput Charges, the Tank Cleaning Charges, the Circulation Charges, the Tank Heating Charges, the Inter Tank Transfer Charges, and the TopSide Facility Charges for such month;
       
    6. Finance Party” means any person providing debt financing to the Operator in connection with the Terminal (excluding any shareholder of the Operator or any Affiliate of any shareholder);
       
    7. Floor Price” has the meaning given to it in Box 13 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    8. Guarantee” means the guarantee to be provided pursuant to Box 6 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    9. Guarantor” has the meaning given to it in Box 6 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    10.  GTCs” has the meaning given to it in Box 4 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    11.  Inter-Tank Transfer Charges” means the charges described in Box 18 of these Key Commercial Terms;

 

-2-

 

  

    12. “Key Commercial Terms” means the provisions of Box 1 to 22;
       
    13. “Market Price” has the meaning given to it in Box 13 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    14. “POF” has the meaning given to it in Box 9 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    15. “Product” has the meaning given to it in Box 8 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    16. “Rental and Handling Charges” means the charges described in Box 13 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    17. “Services” has the meaning given to it in Box 10 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    18. “Storage Facilities” means any storage space with pipelines, pumps, component parts and equipment and appliances belonging thereto, which are within the Terminal, to be made available to or to be used by the Operator for the purpose of carrying out the Services pursuant to the Agreement;
       
    19. “Tank Cleaning Charges” means the charges described in Box 15 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    20. “Tank Heating Charges” means the charges described in Box 17 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    21. Tank Turn” means a volume of Product equal to the Volume Commitment;
       
    22. Term” has the meaning given to it in Box 7 of these Key Commercial Terms;
       
    23. “Terminal” means the petroleum crude and product storage terminal described in Box 9 of these Key Commercial Terms;

  

-3-

 

  

    24. TopSide Facility Charges” means the charges described in Box 19 of these Key Commercial Terms; and
       
    25. “Volume Commitment” has the meaning given to it in Box 11 of these Key Commercial Terms.; and
       
    26. “Port Dues” has the meaning given to it in Box 20 of these Key Commercial Terms.
       
    27. Wharfage Facility Charges” has the meaning given to it in Box 20 of these Key Commercial Terms.
       
6. Guarantee Not used.
7. Period of Agreement The obligations under this Agreement (including the obligation of the Operator to provide the Services and of the Customer to pay the Fee) shall begin on the Commencement Date, and shall subject to the terms of this Agreement continue for a period of 6 months, i.e. 28th  April 2020 to 8th November 2020 (the “Term”). The Agreement can be renewed based on mutual agreement one month prior to the expiry of the Term, for a further 6 months.
8. Product The Product shall comprise petroleum products (Gasoline and Components) delivered by the Customer to the Operator for the purposes of carrying out the Services, as described in the Port Rules for Topside  Facility Operations (the “Top Side Rules”) and the type and specifications of which shall be pre-agreed by the parties prior to delivery.
9. Terminal Terminal means the 399,324 cubic metre capacity fuel oil and product storage terminal developed by BPGIC in the Emirate of Fujairah, and more specifically, located near the Port of Fujairah (“POF”). United Arab Emirates and any other premises, office, building, Storage Facilities (as defined in the GTCs), tank, and pipeline at which or in which Services are provided to the Customer in accordance with this Agreement by the Operator or any third party appointed by the Operator.

 

-4-

 

 

10. Services The Services shall comprise any or all operations carried out or to be carried out by the Operator in respect of the Product at, outside or through the Terminal, inclusive of but not restricted to:
     
    1.

making storage space available in respect of the Volume Commitment; 

       
    2.

storing, manipulating (which shall be deemed to include the through-pumping of the Product between the matrix manifold and the Terminal), moving, treating, processing and delivering; and 

       
    3.

administrative handling of the Product (including preparing shipping documentation for, dealing with mandatory government reporting and/or other administrative activities related to the Product).

       
    The Operator shall prepare the bills of lading in the BIMCO CONGENBILL 94 format as per Annex (CONGENBILL Edition 1994 adopted by the Baltic and International Maritime Council) for the Master or agent(s) to sign; and
     
    4.

ensuring all measurement devices (including but not limited to automatic tank gauging system, are in accordance with officially approved international standards and to have ensure appropriate certificates of periodic calibration, duly updated are available

       
    5.

 taking daily gauges of Customer’s Product in storage and deliver to the Customer the close of each day by confirmed facsimile, email, electronic data exchange and control services as agreed, daily inventory reports in a form reasonably acceptable by the Customer; and

 

-6-

 

  

    6.

To ensure that for all movements of Products, the Independent Inspector and (if necessary upon the Customer’s option) the Customer’s representatives will at all times have free access to the Terminal with the performance of this Contract

    For the avoidance of doubt, the Operator is entitled to sub-contract all or part of the Services to a sub-contractor or third-party operator at its sole discretion.
    The Operator shall not under any circumstances dispose of or otherwise part with possession of the Customer’s Products except in accordance with the written instructions of the Customer or any person authorized in writing by the Customer to provide such instructions.
11. Volume Commitment for Storage The Customer commits to renting a storage capacity of 129,000 cbm at the Terminal (the “Volume Commitment”) commenced on staggered bases, being 61,072 cbm as on 28th April 2020, and the remaining 67,928 cbm as on 8th May 2020, subject to the terms of this Agreement.
12. Payment The Operator shall invoice, and the Customer shall pay in accordance with this Agreement the aggregate for each month during the Term an amount equal to the aggregate of:
     
    1.

the Rental and Handling Charges;

    2.

the Excess Throughput Charges;

    3. the Tank Cleaning Charges;
       
    4. the Circulation Charges;
       
    5.

the Inter-Tank Transfer Charges; and

    6.

the Port of Fujairah tariffs including but not limited to Wharfage Facility Charges; and the TopSide Facility Charges,

       
    for such month.

     

-7-

 

 

13. Rental and Handling Charges For each month, during the Term, the Rental and Handling Charges shall be determined as the Volume Commitment multiplied by the higher of:
       
    1.

                 per cbm per month. (“Floor Price”)

 

The applicable market price (the “Market Price”) for storage (in US dollars per m3 per month) as determined by the Operator not less than 30 days in advance for each calendar year, in case applicable for longer term contracts in case this Agreement was mutually renewed for longer terms.

       
14. Excess Throughput Charges

The Customer shall have at no extra cost a throughput allowance equal to 1 (one) tank turn of 129,000 M3 per month. Tank turn means a volume of product equal to the Volume Commitment. If the Customer exceeds this allowance, the Customer shall pay to the Operator, Excess Throughput Charges in respect of the excess above the Volume Commitment delivered or redelivered at a rate in          per cbm of the volume of the product handled per each import/export. Excess Throughput Charges will be reviewed and may be adjusted annually by the Operator.

 

Unused free throughput cannot be carried forward to subsequent months.

     
15. Tank Cleaning Charges If the Customer requires a tank allocated to it to be cleaned as a result of the Customer requesting a change in the Product stored in that tank, or in the event of the expiration/termination of the Agreement; the Customer shall pay an amount equal to the costs incurred by the Operator in managing and procuring the cleaning of the tank or tanks. A third-party surveyor engaged by the Customer shall inspect and test the tank for cleanliness.
     
16. Circulation Charges The Customer shall pay to the Operator circulation charges (“Circulation Charges”) at a           per hour in case such a service is requested by the Customer.
     
17. Tank Heating Not applicable for the required products

 

-8-

 

 

18. Inter-Tank Transfers If the Customer requests, and the Operator consents to, the transfer of the Customer’s Product from one tank to another, the Customer shall pay Inter Tank Transfer Charges to the Operator at the amount of             per cbm of Product transferred between any tanks at the same Terminal and measured at ambient temperature during the transfer per month. The custody transfer volume will be based on the issuing tank level gauge computation.
19. TopSide Facility Charges The Customer will pay the Operator on a pass-through basis the TopSide Facility charges as charged by the POF as further set out in Clause 11 of the GTCs.
20. Port Dues and Wharfage Facility Charges

Port dues and any other charges (including Wharfage Facility Charges) imposed by the POF on the Customer’s vessels as defined in the port of Fujairah Port Tariff (effective from 1 May 2008) as amended from time to time or any other applicable charges shall be borne directly by the Customer and are not applicable to this Agreement. To the extent these amounts are invoiced directly to the Operator rather than the Customer, the Customer shall repay the Operator all such amounts upon receipt of an invoice in respect of such charges from the Operator in accordance with the provisions of Clause 11.

 

Any duties or taxes levied by any competent authority will be payable by the Customer as further set out in Clause 3.10 of the GTCs.

21. Change in law Any material increase in costs reasonably incurred or to be incurred and properly evidenced and satisfactorily documented by BPGIC in performing its obligations under this Agreement, including any material increase that arises as a direct result of a change in law (including a change in interpretation of an existing law), regulation (including a change in interpretation of an existing regulation) or tax, will be borne by the Customer on a pro rata basis, that is pro rata to the proportion which its Volume Commitment bears to the total storage capacity of the Terminal, by means of an adjustment to the appropriate element(s) of the Fee.

  

-9-

 

 

In witness whereof the Parties hereto have entered into this Agreement on the day and year first above written.

 

/s/ Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper  
Signed by
Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper
Chief Executive Officer
for and on behalf of
Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company
     
In the presence of:  
   
/s/ Meclomen Maramot  
Name:  MECLOMEN MARAMOT  
     
/s/ Benoit Renie  
Signed by  
Benoit Renie  
Senior Vice President Product Trading  
for and on behalf of  
Totsa Total Oil Trading SA  
     
In the presence of:  
   
        
Name:    

 

-10-

 

 

Dated 2020 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

General Terms and Conditions

 

for

 

Tank Storage and Handling of Products

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

  

Hogan Lovells (Middle East) LLP

19th Floor, AI Fattan Currency Tower, Dubai International Financial Centre, PO Box 506602, Dubai,

UAE

 

 

 

 

Contents

 

Clause   Page
     
2. Applicability of GTCs   2
       
3. Products   2
       
4. Storage Facilities   6
       
5. Operation and Maintenance of Storage Facilities   7
       
6. Delivery and Redelivery   8
       
7. Delivery and Redelivery Requirements   8
       
8. Handling of Vessels   9
     
9. Determination of Quantities   11
       
10. Access to Terminal   11
       
11. Conditions of Payment   12
       
12. Third Party Charges and Sums on Products   14
       
13. Rights of Lien and Retention   14
       
14. Transfer of Ownership   14
       
15. Representations and Warranties   14
       
16. Termination   15
       
17. After Termination   17
       
18. Force Majeure   18
       
19. Liability   20
       
20. Insurance   22
       
21. Confidentiality   23
       
22. Cumulative Rights and Remedies   24
       
23. Compliance with Statutes 24
       
24. Notices   24
       
25. Assignment   25
       
26. Consent or Waiver   25
       
27. Severability 25
       
28. Applicable Law   25
       
29. Notice of Dispute   26
       
30. Arbitration   26
       
31. Third Party Rights   26
       
32. Accidental Reporting   26
       
33. Anti-corruption 27

 

 

 

 

1. DEFINITIONS AND INTERPRETATION

 

1.1 Definitions

 

In this Agreement:

 

“Additional Documents” has the meaning as ascrbied to it in Clause 3.2.

 

“Affiliate” means a Party or person Controlling, Controlled by or under common Control with another Party.

 

“Agreement” means this Agreement comprised of the Key Commercial Terms and the GTCs or any agreement made in writing between the Customer and the Operator for the carrying out the Services.

 

“Applicable Laws” means any federal. emirate, municipal or authority statute, ordinance, regulation, guideline, rule, code, direction or any licence, consent, permit, authorisation or other approval, including any conditions attached thereto, of the United Arab Emirates, the Emirate of Fujairah or any public body or authority, local or federal agency, department, Inspector, ministry, official or public or statutory person which has appropriate jurisdiction.

 

“Business Day” means any day excluding Friday and Saturday and any day which shall be a legal holiday or a day on which banking Institutions are authorised or required by law or other governmental action to be closed in the United Arab Emirates;

 

“Control” in relation to a body corporate means the ability of a person to ensure that the activities and business of that body corporate are conducted in accordance with the wishes of that person and a person shall be deemed to have Control of a body corporate if that person possesses the majority of the issued share capital or the voting rights in that body corporate or the right to appoint or remove directors of that body corporate holding a majority of the voting rights at meetings of the board of directors (or equivalent management organ) on all, or substantially all, matters, and except as expressly provided in this Agreement cognates of the term Control shall be construed accordingly.

 

“Customer” means the Customer as specified in the Key Commercial Terms.

 

“Dispute” has the meaning given to it in Clause 28.

 

“Energy Institute” means the professional body for the energy industry, based in the UK.

 

“Failure to Pay Notice” has the meaning given to it in Clause 13.2.

 

“Force Majeure” has the meaning given to it in Clause 18.1.

 

“LIBOR” means the British Bankers· Association Interest Settlement Rate for dollars for a period of one month, displayed on the appropriate page of the Reuters screen.

 

“Loss” means any loss, damage, cost and expense suffered by the claimant due to the loss, destruction or damage of any property (including the property of the claimant) or from any damage to the environment or from the death or injury of any person (including the claimant).

 

“Maintenance Works” means checking, maintenance, repair and alteration work to the Terminal as per Clause 5.1.

 

“OT1” and” OT2” means all permanent existing and planned oil tanker berths at Oil Tanker Terminal 1 and Oil Tanker Terminal 2 within the Port of Fujairah, along with the installations related thereto.

 

 

 

 

“Party” and “Parties” means the Customer and the Operator individually and collectively as the context may require.

 

“Port Regulations” means any rules, regulations, ordinances, procedures, directives, requirements, policies, standards or information of any kind, whether currently in force or introduced from time to time, produced by the POF in connection with POF and with which users of POF are required to comply, including the Port Guidelines, the Port Ordinance 1982, and the Top Side Rules, as may be amended from time to time.

 

“Reasonable and Prudent Operator” means a person seeking in good faith to perform its contractual obligations and in so doing and in the general conduct of its undertaking exercising that degree of skill, diligence, prudence and foresight which would reasonably and ordinarily be expected from a skilled and experienced operator complying with the Port Regulations and all Applicable Laws and engaged in the same type of undertaking under the same or similar circumstances and conditions as contemplated by this Agreement.

 

“Rules” has the meaning given to it in Clause 30.1.

 

“Security Trustee” has the meaning given to it in Clause 16.3.

 

“Standards of a Reasonable and Prudent Operator” means the standards, practices, methods and procedures expected from a Reasonable and Prudent Operator.

 

“Termination Sum” means an amount equal to the aggregate amount that would have become due in respect of the Rental and Handling Charge (fixed at the higher of the Floor Price or the latest Market Price) under this Agreement until the date on which this Agreement would have expired in accordance with its terms.

 

“Vessel” means any boat, ship or tanker delivering Product to the Terminal via the OT1. OT2 or any future jetties or any single buoy mooring system.

 

1.2 Interpretation

 

Words importing the singular only also include the plural and vice versa where the context requires; words and expressions importing the masculine gender include the feminine; reference to person includes any public body and any body of persons incorporate or unincorporate.

 

1.3 Headings

 

Clause headings shall be deemed not to be part of the Agreement and shall not be taken into account in the interpretation thereof.

 

1.4 Prevalence

 

The provisions of the Key Commercial Terms and the Clauses of the GTCs are to be read as mutually explanatory one of another, but in case of conflict, discrepancy in or divergence between the provisions of the Key Commercial Terms and the Clauses of this Agreement the provisions of the Key Commercial Terms shall prevail.

 

2. Applicability of GTCs

 

All Services shall be provided and carried out pursuant to this Agreement, unless otherwise agreed in writing by the Parties.

 

2

 

 

3. Products

 

3.1 Description

 

For each cargo of Product to be delivered to the Terminal the Customer shall, when required by the Operator in accordance with the Operator’s normal operating procedures, furnish to the Operator a correct and full written description of the Products as may be reasonably requested by the Operator and shall include: their nature, type, quality, composition, temperature, weight, volume, value, source, origin, hazard classification, their pressure and in addition thereto all physical/chemical properties including but not restricted to: boiling point, flash point, vapour pressure, toxicity, melting point, coagulation point, viscosity, degradableness in water, stability, corrosivenes, sacidity, static loading, smell level, MAC/PEL value and all particulars, knowledge of which is material to the Operator for the provision of the Services or alternatively, which is of such nature that the Agreement would not have been entered into or not on the same conditions, if the Operator had had knowledge of those particulars. Such description shall be provided by the Customer in the form specified by the Operator.

 

3.2 Additional Documents

 

The Customer agrees to execute in its name, pay for, and furnish to the Operator timely before the receipt of the Products all information, documents, permits, approvals and other materials and data (“Additional Documents”) which may be required by any Applicable Law including statutes, ordinances, rules, or regulations of any public authority relating to the description, receipt, storing, handling (loading/unloading), blending, shipping, or disposal of the Products or their waste or waste products, to or from the Terminal together with detailed written instructions as to their use and disposition.

 

3.3 Notification

 

The Customer shall as soon as practically possible notify the Operator in writing of new data with regard to the Products falling under the Agreement that become known during the duration of the Agreement.

 

3.4 No Cognizance

 

The Operator shall not be deemed to have knowledge of the description of the Products, if the descriptions referred to in Clause 3.1 and/or the Additional Documents as per Clause

3.2 are not materially complete or correct. The Operator may accept delivery of the Products notwithstanding the Operator’s knowledge of any incorrect or incomplete description of the Products and/or incorrect or incomplete Additional Documents (having notified the Customer of such), and if the Operator shall choose to take delivery of the Products for any reason whatsoever:

 

(a) the Customer shall bear the risk and expense of any necessary measures carried out by the Operator in respect of the Products arising from such incorrect or incomplete description and/or such incorrect or incomplete Additional Documents and shall indemnify the Operator against all Loss arising from such measures; and

 

(b) the Operator shall not be liable for any Loss arising from such taking of delivery of the Products,
     
  save in each case to the extent such Loss arises from the gross negligence or wilful misconduct of the Operator.

 

3

 

 

3.5 Inspection of Products

 

(a) The Operator is not bound to check the Products or their quality, conditions and conformity with their description and/or, as the case maybe, the completeness or correctness of the Additional Documents. Without prejudice to Clause 3.4, the Operator shall, however, be entitled, on or before taking delivery of any Products, to measure, test or examine the Products and check the Additional Documents for the purposes of inspection or verification if the Operator suspects that the contents have been incompletely or incorrectly described and/or incomplete or incorrect Additional Documents have been furnished to the Operator. The Customer shall bear the cost of the Operator’s inspection and verification.

 

(b) The Customer may appoint, at its own cost and expense, an independent inspector(s), the identity of which shall be approved by the Operator, to ascertain the quality of the Products at the Terminal. The decision of such inspector(s), if appointed, shall be treated and accepted by the Customer and the Operator as conclusive and shall be final and binding upon the Operator and the Customer, save in the case of fraud or manifest error, as to the quality of the Products so loaded or unloaded. If no inspector is appointed, then in such an event the qualities ascertained by the Operator shall be binding for both Parties.

 

3.6 Delivery of Products

 

(a) Any taking of delivery of the Products by the Operator shall not constitute proof that the Products were delivered in a good and undamaged condition.

 

(b) The Operator shall, as soon as possible, notify the Customer of any damage or defect of the Products and/or incompleteness or incorrectness of the description of the Products or the Additional Documents, which is apparent at the time of delivery thereof but the Customer shall not make any claim against the Operator by reason of the fact that it has not been so notified.

 

(c) The Operator shall be entitled, at the expense of the Customer, to do all things necessary to prevent or reduce further deterioration in the condition of the Products and to arrange for a report to be made on the condition of the Products or, as the case may be, arrange for the correction or completeness of the Additional Documents, without being liable for any Loss arising from doing such things and the Customer shall indemnify the Operator against such Loss save where such Loss arises from the gross negligence or wilful misconduct of the Operator.

 

3.7 Refusal of Products

 

Notwithstanding other provisions of the Agreement, the Operator shall be entitled to refuse to take delivery of the Products or to carry out any Services if the acceptance of Product or carrying out of Services may in the reasonable opinion of the Operator result in:

 

(a) the Products delivered purportedly as the Products do not conform with the description thereof provided by the Customer as per Clause 3.1 and/or are not furnished with complete or correct Additional Documents as per Clause 3.2;

 

(b) danger or damage either to persons, goods, the Terminal or property generally;

 

(c) any environmental damage; or

 

(d) a violation of the Port Regulations or Applicable Laws.

 

4

 

 

3.8 If the Products are at the Terminal and, in the reasonable opinion of the Operator, do not conform with the description thereof provided by the Customer as per Clause 3.1 and/or are not furnished with complete or correct Additional Documents as per Clause 3.2, the Operator shall be entitled to remove the Products forthwith at the risk and expense of the Customer if the carrying out of the Services may lead to a claim.

 

3.9 Admission to Terminal

 

If the Operator gives its consent to admit to the Terminal the Products, whose quality deviates from the description referred to in Clause 3.1 and/or, as the case may be, the Additional Documents are incomplete or incorrect as per Clause 3.2, all the necessary extra operations, of any nature whatsoever, which are carried out in relation to those Products and all further consequences shall be for the account of the Customer.

 

3.10 Duties, Taxes and Charges

 

If the Products are or may be subject to duties, taxation or other charges by the competent authorities, the Customer shall reasonably in advance furnish to the Operator, all information and documents required by the Operator to enable the Operator to make the appropriate declarations to such authorities for such purposes or to facilitate the Operator’s dealings with such authorities. The Customer shall be liable for and shall indemnify the Operator against any Loss, penalties, taxes or duties paid or payable by the Operator in connection with the Product.

 

3.11 Warranty

 

The Customer warrants that the Products:

 

(a) will cause no damage to the Storage Facilities and/or ancillary equipment of the Terminal;

 

(b) will not render, after cleaning, the Storage Facilities unfit for the proper storage of water white chemicals; and

 

(c) may lawfully be stored at the Terminal.

 

The Customer shall be responsible for all fines, penalties and damages directly resulting from the storage of the Products at the Terminal. Provided, however, the Customer shall not be responsible for such fines, penalties and damages arising from the Operator’s failure to use reasonable care in safekeeping and handling of the Products or the property of the Customer pursuant to Its obligations under the Agreement or any damage caused by the gross negligence or wilful misconduct of the Operator.

 

3.12 Title and risk

 

Except to the extent inconsistent with Clause 13.3 and Clause 17.5, title and risk in relation to the Product shall remain with the Customer at all times under the terms of this Agreement.

 

5

 

 

4. Storage Facilities

 

4.1 Use of Storage Facilities

 

The Customer shall only use the Storage Facilities for the purposes specified in the Agreement unless otherwise sublet to another customer, for which in such case the Customer will effect a mutually agreed sublease contract to be annexed to this Commercial Storage Agreement

 

4.2 Selection of Storage Facilities

 

(a) Unless expressly provided otherwise in the Agreement, the Operator shall, at its absolute discretion, in consultation with the Customer, select the Storage Facilities suitable for receipt and storage of the Products and shall be entitled to move the Products from one part of the Storage Facilities to another from time to time with the approval of the Customer (not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed).

 

(b) Subject to obtaining the consent of the Customer and other relevant customers (which consent shall not be required in the event of an emergency), the Operator may receive and store the Products at any of the Storage Facilities at the Terminal in common with Products of the same average quality and of the same grade as the Products.

 

(c) The Customer shall not be entitled to claim that Products, which the Operator shall subsequently deliver to the Customer out of such common place purportedly as the Products, are not in fact the Products, which the Customer had earlier delivered to the Operator for carrying out the Services.

 

(d) The Operator shall as soon as possible, notify the Customer of any movement of the Products but the Customer shall not make any claim against the Operator by reason of the fact that it has not been so notified.

 

For the purpose of this section, “emergency” should be understood as any unforeseeable natural hazard such as flooding, storm risk, fire and accidents in the immediate vicinity of the oil terminal, and representing a threat to people, environment and/or facilities. Commercial or operational optimizations shall not be interpreted as an “emergency”.

 

4.3 Suitability of Storage Facilities and Right of Audit

 

The Customer (or a third-party surveyor engaged by the Customer) shall be entitled to inspect the Storage Facilities to ensure their cleanliness, suitability and good condition prior to the delivery of the Products to the Operator, prior to commencement of this Agreement and at any time during its term. The rights to inspect, their cleanliness, suitability and good condition prior to the delivery of the Products to the Operator shall be exercised at reasonable times, during the Storage Facilities working hours and with prior written notice, provided the relevant representative of the Customer (or a third-party surveyor engaged by the Customer) shall comply with all on-site health and safety and other regulations. If the Customer (or a third party surveyor engaged by the Customer) shall not make such inspection or shall not have objected in writing to the cleanliness, suitability or condition of the Storage Facilities within 7 days following such inspection, the Storage Facilities shall be deemed to have been in a clean, suitable and good condition upon the delivery of the Products thereto and the Operator shall not be liable in any way whatsoever for any Loss arising out of any lack of cleanliness or the state or condition of the Storage Facilities. The decision of any third party surveyor engaged by the Customer as to the cleanliness or otherwise of the Storage Facilities shall, except in the case of fraud or manifest error, be final. The Operator shall keep all records that may reasonably be required for any audit for a period of not less than three years, or for so long as required under the applicable laws, whichever is longer.

 

6

 

 

4.4 Substitute Storage Facilities

 

If at any time during the term of the Agreement, the Operator finds it necessary to provide substitute storage facilities to the Customer, the Operator may do so provided any additional costs involved in the transfer of Products is at the expense of the Operator and the Operator has obtained the Customer’s prior approval (not to be unreasonably withheld or delayed). Any such substitute storage facilities, while in use under this Agreement, shall be Storage Facilities referred to in this Agreement. The Operator shall compensate the Customer for the cost of any Product lost as a result of the use of such substitute Storage Facilities which is only beyond the tolerance rule of 0.5% plus or minus and that is caused by gross negligence of the Operator.

 

4.5 Maximum Contents

 

Unless explicitly permitted otherwise in writing by the Operator, the maximum allowable weight, which may be stored in any Storage Facility shall be equivalent to the weight of the volume of water at a temperature of 4oC, with which the capacity of the Storage Facility in question can be filled. No reduction in the storage rates and charges payable as per Box 12 of the Key Commercial Terms shall be allowed on the ground that any part of such Storage Facilities shall not have been used.

 

5. Operation and Maintenance of Storage Facilities

 

5.1 Operation and Maintenance

 

The Operator at all times during the term of the Agreement shall operate and maintain the Terminal and related equipment provided hereunder in good and serviceable condition to the Standards of a Reasonable and Prudent Operator. The Operator has no Maintenance Works planned during the term of this agreement. Provided that the Operator promptly notifies the Customer, the Operator shall be entitled, to carry out unplanned and urgent Maintenance Works to the Terminal or to have these carried out, and furthermore to effect alterations or to have these effected or alternatively to fit additional or special equipment to the Terminal or to have these fitted, whenever the Operator deems it necessary or prudent to do so or if the Operator is obliged to do so pursuant to Applicable Law. The maintenance costs shall be fully borne by the Operator, unless the maintenance is related to the non conformity of the product to the provided MSDS provided by the customer.

 

The Customer shall have the obligation to pay storage charge for minimum a week calculated from the moment of start of the maintenance work during a period which any or all of the Volume Commitment are taken out of service for scheduled maintenance or otherwise unavailable. Maximum one week per annum can be accrued by the Operator, in case of longer contract terms, for major maintenance works such as but not limited to API 653 inspections.

 

5.2 Moving of Products

 

Subject to obtaining the Customer’s consent (which consent shall not be unreasonably withheld or delayed) and shall not be required in the event of an emergency), the Operator shall be entitled to move the Products from the Terminal to other parts of the Terminal if the Operator shall deem such movement to be necessary for the Operator to carry out such Maintenance Works and in such event the Operator shall as soon as possible notify the Customer of such movement of the Products. The Operator shall compensate the Customer for any Product lost as a result of the movement of Products.

 

7

 

 

5.3 Liability

 

The Customer shall not be entitled to make any claim that has either directly or indirectly arisen from Maintenance Works or from the deprivation of the use of the Terminal for any duration as a result of such Maintenance Works provided that the Operator has notified the Customer as soon as practicable after becoming aware of such works and, except in the case of an emergency, has consulted with the Customer in respect to such works. Nothing in this Clause 5.3 shall prevent the Customer bringing a claim which has arisen from the gross negligence or wilful misconduct of the Operator.

 

5.4 Payment during Maintenance

 

Subject to the provisions of this Clause 5.4, the Operator shall be entitled to payment by the Customer of all the rates and charges or other sums payable by the Customer under the Agreement in respect of the use of the Terminal even during any period that the Customer may be deprived of the use of the Terminal during such Maintenance Works.

 

6. Delivery and Redelivery

 

6.1 Delivery

 

The Products shall be deemed to have been delivered by or on behalf of the Customer to the Operator at the Terminal:

 

(a) if the Products are delivered from a Vessel, immediately upon the Products passing the connecting flange of the pipeline at the Terminal connected to the manifold of the Vessel; or

 

(b) if the Products are delivered through a pipeline of any other person, immediately upon the Products passing the valve placed between that pipeline and the pipeline at the Terminal.

 

6.2 Redelivery

 

The Products shall be deemed to have been re-delivered by the Operator to the Customer from the Terminal:

 

(a) if the Products are re-delivered to a Vessel, immediately after the Products have passed the connecting flange of the pipeline at the Terminal connected to the manifold of the Vessel; or

 

(b) if the Products are re-delivered through a pipeline of any other person, immediately after the Products have passed the valve placed between the pipeline at the Terminal and the first mentioned pipeline.

 

7. Delivery and Redelivery Requirements

 

7.1 Requirements

 

The Operator shall receive from or re-deliver to the Customer the Products:

 

(a) if so instructed by the Customer;

 

(b) against the presentation of a receipt in a form approved by the Operator and duly signed and stamped by the Customer,

 

provided that the Customer shall have performed and observed the material terms and conditions of the Agreement and of any other agreement made between the Operator and the Customer in respect of other Product at the Terminal, up to the date of such re-delivery.

 

8

 

 

7.2 No Obligation

 

Prior to re-delivery of the Product by the Operator to the Customer, the Customer shall advise the Operator in writing of the person(s) authorised to take re-delivery of such Product. The Operator shall be entitled and shall endeavour but not obliged to:

 

(a) demand from any person purporting to be entitled or authorised to take re-delivery of the Products, satisfactory proof of the person’s identity and of such entitlement and authority; and

 

(b) satisfy itself that the signature and stamp appearing on the instructions and receipts are correct and valid as at the date of re-delivery.

 

The Customer shall provide the Operator with, and can amend from time to time, a list of Individuals authorized to submit requests and instructions to the Operator on behalf of the Customer. The Operator accept and act or reject on any request or instruction given by any person included in the list provided by the Customer, and in the event that the Operator acts in reliance on any such request or instruction, the same shall be deemed to have been made or given by the Customer. The Operator shall not be liable for any Loss arising as a result of the Operator accepting and acting on or rejecting any such request or instruction save in the case of gross negligence or wilful misconduct or fraud of the Operator.

 

8. Handling of Vessels

 

8.1 POF

 

The Customer acknowledges and agrees that all Vessels must be acceptable to the Port Operator and it is the responsibility of the Customer to ensure that its nominated Vessels at all times meet and comply with the requirements of the POF, the Port Regulations, Applicable Laws and any other requirements and the Operator shall have no liability in this regard. The Customer further agrees that it shall comply with the Port Regulations and Applicable Laws and any orders or directions issued by the POF or the harbour master, including with respect to Vessel scheduling, loading, discharge and pilotage.

 

8.2 Order of Arrival

 

Subject to Clause 8.1 and except where required otherwise by the competent authorities or where deemed necessary by the Operator to facilitate other operations at the Terminal, the Operator shall take delivery of Product from, and redeliver Product to, a Vessel berthed at OT1 or OT2 on a first-come-first-served basis in accordance with the notices given to the Operator by such means and within such time as shall have been agreed between the Operator and the Customer.

 

8,3 Delayed Arrival

 

In the event of any delay caused to the Vessel or any delay, interruption or departure from the sequence of handing of the handling of the Vessel due to any cause whatsoever (including the non-availability of a berth or ancillary facilities), the Operator shall not be liable to the Customer or any other person for any Loss arising from any such delay or interruption or departure, including any claim for any demurrage or other compensation for any temporary or permanent loss of use of the Vessel.

 

9

 

 

8.4 Handling Instructions

 

If the loading or unloading of the Products shall be undertaken by the Operator as part of the Services, the Customer shall ensure that the Operator shall receive adequate directions in sufficient time regarding the proper manner of such loading or unloading.

 

8.5 Inadequate Instructions

 

(a) If the Operator shall not have received any or any adequate directions as described in Clause 8.4 or shall not have received such directions within sufficient time the Operator shall be entitled to refuse to take delivery of or to re-deliver the Products and at the risk and expense of the Customer, to remove the Vessel to any place chosen by the Operator at its absolute discretion; and
(b) the Customer shall pay to the Operator all losses, costs and expenses (including demurrage and consequential losses) arising from such non-receipt, refusal and removal and shall be liable for any Loss arising from such failure and shall indemnify the Operator against such Loss.

 

8.6 Handling

 

The Customer shall ensure that, when the Vessel has berthed or landed alongside a delivery or re-delivery point at the Terminal designated by the Operator and the Operator has declared itself to be ready for such delivery or re-delivery, such loading from or unloading onto the Vessel (including the connection and disconnection of hoses and the taking and analysis of samples of the Products) shall commence immediately and proceed diligently on a 24-hour basis daily (including Sundays and public holidays) without interruption or delay until the completion of such loading or unloading.

 

8.7 Pumping Capacity

 

Without prejudice to the generality of Clause 8.5, the Customer shall ensure that:

 

(a) the Products shall be unloaded from a Vessel at the maximum pumping capacity which is usual in the case of a vessel of a similar size and tonnage unless directed otherwise by the Operator, taking into account the receiving capacity of the Terminal and the requirements of safety; and

 

(b) the Products shall unless directed otherwise by the Operator, be pumped at such temperature, pressure and condition as will not delay or impede such pumping.

 

If the Operator and the Customer shall differ on the question of such maximum pumping capacity, temperature, pressure or condition, Clause 30 shall apply.

 

8.8 Departure

 

The Customer shall ensure that the Vessel shall be removed from the Terminal promptly upon completion of such loading or unloading or, sooner if necessary for compliance with the requirements of the competent authorities or where deemed necessary by the Operator to facilitate other operations at the Terminal always subject to considerations of safety.

 

8.9 Failure

 

If:

 

(a) the Products shall not be unloaded from or loaded onto the Vessel, as the case may be, at the times and the speed described in Clause 8.7 due to any reason whatsoever; or

 

10

 

 

(b) the Vessel shall not be removed from the Terminal at the time described in Clause 8.8 due to any reason whatsoever (including the arrest or seizure of the Vessel by a third party),

 

and the Operator shall have requested the Customer or the master of the Vessel to increase the speed of such discharge or to remove the Vessel, as the case may be, and the Customer or the master shall fail to comply with such request due to any reason whatsoever:

 

  (i) the Customer shall pay to the Operator all losses, costs and expenses (including demurrage and consequential losses) arising from such failure and removal and shall be liable for any Loss arising from such failure and shall indemnify the Operator against such claims.

 

8.10 Not used

 

9. Determination of Quantities

 

9.1 Vessels

 

Quantities loaded to or unloaded from a Vessel will be ascertained by the Operator’s automatic tank level gauging system before and after each loading/unloading event and shall take into account quantities of Product stored in the Terminal’s pipelines. All determinations or quantities shall be in accordance with ASTM International Standards.

 

Quantities unloaded from a vessel: Notwithstanding the above, if the floating roof of the shore-tank opens or closes in the critical zone, or if the shore-tank measurements do not conform to the standards in the American Petroleum Institute Manual of Petroleum Measurement Standards (AP! MPMS), the vessel/barge delivered figures, adjusted by a valid VEF as calculated In API MPMS Chapter 17.9 shall be used for the quantity.

 

Quantities loaded onto a vessel: If the shore-tank measurements do not confirm to the standards in the API MPMS, the vessel/barge delivered figures, adjusted by a valid VEF as calculated in API MPMS Chapter 17.9 shalt be used for the quantity.

 

9.2 Surveyor

 

The Customer may appoint independent inspector(s), the identity of which shall be approved by the Operator, to witness the loading/unloading of the Products for delivery to, or redelivery from, the Terminal. The decision of such inspectors, if appointed, shall be treated and accepted by the Customer and the Operator as conclusive and shall be final and binding upon the Operator and the Customer, save for fraud or manifest error, as to the quantity of the Products so loaded or unloaded. If no inspector is appointed, then in such an event the quantities ascertained by the Operator shall be binding for both Parties.

 

10. Access To Terminal

 

10.1 Authorised Access

 

The Operator shall grant the Customer and persons authorised in writing by the Customer, access to the Storage Facilities only for the purposes of the Agreement subject to their compliance with the requirements of the Operator and the competent authorities.

 

11

 

 

10.2 No Claim

 

The Operator shall not be liable for any Loss due to any cause whatsoever arising from the entry to or presence of the Customer or such authorised persons on the Terminal and the Customer shall indemnify the Operator against such Loss except for Loss which arises due to the gross negligence or wilful misconduct of the Operator.

 

10.3 Not used

 

11. Conditions of Payment

 

11.1 Invoicing and Payment

 

(a) In Consideration to Box 13 of Commercial Storage Agreement; the Customer will pay the Operator the Rental and Handling Charges (as may be revised from time to time pursuant the terms of this Agreement) on account in an upfront payment covering the entire Term with a proof of payment to be delivered to the Operator upon signing the Agreement.

 

(b) Not later than 10 days after the end of each month, the Operator shall submit to the Customer an invoice for the Fee incurred (excluding the Rental and Handling Charges) in respect of the immediately preceding month. The Customer shall pay such invoice within 10 days of its being issued.

 

(c) All sums of whatever nature due from the Customer to the Operator under the Agreement shall be payable without demand and set-off, or counter claim and without deduction.

 

(d) If any deduction or withholding for or on account of tax is required by the laws of any jurisdiction to be made by the Customer from any payment, the Customer shall pay to the Operator such additional amount as will (after such deduction or withholding has been made) leave the Operator with an amount equal to the payment which would have been due if no deduction or withholding for or on account of tax had been required.

 

11.2 Immediate Payment

 

Notwithstanding the period for payment stipulated in Clause 11.1:

 

(a) if legal proceedings shall be commenced by any third party for the bankruptcy or liquidation or winding up of the Customer, unless the Customer can provide evidence satisfactory to the Operator that such proceedings are frivolous or vexatious and can be dismissed within 15 days;
(b) if the Customer shall make any offer of composition to its creditors (except in the case of a voluntary reorganisation not including the insolvency of the Customer);

 

(c) if any order of distress or attachment or similar order shall be made against any property of the Customer and is in respect of an amount greater than US$5,000,000 and remains undischarged for 14 days;

 

(d) if the Customer shall cease to carry on the business in which it was engaged at the commencement of effect of the Agreement; or

 

(e) if the Customer shall fail to perform or observe any material term or condition of the Agreement, all sums due from the Customer to the Operator shall become immediately due and payable.

 

12

 

 

11.3 Interest

 

If due to any reason whatsoever (except the default of the Operator), the Customer shall not pay any sum payable to the Operator under the Agreement within 15 days after the date of the Operator’s invoice then:

 

(a) the Operator shall be entitled to engage the services of any person to recover such sum from the Customer, in which event the Customer shall also be liable for all actual costs incurred by the Operator for such services (including the legal costs); and

 

(b) regardless of whether or not the Operator shall have engaged the services of any person as described In Clause 11.3(a) the Customer shall in addition to all sums payable under the Agreement and the costs described in Clause 11.3(a) (if any), pay to the Operator interest on such sums and the costs at 5% above the then current LIBOR rate, which interest shall be payable on a day to day basis from the date immediately after the due date for payment to the date of actual payment of such sums.

 

the costs and interest thereon or to the date of expiry or sooner termination of the Agreement, whichever is earlier.

 

11.4 Suspension

 

If the Customer falls to pay any amount within 10 days after the due date under this Agreement, the Operator may suspend the provision of Services under this Agreement until such non-payment is remedied. The Operator shall notify the Customer of any imminent suspension of the provision of Services, not less than 5 days prior to the date on which the Operator shall effect such suspension. Failure by the Operator to provide notification to the Customer of any suspension of the Services shall not limit, diminish or invalidate in any way the Operator’s right to suspend the provision of the Services in accordance with this Clause 11.4. During the period of suspension, the Rental and Handling Charges shall continue to be payable.

 

11.5 Basis

 

For the avoidance of doubt, it is hereby agreed and declared that:

 

(a) where the Products shall be delivered or taken re-delivery of by a Vessel, such sums have been charged on the basis that the Products shall be delivered or re delivered at the flange of the pipeline which is connected to the manifold of the Vessel;

 

(b) unless expressly agreed otherwise, such sums shall be payable for the whole period during which the Storage Facilities are available for the Customer’s use pursuant to the Agreement regardless of whether or not the Customer shall have actually used the same;

 

(c) unless expressly agreed otherwise, such sums shall be payable on a monthly basis. Payment for a part only of a month should be on a pro rata basis; and

 

(d) the Operator shall not be obliged to recover from third parties any sums which may be due from third parties to the Customer in respect of the Products.

 

13

 

 

12. Third Party Charges and Sums on Products

 

12.1 Customer’s Liability

 

The Customer shall pay to the Operator the amount of any properly invoiced charges or sums due or paid to third parties (including any freight, port charges, taxes, duties, contributions, fines and any other costs) in respect of the Customer’s product and/or the provision of Services to the Customer save for any charges which are specified in the Key Commercial Terms to be borne by the Operator and shall indemnify the Operator against any Loss arising in respect of such unpaid charges and sums regardless of whether or not the Products shall then be present at the Terminal.

 

13. Rights Of Lien And Retention

 

13.1 The Operator shall have a right of lien and retention over the Products and all sums (including any insured sums collected by the Operator for the Customer), documents and valuables which the Operator shall now or hereafter hold of or on behalf of the Customer or which is now or hereafter due to the Customer, to secure the performance of all of the duties, undertakings and obligations of the Customer under the Agreement or under any other agreement made between the Operator and the Customer in respect of other Products at the Terminal.

 

13.2 The Operator shall exercise its rights under Clause 13.1 by delivering a notice to the Customer setting out the amount of the sums due under the Agreement and any other agreement between the Operator and the Customer in respect of other Products at the Terminal (a “Failure to Pay Notice”). The Failure to Pay Notice shall also set out a due date for payment of such sums, such date to fall at least 7 days after the date of issuance of the Failure to Pay Notice.

 

13.3 The Customer acknowledges and agrees that if the Customer has not paid the amounts due by the due date set out in the Failure to Pay Notice, then the Operator shall be entitled to make an application to any relevant court, to allow the Operator to sell a quantity of Product that will satisfy the amounts due under the Failure to Pay Notice.

 

14. Transfer Of Ownership

 

The Customer may transfer title to Product stored in the Storage Facilities to any person who has contractual rights to the necessary storage capacity in the Terminal. Any such transfer of title shall be promptly notified to Operator

 

15. Representations and Warranties

 

The Customer hereby represents and warrants to the Operator that:

 

(a) it is a company duly incorporated and validly existing under the laws of the jurisdiction referred to in Box 2 of the Key Commercial Terms;

 

(b) it has the power and authority required to enter into this Agreement and perform fully its obligations under this Agreement in accordance with its terms;

 

(c) subject to any general principles of law, assumptions or qualificaitons referred to in any legal opinion required in relation to this Agreement, this Agreement is legal, valid and binding on it and is enforceable in accordance with its terms;

 

(d) the execution and delivery of this Agreement and the performance of its obligations under this Agreement have been duly authorised by all the necessary corporate actions on the part of such Party; and

 

14

 

 

(e) neither the entry into this Agreement nor the implementation of the transactions contemplated by it will result in:

 

(i) a violation or breach of any provision of its statutes, by-laws or other constitutional documents;

 

(ii) a breach of, or give rise to a default under, any contract or other agreement to which it is a party or by which it is bound; or

 

(iii) a violation or breach of any applicable laws or regulations or of any order, decree or judgment of any court, governmental agency or regulatory authority applicable to it or any of its assets,

 

and in case of breach of any such representation and warranty, the Customer agrees to indemnify and keep indemnified the Operator against any such breach.

 

16. Termination

 

16.1 Early Termination by Operator

 

Notwithstanding the other provisions of the Agreement, the Operator may at any time after the occurrence of an Event of Default by the Customer which is continuing terminate the Agreement, by giving written notice of such termination to the Customer.

 

16.2 Event of Default

 

Each of the following is an Event of Default by the Customer:

 

(a) if the Customer shall fail to observe or perform any of its material obligations under the Agreement and shall not remedy its failure to so observe or perform such material obligations within 30 days’ time after the Operator has notified the Customer of such failure;

 

(b) If the Customer shall fail to pay any sum due under this Agreement and shall not remedy its failure to pay within 15 days’ time after the Operator has notified the Customer of such failure to pay;

 

(c) if the Guarantor fails to pay any sum due under the Guarantee and shall not remedy its failure to pay within 15 days’ after the Operator has notified the Guarantor of such failure to pay;

 

(d) If the Guarantor shall fail to observe or perform any of its material obligations under the Guarantee and shall not remedy its failure to so observe or perform such material obligations within 30 days’ time after the Operator has notified the Guarantor of such failure;·

 

(e) the Guarantor repudiates or otherwise indicates an intention no longer to be bound by the Guarantee;

 

(f) If the Storage Facilities shall become unfit in any way for the performance of the Services;

 

(g) if the Operator shall be of the reasonable opinion that the Products have become subject to changes or deteriorated or may become subject to changes or deteriorate and the Operator is of the reasonable opinion that the Customer has failed to give proper or full Instructions to the Operator for the prevention or reduction of such changes or deterioration;

 

15

 

 

(h) if the Customer or the Guarantor shall have a receiver appointed over all or any substantial part of its asset and in the case of an appointment by a creditor, such appointment is not dismissed within 30 days;

 

(i) if the Customer or the Guarantor shall make any composition with its creditors (except in the case of voluntary reorganisation not involving insolvency of the Customer or the Guarantor);
     
  j) if the Customer or the Guarantor shall go into liquidation whether voluntary or compulsory (otherwise than for the purposes of amalgamation or reconstruction)

 

16.3 Early Termination by Customer

 

Notwithstanding the other provisions of the Agreement and the required notice periods therein, the Customer may terminate the Agreement forthwith at any time without claim or charge by the Operator, by giving notice to the Operator if any of the following has occurred and is continuing:

 

(a) if the Operator shall have a receiver, bankruptcy trustee or analogous person appointed over or to administer and manage all or any substantial part of its assets and such appointment is not dismissed or withdrawn within 30 days; or

 

(b) if the Operator shall make any composition with its creditors (except in the case of voluntary reorganisation not involving insolvency of the Operator); or

 

(c) if the Operator shall go into liquidation whether voluntary or compulsory (otherwise than for the purpose of amalgamation or reconstruction),

 

provided that for as long as any amount owed to any secured Finance Party, or any agent or trustee acting on its behalf (a “Security Trustee” ), by the Operator is outstanding, the Customer shall not be permitted to terminate this Agreement upon the occurrence of any of the events or circumstances specified in Clauses 16.3(a) to 16.3(c) (inclusive) and shall instead, subject to the required notice period therein, only be permitted to terminate this Agreement:

 

(i) in the event or circumstance set out in Clause 16.3(a) occurs; or

 

(ii) if:

 

(A) a receiver with a power of sale has been appointed by any secured Finance Party or the Security Trustee;

 

(B) a bankruptcy trustee has been appointed by a court in the United Arab Emirates on the application of any secured Finance Party or the Security Trustee; or

 

(C) any analogous person is appointed by or on the application of any secured Finance Party or the Security Trustee,

 

in each case over or to administer and manage:

 

(D) all or any substantial part of the Operator’s assets; or

 

(E) the shares in the Operator that have been charged to the secured Finance Party, or the Security Trustee (as the case may be) by the Guarantor,

 

and any appointment referred to in paragraph (A), (8) or (C) is not dismissed or withdrawn within 30 days; or

 

16

 

 

(iii) any secured Finance Party or Security Trustee (as the case may be) has been awarded a favourable judgment of a court in the United Arab Emirates substantiating the secured Finance Party’s, or Security Trustee’s (as the case may be) debt claim and enabling it to sell (X) the Operator’s business and/or assets that have been charged to the secured Finance Party, or the Security Trustee (as the case may be) by the Operator or (Y) the shares in the Operator that have been charged to the secured Finance Party, or the Security Trustee (as the case may be) by the Guarantor; or

 

(iv) a court in the United Arab Emirates has issued a judgment of liquidation or otherwise authorising (or permitting) the dissolution of the Operator following a judgment of bankruptcy, or any similar or comparable events under any new legislation applicable to the Operator.

 

16.4 Not used

 

17. After Termination

 

17.1 Termination Payment on Early Termination by Operator

 

The Customer shall pay to the Operator forthwith on any termination pursuant to Clause 16.1, other than in the case of a termination pursuant to Clause 16.2(f) due to an act or omission of the Operator or Force Majeure, an amount equal to the aggregate of:

 

(a) any amounts then due or payable but unpaid by the Customer under this Agreement; and

 

(b) by way of agreed compensation, the Termination Sum calculated as at the date of that termination.

 

17.2 No liability following early termination by Customer

 

Without prejudice to any accrued rights up to termination, the Operator shall have no liability under this Agreement or otherwise in connection with or as a result of any termination of this Agreement pursuant to Clause 16.3 (Early Termination by Customer).

 

17.3 Removal of Products

 

The Customer shall completely remove the Products from the Storage Facilities not later than the date of expiry or the day falling 30 days after termination of the Agreement pursuant to Clause 16.

 

17.4 Return of Storage Facilities

 

If cleaning of the Storage Facilities is, in the opinion of the Operator, necessary, upon expiry or termination of the Agreement, or due to a change in the nature of the Products stored or to be stored therein. during the term hereof, or both, the Customer agrees to remove or cause to remove any Products and waste to permit cleaning in a safe and legal way and to reimburse the Operator for said cleaning, removal and disposal.

 

17

 

 

17.5 Right of Disposal

 

If the Customer fails to remove the Products due to any reason whatsoever upon the expiry or termination of the Agreement in accordance with Clause 17.3, the Operator shall be entitled, by notice to the Customer, to remove the Products from the Storage Facilities to any place whether in or outside the Terminal and dispose of or destroy the Products in such manner as the Operator deems fit and at the risk and expense of the Customer and by rendering any surplus to the Customer to an account as notified by the Customer.

 

17.6 Proceeds

 

If the Operator shall decide to dispose of the Products under Clause 17.5 by sale by private treaty or public auction any proceeds of the sale shall be applied by the Operator in the following manner:

 

(a) firstly, in payment of all sums due from the Customer to the Operator under the Agreement or under any other agreement made between the Operator and the Customer;

 

(b) secondly, in payment of the expenses of the removal and disposal and any storage of the Products in the period between such removal and disposal;

 

(c) thirdly, in payment of any sums due from the Customer to the competent authorities; and

 

(d) fourthly, in payment of other claims or liens of which notice has been given by third parties to the Operator, and by rendering any surplus to the Customer to an account as notified by the Customer.

 

17.7 Insufficient Proceeds

 

If the proceeds of any sale of the Products by the Operator pursuant to Clause 17.5 shall be insufficient to satisfy in full any claim of the Operator under the Agreement and under any other agreement made between the Operator and the Customer, the Operator shall be entitled to recover the same from the Customer as a debt in any court of competent jurisdiction. Any sale of the Products by the Operator pursuant to Clause 17.5 shall be free from any encumbrances.

 

17.8 No Liability

 

The Operator shall not be liable for any claim arising from the removal, disposal, destruction and intermediate storage of the Products and the Customer shall indemnify the Operator against such claims.

 

18. Force Majeure

 

18.1 Scope of Force Majeure

 

Any delays in or failure of performance by either Party shall not constitute default hereunder or give liability for any claims if and to the extent such delays in or failures of performance are, without the fault or negligence on the part of the affected Party, caused by Force Majeure. “Force Majeure” shall mean any event or circumstances, which is not within the reasonable control of the Party (acting as a Reasonable and Prudent Operator) affected by the cause and which, by the exercise of diligence, such Party (acting as a Reasonable and Prudent Operator) is unable to foresee or prevent and may include, but shall not be limited to:

 

(a) war, hostilities, revolution, riots, insurrection or other civil commotion, acts of terrorism or sabotage;

 

18

 

 

(b) nuclear explosion, radioactive, biological or chemical contamination, ionizing radiation, or the discovery of such contamination or radiation;

 

(c) strikes and/or lockouts except any such action by employees or subcontractors or agents of the Party claiming Force Majeure;

 

(d) any effect of the natural elements, including lightning, fire, earthquake, sandstorm, flood, storm, tsunami, cyclone, typhoon or tornado;

 

(e) explosion (other than nuclear explosion or an explosion resulting from an act or war);

 

(f) epidemic or plague:

 

(g) Inability to obtain necessary equipment or materials due to blockade, embargo or sanctions; and

 

(h) any act of omission of any competent authority including any refusal to issue, withdrawal, non-renewal or non-extension of a license, permit or approval.

 

18.2 Notification

 

If either Party is prevented from or delayed in performing any of its obligations under the Agreement by Force Majeure, such Party shall immediately notify the other Party in writing of the occurrence of the circumstances constituting Force Majeure. Forthwith upon the Force Majeure ceasing to have effect, the Party relying upon it shall immediately give written notice thereof to the other Party.

 

18.3 General Limitations

 

The affected Party shall not be entitled to suspend performance under this Agreement for any greater scope or longer duration than is required by the Force Majeure or the delay occasioned thereby. Obligations of the Parties that were required to be· completely performed prior to the occurrence of Force Majeure shall not be excused as a result of such occurrence.

 

The Customer shall be able to claim Force Majeure only in respect of a vessel that is loading or unloading at the Terminal, or whose scheduled loading and unloading at the Terminal has been notified to the Operator.

 

The failure or inability of either Party to satisfy a payment obligation that has arisen under this Agreement shall not be excused by Force Majeure.

 

18.4 No Breach

 

Neither Party shall be deemed to be in breach of the Agreement or be liable to the other for any delay in performance or non-performance of its obligations under the Agreement to the extent that such delay or non-performance is due to Force Majeure, of which it has notified the other Party. The Party claiming Force Majeure shall perform and observe its obligations under the Agreement insofar as the performance and observance thereof are not prevented by Force Majeure.

 

To the extent that the Operator is unable to provide the Services as a result of Force Majeure affecting the Operator, the Customer shall not be obliged to pay the Rental and Handing Charges.

 

19

 

 

18.5 Use of Storage Facilities

 

If Force Majeure is being claimed by the Customer, and as a result of such Force Majeure, the Customer is not using the Storage Facilities, the Operator may allow the use of the Storage Facilities to other customers for so long as the Force Majeure continues.

 

18.6 Efforts

 

The Party claiming Force Majeure shall use reasonable efforts to promptly cure the effect of Force Majeure.

 

18.7 Termination

 

Where an event of Force Majeure affecting Operator or Customer extends for more than 90 consecutive days, the Operator shall have the right to terminate this Agreement by giving 30 days’ written notice to the Customer to that effect.

 

19. Liability

 

19.1 Operator’s Liability

 

(a) The Customer shall indemnify and hold the Operator harmless from and against all claims, costs, losses, liabilities, injury to person and/or damage to property, caused by or resulting from:

 

(i) Any negligence, misconduct, and/or any intentional wrongful acts or omissions on the part of the Customer, its employees, agents, contractors or any other persons acting under its authority (including but not limited to; any contractors transporting product to or from the terminal) in the performance of this agreement; and

 

(ii) Any breach of this agreement by the Customer;

 

(iii) To the extent not caused by the negligence, misconduct of the wrongful acts or omissions of the Operator, its employees, agents or contractors, any losses incurred directly as a results of the physical or chemical characteristics of the product

 

(b) For the avoidance of doubt, the Operator shall not be liable to the Customer for any claims, costs, losses, damages, liabilities, injury to person and/or damage to property incurred by the Customer to the extent that such claims, losses, damages, liabilities, injury to person and/or damage to property are caused (whether directly or indirectly) by the Operator in the performance of its obligations under this agreement in accordance with its terms.

 

The Operator shall carry out the Services with reasonable care and to the Standards of a Reasonable and Prudent Operator. Without prejudice to the Operator’s rights under the other provisions of the Agreement, this Clause 19.1 shall not impose on the Operator any liability for claims arising from:

 

(c) Force Majeure;

 

(d) any delay in the delivery of the Products to the Operator;

 

(e) any other cause unless it is first proven by the Customer that such claim has arisen from the gross negligence or wilful misconduct of the Operator or if it concerns claims due to injury to life, body or health.

 

20

 

 

19.2 Event of Claim

 

Notwithstanding anything to the contrary in this Agreement, in the event of any claim against the Operator:

 

(a) the Operator shall not be liable for any forms of consequential losses (including loss or profits, Indirect loss or damage or other forms of purely economic losses);

 

(b) the Operator shall not be liable for any claim arising before delivery of the Products to the Operator or after re-delivery of the Products to the Customer;

 

(c) the claim will be void if the Customer shall not have notified the Operator thereof within 30 days after the occurrence of the event giving rise to the claim or within 30 days after the re-delivery of the Products to the Customer, whichever is earlier; and

 

(d) if the claim shall have been notified to the Operator in accordance with Clause 19.2(d), the claim shall become void if the Customer shall not commence legal proceedings in respect thereof within the period of 90 days after the date of such notice.

 

19.3 Compensation

 

If any claim shall be made against the Operator by more than one person and the Operator shall decide to pay compensation in respect of the claim, the Operator shall be entitled to apportion such compensation among such persons according to the extent of proven loss or damage suffered by each of them.

 

19.4 Customer’s indemnities

 

The Customer shall indemnify, defend and hold harmless the Operator, its respective officers, employees and agents against:

 

(a) any and all claims for Loss, damage and expense of whatever kind and nature, including all related costs and expenses, in respect of personal injury to or death of any person employed by the Customer; and

 

(b) any and all claims for Loss, damage and expense of whatever kind or nature, Including all related costs and expenses, brought by third parties against the Operator or its officers , employees or agents in connection with any act or omission of the Customer or its officers, employees or agents.

 

19.5 Operator’s Indemnities

 

The Operator shall indemnify, defend and hold harmless the Customer, its respective officers, employees and agents against any and all claims for Loss, damage and expense of whatever kind and nature, including all related costs and expenses, in respect of personal injury to or death of any person employed by the Operator.

 

19.6 Indemnity Process

 

(a) Each of the Operator and the Customer undertakes and agrees, when asserting its right to indemnification from the other party for the negligence or misconduct or wrongful acts or omissions of any of such other party’s contractors:

 

(i) To first seek recourse against any such contractor (including, where applicable, recourse against the Owners, Insurers or P and I Clubs of the responsible barge or marine vessel);

 

21

 

  

(ii) To use commercially reasonable efforts to obtain from such Owners, Insurer or P and I Clubs sufficient security to cover said contractors liability;

 

(iii) To claim under this indemnity only if and to the extent such contractor (including, where applicable, recourse against the Owners, Insurers or P and I Clubs of the responsible barge or marine vessel) is liable and is unable within a reasonable time under the circumstances to meet and discharge its liabilities in full; and

 

(iv) That it will exercise commercially reasonable efforts to assist the other in obtaining recourse and recompense from or on behalf of third parties for losses incurred.

 

(b) In the event that any loss in caused in whole or in partly by the concurrent negligence or intentional wrongful acts or omissions of the Operators, its employees, agents, contractors or any other persons acting under its authority on the one hand and the Customer its employees, agents, contractors or any other persons acting under its authority on the other hand, then this obligation to indemnify shall be comparative and each party shall indemnify the other to the extent that such party’s negligence or intentional wrongful acts or omissions were the cause of such loss.

 

20. Insurance

 

20.1 Insurance and Liability

 

The Operator shall maintain throughout the course of the Agreement the following insurance requirements:

 

A) Worker’s Compensation and Employer’s Liability insurance, as prescribed by applicable law
     
B) Commercial General Liability Insurance with an adequate maximum limit per occurrence and in the aggregate per year for bodily injury, property damages, and contractual liability coverage not exceeding the legal liability
     
20.2 No Insurance of Products by Operator

 

Unless it has been explicitly agreed in writing with the Customer, the Operator shall not be obliged to insure the Products of the Customer or any other property of the Customer or any third party.

 

20.3 Insurance of Products by Customer

 

The Customer must maintain adequate insurance for the Products of the Customer in the Terminal. The terms and conditions of such insurance shall include:

 

(a) that the Operator be a co-insured in respect of such policy;

 

(b) the insurers waive any rights of subrogation against the Operator and

 

(c) such other terms as the Operator shall specify.

 

22

 

 

20.4 Operator’s Assistance

 

If the Customer shall request the assistance of the Operator to determine the extent and value of any loss, damage or destruction of the Products, the Operator will render such assistance subject to:

 

(a) the Customer’s payment of the costs of such assistance (including the fee of the Operator) and

 

(b) if the Operator so stipulates, the Customer’s prior payment in cash of all sums due from the Customer to the Operator under the Agreement or under any other agreement made between the Operator and the Customer.

 

20.5 Insurance of Protection and Indemnity Cover by Customer

 

The Customer shall procure and maintain (or, in the case of Vessels it has chartered, cause to be procured and maintained), in relation to its Products , activities and the activities of its Vessels at the Terminal, comprehensive protection and indemnity insurance including coverage for injury/loss of lives, full collision liability, damage to property including fixed floating objects or Port of Fujairah property, crew, cargo, pollution liability, spillage and wreck removal, to wage, war risks and fines, in accordance with good industry practice in addition to any requirements imposed by the Port Regulations.

 

21. Confidentiality

 

21.1 Confidential Information

 

(a) Subject to Clause 21.1(b), each Party agrees to and shall cause its respective agents, representatives, affiliates, employees, officers and directors, to treat and hold as confidential (and not disclose or provide access to any person), all confidential information received by it relating to the other Party, information relating to the provisions of and negotiations leading to this Agreement, and all other confidential or proprietary information with respect to the Terminal.

 

(b) A Party may disclose information which would otherwise be confidential without the consent of the other Party, if and to the extent

 

(i) required by the rules of any stock exchange or any governmental, regulatory or supervisory body or court of competent jurisdiction to which the Party making the disclosure is subject;
     
(ii) required by any stock exchange or any governmental, regulatory or supervisory body of the Operator’s parent company, which for the avoidance of doubt, is listed on the Nasdaq Stock Exchange, New York.

 

(iii) required by the law of any relevant jurisdiction;

 

(iv) required by lenders in connection with debt financing arrangements for the Terminal;

 

(v) disclosure is made to the affiliates, professional advisers, auditors and bankers of that Party;

 

(vi) disclosure is made to bona fide potential purchasers of shares in that Party and the professional advisers of such bona fide potential purchasers;

 

(vii) the Information has come into the public domain through no fault of that Party; or

 

(viii) the other Party has given prior written approval to the disclosure.

 

23

 

 

(c) This Clause 21 and such Clauses of this Agreement as are necessary to permit the enforcement of this Clause 21 shall continue to apply for two (2) years following the expiry or termination of this Agreement.

 

22. Cumulative Rights and Remedies

 

The rights and remedies given to the Parties under this Agreement shall be cumulative remedies and shall not prejudice any other rights or remedies of the Parties contained in the Agreement or at law or the right of action or other remedy of the Parties for the recovery of any sums due to it from any other Party or in respect of any antecedent breach of the Agreement by that Party.

 

23. Compliance with Statutes

 

The Parties shall comply with the provisions of all statutes affecting the Products, the Services and the Agreement (including, without limitation, those specified in Box 20 of the Key Commercial Terms) and shall give all necessary notices and the Customer shall obtain all requisite permission, approvals and consents. The Customer shall indemnify the Operator against any fines, penalties, losses, costs or expenses incurred by the Operator in respect of any non-compliance with the provisions of such statutes save for where such fines, penalties, losses, costs or expenses were caused by the gross negligence or wilful misconduct of the Operator.

 

24. Notices

 

24.1 Unless otherwise provided for herein, all notices to be given or made in connection with the matters contemplated by this Agreement shall be in writing and shall be delivered personally or sent by prepaid mail:

 

In the case of the Operator to:

 

Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment
Company Address: P.0. Box 50170,
Fujairah, UAE

 

Attention:

 

Ms Lina Saheb 

Chief Strategy Officer 

Email: linasaheb@bpgic.com

 

 

In the case of the Customer to:

 

                                                                               

                                              

                                                                    

 

                          

 

                                           

                                                                               

                                                              

 

24

 

 

and shall be deemed to have been duly given or made served as follows:

 

(a) if personally delivered, upon delivery at the address of the relevant party;

 

(b) if sent by mail, 2 Business Days after the date of posting; and

 

provided that if, in accordance with the above provision, any such notice, demand or other communication would otherwise be deemed to be given or made on a non-business day after 5.00 p.m. at the location of the recipient, such notice, demand or other communication shall be deemed to be given or made at 9.00 a.m. on the next business day at the location of the recipient. Unless the contrary be proven, proof of postage or delivery shall be proof of service.

 

24.2 A Party may notify the other Party of a change to its name, relevant addressee, address or fax number for the purposes of Clause 24.1 provided that such notification shall only be effective:

 

(a) on the date specified in the notification as the date on which the change is to take place; or

 

(b) If no date Is specified or the date specified is less than 1O days after the date on which notice is given, the date falling 10 days after notice of any such change has been given.

 

25. Assignment/Sublease
   
25.1 The Operator may at any time assign or otherwise transfer all or any part of its rights under this Agreement.

 

25.2 The Customer shall not assign or otherwise transfer all or any part of its rights under this Agreement without the prior consent of the Operator (which may be granted or withheld in Its absolute discretion and may be granted subject to any conditions as the Operator deems necessary in the circumstances). The Customer shall also be entitled to sublease part or all the Committed Volume to another well reputed third party subject to having the Operator’s prior written approval (not to be unreasonably withheld).
   
26. Consent or Waiver

 

No consent or expressed or implied waiver by a Party to or of any breach of any covenant. condition or duty of the other Party shall be constructed as a consent or waiver by that Party to or of any other breach of the name or any other covenant condition or duty by that Party and shall not prejudice In any way the rights powers and remedies of that Party contained in the Agreement.

 

27. Severability

 

Should any part, term or provision of the Agreement be judged illegal or in conflict with any law, by a court of competent jurisdiction, the validity of the remaining portions or provisions shall not be affected thereby.

 

28. Applicable Law

 

The Agreement and any dispute, difference, controversy or claim arising out of or relating to this Agreement including the negotiation, existence, validity, invalidity, enforceability, breach or termination thereof regardless of whether the same shall be regarded as contractual or not (a “Dispute”), shall be governed by the federal laws of the United Arab Emirates and the laws of the Emirate of Fujairah.

 

25

 

 

29. Notice of Dispute

 

Any Party intending to commence proceedings in relation to any Dispute shall give at least 1O Business Days’ prior notice in writing to the other Parties of its intention to do so, explaining the nature of the Dispute and the intended proceedings.

 

30. Arbitration

 

30.1 Any Dispute shall be referred to and finally resolved by arbitration under the DIFC-LCIA Arbitration Centre Rules (the “Rules”) which (save as modified by this Clause 30) are deemed to be incorporated by reference into this Clause 30. Capitalised terms used in this Clause 30 and not otherwise defined in this Agreement have the meanings given to them in the Rules.

 

30.2 The seat, or legal place, of arbitration shall be the Dubai International Financial Centre, Dubai, United Arab Emirates.

 

30.3 The number of arbitrators shall be three. The claimant (or, if more than one claimant, the claimants jointly) shall nominate one arbitrator and the respondent (or, if more than one respondent, the respondents jointly) shall nominate one arbitrator, in each case in accordance with the Rules. The third arbitrator, who will act as chairperson of the arbitral tribunal, shall be nominated jointly by the two co-arbitrators, provided that if the third arbitrator has not been so nominated within 30 Business Days of the time-limit for service of the response, the third arbitrator shall be appointed by the LCIA Court.

 

30.4 The language to be used in the arbitral proceedings shall be English.

 

31. Third Party Rights

 

Save as expressly provided in this Agreement, a person, who or which is not a party to the Agreement, has no right under the Contracts (Rights of Third Parties) Act 1999 (UK) to enforce or enjoy the benefit of any term of the Agreement.

 

32. Accident Reporting

 

32.1 The Operator shall immediately report by telephone and by email in accordance with Sections 32.2 and 32.3 below any accident with respect to Health Safety Environment and Security at the Terminal. For the purpose of this clause an accident means any sudden, undesirable event on a given date which causes injury to a person, damage to assets or property, or harm to the environment

 

32.2 Any reporting of an accident must contain available details, such as date and time of the accident, its location and description, details/parts of the facility affected (identification of the tank, of the dock, etc.), resources at risk (product characteristics, quantity), consequences, steps taken to fight the Accident, and any other information as STORAGE COMPANY deems relevant.

 

32.3 Any reporting of an accident pursuant to this Section 32.1 and related to Totsa must be made in writing to groupmail: cargoincidents.tsqeneva@totsa.com

 

and by telephone to one of your usual operational contacts, (or to the operational contacts in the Notice provision of this contract) or to the following contact : +971 50 552 2801 Vincent Chauvet, Ops Manager Should you be unable to get hold of these above contacts, you may call management duty phone number to receive assistance: +41 22 9 202 202.

 

26

 

 

33. Anti-corruption

 

In recognition of the principles recorded in the pertinent international and regional conventions on combating corruption and to ensure compliance with the anti-corruption laws applicable to the activities under the Agreement and any other anti-corruption laws otherwise applicable to the Parties or their ultimate parent company,

 

33.1 - Neither Party, in respect of the Agreement and the matters that are the subject of the, Agreement warrants that neither it nor to its knowledge anyone on its behalf, has made or offered nor will make or offer any payment, gift, or promise or give any advantage, whether directly or through Intermediaries, to or for the use of any Public Official, where such payment. gift, promise or advantage would be for purposes of:

 

(i) influencing any act or decision of such Public Official;

 

(ii) inducing such Public Official to do or omit to do any act in violation of his or her lawful duties;

 

(iii) securing any improper advantage; or

 

(iv) inducing such Public Official to use his or her influence to affect any act or decision of any department, agency or instrumentality of any government or public enterprise;

 

33.2 - Each Party, in respect of the Agreement and the matters that are the subject of the Agreement, warrants that it has not made or offered and will not make or offer any payment. gift, promise or other advantage, whether directly or through intermediaries, to or for the use of any person (other than a Public Official) where such payment, gift, promise or advantage would be for purposes of Inducing such person to do or omit to do any act in violation of his or her lawful duty or to secure any Improper advantage, or otherwise to do something or refrain from doing something that would violate the laws applicable to the activities under the Agreement.

 

33.3 - Without prejudice to any other rights or remedies that either Party otherwise may have hereunder or at law, including but not limited to damages for breach of the Agreement. if any of the undertakings or requirements of this Article 33 have not been complied with or fulfilled by the defaulting Party In any material respect, the other Party shall have the right:

 

(i) to suspend payment and/or require reimbursement of any advance payment made under the Agreement, and/or

 

(ii) to suspend and/or terminate the Agreement with Immediate effect upon written notice to the defaulting Party.

 

DEFINITIONS:

 

“Public Official” means an elected or appointed official, employee or agent of any national, regional or local government/state or department, agency or instrumentality of any such government/state or any enterprise in which such a government/state owns, directly or indirectly, a majority or controlling interest; an official of a political Party; a candidate for public office; and any official, employee or agent of any public international organization.

 

Close Family Member of a Public Official” means a spouse or partner, one of his/her children, siblings or parents; the spouse or partner of his/her children or siblings; or any household member.

 

27

 

 

In witness whereof the Parties hereto have entered into this Agreement and accepted the General Terms and Conditions on the day and year first above written.

 

/s/ Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper

Signed by:
Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper
Chief Executive Officer
for and on behalf of
Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company

 

In the presence of:  
   
Name:

MECLOMEN MARAMOT

 
   
Signature: /s/ MECLOMEN MARAMOT  
     
/s/ Benoit Renie  
Signed by:  
   
Benoit Renie  
Senior Vice President Product
Trading
 
for and on behalf of  
Totsa Total Oil Trading SA  
   
In the presence of:  
Name:     
     
Signature:  

 

 

28

 

 

Exhibit 4.91

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 

 

Exhibit 4.92

 

 

 
 

   

 
 

 

 
 

 

 
 

 

 

 

Exhibit 4.93

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 4.94

 

 

 

 

 

 

Exhibit 4.95

 

 

 
 

   

 
 

 

 
 

 

 
 

 

 

 
 

 

 
 

 

 
 

 

 
 

 

 
 

 

 

 

Exhibit 8.1

 

Subsidiaries of Registrant

 

Company   Country or
Jurisdiction of
Organization
  Percentage
of Voting
Securities
  Owned
 
Brooge Petroleum and Gas Investment Company FZE   United Arab Emirates     100 %
BPGIC International   Cayman Islands     100 %

 

All of the above subsidiaries are included in the consolidated financial statements of the Company as of December 31, 2019.

 

 

Exhibit 12.1

 

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY

 

ACT OF 2002 15 U.S.C. SECTION 7241

 

CERTIFICATIONS*

 

I, Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper, certify that:

 

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of Brooge Energy Limited;

 

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4. The company’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the company and have:

 

(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5. The company’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the company’s auditors and the audit committee of the company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

(a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

(b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Date: June 30, 2020

  

  /s/ Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper
  Name: Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper
  Title: Chief Executive Officer

  

Exhibit 12.2

 

CERTIFICATION PURSUANT TO SECTION 302 OF THE SARBANES-OXLEY

 

ACT OF 2002 15 U.S.C. SECTION 7241

 

CERTIFICATIONS*

 

I, Syed Masood, certify that:

 

1. I have reviewed this annual report on Form 20-F of Brooge Energy Limited;

 

2. Based on my knowledge, this report does not contain any untrue statement of a material fact or omit to state a material fact necessary to make the statements made, in light of the circumstances under which such statements were made, not misleading with respect to the period covered by this report;

 

3. Based on my knowledge, the financial statements, and other financial information included in this report, fairly present in all material respects the financial condition, results of operations and cash flows of the company as of, and for, the periods presented in this report;

 

4. The company’s other certifying officer(s) and I are responsible for establishing and maintaining disclosure controls and procedures (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(e) and 15d-15(e)) and internal control over financial reporting (as defined in Exchange Act Rules 13a-15(f) and 15d-15(f)) for the company and have:

 

(a) Designed such disclosure controls and procedures, or caused such disclosure controls and procedures to be designed under our supervision, to ensure that material information relating to the company, including its consolidated subsidiaries, is made known to us by others within those entities, particularly during the period in which this report is being prepared;

 

(b) Designed such internal control over financial reporting, or caused such internal control over financial reporting to be designed under our supervision, to provide reasonable assurance regarding the reliability of financial reporting and the preparation of financial statements for external purposes in accordance with generally accepted accounting principles;

 

(c) Evaluated the effectiveness of the company’s disclosure controls and procedures and presented in this report our conclusions about the effectiveness of the disclosure controls and procedures, as of the end of the period covered by this report based on such evaluation; and

 

(d) Disclosed in this report any change in the company’s internal control over financial reporting that occurred during the period covered by the annual report that has materially affected, or is reasonably likely to materially affect, the company’s internal control over financial reporting; and

 

5. The company’s other certifying officer(s) and I have disclosed, based on our most recent evaluation of internal control over financial reporting, to the company’s auditors and the audit committee of the company’s board of directors (or persons performing the equivalent functions):

 

(a) All significant deficiencies and material weaknesses in the design or operation of internal control over financial reporting which are reasonably likely to adversely affect the company’s ability to record, process, summarize and report financial information; and

 

(b) Any fraud, whether or not material, that involves management or other employees who have a significant role in the company’s internal control over financial reporting.

 

Date: June 30, 2020

  

  /s/ Syed Masood
  Name: Syed Masood
  Title: Chief Financial Officer

  

Exhibit 13.1

 

Certification of Principal Executive Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350 as Adopted
Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

 

Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, I, Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper, the Chief Executive Officer of Brooge Energy Limited (the “Company”), hereby certify, that, to my knowledge:

 

1. The Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2019 (the “Report”) of the Company fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

 

2. The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

 

Date: June 30, 2020

 

  /s/ Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper
  Name: Nicolaas L. Paardenkooper
  Title: Chief Executive Officer

 

Exhibit 13.2

 

Certification of Principal Financial Officer Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350 as Adopted
Pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002

 

Pursuant to 18 U.S.C. Section 1350, as adopted pursuant to Section 906 of the Sarbanes-Oxley Act of 2002, I, Syed Masood, the Chief Financial Officer of Brooge Energy Limited (the “Company”), hereby certify, that, to my knowledge:

 

1. The Annual Report on Form 20-F for the year ended December 31, 2019 (the “Report”) of the Company fully complies with the requirements of Section 13(a) of the Securities Exchange Act of 1934; and

 

2. The information contained in the Report fairly presents, in all material respects, the financial condition and results of operations of the Company.

 

Date: June 30, 2020

 

  /s/ Syed Masood
  Name: Syed Masood
  Title: Chief Financial Officer

 

Exhibit 15.3

 

 

 

1185 Avenue of the Americas, 38th Floor

New York, NY 10036

     
  Phone 212-381-4800
  Fax 212-381-4811
  Web www.uhy-us.com

 

June 30, 2020

 

Office of the Chief Accountant

Securities and Exchange Commission

460 Fifth Street N. W.

Washington, DC 20549

 

Re: Brooge Energy Limited

 

Commission File Number: 001-39171

 

Dear Sirs:

 

We have received a copy of, and are in agreement with, the statements being made by Brooge Energy Limited in Item 16F of its Form 20-F dated June 30, 2020, captioned “Changes in Registrant’s Certifying Accountant.”

 

We hereby consent to the filing of this letter as an exhibit to the foregoing report on Form 20-F.

 

Sincerely,

 

 

 

 

 

 

A member of UHY International,

a network of independent accounting and consulting firms